consistently use @insertcopying, @direntry, @contents
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / calc.texi
CommitLineData
4009494e
GM
1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2@comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3@c smallbook
db78a8cb 4@setfilename ../../info/calc
4009494e 5@c [title]
5a83c46e 6@settitle GNU Emacs Calc Manual
4009494e
GM
7@setchapternewpage odd
8@comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
9
10@c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
11@c @texline foo
12@c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
13@c @infoline foo
14@c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
15
16@c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
17@c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
18
19@iftex
20@macro texline
21@end macro
22@alias infoline=comment
23@alias expr=math
24@alias tfn=code
25@alias mathit=expr
8dc6104d 26@alias summarykey=key
4009494e
GM
27@macro cpi{}
28@math{@pi{}}
29@end macro
30@macro cpiover{den}
31@math{@pi/\den\}
32@end macro
33@end iftex
34
35@ifnottex
36@alias texline=comment
37@macro infoline{stuff}
38\stuff\
39@end macro
40@alias expr=samp
41@alias tfn=t
42@alias mathit=i
8dc6104d
JB
43@macro summarykey{ky}
44\ky\
45@end macro
4009494e
GM
46@macro cpi{}
47@expr{pi}
48@end macro
49@macro cpiover{den}
50@expr{pi/\den\}
51@end macro
52@end ifnottex
53
54
55@tex
56% Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
57\gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
58@end tex
59
60@c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
61@iftex
62@finalout
63@mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
64@tex
65\gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
66
67\gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
68\gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
69\gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
70\gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
71@end tex
72@newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
73@newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
74@newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
75@ignore
76@newcount@calcpageno
77@newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
78@everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
79@ifx@turnoffactive@undefinedzzz@def@turnoffactive{}@fi
80@ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
81@catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
82\r@ggedbottomtrue
83\catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
84@end ignore
85@end iftex
86
87@copying
5a83c46e 88@ifinfo
4009494e 89This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
5a83c46e
JB
90@end ifinfo
91@ifnotinfo
92This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator, included with GNU Emacs 23.1.
93@end ifnotinfo
4009494e
GM
94
95Copyright @copyright{} 1990, 1991, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
6ed161e1 962005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4009494e
GM
97
98@quotation
99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
6a2c4aec 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
4009494e
GM
101any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
102Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
103Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
104Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section
105entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
106
6f093307
GM
107(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
108modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
109developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
4009494e
GM
110@end quotation
111@end copying
112
113@dircategory Emacs
114@direntry
115* Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
116@end direntry
117
118@titlepage
119@sp 6
120@center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
121@sp 4
5a83c46e 122@center GNU Emacs Calc
4009494e
GM
123@c [volume]
124@sp 5
125@center Dave Gillespie
126@center daveg@@synaptics.com
127@page
128
129@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
4009494e
GM
130@insertcopying
131@end titlepage
132
133
134@summarycontents
135
136@c [end]
137
138@contents
139
140@c [begin]
141@ifnottex
142@node Top, Getting Started, (dir), (dir)
143@chapter The GNU Emacs Calculator
144
145@noindent
146@dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
147written by Dave Gillespie that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
148
149This manual, also written (mostly) by Dave Gillespie, is divided into
150three major parts: ``Getting Started,'' the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the
151``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial introduces all the major aspects of
152Calculator use in an easy, hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is
153a complete reference to the features of the Calculator.
154@end ifnottex
155
156@ifinfo
157For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
158file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
159longer Info tutorial.)
160@end ifinfo
161
5dc584b5
KB
162@insertcopying
163
4009494e
GM
164@menu
165* Getting Started:: General description and overview.
166@ifinfo
167* Interactive Tutorial::
168@end ifinfo
169* Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
170
171* Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
172* Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
173* Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
174* Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
175* Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
176* Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
177* Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
178* Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
179* Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
180* Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
181* Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
182* Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
183* Keypad Mode:: Operating Calc from a keypad.
184* Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
185* Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
186
187* Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
188* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
189* Customizing Calc:: Customizing Calc.
190* Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
191
192* Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
193
194* Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
195* Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
196* Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
197* Concept Index:: General concepts.
198* Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
199* Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
200@end menu
201
202@ifinfo
203@node Getting Started, Interactive Tutorial, Top, Top
204@end ifinfo
205@ifnotinfo
206@node Getting Started, Tutorial, Top, Top
207@end ifnotinfo
208@chapter Getting Started
209@noindent
210This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
211Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
212and what are the various ways that it can be used.
213
214@menu
215* What is Calc::
216* About This Manual::
217* Notations Used in This Manual::
218* Demonstration of Calc::
219* Using Calc::
220* History and Acknowledgements::
221@end menu
222
223@node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
224@section What is Calc?
225
226@noindent
227@dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
228part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
229series of calculators, its many features include:
230
231@itemize @bullet
232@item
233Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
234
235@item
236Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
237
238@item
239Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
240error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
241and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
242and algebraic formulas.
243
244@item
245Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
246
247@item
248Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
249
250@item
251Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
252
253@item
254Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
255modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
256
257@item
258Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
259
260@item
261Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
262
263@item
264Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
265inside any editing buffer.
266
267@item
268Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
269
270@item
271Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
272algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
273@end itemize
274
275Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
276large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
277use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
278read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
279first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
280the program you can learn its additional features. Calc does not
281have the scope and depth of a fully-functional symbolic math package,
282but Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and freedom.
283
284@node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
285@section About This Manual
286
287@noindent
288This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
3bf8054f 289Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices and as
4009494e
GM
290a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
291experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
292this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
293regularly.
294
3bf8054f 295This manual is divided into three major parts:@: the ``Getting
4009494e
GM
296Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial (chapter 2),
297and the Calc reference manual (the remaining chapters and appendices).
298@c [when-split]
299@c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
300@c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
301@c chapter.
302
303If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
304below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
305pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
306will show you everything you need to know to begin.
307@xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
308
309The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
310with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
311to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
312beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
313with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
314Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
315to use its features.
316
317The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
318the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
319of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
320Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
321need to know.
322
17587b1b 323@c @cindex Marginal notes
4009494e
GM
324Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
325in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
326variables also have their own indices.
17587b1b
JB
327@c @texline Each
328@c @infoline In the printed manual, each
329@c paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
330@c in the margin with its index entry.
4009494e
GM
331
332@c [fix-ref Help Commands]
3bf8054f
JB
333You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by pressing
334the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window, you can press
335@kbd{C-x * i} to read the manual on-line. From within Calc the command
336@kbd{h t} will jump directly to the Tutorial; from outside of Calc the
337command @kbd{C-x * t} will jump to the Tutorial and start Calc if
338necessary. Pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{C-x * s} will take you directly
339to the Calc Summary. Within Calc, you can also go to the part of the
340manual describing any Calc key, function, or variable using
341@w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v}, respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
4009494e
GM
342
343@ifnottex
344The Calc manual can be printed, but because the manual is so large, you
345should only make a printed copy if you really need it. To print the
346manual, you will need the @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free
347program by Donald Knuth at Stanford University) as well as the
348@file{texindex} program and @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can
349be obtained from the FSF as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
350To print the Calc manual in one huge tome, you will need the
351source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
352Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
353Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
354source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
355get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
356The result will be a device-independent output file called
357@file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
358for your system. On many systems, the command is
359
360@example
361lpr -d calc.dvi
362@end example
363
364@noindent
365or
366
367@example
368dvips calc.dvi
369@end example
370@end ifnottex
371@c Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
372@c Foundation.
373
374@node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
375@section Notations Used in This Manual
376
377@noindent
378This section describes the various notations that are used
379throughout the Calc manual.
380
381In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
382the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
383held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
384are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
385Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
386@key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
387The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
388whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
389regularly using Emacs.
390
391(If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
392the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
393If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
394also press @key{ESC} or @kbd{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
395that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
396
397Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
398that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
399is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
400
401Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
402or @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
403normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{C-x * k} key sequence,
404but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
405
406Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
407are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
408the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
409the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
410be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
411
412A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
413[@code{sincos}].
414
415@node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
416@section A Demonstration of Calc
417
418@noindent
419@cindex Demonstration of Calc
420This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
421Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
422everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
423Tutorial.
424
425To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
426does this), and type @kbd{C-x * c} to start the
427Calculator. (You can also use @kbd{M-x calc} if this doesn't work.
428@xref{Starting Calc}, for various ways of starting the Calculator.)
429
430Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
431difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
432@key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
433Delete, and Space keys.
434
435@strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
436then the command to operate on the numbers.
437
438@noindent
439Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
440@texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
441@infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
442
443@noindent
444Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
445@texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
446@infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
447
448@noindent
449Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
450
451@noindent
452Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
453Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
454
455@noindent
456Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
457
458@strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
459conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
460use the apostrophe key.
461
462@noindent
463Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
464@texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
465@infoline the square root of 2+3.
466
467@noindent
468Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
469@texline @math{\pi^2}.
470@infoline `pi' squared.
471To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
472
473@noindent
474Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
475result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
476
477@strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
478@w{@kbd{C-x * k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
479the next section.)
480
481@noindent
482Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
483``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
484
485@noindent
486Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @tfn{y^x}.
487
488@noindent
489Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
490
491@noindent
492Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
493
494@noindent
495Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
496the Keypad Calculator off.
497
498@strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{C-x * x} if necessary to exit Calc.
499Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
500front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
501then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
502the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{C-x * i}}, or just
503type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{C-x * g} to
504``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
505
506@example
507@group
5081.23 1.97
5091.6 2
5101.19 1.08
511@end group
512@end example
513
514@noindent
515The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
516Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
517
518@noindent
519Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
520the product of the numbers.
521
522@noindent
523You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
524the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
525the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{C-x * r}.
526
527@noindent
528Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
529@texline @math{3\times2}
530@infoline 3x2
531matrix into a
532@texline @math{2\times3}
533@infoline 2x3
534matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
535vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
536of the two original columns. (There is also a special
537grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{C-x * :}.)
538
539@strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
540Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
541Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
542
543@strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
544time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
545@kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
546many weeks have passed since then.
547
548@strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
549or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
550to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
551(Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
3bf8054f 552in @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
4009494e
GM
553these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
554
555@noindent
556Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
557Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, @kbd{d T}
558to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system,
559and @kbd{d L} to view them in the notation for the La@TeX{} typesetting
560system. Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
561
562@noindent
563Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
3bf8054f 564(That's the letter @kbd{l}, not the numeral @kbd{1}.)
4009494e
GM
565
566@ifnotinfo
567@strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
568manual. Type @kbd{C-x * c} to return to Calc after each of these
569commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
570@kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
571@kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
572@end ifnotinfo
573@ifinfo
574@strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
575manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{C-x * c}, to
576return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
577about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
578@code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
579@end ifinfo
580
581Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
582To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again.
583
584@node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgements, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
585@section Using Calc
586
587@noindent
588Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
589different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
590there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
591
592@menu
593* Starting Calc::
594* The Standard Interface::
595* Quick Mode Overview::
596* Keypad Mode Overview::
597* Standalone Operation::
598* Embedded Mode Overview::
599* Other C-x * Commands::
600@end menu
601
602@node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
603@subsection Starting Calc
604
605@noindent
606On most systems, you can type @kbd{C-x *} to start the Calculator.
607The key sequence @kbd{C-x *} is bound to the command @code{calc-dispatch},
608which can be rebound if convenient (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
609
610When you press @kbd{C-x *}, Emacs waits for you to press a second key to
611complete the command. In this case, you will follow @kbd{C-x *} with a
612letter (upper- or lower-case, it doesn't matter for @kbd{C-x *}) that says
613which Calc interface you want to use.
614
615To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{C-x * c}. To get
616Keypad mode, type @kbd{C-x * k}. Type @kbd{C-x * ?} to get a brief
617list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
618a complete list.
619
620To ease typing, @kbd{C-x * *} also works to start Calc. It starts the
621same interface (either @kbd{C-x * c} or @w{@kbd{C-x * k}}) that you last
622used, selecting the @kbd{C-x * c} interface by default.
623
624If @kbd{C-x *} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
625commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
626@w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
627(that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
628type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
629
630The same commands (like @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}) that start
631the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
632
633@node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
634@subsection The Standard Calc Interface
635
636@noindent
637@cindex Standard user interface
638Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
639operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}
640to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
641with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
642
643@smallexample
644@group
645
646...
647--**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
648--- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calculator Trail
6492: 17.3 | 17.3
6501: -5 | 3
651 . | 2
652 | 4
653 | * 8
654 | ->-5
655 |
92e15881 656--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%*- *Calc Trail*
4009494e
GM
657@end group
658@end smallexample
659
660In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
661``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
662actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
663called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
664@dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
665calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
666record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
667a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
668you do.
669
670In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
671were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
672multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
673(The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
674The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
675
676Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
677there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
678the trail and retrieve any previous result.
679
680Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
681Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
682letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
683commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
684@kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
685the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
686``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
687
688There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
689window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
690@w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
691inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
692cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
693as Calc commands.
694
695When you quit by pressing @kbd{C-x * c} a second time, the Calculator
696windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
697hidden. When you press @kbd{C-x * c} once again you will get the
698same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
699Calculator.
700
701The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
702Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{C-x * c} will give you
703a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
704you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
705One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
706Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
707always treat @kbd{C-x * *} the same as @kbd{C-x * c}.
708
709The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
710
711If you type @kbd{C-x * b} first and then @kbd{C-x * c}, you get a
712full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
713trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
714Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again to quit,
715the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{C-x * b} key
716switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
717normal partial-screen mode.
718
719Finally, @kbd{C-x * o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{C-x * c}
720except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
3bf8054f
JB
721editing before remains selected instead. If you are in a Calc window,
722then @kbd{C-x * o} will switch you out of it, being careful not to
723switch you to the Calc Trail window. So @kbd{C-x * o} is a handy
724way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; you can then
725type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
4009494e
GM
726
727@node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
728@subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
729
730@noindent
731@dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
732full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{C-x * q}
733(@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
734
735Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
736standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
737the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
738in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
739were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{C-x * q}
740again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
741will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
742at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
743
744Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
745go into regular Calc (with @kbd{C-x * c}) to change the mode settings.
746
747@c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
748@xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
749
750@node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
751@subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
752
753@noindent
754@dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
755It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
756don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
757arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
758
759Type @kbd{C-x * k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
760get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
761instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
762Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
763
764@tex
765\dimen0=\pagetotal%
766\advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
767\ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
768\medskip
769@end tex
770@smallexample
771@group
772|--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
773|2: 17.3
774|1: -5
775| .
92e15881 776|--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
5a83c46e 777|----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
4009494e
GM
778|FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
779|----+----+----+----+----+----|
780| LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
781|----+----+----+----+----+----|
782|SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
783|----+----+----+----+----+----|
784| ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
785|-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
786| INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
787|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
788| HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
789|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
790|EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
791|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
792| OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
793|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
794@end group
795@end smallexample
796
797Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
798is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
799commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
800always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
801standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
802often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
803
804To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
805keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
806shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
807add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
808the stack).
809
810If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
811keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
812math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
813numbers.
814
815Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
816the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
817this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
818keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
819explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
820
821If you press @kbd{C-x * b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
822(@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
823left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
824
825@c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
826@xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
827
828@node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
829@subsection Standalone Operation
830
831@noindent
832@cindex Standalone Operation
833If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
834you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
835can give the commands:
836
837@example
838emacs -f full-calc
839@end example
840
841@noindent
842or
843
844@example
845emacs -f full-calc-keypad
846@end example
847
848@noindent
849which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * c}) or
850a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * k}).
851In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
852@kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
853itself.
854
855@node Embedded Mode Overview, Other C-x * Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
856@subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
857
858@noindent
859@dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
860editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
861document like this:
862
863@smallexample
864@group
865The derivative of
866
867 ln(ln(x))
868
869is
870@end group
871@end smallexample
872
873@noindent
874and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
875you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
876do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
3bf8054f
JB
877you want the result to be, leaving a blank line before and after the
878formula:
4009494e
GM
879
880@smallexample
881@group
882The derivative of
883
884 ln(ln(x))
885
886is
887
888 ln(ln(x))
889@end group
890@end smallexample
891
892Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{C-x * e}.
3bf8054f
JB
893Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to tell
894how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly) onto the Calc
895stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the editing buffer, but
896the line with the formula will now appear as it would on the Calc stack
897(in this case, it will be left-aligned) and the buffer's mode line will
898change to look like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like
899@samp{12 Deg} and so on). Even though you are still in your editing
900buffer, the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
901you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take the
902derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
4009494e
GM
903
904@smallexample
905@group
906The derivative of
907
908 ln(ln(x))
909
910is
911
9121 / ln(x) x
913@end group
914@end smallexample
915
5fafc247
JB
916(Note that by default, Calc gives division lower precedence than multiplication,
917so that @samp{1 / ln(x) x} is equivalent to @samp{1 / (ln(x) x)}.)
3bf8054f 918
4009494e
GM
919To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
920the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
921
922@smallexample
923@group
924The derivative of
925
926 ln(ln(x))
927
928is
929% [calc-mode: justify: center]
930% [calc-mode: language: big]
931
932 1
933 -------
934 ln(x) x
935@end group
936@end smallexample
937
938Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
939that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
940in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{} or
941La@TeX{}. (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want
942to move these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them
943out of the way.)
944
945As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
946righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
947
948@smallexample
949@group
950% [calc-mode: justify: center]
951% [calc-mode: language: big]
952% [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
953
954 1
955 ------- (1)
956 ln(x) x
957@end group
958@end smallexample
959
960To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{C-x * e} again. The mode line
961and keyboard will revert to the way they were before.
962
963The related command @kbd{C-x * w} operates on a single word, which
4a65fb7a
JB
964generally means a single number, inside text. It searches for an
965expression which ``looks'' like a number containing the point.
966Here's an example of its use:
4009494e
GM
967
968@smallexample
969A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
970@end smallexample
971
972Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{C-x * w} to enable
973Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
974and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
975then @w{@kbd{C-x * w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
976
977@smallexample
978A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
979@end smallexample
980
981@c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
982@xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
983
984@node Other C-x * Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
985@subsection Other @kbd{C-x *} Commands
986
987@noindent
988Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{C-x * g} and @kbd{C-x * r},
989which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
990Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
991a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
992cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
993
994The @kbd{C-x * g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
995top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
996of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
997user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
998to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
999@kbd{C-u C-x * g} interprets the region as a single number or
1000formula.
1001
1002The @kbd{C-x * r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
1003mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
1004is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
1005
1006Complementary to these is @kbd{C-x * y}, which ``yanks'' the
1007value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
1008If you type @w{@kbd{C-x * y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
1009yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{C-x * y} while
1010in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
1011editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
1012to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
1013is something on the Calc stack.
1014
1015Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{C-x *} commands.
1016The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1017following @kbd{C-x *}.
1018
1019@noindent
1020Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1021
1022@table @kbd
1023@item *
1024Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1025
1026@item =, +, -, /, \, &, #
1027Alternatives for @kbd{*}.
1028
1029@item C
1030Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1031interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1032in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1033
1034@item O
1035Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1036Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1037move it out of that window.
1038
1039@item B
1040Control whether @kbd{C-x * c} and @kbd{C-x * k} use the full screen.
1041
1042@item Q
1043Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1044
1045@item K
1046Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1047
1048@item E
1049Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1050
1051@item J
1052Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1053
1054@item W
1055Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1056
1057@item Z
1058Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1059
1060@item X
1061Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1062(This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1063@end table
1064@iftex
1065@sp 2
1066@end iftex
1067
1068@noindent
1069Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1070
1071@table @kbd
1072@item G
1073Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1074
1075@item R
1076Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1077
1078@item :
1079Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1080
1081@item _
1082Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1083
1084@item Y
1085Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1086@end table
1087@iftex
1088@sp 2
1089@end iftex
1090
1091@noindent
1092Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1093
1094@table @kbd
1095@item A
1096``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1097contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1098so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1099
1100@item D
1101Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1102the duplicate.
1103
1104@item F
1105Insert a new formula at the current point.
1106
1107@item N
1108Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1109
1110@item P
1111Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1112
1113@item U
1114Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1115
1116@item `
1117Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1118@end table
1119@iftex
1120@sp 2
1121@end iftex
1122
1123@noindent
1124Miscellaneous commands:
1125
1126@table @kbd
1127@item I
1128Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1129(This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1130
1131@item T
1132Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1133
1134@item S
1135Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1136
1137@item L
1138Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1139are loaded only as they are needed.)
1140
1141@item M
1142Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1143and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1144
1145@item 0
1146(This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1147its initial state: Empty stack, and initial mode settings.
1148@end table
1149
1150@node History and Acknowledgements, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1151@section History and Acknowledgements
1152
1153@noindent
1154Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1155in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1156the value of
1157@texline @math{2^{32}}.
1158@infoline @expr{2^32}.
1159I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1160@code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1161question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1162digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1163was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1164all.
1165
1166I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1167and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1168all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1169got too far out of hand.
1170
1171To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1172solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1173turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1174
1175Emacs Lisp didn't have built-in floating point math (now it does), so
4bb49b43
JB
1176this had to be simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers would
1177only comfortably fit six decimal digits or so---not enough for a decent
1178calculator. So I had to write my own high-precision integer code as
1179well, and once I had this I figured that arbitrary-size integers were
1180just as easy as large integers. Arbitrary floating-point precision was
1181the logical next step. Also, since the large integer arithmetic was
1182there anyway it seemed only fair to give the user direct access to it,
1183which in turn made it practical to support fractions as well as floats.
1184All these features inspired me to look around for other data types that
1185might be worth having.
4009494e
GM
1186
1187Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1188calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1189numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I
1190decided that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once
1191things had gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at
1192serious algebra systems for further ideas. Since these systems did
1193far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided to focus on
1194rewrite rules and other programming features so that users could
1195implement what they needed for themselves.
1196
1197Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1198format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1199was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1200
1201Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1202bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1203including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1204
1205Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1206Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1207expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1208idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1209back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1210algebra system for microcomputers.
1211
1212Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1213features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1214who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1215rules, and many other algebra features;
1216@texline Fran\c{c}ois
1217@infoline Francois
1218Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1219as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1220Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1221errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1222Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1223algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
f10d0e80 1224Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Juha
4009494e 1225Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
f10d0e80
JB
1226parts; Bob Weiner, who helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port; and
1227Robert J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises as
1228well as many other things.
4009494e
GM
1229
1230@cindex Bibliography
1231@cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1232@cindex Numerical Recipes
1233@c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1234Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1235of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1236Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1237and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis
1238for the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham,
1239Knuth, and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the
1240@emph{CRC Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and
1241Abramowitz and Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical
1242Functions}. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written without
1243the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil Lewis and
1244Dan LaLiberte.
1245
1246Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1247of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1248finished in two weeks.
1249
1250@c [tutorial]
1251
1252@ifinfo
1253@c This node is accessed by the `C-x * t' command.
1254@node Interactive Tutorial, Tutorial, Getting Started, Top
1255@chapter Tutorial
1256
1257@noindent
1258Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1259
1260Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1261section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1262for this).
1263
1264Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1265If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1266or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1267go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1268
1269Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1270appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1271the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1272you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1273@kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1274
1275You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1276
59ee4113 1277Press the number @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
4009494e
GM
1278
1279@menu
1280* Tutorial::
1281@end menu
1282
1283@node Tutorial, Introduction, Interactive Tutorial, Top
1284@end ifinfo
1285@ifnotinfo
1286@node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1287@end ifnotinfo
1288@chapter Tutorial
1289
1290@noindent
1291This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1292a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1293work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1294If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1295@c [not-split]
1296to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1297@c [when-split]
1298@c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1299
1300@c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1301This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1302The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1303self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1304the Embedded mode interface.
1305
1306The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
59ee4113
JB
1307your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. Press
1308@kbd{C-x * t} to set this up; the on-line tutorial will be opened in the
1309current window and Calc will be started in another window. From the
1310Info window, the command @kbd{C-x * c} can be used to switch to the Calc
1311window and @kbd{C-x * o} can be used to switch back to the Info window.
1312(If you have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead; in
1313that case you only need to press @kbd{C-x * c} to start Calc.)
4009494e
GM
1314
1315This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1316manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1317does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1318general areas.
1319
1320@ifnottex
1321You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1322it as you learn Calc. @xref{About This Manual}, to see how to make a
1323printed summary. @xref{Summary}.
1324@end ifnottex
1325@iftex
1326The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1327space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1328Calc.
1329@end iftex
1330
1331@menu
1332* Basic Tutorial::
1333* Arithmetic Tutorial::
1334* Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1335* Types Tutorial::
1336* Algebra Tutorial::
1337* Programming Tutorial::
1338
1339* Answers to Exercises::
1340@end menu
1341
1342@node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1343@section Basic Tutorial
1344
1345@noindent
1346In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1347work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1348to control various modes of the Calculator.
1349
1350@menu
1351* RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1352* Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1353* Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1354* Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1355@end menu
1356
1357@node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1358@subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1359
1360@cindex RPN notation
1361@ifnottex
1362@noindent
1363Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1364system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1365(Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1366Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1367@end ifnottex
1368@tex
1369\noindent
1370Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1371system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1372(Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1373Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1374@end tex
1375
1376The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1377calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1378added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1379from the top of the stack.
1380
1381@cindex Operators
1382@cindex Operands
1383In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1384and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1385enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1386number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1387When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1388number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1389
1390Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1391@kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1392the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1393you wish; type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1394@kbd{C-x * c} again or @kbd{C-x * o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1395The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1396The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1397and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1398will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1399
1400@smallexample
1401@group
1402 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1403 . 1: 3 .
1404 .
1405
1406 C-x * c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1407@end group
1408@end smallexample
1409
1410The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1411Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1412the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1413less distracting in regular use.
1414
1415@cindex Stack levels
1416@cindex Levels of stack
1417The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1418numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1419@expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1420as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1421stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1422which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1423work on the top few levels of the stack.
1424
1425@c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1426The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1427it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1428cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1429view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1430before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1431upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1432commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1433we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1434if you are interested.
1435
1436You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1437@key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1438other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1439automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1440Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1441
1442Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1443stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1444
1445@smallexample
1446@group
14471: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1448 . 1: 3 .
1449 .
1450
1451 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1452@end group
1453@end smallexample
1454
1455@noindent
1456Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1457with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1458press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1459
1460(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1461at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1462are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1463include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1464reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1465exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1466return to where you were.)
1467
1468@noindent
1469Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1470@key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1471multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1472if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1473
1474(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1475@texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.4) + {5\over4}}
1476@infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1477using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1478
1479The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1480whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1481regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1482top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1483the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1484in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1485results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1486In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1487clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1488
1489(It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1490whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1491spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1492
1493Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1494stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1495the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1496So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1497will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1498
1499You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1500the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1501from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1502
1503@cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1504If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1505is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1506
1507@smallexample
1508@group
15091: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1510 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1511 . .
1512
1513 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1514@end group
1515@end smallexample
1516
1517@noindent
1518(Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1519to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1520
1521The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1522as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1523the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1524
1525@cindex Exchanging stack entries
1526Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1527two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1528to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1529was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1530
1531@smallexample
1532@group
15331: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1534 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1535 . .
1536
1537 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1538@end group
1539@end smallexample
1540
1541@noindent
1542Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1543
1544@smallexample
1545@group
15461: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1547 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1548 . 1: 3 .
1549 .
1550
1551 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1552@end group
1553@end smallexample
1554
1555A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1556@key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1557bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1558
1559@smallexample
1560@group
15611: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1562 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1563 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1564 . . .
1565
1566 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1567@end group
1568@end smallexample
1569
1570(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1571on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1572without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1573one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1574
1575Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1576arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1577@kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1578think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1579
1580@smallexample
1581@group
15821: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1583 . . 1: 16 . .
1584 .
1585
1586 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1587@end group
1588@end smallexample
1589
1590@noindent
1591(Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1592typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1593
1594@cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1595Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1596right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1597@kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1598We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1599
1600@smallexample
1601@group
16021: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1603 . 1: 4 .
1604 .
1605
1606 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1607@end group
1608@end smallexample
1609
1610All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1611gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1612like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1613prefix for you:
1614
1615@smallexample
1616@group
16171: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1618 . 1: 4 .
1619 .
1620
1621 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1622@end group
1623@end smallexample
1624
1625What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1626
1627@smallexample
1628@group
16291: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1630 . . .
1631
1632 4 @key{RET} n Q
1633@end group
1634@end smallexample
1635
1636@noindent
1637The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1638Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1639Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1640@expr{(a, b)} notation.
1641
1642If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1643feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1644errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1645taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1646complex result.)
1647
1648Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1649@kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1650
1651@smallexample
1652@group
16531: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1654 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1655 . .
1656
1657 ( 2 , 3 )
1658@end group
1659@end smallexample
1660
1661You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1662However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1663
1664@smallexample
1665@group
16661: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1667 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1668 . 1: 3 . .
1669 .
1670 (error)
1671 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1672@end group
1673@end smallexample
1674
1675@noindent
1676Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1677produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1678
1679Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1680moved around by the regular stack commands.
1681
1682@smallexample
1683@group
16842: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
16851: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1686 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1687 . . .
1688
16892 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1690@end group
1691@end smallexample
1692
1693@noindent
1694Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1695When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1696entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1697to use the comma. It's up to you.
1698
1699(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1700your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1701(Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1702keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1703@xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1704
1705Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1706brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1707the tutorial.
1708
1709Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1710typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1711awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1712necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1713@kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1714prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1715on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1716
1717@smallexample
1718@group
17191: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1720 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1721 . 1: 30 1: 30
1722 . .
1723
1724 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1725@end group
1726@end smallexample
1727
1728For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1729prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1730negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1731argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1732the second-to-top element of the stack:
1733
1734@smallexample
1735@group
17361: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1737 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1738 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1739 . . 1: 20
1740 .
1741
1742 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1743@end group
1744@end smallexample
1745
1746@cindex Clearing the stack
1747@cindex Emptying the stack
1748Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1749(The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1750entire stack.)
1751
1752@node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1753@subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1754
1755@noindent
1756If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1757Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1758non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1759in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1760
5fafc247
JB
1761@strong{Notice:} Calc gives @samp{/} lower precedence than @samp{*}, so
1762that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}; this is not
1763standard across all computer languages. See below for details.
4009494e
GM
1764
1765You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1766You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1767key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1768The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1769If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1770computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1771@key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1772
1773Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1774The result should be the number 9.
1775
1776Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1777@samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1778of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1779evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1780@samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1781
1782@example
17832 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1784@end example
1785
1786@noindent
1787is equivalent to
1788
1789@example
17902 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1791@end example
1792
1793@noindent
1794or, in large mathematical notation,
1795
1796@ifnottex
1797@example
1798@group
1799 3 * 4 * 5
18002 + --------- - 9
1801 8
1802 6 * 7
1803@end group
1804@end example
1805@end ifnottex
1806@tex
1807\turnoffactive
1808\beforedisplay
1809$$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1810\afterdisplay
1811@end tex
1812
1813@noindent
1814The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1815
1816Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
1817except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
1818example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
1819can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
1820
1821Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
1822that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
1823equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
1824to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
1825
1826If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
1827Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
1828when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
1829mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
1830should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
1831
1832Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
1833
1834In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
1835entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
1836key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
1837an algebraic entry.
1838
1839Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
1840must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
1841the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
1842@code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
1843the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
1844
1845Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
1846be @expr{0.16227766017}.
1847
1848Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
1849the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
1850out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
1851command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
1852rule to use!
1853
1854Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
1855form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
1856distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
1857
1858Still in Algebraic mode, type:
1859
1860@smallexample
1861@group
18621: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
1863 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
1864 . .
1865
1866 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
1867@end group
1868@end smallexample
1869
1870Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
1871an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
1872after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
1873
1874(You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
1875mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
1876though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
1877Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
1878normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
1879to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
1880mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
1881
1882If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
1883
1884Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
1885In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
1886use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
1887use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
1888intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
1889accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
1890of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
1891In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
1892of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
1893@texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
1894@infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
1895which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
1896@kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
1897
1898@smallexample
1899@group
19001: 8 1: 9 1: 3
1901 . . .
1902
1903 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
1904@end group
1905@end smallexample
1906
1907@noindent
1908Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
1909because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
1910
1911(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
1912pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
1913if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
1914@xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1915
1916The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
1917entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
1918
1919Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
1920variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
1921@key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
1922@kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
1923on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
1924stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
1925or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
1926
1927@smallexample
1928@group
19291: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
1930 . . .
1931
1932 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
1933@end group
1934@end smallexample
1935
1936@noindent
1937The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
1938variables by the values that were stored in them.
1939
1940For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
1941stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
1942or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
1943
1944@smallexample
1945@group
19461: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
1947 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
1948 . 1: 2 .
1949 .
1950
1951 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
1952@end group
1953@end smallexample
1954
1955If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
1956get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
1957They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
1958@code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
1959simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
1960@kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
1961
1962Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
1963values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
1964
1965@smallexample
1966@group
19671: 2 a + 2 b 1: 34 + 2 b
1968 . .
1969
1970 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
1971@end group
1972@end smallexample
1973
1974Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
1975alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
1976
1977@smallexample
1978@group
19791: 2 + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3)
1980 .
1981
1982 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
1983@end group
1984@end smallexample
1985
1986@noindent
1987In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
1988calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
1989undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
1990is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
1991fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
1992``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
1993Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
1994have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
1995``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
1996automatically displays the first message only if the message is
1997sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
1998of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
1999report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
2000will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
2001
2002(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
2003stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
2004@samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
2005expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
2006@xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2007
2008(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
2009@kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
2010@xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2011
2012One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
2013@dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
2014Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
2015the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
2016command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
2017the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
2018between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
2019the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2020
2021@smallexample
2022@group
20232: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
20241: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2025 . .
2026
2027' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2028@end group
2029@end smallexample
2030
2031@noindent
2032Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2033@samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2034were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2035set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2036to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2037
2038You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2039
2040@smallexample
2041@group
20422: 2 + 5 => 5
20431: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2044 .
2045
2046 s u a @key{RET}
2047@end group
2048@end smallexample
2049
2050We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2051when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2052
2053@node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2054@subsection Undo and Redo
2055
2056@noindent
2057If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2058the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2059and restart Calc (@kbd{C-x * * C-x * *}) to make sure things start off
2060with a clean slate. Now:
2061
2062@smallexample
2063@group
20641: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2065 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2066 . .
2067
2068 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2069@end group
2070@end smallexample
2071
2072You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2073all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2074above example, you could type:
2075
2076@smallexample
2077@group
20781: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2079 . 1: 3 .
2080 .
2081 (error)
2082 U U U U
2083@end group
2084@end smallexample
2085
2086You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2087mistakenly.
2088
2089@smallexample
2090@group
2091 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2092 . 1: 3 . .
2093 .
2094 (error)
2095 D D D D
2096@end group
2097@end smallexample
2098
2099@noindent
2100It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2101by something other than an undo command.
2102
2103@cindex Time travel
2104You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2105@kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2106backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2107reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2108again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2109was an earlier undo command.
2110
2111You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2112the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2113did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2114press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2115
2116Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2117undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2118@kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2119@samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2120entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2121Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2122@expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2123stack.
2124
2125If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2126went into the trail.
2127
2128Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2129a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2130what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2131(which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2132The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2133the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2134incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2135continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2136
2137To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2138search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2139can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2140remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2141then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2142
2143You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2144the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2145all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2146enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2147two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2148key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2149to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2150anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2151followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2152so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2153You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2154
2155Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2156
2157@smallexample
2158trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2159@end smallexample
2160
2161@noindent
2162The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2163trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2164with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2165that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2166@kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2167again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2168are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2169
2170When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2171still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2172it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2173was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2174the prefix.
2175
2176One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2177The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2178directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2179to edit a stack entry.
2180
2181Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2182@cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2183Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2184the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2185press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2186new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2187of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2188during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2189
2190@node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2191@subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2192
2193@noindent
2194Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2195your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2196mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2197try some of the most common ones here.
2198
2199Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2200Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2201
2202@smallexample
92e15881 2203--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
4009494e
GM
2204@end smallexample
2205
2206@noindent
2207Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2208about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2209The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
221012 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2211we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2212leading and trailing zeros.
2213
2214You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2215then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2216then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2217
2218@smallexample
2219@group
22201: 0.142857142857
22212: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2222 .
2223@end group
2224@end smallexample
2225
2226Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2227has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2228all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2229Calc has to stop somewhere.
2230
2231Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2232Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2233
2234Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2235though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2236we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2237down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2238duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2239key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2240But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2241
2242@smallexample
2243@group
22441: 0.142857142857
22452: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
22463: 1.14285714286
2247 .
2248@end group
2249@end smallexample
2250
2251@noindent
2252In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2253digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2254
2255How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2256answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2257@dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2258that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2259``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2260itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2261have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2262If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2263correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2264use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2265arithmetic.
2266
2267You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2268floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2269to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2270
2271Let's try entering that last calculation:
2272
2273@smallexample
2274@group
22751: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2276 . 1: 10000 .
2277 .
2278
2279 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2280@end group
2281@end smallexample
2282
2283@noindent
2284@cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2285Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2286power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2287number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2288want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2289
2290@smallexample
2291@group
22921: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2293 . 1: 10000. .
2294 .
2295
2296 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2297@end group
2298@end smallexample
2299
2300@cindex Round-off errors
2301@noindent
2302Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2303of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2304exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2305a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2306number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2307multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2308power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2309a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2310one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2311out:
2312
2313@smallexample
2314@group
2315 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2316 . 1: 10000. .
2317 .
2318
2319 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2320@end group
2321@end smallexample
2322
2323@noindent
2324@cindex Guard digits
2325Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2326calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2327have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2328no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2329accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2330last place.
2331
2332@cindex Guard digits
2333Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2334precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2335In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2336its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2337afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2338wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2339never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2340
2341What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2342We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2343formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2344@dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2345notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2346@kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2347supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2348should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2349onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2350use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2351numbers shown here:
2352
2353@smallexample
2354@group
23554: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
23563: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
23572: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
23581: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2359 . . . . .
2360
2361 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2362@end group
2363@end smallexample
2364
2365@noindent
2366Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2367to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2368five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2369affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2370displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2371of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2372
2373Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2374except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2375a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2376there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2377
2378Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2379in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2380so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2381prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2382mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2383
2384@smallexample
2385@group
23864: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
23873: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
23882: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
23891: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2390 . . . . .
2391
2392 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2393@end group
2394@end smallexample
2395
2396@noindent
2397Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2398updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2399causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2400entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2401whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2402format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2403the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2404
2405Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2406of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2407displayed exactly.
2408
2409@cindex Large numbers, readability
2410Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2411the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2412
2413@example
24142417851639229258349412352
2415@end example
2416
2417@noindent
2418Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2419
2420@example
24212,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2422@end example
2423
2424@noindent
2425Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2426We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2427people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2428
2429@example
243024178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2431@end example
2432
2433Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2434First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2435to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2436
2437@example
243824,17851,63922.9258349412352
2439@end example
2440
2441@noindent
2442The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2443@kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2444
2445@example
244624,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2447@end example
2448
2449If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2450changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2451
2452@example
245324 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2454@end example
2455
2456Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2457@kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2458restore the default precision.
2459
2460Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2461(Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2462you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2463Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2464
2465@example
246616#200000000000000000000
2467@end example
2468
2469@noindent
2470The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2471Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2472got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2473In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2474form:
2475
2476@example
24772#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2478@end example
2479
2480@noindent
2481We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2482fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2483scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2484stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2485something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2486stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2487
2488You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2489Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2490binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2491lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2492help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2493
2494@example
24952#101,1111,1110
2496@end example
2497
2498Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2499is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2500other radix.
2501
2502Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2503
2504@example
25051,534
2506@end example
2507
2508Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2509just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2510in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2511to integers, fractions, and floats.
2512
2513@cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2514(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2515as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2516@samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2517that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2518@samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2519saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2520@samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2521@xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2522
2523@cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2524(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2525modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2526a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2527Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2528@samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2529What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2530work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2531
2532The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2533Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2534modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2535the way they are actually computed.
2536
2537The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2538the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2539a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2540angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2541
2542@smallexample
2543@group
25441: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2545 . . . .
2546
2547 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2548@end group
2549@end smallexample
2550
2551@noindent
2552The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2553of 45 degrees is
2554@texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2555@infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2556squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2557roundoff error because the representation of
2558@texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2559@infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2560wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2561in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2562re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2563
2564@cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2565(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2566of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2567result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2568What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2569
2570To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2571(The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2572@cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2573again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2574@kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2575
2576@smallexample
2577@group
25781: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2579 . . .
2580
2581 P 4 / m r S
2582@end group
2583@end smallexample
2584
2585Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2586either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2587
2588@smallexample
2589@group
25901: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2591 . . .
2592
2593 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2594@end group
2595@end smallexample
2596
2597@noindent
2598Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2599@texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2600@infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2601first in radians, then in degrees.
2602
2603Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2604and vice-versa.
2605
2606@smallexample
2607@group
26081: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2609 . . .
2610
2611 45 c r c d
2612@end group
2613@end smallexample
2614
2615Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2616dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2617quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2618causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2619number, instead.
2620
2621@smallexample
2622@group
26232: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
26241: 9 . .
2625 .
2626
2627 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2628@end group
2629@end smallexample
2630
2631@noindent
2632In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2633In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2634
2635You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2636(Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2637because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2638elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2639produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2640what to do when dividing two integers.
2641
2642@cindex Fractions vs. floats
2643@cindex Floats vs. fractions
2644(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2645why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2646@xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2647
2648Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2649In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2650again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2651evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2652recompute for you.
2653
2654@smallexample
2655@group
26561: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2657 . . .
2658
2659 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2660@end group
2661@end smallexample
2662
2663@noindent
2664In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2665on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2666again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2667on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2668might affect their values.
2669
2670@node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2671@section Arithmetic Tutorial
2672
2673@noindent
2674In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2675available in the Calculator.
2676
2677The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2678and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2679and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2680change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2681
2682@smallexample
2683@group
26841: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2685 . . . . .
2686
2687 5 & & n n
2688@end group
2689@end smallexample
2690
2691@cindex Binary operators
2692You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2693stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2694pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2695a negative prefix.
2696
2697@smallexample
2698@group
26993: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
27002: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
27011: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2702 . . 1: 10 .
2703 .
2704
27052 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2706@end group
2707@end smallexample
2708
2709@cindex Unary operators
2710You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2711stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2712
2713@smallexample
2714@group
27153: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
27162: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
27171: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2718 . . .
2719
27202 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2721@end group
2722@end smallexample
2723
2724Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2725We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2726``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2727integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2728integer.
2729
2730@smallexample
2731@group
27327: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
27336: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
27345: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
27354: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
27363: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
27372: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
27381: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2739 . . .
2740
2741 M-7 F U M-7 R
2742@end group
2743@end smallexample
2744
2745Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2746common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2747backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2748computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2749the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2750
2751@smallexample
2752@group
27532: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
27541: 100 . 1: 100 .
2755 . .
2756
27571234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2758@end group
2759@end smallexample
2760
2761These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2762
2763@smallexample
2764@group
27652: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
27661: 1 . 1: 1 .
2767 . .
2768
27693.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2770@end group
2771@end smallexample
2772
2773(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2774frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2775of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2776Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2777provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2778
2779We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2780commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2781@kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2782logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2783@kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2784
2785Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2786identity
2787@texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2788@infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2789We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2790With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2791
2792@smallexample
2793@group
27942: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
27951: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2796 . . . .
2797
2798 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2799@end group
2800@end smallexample
2801
2802@noindent
2803(For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2804You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2805
2806Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2807of squares, command.
2808
2809Another identity is
2810@texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2811@infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2812@smallexample
2813@group
2814
28152: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
28161: 0.43837 . .
2817 .
2818
2819 U / I T
2820@end group
2821@end smallexample
2822
2823A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
2824@expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
2825your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
2826we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
2827
2828@smallexample
2829@group
28302: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
28311: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
2832 . .
2833
2834 U U M-2 n / I T
2835@end group
2836@end smallexample
2837
2838@noindent
2839How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
2840loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
2841is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
2842can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
2843computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
2844Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
2845to give you a full 360-degree answer.
2846
2847@smallexample
2848@group
28492: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
28501: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
2851 . 1: 0.43837 .
2852 .
2853
2854 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
2855@end group
2856@end smallexample
2857
2858@noindent
2859The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
2860point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
2861
2862The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
2863``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
2864restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
2865the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
2866where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
2867have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
2868the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
2869@kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
2870
2871A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
2872except that it is the @emph{difference}
2873@texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
2874@infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
2875that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
2876
2877@smallexample
2878@group
28792: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
28801: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
2881 . . . . .
2882
2883 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
2884@end group
2885@end smallexample
2886
2887@noindent
2888@cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2889Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
2890the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
2891numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
2892place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
2893error.
2894
2895We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
2896say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
2897enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
28980.99999, reasonably close to 1.
2899
2900Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
2901a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
2902
2903@cindex Common logarithm
2904Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
2905The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
2906@expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
2907prefix.
2908
2909@smallexample
2910@group
29111: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
2912 . . . .
2913
2914 1000 L U H L
2915@end group
2916@end smallexample
2917
2918@noindent
2919First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
2920and compute a common logarithm instead.
2921
2922The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
2923value of @var{b}.
2924
2925@smallexample
2926@group
29272: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
29281: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
2929 . .
2930
2931 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
2932@end group
2933@end smallexample
2934
2935@noindent
2936Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
2937the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
29381000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
2939that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
2940onto the stack.
2941
2942You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
2943of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
2944an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
2945where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
2946floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
2947computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
2948exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
2949a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
2950not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
2951probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
2952
2953(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
2954the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
2955result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2956
2957The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
2958and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
2959which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
2960
2961@smallexample
2962@group
29631: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
2964 . . . .
2965
2966 100 ! U c f !
2967@end group
2968@end smallexample
2969
2970@noindent
2971Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
2972top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
2973of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
2974accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
2975exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
2976in this case).
2977
2978If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
2979factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
2980@texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
2981@infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
2982(which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
2983
2984@smallexample
2985@group
29863: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
29872: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
29881: 5. 1: 120.
2989 . .
2990
2991 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
2992@end group
2993@end smallexample
2994
2995@noindent
2996Here we verify the identity
2997@texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
2998@infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
2999
3000The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
3001@texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
3002is defined by
3003@texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
3004@infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
3005for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
3006formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
3007@kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
3008large intermediate values.
3009
3010The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
3011combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
3012coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
3013
3014@smallexample
3015@group
30162: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
30171: 20 . .
3018 .
3019
3020 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3021@end group
3022@end smallexample
3023
3024@noindent
a8b14149
JB
3025You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{V R *} to multiply
3026together the elements of this vector. The result is the original
3027number, 30045015.
4009494e
GM
3028
3029@cindex Hash tables
3030Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
303110000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3032of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3033
3034@smallexample
3035@group
30361: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3037 . . .
3038
3039 10000 k n I k n
3040@end group
3041@end smallexample
3042
3043@noindent
3044Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
304510000.
3046
3047@c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3048@xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3049commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3050like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3051
3052@c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3053@xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3054on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3055
3056@node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3057@section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3058
3059@noindent
3060A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3061Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3062are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3063a vector as a list of objects.
3064
3065@menu
3066* Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3067* Matrix Tutorial::
3068* List Tutorial::
3069@end menu
3070
3071@node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3072@subsection Vector Analysis
3073
3074@noindent
3075If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3076elements, taken pairwise.
3077
3078@smallexample
3079@group
30801: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3081 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3082 .
3083
3084 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3085@end group
3086@end smallexample
3087
3088@noindent
3089Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3090spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3091algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3092vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3093
3094If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3095of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3096of the vectors.
3097
3098@smallexample
3099@group
31002: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
31011: [7, 6, 0] .
3102 .
3103
3104 r 1 r 2 *
3105@end group
3106@end smallexample
3107
3108@cindex Dot product
3109The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3110lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3111is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3112specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3113(absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3114vector.
3115
3116@smallexample
3117@group
31183: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
31192: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
31201: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3121 . .
3122
3123 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3124@end group
3125@end smallexample
3126
3127@noindent
3128First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3129we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3130obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3131by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3132The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3133is about 56 degrees.
3134
3135@cindex Cross product
3136@cindex Perpendicular vectors
3137The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3138is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3139angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3140input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3141defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3142our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3143
3144@smallexample
3145@group
31462: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
31471: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3148 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3149 .
3150
3151 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3152@end group
3153@end smallexample
3154
3155@noindent
3156First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3157which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3158by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3159this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3160
3161@c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3162Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3163Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3164to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3165the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3166prefix keys have this property.)
3167
3168If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3169to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3170that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3171
3172@smallexample
3173@group
31742: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
31751: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3176 . .
3177
3178 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3179@end group
3180@end smallexample
3181
3182@cindex Normalizing a vector
3183@cindex Unit vectors
3184(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3185stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3186vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3187direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3188
3189(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3190at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3191those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3192probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3193Find the average position of the particle.
3194@xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3195
3196@node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3197@subsection Matrices
3198
3199@noindent
3200A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3201This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3202also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3203both methods here:
3204
3205@smallexample
3206@group
32071: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3208 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3209 . .
3210
3211 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3212@end group
3213@end smallexample
3214
3215@noindent
3216We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3217
3218Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3219better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3220the second example.
3221
3222When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3223the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3224Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3225dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3226of the right matrix.
3227
3228If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3229the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3230
3231@smallexample
3232@group
32331: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3234 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3235 .
3236
3237 @key{RET} *
3238@end group
3239@end smallexample
3240
3241@noindent
3242Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3243of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3244been left in symbolic form.
3245
3246We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3247
3248@smallexample
3249@group
32502: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3251 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
32521: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3253 [ 2, 5 ] .
3254 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3255 .
3256
3257 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3258@end group
3259@end smallexample
3260
3261Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3262order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3263matrix, as happened here!
3264
3265If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3266single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3267on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3268as a row or column as appropriate.
3269
3270@smallexample
3271@group
32722: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3273 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
32741: [1, 2, 3]
3275 .
3276
3277 r 4 r 1 *
3278@end group
3279@end smallexample
3280
3281Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3282rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3283vector.
3284
3285(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3286of the above
3287@texline @math{2\times3}
3288@infoline 2x3
3289matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3290to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3291@xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3292
3293@cindex Identity matrix
3294An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3295diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3296by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3297the original matrix.
3298
3299@smallexample
3300@group
33011: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3302 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3303 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3304 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3305 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3306 .
3307
3308 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3309@end group
3310@end smallexample
3311
3312If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3313that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3314an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3315inverse of a matrix.
3316
3317@smallexample
3318@group
33191: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3320 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3321 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3322 . .
3323
3324 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3325@end group
3326@end smallexample
3327
3328@noindent
3329The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3330matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3331our matrix to make it square.
3332
3333We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3334
3335@smallexample
3336@group
33371: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3338 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3339 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3340 . .
3341
3342 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3343@end group
3344@end smallexample
3345
3346@cindex Systems of linear equations
3347@cindex Linear equations, systems of
3348Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3349Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3350
3351@ifnottex
3352@group
3353@example
3354 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3355 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3356 7a + 6b = 3
3357@end example
3358@end group
3359@end ifnottex
3360@tex
3361\turnoffactive
3362\beforedisplayh
3363$$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3364\halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3365 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3366 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3367 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3368 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3369 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3370 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3371$$
3372\afterdisplayh
3373@end tex
3374
3375@noindent
3376This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3377
3378@ifnottex
3379@group
3380@example
3381 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3382 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3383 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3384@end example
3385@end group
3386@end ifnottex
3387@tex
3388\turnoffactive
3389\beforedisplay
3390$$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3391 \times
3392 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3393$$
3394\afterdisplay
3395@end tex
3396
3397We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3398inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3399
3400@smallexample
3401@group
34022: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
34031: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3404 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3405 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3406 .
3407
3408 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3409@end group
3410@end smallexample
3411
3412@noindent
3413The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3414(Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3415inverse.)
3416
3417Let's verify this solution:
3418
3419@smallexample
3420@group
34212: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3422 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3423 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
34241: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3425 .
3426
3427 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3428@end group
3429@end smallexample
3430
3431@noindent
3432Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3433the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3434assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3435come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3436don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3437vectors, use explicit
3438@texline @math{N\times1}
3439@infoline Nx1
3440or
3441@texline @math{1\times N}
3442@infoline 1xN
3443matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3444vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3445
3446(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3447vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3448system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3449in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3450
3451@ifnottex
3452@group
3453@example
3454 x + a y = 6
3455 x + b y = 10
3456@end example
3457@end group
3458@end ifnottex
3459@tex
3460\turnoffactive
3461\beforedisplay
3462$$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3463 x &+ b y = 10}
3464$$
3465\afterdisplay
3466@end tex
3467
3468@noindent
3469@xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3470
3471@cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3472@cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3473(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3474if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3475there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3476equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3477which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3478you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3479is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3480only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3481on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3482@ifnottex
3483@samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3484@end ifnottex
3485@tex
3486\turnoffactive
3487$A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3488@end tex
3489Now
3490@texline @math{A^T A}
3491@infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3492is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3493@expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3494solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3495of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3496system:
3497
3498@ifnottex
3499@group
3500@example
3501 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3502 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3503 7a + 6b = 3
3504 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3505@end example
3506@end group
3507@end ifnottex
3508@tex
3509\turnoffactive
3510\beforedisplayh
3511$$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3512\halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3513 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3514 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3515 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3516 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3517 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3518 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3519 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3520$$
3521\afterdisplayh
3522@end tex
3523
3524@noindent
3525@xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3526
3527@node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3528@subsection Vectors as Lists
3529
3530@noindent
3531@cindex Lists
3532Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3533matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3534simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3535command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3536number.
3537
3538You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3539
3540@smallexample
3541@group
35423: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
35432: 20 . 2: 20
35441: 30 1: 30
3545 . .
3546
3547 M-3 v p v u
3548@end group
3549@end smallexample
3550
3551You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3552of many copies of a given value:
3553
3554@smallexample
3555@group
35561: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3557 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3558 . .
3559
3560 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3561@end group
3562@end smallexample
3563
3564You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3565@dfn{map} command.
3566
3567@smallexample
3568@group
35691: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3570 . . .
3571
3572 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3573@end group
3574@end smallexample
3575
3576@noindent
3577In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3578of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3579the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3580vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3581other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3582of each element.
3583
3584(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3585from
3586@texline @math{2^{-4}}
3587@infoline @expr{2^-4}
3588to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3589
3590You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3591For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3592elements in the vector:
3593
3594@smallexample
3595@group
35961: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3597 . . .
3598
3599 123123 k f V R *
3600@end group
3601@end smallexample
3602
3603@noindent
3604In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3605multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3606
3607We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3608reduction:
3609
3610@smallexample
3611@group
36122: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
36131: [7, 6, 0] . .
3614 .
3615
3616 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3617@end group
3618@end smallexample
3619
3620@noindent
3621Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3622sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3623for the dot product as before.
3624
3625A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3626@kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3627a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3628
3629@smallexample
3630@group
36311: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3632 . .
3633
3634 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3635@end group
3636@end smallexample
3637
3638Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3639rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3640Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3641for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3642(if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3643vector size).
3644
3645@smallexample
3646@group
36471: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3648 . .
3649
3650 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3651@end group
3652@end smallexample
3653
3654Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3655experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3656``abbreviated'' like this:
3657
3658@smallexample
3659@group
36601: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3661 . .
3662
3663 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3664@end group
3665@end smallexample
3666
3667@noindent
3668(where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3669You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3670even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3671Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3672experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3673fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3674to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3675
3676An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3677to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3678with the full, unabbreviated value.
3679
3680@cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3681@cindex Fitting data to a line
3682@cindex Line, fitting data to
3683@cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3684@cindex Columns of data, extracting
3685As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3686using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3687least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3688practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3689of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3690
3691@smallexample
3692 x y
3693 --- ---
3694 1.34 0.234
3695 1.41 0.298
3696 1.49 0.402
3697 1.56 0.412
3698 1.64 0.466
3699 1.73 0.473
3700 1.82 0.601
3701 1.91 0.519
3702 2.01 0.603
3703 2.11 0.637
3704 2.22 0.645
3705 2.33 0.705
3706 2.45 0.917
3707 2.58 1.009
3708 2.71 0.971
3709 2.85 1.062
3710 3.00 1.148
3711 3.15 1.157
3712 3.32 1.354
3713@end smallexample
3714
3715@noindent
3716If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3717easiest to press @kbd{C-x * i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3718the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3719@kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3720
3721Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3722to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3723(On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3724Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3725You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3726in the Info buffer, type @kbd{C-x * r}. This command
3727(@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3728the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3729
3730@smallexample
3731@group
37321: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3733 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3734 @dots{}
3735@end group
3736@end smallexample
3737
3738@noindent
3739(You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3740large matrix.)
3741
3742We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3743transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3744just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3745of row vectors on the stack.
3746
3747@smallexample
3748@group
37491: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3750 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3751 . .
3752
3753 v t v u
3754@end group
3755@end smallexample
3756
3757@noindent
3758Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3759
3760@smallexample
3761@group
37621: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3763 .
3764
3765 t 2 t 1
3766@end group
3767@end smallexample
3768
3769@noindent
3770(Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3771stored value from the stack.)
3772
3773In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3774
3775@ifnottex
3776@example
3777m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3778@end example
3779@end ifnottex
3780@tex
3781\turnoffactive
3782\beforedisplay
3783$$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3784 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3785\afterdisplay
3786@end tex
3787
3788@noindent
3789where
3790@texline @math{\sum x}
3791@infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3792represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3793actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3794simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3795this formula uses.
3796
3797@smallexample
3798@group
37991: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3800 . .
3801
3802 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3803
3804@end group
3805@end smallexample
3806@noindent
3807@smallexample
3808@group
38091: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3810 . .
3811
3812 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3813@end group
3814@end smallexample
3815
3816@ifnottex
3817@noindent
3818These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
3819respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
3820@samp{sum(x y)}.)
3821@end ifnottex
3822@tex
3823\turnoffactive
3824These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
3825respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
3826$\sum x y$.)
3827@end tex
3828
3829Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
3830the length of either of our lists.
3831
3832@smallexample
3833@group
38341: 19
3835 .
3836
3837 r 1 v l t 7
3838@end group
3839@end smallexample
3840
3841@noindent
3842(That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
3843
3844Now we grind through the formula:
3845
3846@smallexample
3847@group
38481: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
3849 . 1: 566.70919 .
3850 .
3851
3852 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
3853
3854@end group
3855@end smallexample
3856@noindent
3857@smallexample
3858@group
38592: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
38601: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
3861 . 1: 1733.0569 .
3862 .
3863
3864 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
3865@end group
3866@end smallexample
3867
3868That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
3869be found with the simple formula,
3870
3871@ifnottex
3872@example
3873b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
3874@end example
3875@end ifnottex
3876@tex
3877\turnoffactive
3878\beforedisplay
3879$$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
3880\afterdisplay
3881\vskip10pt
3882@end tex
3883
3884@smallexample
3885@group
38861: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
3887 . 1: 21.70658 . .
3888 .
3889
3890 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
3891@end group
3892@end smallexample
3893
3894Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
3895@texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
3896@infoline @expr{m x + b},
3897and compare it with the original data.
3898
3899@smallexample
3900@group
39011: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
3902 . .
3903
3904 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
3905@end group
3906@end smallexample
3907
3908@noindent
3909Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
3910to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
3911common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
3912we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
3913
3914We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
3915a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
3916
3917@smallexample
3918@group
39191: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
3920 . . .
3921
3922 r 2 - V M A V R X
3923@end group
3924@end smallexample
3925
3926@noindent
3927First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
3928values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
3929across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
3930@kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
3931operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
3932@code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
3933the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
3934invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
3935even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
3936
3937If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
3938data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
3939GNUPLOT 3.0 or higher, the following instructions will work regardless
3940of the kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
3941may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
3942
3943Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
3944vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
3945command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
3946plotting of data.
3947
3948@smallexample
3949@group
39502: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
39511: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3952 .
3953
3954 r 1 r 2 g f
3955@end group
3956@end smallexample
3957
3958If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
3959of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
3960out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
3961graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
3962display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
3963Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
3964
3965Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
3966@ifinfo
3967(If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
3968@kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
3969replaced by a buffer named @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
3970will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
3971@end ifinfo
3972
3973@smallexample
3974@group
39752: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
39761: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
3977 .
3978
3979 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
3980@end group
3981@end smallexample
3982
3983It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
3984second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
3985when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
3986
3987(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
3988least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
3989points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
3990different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
3991to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
3992@xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3993
3994@cindex Geometric mean
3995(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
3996rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{C-x * g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
3997to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
3998left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
3999Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
4000(The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
4001
4002@example
40032.3 6 22 15.1 7
4004 15 14 7.5
4005 2.5
4006@end example
4007
4008@noindent
4009The @kbd{C-x * g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
4010with or without surrounding vector brackets.
4011@xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4012
4013@ifnottex
4014As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4015us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4016@var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
4017on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
4018always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4019for @expr{n=6}.
4020@end ifnottex
4021@tex
4022As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4023us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4024${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4025always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4026for \cite{n=6}.
4027@end tex
4028
4029@smallexample
4030@group
40311: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4032 . .
4033
4034 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4035
4036@end group
4037@end smallexample
4038@noindent
4039@smallexample
4040@group
40411: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4042 . .
4043
4044 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4045@end group
4046@end smallexample
4047
4048The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4049to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4050inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4051The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4052substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4053
4054To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4055argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4056equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4057entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4058and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4059would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4060
4061Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4062trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4063@samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4064The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4065denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4066would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4067@kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4068trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4069@w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4070Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4071property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4072it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4073@samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4074of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4075@samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4076
4077Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4078the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4079and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4080@w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4081
4082Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4083vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4084into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4085one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4086element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4087and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4088
4089@cindex Divisor functions
4090(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4091@tex
4092$\sigma_k(n)$
4093@end tex
4094is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4095integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4096function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4097the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4098@xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4099
4100@cindex Square-free numbers
4101@cindex Duplicate values in a list
4102(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4103list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4104know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4105more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4106keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4107leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4108@xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4109
4110@cindex Triangular lists
4111(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4112like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4113command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4114
4115@smallexample
4116@group
41171: [ [1],
4118 [1, 2],
4119 [1, 2, 3],
4120 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4121 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4122 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4123@end group
4124@end smallexample
4125
4126@noindent
4127@xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4128
4129(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4130
4131@smallexample
4132@group
41331: [ [0],
4134 [1, 2],
4135 [3, 4, 5],
4136 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4137 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4138 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4139@end group
4140@end smallexample
4141
4142@noindent
4143@xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4144
4145@cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4146@c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4147(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4148@texline @math{J_1(x)}
4149@infoline @expr{J1}
4150function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4151Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4152which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4153i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4154is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4155of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4156@xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4157
4158@cindex Digits, vectors of
4159(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4160@texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4161@infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4162for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4163twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4164digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4165add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4166(since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4167Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4168to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4169
4170(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4171@kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4172happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4173
4174(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4175is @cpi{}. The area of the
4176@texline @math{2\times2}
4177@infoline 2x2
4178square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4179random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4180the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4181@cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4182command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4183We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4184@w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4185this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4186points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4187@xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4188
4189@cindex Matchstick problem
4190(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4191another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4192of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4193onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4194a line turns out to be
4195@texline @math{2/\pi}.
4196@infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4197Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4198the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4199one turns out to be
4200@texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4201@infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4202That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4203@xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4204
4205(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4206double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4207(ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4208Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4209which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4210Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4211@dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4212over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4213any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4214their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4215but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4216One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4217Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4218where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4219we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4220simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4221The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4222511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4223
4224(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4225commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4226value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4227function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4228and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4229``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4230@expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4231in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4232@kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4233walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4234(Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4235sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4236
4237@node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4238@section Types Tutorial
4239
4240@noindent
4241Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4242In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4243
4244The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4245or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4246the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4247and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4248which can exactly represent any rational number.
4249
4250@smallexample
4251@group
42521: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4253 . 1: 49 . . .
4254 .
4255
4256 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4257@end group
4258@end smallexample
4259
4260@noindent
4261The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4262would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4263Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4264since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4265fraction beginning with 49.
4266
4267You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4268@kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4269
4270@smallexample
4271@group
42721: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4273 . .
4274
4275 c f c F
4276@end group
4277@end smallexample
4278
4279The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4280``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4281same, to within the current precision.
4282
4283@smallexample
4284@group
42851: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4286 . . . .
4287
4288 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4289@end group
4290@end smallexample
4291
4292(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4293result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4294product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4295to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4296
4297@dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4298
4299@smallexample
4300@group
43011: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4302 . . . . .
4303
4304 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4305@end group
4306@end smallexample
4307
4308@noindent
4309The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4310(@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4311phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4312operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4313
4314Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4315isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4316Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4317i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4318also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4319real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4320algebraic entry.
4321
4322@smallexample
4323@group
43242: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
43251: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4326 . . . .
4327
4328' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4329@end group
4330@end smallexample
4331
4332@noindent
4333Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4334number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4335is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4336(``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4337negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4338leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4339infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4340infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4341the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4342lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4343the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4344So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4345with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4346
4347Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4348Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4349to turn on Infinite mode.
4350
4351@smallexample
4352@group
43533: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
43542: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
43551: 0 . . .
4356 .
4357
4358 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4359@end group
4360@end smallexample
4361
4362@noindent
4363Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4364it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4365@code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4366@expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4367plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4368infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4369Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4370That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4371by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4372point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4373unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4374yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4375@code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4376``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4377@code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4378that matter, with anything else.
4379
4380(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4381for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4382@samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4383@samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4384@xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4385
4386(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4387which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4388a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4389@xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4390
4391@dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4392seconds.
4393
4394@smallexample
4395@group
43961: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4397 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4398 .
4399
4400 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4401@end group
4402@end smallexample
4403
4404HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4405seconds.
4406
4407@smallexample
4408@group
44091: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4410 . . . .
4411
4412 0.5 I T c h S
4413@end group
4414@end smallexample
4415
4416@noindent
4417First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4418form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4419functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4420
4421@cindex Beatles
4422(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
442347 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4424average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4425Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4426song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4427
4428A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4429be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4430@samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4431
4432@smallexample
4433@group
44342: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
44351: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4436 .
4437
4438' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4439@end group
4440@end smallexample
4441
4442@noindent
4443In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4444number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4445HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4446date form.
4447
4448@smallexample
4449@group
44501: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4451 . .
4452
4453 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4454@end group
4455@end smallexample
4456
4457@c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4458@noindent
4459The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4460stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4461time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4462does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4463the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4464date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4465
4466(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4467Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4468
4469(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4470between now and the year 10001 A.D.? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4471
4472@cindex Slope and angle of a line
4473@cindex Angle and slope of a line
4474An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4475deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4476a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4477error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4478meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4479pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4480
4481@smallexample
4482@group
44831: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4484 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4485 .
4486
4487 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4488@end group
4489@end smallexample
4490
4491@noindent
4492This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4493original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4494a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4495
4496@cindex Torus, volume of
4497(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4498@texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4499@infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4500where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4501defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4502itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4503within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4504the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4505
4506An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4507error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4508you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4509our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4510and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4511
4512@smallexample
4513@group
45141: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4515 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4516 .
4517
4518 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4519@end group
4520@end smallexample
4521
4522@noindent
4523If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4524is sure to lie in the range shown.
4525
4526The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4527themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4528telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4529make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4530parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4531which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4532the other.
4533
4534@smallexample
4535@group
45361: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4537 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4538 .
4539
4540 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4541@end group
4542@end smallexample
4543
4544@noindent
4545The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4546be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4547semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4548or both endpoints.
4549
4550(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4551@samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4552about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4553zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4554@xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4555
4556(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4557are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4558answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4559If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4560@xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4561
4562A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4563For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4564or 24 hours.
4565
4566@smallexample
4567@group
45681: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4569 . . . .
4570
4571 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4572@end group
4573@end smallexample
4574
4575@noindent
4576In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4577new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4578number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4579@var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4580@var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4581
4582@smallexample
4583@group
45841: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4585 . . . .
4586
4587 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4588@end group
4589@end smallexample
4590
4591@noindent
4592These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4593much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4594that arises in the second one.
4595
4596@cindex Fermat, primality test of
4597(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4598says that
4599@texline @w{@math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}}
4600@infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4601if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4602@expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4603@emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4604informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4605values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4606are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4607
4608It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4609modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4610For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4611of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4612
4613@smallexample
4614@group
46151: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4616 . .
4617
4618 x time @key{RET} n
4619@end group
4620@end smallexample
4621
4622@noindent
4623This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4624
4625(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4626is about
4627@texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4628@infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4629seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4630@xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4631
4632(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4633for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4634You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4635seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4636of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4637@xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4638
4639Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4640@dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4641application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4642suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4643like centimeters and inches.
4644
4645@smallexample
4646@group
46471: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4648 . . . .
4649
4650 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4651@end group
4652@end smallexample
4653
4654@noindent
4655We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4656which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4657first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4658which in this case means meters.
4659
4660@smallexample
4661@group
46621: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4663 . . . .
4664
4665 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4666
4667@end group
4668@end smallexample
4669@noindent
4670@smallexample
4671@group
46721: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4673 . . .
4674
4675 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4676@end group
4677@end smallexample
4678
4679@noindent
4680Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4681root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4682algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4683``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4684being interpreted as unit names.
4685
4686In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4687units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4688as its standard unit of length.
4689
4690There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4691
4692@smallexample
4693@group
46941: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4695 . . . .
4696
4697 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4698@end group
4699@end smallexample
4700
4701@noindent
4702We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4703hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4704finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4705
4706Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4707interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4708temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4709units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4710as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4711for them.
4712
4713@smallexample
4714@group
47151: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -20:3 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4716 . . . .
4717
4718 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET} c f
4719@end group
4720@end smallexample
4721
4722@noindent
4723First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4724change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4725absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius. Since
4726this comes out as an exact fraction, we then convert to floating-point
4727for easier comparison with the other result.
4728
4729For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4730Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4731When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4732numbers are in which units:
4733
4734@smallexample
4735@group
47361: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4737 . . .
4738
4739 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4740@end group
4741@end smallexample
4742
4743To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4744@w{@kbd{C-x * c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4745at the units table.
4746
4747(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4748in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4749
4750@cindex Speed of light
4751(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4752the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4753Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4754cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4755significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4756
4757(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4758five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4759Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4760swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4761@xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4762
4763@node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4764@section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4765
4766@noindent
4767This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4768equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4769formulas.
4770
4771@menu
4772* Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4773* Rewrites Tutorial::
4774@end menu
4775
4776@node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4777@subsection Basic Algebra
4778
4779@noindent
4780If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4781the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4782formulas as regular data objects.
4783
4784@smallexample
4785@group
47861: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (6 - 2 x^2) (3 x^2 + y)
4787 . . .
4788
4789 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4790@end group
4791@end smallexample
4792
4793(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4794@kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4795Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4796
4797There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4798formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4799
4800@smallexample
4801@group
48021: 18 x^2 + 6 y - 6 x^4 - 2 x^2 y 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4803 . .
4804
4805 a x a c x @key{RET}
4806@end group
4807@end smallexample
4808
4809@noindent
4810First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4811terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4812
4813Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4814is one-half.
4815
4816@smallexample
4817@group
48181: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
4819 . .
4820
4821 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
4822@end group
4823@end smallexample
4824
4825@noindent
4826The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
4827the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
4828you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
4829next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
4830back to its original value, if any.
4831
4832(An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
4833variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
4834unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
4835properly.)
4836
4837@cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
4838Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
4839is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
4840do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
4841values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
4842derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
4843the function has a local maximum there.
4844
4845@smallexample
4846@group
48471: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
4848 . .
4849
4850 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
4851@end group
4852@end smallexample
4853
4854@noindent
4855Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
4856the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
4857
4858@smallexample
4859@group
48601: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 x / x - 24 x^3 / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
4861 . . .
4862
4863 ' x @key{RET} / a x a s
4864
4865@end group
4866@end smallexample
4867@noindent
4868@smallexample
4869@group
48701: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023
4871 . .
4872
4873 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
4874@end group
4875@end smallexample
4876
4877@noindent
4878Notice the use of @kbd{a s} to ``simplify'' the formula. When the
4879default algebraic simplifications don't do enough, you can use
4880@kbd{a s} to tell Calc to spend more time on the job.
4881
4882Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
4883
4884@smallexample
4885@group
48861: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
4887 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
4888 . .
4889
4890 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
4891@end group
4892@end smallexample
4893
4894@noindent
4895(The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
4896Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
4897@w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
4898to delete the @samp{x}.)
4899
4900@smallexample
4901@group
49022: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
49031: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
4904 . .
4905
4906 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
4907@end group
4908@end smallexample
4909
4910@noindent
4911The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
4912has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
4913local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
4914
4915When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
4916@expr{34 - 24 x^2 = 0} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
4917two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
4918single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
4919arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
4920If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
4921solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
4922
4923@smallexample
4924@group
49251: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
4926 . . .
4927
4928 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
4929@end group
4930@end smallexample
4931
4932@noindent
4933Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
4934it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
4935the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
4936If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
4937negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
4938
4939To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
4940into the original formula.
4941
4942@smallexample
4943@group
49442: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
49451: x = 1.19023 s1 .
4946 .
4947
4948 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
4949@end group
4950@end smallexample
4951
4952@noindent
4953(Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
4954with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
4955like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
4956
4957It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
4958@code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
4959
4960@smallexample
4961@group
49622: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
49631: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
4964 .
4965
4966 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
4967@end group
4968@end smallexample
4969
4970@noindent
4971Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
4972at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
4973except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
4974formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
4975next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
4976@samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
4977different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
4978the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
4979default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
4980what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
4981
4982If there had been several different values, we could have used
4983@w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
4984
4985Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
4986@w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
4987automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
4988cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
4989@expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
4990which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
4991method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
4992to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
4993
4994(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
4995polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
4996sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
4997polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
4998multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
4999@xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5000
5001The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
5002like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
5003symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
5004Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
5005
5006@smallexample
5007@group
50082: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
50091: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
5010 . .
5011
5012 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
5013@end group
5014@end smallexample
5015
5016One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
5017
5018@smallexample
5019@group
5020 3
50212: 34 x - 24 x
5022
5023 ____ ____
5024 V 51 V 51
50251: [-----, -----, 0]
5026 6 -6
5027
5028 .
5029
5030 d B
5031@end group
5032@end smallexample
5033
5034Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5035are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5036language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, @TeX{} mode
5037and La@TeX{} mode.
5038
5039@smallexample
5040@group
50412: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
50421: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5043 . .
5044
5045 d C d F
5046
5047@end group
5048@end smallexample
5049@noindent
5050@smallexample
5051@group
50523: 34 x - 24 x^3
50532: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
50541: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5055 .
5056
5057 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5058@end group
5059@end smallexample
5060
5061@noindent
5062As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5063formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5064functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5065and notations for vectors and matrices.
5066
5067Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5068implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5069like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5070produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5071correct.
5072
5073Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5074may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5075are shown in normal mode.)
5076
5077@cindex Area under a curve
5078What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5079This is simply the integral of the function:
5080
5081@smallexample
5082@group
50831: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5084 . .
5085
5086 r 1 a i x
5087@end group
5088@end smallexample
5089
5090@noindent
5091We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5092One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5093
5094@smallexample
5095@group
50962: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
50971: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5098
5099 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5100@end group
5101@end smallexample
5102
5103(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5104of
5105@texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5106@infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5107(where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5108integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
51093}. (@bullet{})
5110
5111Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5112others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5113under the curve
5114@texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5115@infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5116over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5117@kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5118long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5119closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5120
5121@cindex Integration, numerical
5122@cindex Numerical integration
5123One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5124to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5125slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5126We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5127
5128@smallexample
5129@group
51303: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
51312: 1 .
51321: 0.1
5133 .
5134
5135 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5136@end group
5137@end smallexample
5138
5139@noindent
5140(Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5141also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5142
5143@smallexample
5144@group
51452: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
51461: sin(x) ln(x) .
5147 .
5148
5149 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5150
5151@end group
5152@end smallexample
5153@noindent
5154@smallexample
5155@group
51561: 3.4195 0.34195
5157 . .
5158
5159 V R + 0.1 *
5160@end group
5161@end smallexample
5162
5163@noindent
5164(If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5165to Radians mode?)
5166
5167Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5168approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5169the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5170of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5171faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5172is the same for every box.)
5173
5174The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5175we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5176
5177@smallexample
5178@group
51791: sin(x) ln(x) 1: 0.84147 x - 0.84147 + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5180 . .
5181
5182 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5183@end group
5184@end smallexample
5185
5186@noindent
5187Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5188about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5189approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5190
5191@smallexample
5192@group
51931: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5194 . . .
5195
5196 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5197@end group
5198@end smallexample
5199
5200@noindent
5201Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5202in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5203(Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5204function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5205expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5206of @expr{x=1}.)
5207
5208@cindex Simpson's rule
5209@cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5210(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5211curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5212of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5213method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5214to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5215@dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5216that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5217down to the formula,
5218
5219@ifnottex
5220@example
5221(h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5222 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5223@end example
5224@end ifnottex
5225@tex
5226\turnoffactive
5227\beforedisplay
5228$$ \displaylines{
5229 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5230 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5231} $$
5232\afterdisplay
5233@end tex
5234
5235@noindent
5236where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5237is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5238For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5239method:
5240
5241@ifnottex
5242@example
5243h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5244 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5245@end example
5246@end ifnottex
5247@tex
5248\turnoffactive
5249\beforedisplay
5250$$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5251 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5252\afterdisplay
5253@end tex
5254
5255Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5256@texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5257@infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5258using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5259@xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5260
5261Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5262It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5263of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5264result until the current precision is satisfied.
5265
5266@c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5267Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5268large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5269indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5270of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5271be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5272details and examples.
5273
5274@c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5275@c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5276
5277@node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5278@subsection Rewrite Rules
5279
5280@noindent
5281No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5282there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5283in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5284that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5285
5286Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5287
5288@smallexample
5289@group
52901: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x)
5291 .
5292
5293 ' 1/cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) @key{RET} s 1
5294@end group
5295@end smallexample
5296
5297@noindent
5298If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably replace the
5299@samp{tan} with a @samp{sin/cos} first, then combine over a common
5300denominator. There is no Calc command to do the former; the @kbd{a n}
5301algebra command will do the latter but we'll do both with rewrite
5302rules just for practice.
5303
5304Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5305
5306@smallexample
5307@group
53081: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x)
5309 .
5310
5311 a r tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a) @key{RET}
5312@end group
5313@end smallexample
5314
5315@noindent
5316(The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5317by itself the formula @samp{tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a)} doesn't do anything,
5318but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5319it as a rewrite rule.)
5320
5321The lefthand side, @samp{tan(a)}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5322rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5323match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5324@dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5325can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5326the actual variable @samp{x}.
5327
5328When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5329that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5330substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5331@samp{sin(x) / cos(x)}. Calc's normal algebraic simplifications then
5332mix this in with the rest of the original formula.
5333
5334To merge over a common denominator, we can use another simple rule:
5335
5336@smallexample
5337@group
53381: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5339 .
5340
5341 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5342@end group
5343@end smallexample
5344
5345This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5346First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5347match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5348because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5349denominators.
5350
5351Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5352target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
5353the subformula @samp{cos(x)}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
5354@samp{x}.
5355
5356And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5357properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5358Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
5359@samp{a = 1}, @samp{b = -sin(x)^2}, and @samp{x = cos(x)}.
5360
5361@c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5362We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5363the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5364really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5365we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5366of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5367
5368One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5369@samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}, but of course we must first rearrange
5370the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
5371would be @samp{@w{1 - sin(x)^2} := cos(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
5372that the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2} will also work. The
5373latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5374situations, too.
5375
5376@smallexample
5377@group
53781: (1 + cos(x)^2 - 1) / cos(x) 1: cos(x)
5379 . .
5380
5381 a r sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} a s
5382@end group
5383@end smallexample
5384
5385You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5386have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5387you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5388name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5389use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5390need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5391can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5392having to retype it.
5393
5394@smallexample
5395@group
5396' tan(x) := sin(x)/cos(x) @key{RET} s t tsc @key{RET}
5397' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5398' sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} s t sinsqr @key{RET}
5399
54001: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5401 . .
5402
5403 r 1 a r tsc @key{RET} a r merge @key{RET} a r sinsqr @key{RET} a s
5404@end group
5405@end smallexample
5406
5407To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5408Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5409the edited value back into the variable.
5410You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5411
5412Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5413message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5414optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5415This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5416efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5417only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5418another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5419entering them on the fly.
5420
5421(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5422mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5423Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying the top and
5424bottom by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5425to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5426rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5427
5428The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5429a variable containing a vector of rules.
5430
5431@smallexample
5432@group
54331: [tsc, merge, sinsqr] 1: [tan(x) := sin(x) / cos(x), ... ]
5434 . .
5435
5436 ' [tsc,merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5437
5438@end group
5439@end smallexample
5440@noindent
5441@smallexample
5442@group
54431: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5444 . .
5445
5446 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET} a s
5447@end group
5448@end smallexample
5449
5450@c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5451Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5452repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5453which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5454the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5455@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5456
5457Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5458has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5459to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5460only one rewrite at a time.
5461
5462@smallexample
5463@group
54641: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x) 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5465 . .
5466
5467 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5468@end group
5469@end smallexample
5470
5471You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5472of rewrites that occur.
5473
5474Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5475with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5476
5477@smallexample
5478@group
54791: exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i)
5480 .
5481
5482 ' exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i) @key{RET}
5483
5484@end group
5485@end smallexample
5486@noindent
5487@smallexample
5488@group
54891: 1 + exp(3 pi i) + 1
5490 .
5491
5492 a r exp(k pi i) := 1 :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5493@end group
5494@end smallexample
5495
5496@noindent
5497(Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5498which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5499
5500An interesting point is that the variables @samp{pi} and @samp{i}
5501were matched literally rather than acting as meta-variables.
5502This is because they are special-constant variables. The special
5503constants @samp{e}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5504A common error with rewrite
5505rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5506to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5507only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5508
5509@cindex Fibonacci numbers
5510@ignore
5511@starindex
5512@end ignore
5513@tindex fib
5514Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5515Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5516Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5517later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5518the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5519
5520@smallexample
5521@group
5522' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5523
55241: fib(7) 1: 13
5525 . .
5526
5527 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5528@end group
5529@end smallexample
5530
5531One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5532is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5533be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5534first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5535be used preferentially.
5536
5537This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5538formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5539will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5540Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5541fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5542the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5543@w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5544
5545@smallexample
5546fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5547@end smallexample
5548
5549@noindent
5550Now:
5551
5552@smallexample
5553@group
55541: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: 8 + fib(x) + fib(0)
5555 . .
5556
5557 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5558@end group
5559@end smallexample
5560
5561@noindent
5562We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5563@w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5564this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5565apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5566variable @code{EvalRules}.
5567
5568@smallexample
5569@group
55701: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5571 . .
5572
5573 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5574@end group
5575@end smallexample
5576
5577It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5578more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5579first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5580
5581@smallexample
5582@group
5583fib(6) =
5584fib(5) + fib(4) =
5585fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5586fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5587@end group
5588@end smallexample
5589
5590@noindent
5591Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5592algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5593them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5594needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5595to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5596@code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5597
5598@smallexample
5599fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5600@end smallexample
5601
5602@noindent
5603If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5604that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5605to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5606for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5607example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5608to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5609
5610Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5611type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5612
5613With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5614@samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5615up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5616computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5617(and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5618
5619All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5620contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5621un-store the variable.
5622
5623(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5624a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5625Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5626to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5627@samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5628@var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5629rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5630interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5631get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5632
5633There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5634are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5635and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5636could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5637
5638@example
5639[fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5640@end example
5641
5642@noindent
5643That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5644to 1.''
5645
5646You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5647For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5648@samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5649matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5650and one for @samp{b}.
5651
5652(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5653on the stack and tried to use the rule
5654@samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5655@xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5656
5657(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5658divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5659Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5660is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5661reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5662rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5663is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5664Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5665configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5666Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5667to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5668and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5669vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5670@xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5671
5672(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5673@samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5674@var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5675is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5676so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5677@xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5678
5679(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5680infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5681values of @expr{x} near zero.
5682
5683@ifnottex
5684@example
5685cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5686@end example
5687@end ifnottex
5688@tex
5689\turnoffactive
5690\beforedisplay
5691$$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5692\afterdisplay
5693@end tex
5694
5695The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5696is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5697Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5698Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5699that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5700
5701@ifnottex
5702@example
5703cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5704@end example
5705@end ifnottex
5706@tex
5707\turnoffactive
5708\beforedisplay
5709$$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5710\afterdisplay
5711@end tex
5712
5713@noindent
5714The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5715if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5716
5717The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5718power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5719For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5720on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5721@samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5722rearranged or if @kbd{a s} needs to be typed after rewriting. (This one
5723is rather tricky; the solution at the end of this chapter uses 6 rewrite
5724rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)} condition tests whether @samp{x} is
5725a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5726
5727Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5728What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5729a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5730
5731@xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5732
5733@node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5734@section Programming Tutorial
5735
5736@noindent
5737The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5738language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5739anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5740system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5741all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5742times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5743
5744One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5745Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5746key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5747the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5748case @kbd{z} prefix.
5749
5750@smallexample
5751@group
57521: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6
5753 . .
5754
5755 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5756@end group
5757@end smallexample
5758
5759This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5760The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5761say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5762@kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5763function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5764default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5765answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5766arguments?''
5767
5768@smallexample
5769@group
57701: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5771 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5772 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5773 .
5774
5775 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5776@end group
5777@end smallexample
5778
5779@noindent
5780First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5781argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5782we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5783argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5784function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5785final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5786in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5787
5788@cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5789@ignore
5790@starindex
5791@end ignore
5792@tindex Si
5793(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5794@texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5795@infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5796is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5797@expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5798integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5799to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5800give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5801which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5802with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5803@code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5804default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
58050.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5806Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5807you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5808@xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5809
5810The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5811@dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5812keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5813For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5814you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5815
5816@smallexample
5817@group
58181: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
5819 . .
5820
5821 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
5822
58231: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 pi n1
5824 . .
5825
5826 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
5827@end group
5828@end smallexample
5829
5830@noindent
5831When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
5832still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
5833Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
5834@w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
5835re-execute the same keystrokes.
5836
5837You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
5838
5839@smallexample
5840@group
58411: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
5842 . .
5843
5844 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
5845@end group
5846@end smallexample
5847
5848@noindent
5849Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
5850@kbd{z} to call it up.
5851
5852Keyboard macros can call other macros.
5853
5854@smallexample
5855@group
58561: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
5857 . . . .
5858
5859 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
5860@end group
5861@end smallexample
5862
5863(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
5864the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
5865the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5866
5867(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
5868the following functions:
5869
5870@enumerate
5871@item
5872Compute
5873@texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
5874@infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
5875where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
5876
5877@item
5878Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
5879the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
5880
5881@item
5882Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
5883the stack.
5884@end enumerate
5885@noindent
5886@xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5887
5888(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
5889the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
5890@xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5891
5892In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
5893Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
5894inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
5895
5896@smallexample
5897@group
58981: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
5899 . 1: 4 .
5900 .
5901
5902 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
5903@end group
5904@end smallexample
5905
5906@noindent
5907Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
5908enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
5909This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
5910executes the body of the loop that many times.
5911
5912If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
5913type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
5914
5915@cindex Fibonacci numbers
5916Here's another example:
5917
5918@smallexample
5919@group
59203: 1 2: 10946
59212: 1 1: 17711
59221: 20 .
5923 .
5924
59251 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
5926@end group
5927@end smallexample
5928
5929@noindent
5930The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
5931numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
5932of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
5933key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
5934
5935@cindex Golden ratio
5936@cindex Phi, golden ratio
5937A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
5938Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
5939@texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
5940@infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
5941and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
5942@texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
5943@infoline @expr{phi},
5944the ``golden ratio,'' is
5945@texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
5946@infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
5947(For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
5948variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
5949
5950@smallexample
5951@group
59521: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
5953 . . . .
5954
5955 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
5956@end group
5957@end smallexample
5958
5959@cindex Continued fractions
5960(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
5961representation of
5962@texline @math{\phi}
5963@infoline @expr{phi}
5964is
5965@texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
5966@infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
5967We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
5968and then replacing the innermost
5969@texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
5970@infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
5971by 1. Approximate
5972@texline @math{\phi}
5973@infoline @expr{phi}
5974using a twenty-term continued fraction.
5975@xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5976
5977(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
5978Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
5979vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
5980vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
5981@expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
5982that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
5983using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5984
5985@cindex Harmonic numbers
5986A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
5987we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
5988the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
5989
5990@smallexample
5991@group
59923: 0 1: 3.597739
59932: 1 .
59941: 20
5995 .
5996
59970 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
5998@end group
5999@end smallexample
6000
6001@noindent
6002The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
6003repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
6004the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
6005body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
6006finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
6007increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
6008uses a step of one.
6009
6010This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
6011total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
6012you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
6013
6014@smallexample
6015@group
60161: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
6017 . 1: 20 .
6018 .
6019
6020 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
6021@end group
6022@end smallexample
6023
6024@noindent
6025The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
6026variable (and removes that value from the stack).
6027
6028It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
6029also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6030other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6031and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6032or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6033probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6034situations where loops really are the way to go:
6035
6036(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6037harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6038@xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6039
6040Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6041we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6042caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6043fix, though:
6044
6045@smallexample
6046@group
6047 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6048 . . 2: 3.597739
6049 1: 0.6667
6050 .
6051
6052 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6053@end group
6054@end smallexample
6055
6056@noindent
6057When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6058its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6059for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6060now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6061@kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6062this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6063interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6064the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6065survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6066
6067@cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6068The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6069property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6070even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6071by the formula
6072@texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6073@infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6074Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6075(Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6076this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6077numbers are very large fractions.)
6078
6079@smallexample
6080@group
60811: 10 1: 0.0756823
6082 . .
6083
6084 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6085@end group
6086@end smallexample
6087
6088@noindent
6089You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6090@kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6091command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6092if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6093if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6094Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6095if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6096
6097The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6098
6099@smallexample
6100@group
61013: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
61022: 5:66 . . . .
61031: 0.0757575
6104 .
6105
610610 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6107@end group
6108@end smallexample
6109
6110Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6111Bernoulli numbers.
6112
6113@smallexample
6114@group
61153: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
61162: 2 .
61171: 30
6118 .
6119
6120 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6121@end group
6122@end smallexample
6123
6124@noindent
6125The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6126we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6127(initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6128will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6129onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6130Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6131sequence of keystrokes.)
6132
6133With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6134in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6135which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6136loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6137``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6138
6139If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6140it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6141One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6142then enter the real one in the edit command.
6143
6144@smallexample
6145@group
61461: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6147 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6148
6149 1 ;; calc digits
6150 RET ;; calc-enter
6151 2 ;; calc digits
6152 + ;; calc-plus
6153
6154C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6155@end group
6156@end smallexample
6157
6158@noindent
6159A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6160@file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6161macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6162Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6163@samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6164Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6165To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6166characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6167and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6168@code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6169
6170Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6171First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6172in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6173to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6174typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6175
6176@smallexample
6177Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
61780 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6179st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
61801 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
61811 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6182TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6183Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6184& ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6185s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
61861 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
61871 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6188Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6189sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
61901 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6191Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6192@end smallexample
6193
6194@noindent
6195Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6196
6197@smallexample
6198@group
61991: 20 1: 3.597739
6200 . .
6201
6202 20 z h
6203@end group
6204@end smallexample
6205
6206The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6207which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6208keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6209(and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6210command on the @kbd{C-x * m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6211following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6212one end of the text below, then type @kbd{C-x * m} at the other.
6213
6214@example
6215@group
6216Z ` 0 t 1
6217 1 TAB
6218 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6219 r 1
6220Z '
6221@end group
6222@end example
6223
6224(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6225equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6226@expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6227@expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6228this formula over and over:
6229
6230@ifnottex
6231@example
6232new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6233@end example
6234@end ifnottex
6235@tex
6236\beforedisplay
6237$$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f'(x)} $$
6238\afterdisplay
6239@end tex
6240
6241@noindent
6242where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6243values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6244@texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6245@infoline @expr{new_x}
6246and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6247of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6248involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6249on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6250is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6251@texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6252@infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6253near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6254the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6255method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6256
6257@cindex Digamma function
6258@cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6259@cindex Euler's gamma constant
6260(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6261@texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6262@infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6263is defined as the derivative of
6264@texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6265@infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6266For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6267
6268@ifnottex
6269@example
6270psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6271@end example
6272@end ifnottex
6273@tex
6274\beforedisplay
6275$$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6276 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6277$$
6278\afterdisplay
6279@end tex
6280
6281@noindent
6282where
6283@texline @math{\sum}
6284@infoline @expr{sum}
6285represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6286(or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6287the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6288While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6289An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6290to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6291@texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6292@infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6293Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6294for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6295Fortunately, we can compute
6296@texline @math{\psi(1)}
6297@infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6298from
6299@texline @math{\psi(5)}
6300@infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6301using the recurrence
6302@texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6303@infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6304Your task: Develop a program to compute
6305@texline @math{\psi(z)};
6306@infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6307it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6308if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6309formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6310to compute
6311@texline @math{\gamma}
6312@infoline @expr{gamma}
6313to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6314for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6315@xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6316
6317@cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6318(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6319a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6320@expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6321write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6322notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6323should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6324a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6325@xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6326
6327@cindex Recursion
6328(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6329first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6330
6331@ifnottex
6332@example
6333s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6334s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6335s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6336@end example
6337@end ifnottex
6338@tex
6339\turnoffactive
6340\beforedisplay
6341$$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6342 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6343 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6344 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6345$$
6346\afterdisplay
6347\vskip5pt
6348(These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6349@end tex
6350
6351This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6352program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6353terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6354``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6355the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6356macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6357So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6358it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6359using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6360to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6361the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6362or @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6363thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6364that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6365@expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6366@expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6367@kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6368@xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6369
6370The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6371are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6372that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6373rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6374program can:
6375
6376(@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6377computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6378rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6379from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6380
6381@example
6382
6383@end example
6384This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6385about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6386Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6387@c [not-split]
6388The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6389@c [when-split]
6390@c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6391
6392@page
6393@node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6394@section Answers to Exercises
6395
6396@noindent
6397This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6398
6399@menu
6400* RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6401* RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6402* RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6403* RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6404* Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6405* Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6406* Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6407* Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6408* Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6409* Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6410* Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6411* Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6412* Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6413* Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6414* Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6415* Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6416* Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6417* Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6418* List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6419* List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6420* List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6421* List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6422* List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6423* List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6424* List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6425* List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6426* List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6427* List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6428* List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6429* List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6430* List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6431* List Answer 14:: Random walk
6432* Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6433* Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6434* Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6435* Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6436* Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6437* Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6438* Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6439* Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6440* Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6441* Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6442* Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6443* Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6444* Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6445* Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6446* Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6447* Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6448* Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6449* Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6450* Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6451* Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6452* Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6453* Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6454* Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6455* Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6456* Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6457* Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6458* Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6459* Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6460* Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6461* Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6462* Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6463* Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6464* Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6465* Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6466* Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6467* Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6468* Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6469@end menu
6470
6471@c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6472@c being entered on the table of contents.
6473@tex
6474\global\let\oldwrite=\write
6475\gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6476\global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6477\gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6478@end tex
6479
6480@node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6481@subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6482
6483@noindent
6484@kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6485
6486The result is
6487@texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6488@infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6489
6490@node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6491@subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6492
6493@noindent
6494@texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6495@infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6496
6497After computing the intermediate term
6498@texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6499@infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6500you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6501term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6502compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6503
6504@smallexample
6505@group
65062: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
65071: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6508 . 1: 9.5 .
6509 .
6510
6511 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6512
6513@end group
6514@end smallexample
6515@noindent
6516@smallexample
6517@group
65184: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
65193: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
65202: 5 1: 1.25 .
65211: 4 .
6522 .
6523
6524 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6525@end group
6526@end smallexample
6527
6528Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6529with the third term.
6530
6531@smallexample
6532@group
65332: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
65341: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6535 . 1: 4 .
6536 .
6537
6538 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6539@end group
6540@end smallexample
6541
6542On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6543advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6544can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6545you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6546
6547@node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6548@subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6549
6550@noindent
6551The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6552
6553@smallexample
6554@group
65553: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
65562: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
65571: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6558 . . 1: 1 . .
6559 .
6560
6561 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6562@end group
6563@end smallexample
6564
6565Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6566
6567@smallexample
6568@group
65693: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
65702: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
65711: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6572 . . . . .
6573
6574 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6575@end group
6576@end smallexample
6577
6578@node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6579@subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6580
6581@noindent
6582Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6583but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6584
6585@smallexample
6586@group
65871: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6588 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6589 . . .
6590
6591 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6592@end group
6593@end smallexample
6594
6595Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6596extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6597But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6598deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6599@key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6600
6601@smallexample
6602@group
66032: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
66041: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6605 . . .
6606
6607 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6608@end group
6609@end smallexample
6610
6611(As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6612enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6613@kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6614the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6615
6616@node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6617@subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6618
6619@noindent
6620Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6621
6622If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6623Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6624
6625(Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6626a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6627@samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6628
6629@node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6630@subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6631
6632@noindent
6633In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6634name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6635has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6636explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6637
6638@node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6639@subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6640
6641@noindent
6642The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6643The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6644is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6645the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6646times anything is zero.''
6647
6648@c [fix-ref Infinities]
6649The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6650results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6651multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6652show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6653further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6654
6655@node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6656@subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6657
6658@noindent
6659Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6660an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
66610.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6662the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6663to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6664multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6665
6666When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6667to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6668to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6669exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6670numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6671the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6672happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6673digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6674he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
66750.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6676higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6677
6678If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6679@kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6680you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6681so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6682inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6683rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6684@samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6685off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6686nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6687a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6688
6689Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6690@kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6691you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6692display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6693always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6694rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6695be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6696uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6697than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6698to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6699
6700An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6701floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6702Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6703represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6704comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6705they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6706we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6707be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6708in decimal display mode.
6709
6710It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6711in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6712of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6713you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6714
6715@node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6716@subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6717
6718If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6719the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6720needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6721@samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6722algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6723normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6724puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6725way to enter this number.
6726
6727The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6728huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6729@samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6730exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6731it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6732matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6733copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6734
6735@node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6736@subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6737
6738@noindent
6739The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6740
6741The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6742sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6743Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6744their inputs.
6745
6746The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6747squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6748commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6749place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6750determining facts like this.
6751
6752@smallexample
6753@group
67541: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6755 . .
6756
6757 45 S 2 ^
6758
6759@end group
6760@end smallexample
6761@noindent
6762@smallexample
6763@group
67641: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6765 . . .
6766
6767 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6768@end group
6769@end smallexample
6770
6771A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6772all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6773exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6774before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6775for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6776
6777@node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6778@subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6779
6780@noindent
6781Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6782height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6783can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6784a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6785of time.
6786
6787Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6788done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6789integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
67909304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6791time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6792calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6793
6794Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6795There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6796@w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6797
6798@node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6799@subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6800
6801@noindent
6802Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6803give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6804down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6805precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6806with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6807@texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6808@infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6809The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6810
6811Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6812floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6813decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6814produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6815down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
6816format.
6817
6818@node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6819@subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
6820
6821@noindent
6822@kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
6823does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
6824
6825Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
6826or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
6827no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
6828for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
6829
6830@node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6831@subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
6832
6833@noindent
6834Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
6835by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
6836
6837@smallexample
6838@group
68391: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
6840 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
6841 .
6842
6843 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
6844@end group
6845@end smallexample
6846
6847The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
6848indeed have unit length.
6849
6850@node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6851@subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
6852
6853@noindent
6854The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
6855positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
6856definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
6857is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
6858
6859@node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6860@subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
6861
6862@noindent
6863The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
6864get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
6865
6866@node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6867@subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
6868
6869@ifnottex
6870@example
6871@group
6872 x + a y = 6
6873 x + b y = 10
6874@end group
6875@end example
6876@end ifnottex
6877@tex
6878\turnoffactive
6879\beforedisplay
6880$$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
6881 x &+ b y = 10}
6882$$
6883\afterdisplay
6884@end tex
6885
6886Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
6887matrix as usual.
6888
6889@smallexample
6890@group
68911: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [6 - 4 a / (b - a), 4 / (b - a) ]
6892 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
6893 [ 1, b ] ]
6894 .
6895
6896' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
6897@end group
6898@end smallexample
6899
6900This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
6901mode:
6902
6903@smallexample
6904@group
6905 4 a 4
69061: [6 - -----, -----]
6907 b - a b - a
6908@end group
6909@end smallexample
6910
6911Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
6912
6913@node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6914@subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
6915
6916@noindent
6917To solve
6918@texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
6919@infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
6920first we compute
6921@texline @math{A' = A^T A}
6922@infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
6923and
6924@texline @math{B' = A^T B};
6925@infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
6926now, we have a system
6927@texline @math{A' X = B'}
6928@infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
6929which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
6930
6931@ifnottex
6932@example
6933@group
6934 a + 2b + 3c = 6
6935 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
6936 7a + 6b = 3
6937 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
6938@end group
6939@end example
6940@end ifnottex
6941@tex
6942\turnoffactive
6943\beforedisplayh
6944$$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
6945\halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
6946 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6947 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6948 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
6949 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
6950 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
6951 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
6952 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
6953$$
6954\afterdisplayh
6955@end tex
6956
6957The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
6958quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
6959@texline @math{B'}
6960@infoline @expr{B2}
6961vector.
6962
6963@smallexample
6964@group
69651: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
6966 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
6967 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
6968 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
6969 . .
6970
6971' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
6972@end group
6973@end smallexample
6974
6975@noindent
6976Now we compute the matrix
6977@texline @math{A'}
6978@infoline @expr{A2}
6979and divide.
6980
6981@smallexample
6982@group
69832: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
69841: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
6985 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
6986 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
6987 .
6988
6989 r 7 v t r 7 * /
6990@end group
6991@end smallexample
6992
6993@noindent
6994(The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
6995round-off error.)
6996
6997Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
6998@texline @math{3\times3}
6999@infoline 3x3
7000system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
7001added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
7002by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
7003answer since the
7004@texline @math{4\times3}
7005@infoline 4x3
7006system would be equivalent to the original
7007@texline @math{3\times3}
7008@infoline 3x3
7009system.)
7010
7011Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
7012can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
7013the original system of equations to see how well they match.
7014
7015@smallexample
7016@group
70172: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
70181: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
7019 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
7020 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
7021 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
7022 .
7023
7024 r 7 @key{TAB} *
7025@end group
7026@end smallexample
7027
7028@noindent
7029This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
7030@expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
7031
7032@node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7033@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7034
7035@noindent
7036We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7037adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7038across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7039plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7040
7041@smallexample
7042@group
70432: 2 2: 2
70441: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7045 . .
7046
7047 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7048@end group
7049@end smallexample
7050
7051@noindent
7052Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7053vector.
7054
7055@smallexample
7056@group
70571: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7058 .
7059
7060 V M ^
7061@end group
7062@end smallexample
7063
7064@node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7065@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7066
7067@noindent
7068Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7069the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7070
7071@ifnottex
7072@example
7073 m*x + b*1 = y
7074@end example
7075@end ifnottex
7076@tex
7077\turnoffactive
7078\beforedisplay
7079$$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7080\afterdisplay
7081@end tex
7082
7083Thus we want a
7084@texline @math{19\times2}
7085@infoline 19x2
7086matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7087ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7088we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7089
7090@smallexample
7091@group
70922: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
70931: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7094 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7095 @dots{}
7096
7097 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7098@end group
7099@end smallexample
7100
7101@noindent
7102Now we compute
7103@texline @math{A^T y}
7104@infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7105and
7106@texline @math{A^T A}
7107@infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7108and divide.
7109
7110@smallexample
7111@group
71121: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7113 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7114 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7115 .
7116
7117 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7118@end group
7119@end smallexample
7120
7121@noindent
7122(Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7123
7124@smallexample
7125@group
71261: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7127 .
7128
7129 /
7130@end group
7131@end smallexample
7132
7133Since we were solving equations of the form
7134@texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7135@infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7136these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7137enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7138@kbd{V R}!
7139
7140The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7141your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7142arithmetic functions!
7143
7144@c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7145In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7146fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7147
7148@node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7149@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7150
7151@noindent
7152Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7153whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7154and type @w{@kbd{C-x * g}}.
7155
7156@smallexample
7157@group
71581: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7159 .
7160@end group
7161@end smallexample
7162
7163To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7164how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7165
7166@smallexample
7167@group
71682: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
71691: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7170 . .
7171
7172 @key{RET} V R *
7173
7174@end group
7175@end smallexample
7176@noindent
7177@smallexample
7178@group
71792: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
71801: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7181 . .
7182
7183 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7184@end group
7185@end smallexample
7186
7187@noindent
7188(The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7189You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7190then raise the number to that power.)
7191
7192@node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7193@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7194
7195@noindent
7196A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7197@texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7198@infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7199The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7200
7201@smallexample
7202@group
72032: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
72041: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7205 . .
7206
7207 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7208@end group
7209@end smallexample
7210
7211@noindent
7212This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7213
7214The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7215The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7216
7217@smallexample
7218@group
72191: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7220 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7221 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7222 .
7223
7224 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7225@end group
7226@end smallexample
7227
7228@noindent
7229Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7230a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7231
7232@node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7233@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7234
7235@noindent
7236The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7237This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7238they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7239the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7240
7241@smallexample
7242@group
72431: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7244 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7245 . .
7246
7247 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7248
7249@end group
7250@end smallexample
7251@noindent
7252@smallexample
7253@group
72541: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7255 . . .
7256
7257 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7258@end group
7259@end smallexample
7260
7261@noindent
7262Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7263so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7264zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7265the job is pretty straightforward.
7266
7267Incidentally, Calc provides the
7268@texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7269@infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7270function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7271would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7272
7273@node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7274@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7275
7276@noindent
7277First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7278to get a list of lists of integers!
7279
7280@node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7281@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7282
7283@noindent
7284Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7285exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7286
7287@smallexample
7288@group
72891: [ [0],
7290 [0, 1],
7291 [0, 1, 2],
7292 @dots{}
7293
7294 1 -
7295@end group
7296@end smallexample
7297
7298The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7299the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7300triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7301can be computed directly by the formula
7302@texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7303@infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7304
7305@smallexample
7306@group
73072: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
73081: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7309 . .
7310
7311 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7312@end group
7313@end smallexample
7314
7315@noindent
7316Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7317result:
7318
7319@smallexample
7320@group
73211: [ [0],
7322 [1, 2],
7323 [3, 4, 5],
7324 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7325 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7326 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7327 .
7328
7329 V M +
7330@end group
7331@end smallexample
7332
7333If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7334computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7335gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7336triangular list.
7337
7338@smallexample
7339@group
73402: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
73411: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7342 . .
7343
7344 @key{RET} V M V R +
7345@end group
7346@end smallexample
7347
7348@noindent
7349(This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7350since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7351@kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7352
7353@node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7354@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7355
7356@noindent
7357The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7358
7359@smallexample
7360@group
73611: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7362 . . .
7363
7364 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7365@end group
7366@end smallexample
7367
7368Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7369
7370@smallexample
7371@group
73721: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7373 .
7374
7375 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7376@end group
7377@end smallexample
7378
7379@noindent
7380(Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7381
7382A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7383@kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7384
7385@smallexample
7386@group
73872: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
73881: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7389 . .
7390
7391 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7392@end group
7393@end smallexample
7394
7395@noindent
7396It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7397one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7398@texline @math{\sin x}
7399@infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7400might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7401
7402The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7403the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7404this back into the corresponding value itself.
7405
7406@smallexample
7407@group
74082: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
74091: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7410 .
7411
7412 r 1 V M * V R +
7413@end group
7414@end smallexample
7415
7416If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7417would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7418useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7419instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7420correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7421example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7422
7423The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7424efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7425to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7426
7427@smallexample
7428@group
74292: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
74301: [0 .. 5] .
7431 .
7432
7433' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7434@end group
7435@end smallexample
7436
7437@noindent
7438The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7439that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7440As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7441
7442@node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7443@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7444
7445@noindent
7446Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7447
7448@smallexample
7449@group
74501: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7451 . 2: 10
7452 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7453 .
7454
7455 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7456
7457@end group
7458@end smallexample
7459@noindent
7460@smallexample
7461@group
74621: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
74632: [100000000000, ... ] .
7464 .
7465
7466 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7467@end group
7468@end smallexample
7469
7470@noindent
7471(Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7472
7473@smallexample
7474@group
74751: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7476 .
7477
7478 10 V M % s 2
7479@end group
7480@end smallexample
7481
7482Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7483the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7484left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7485the right of it are nines.
7486
7487@smallexample
7488@group
74891: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7490 . .
7491
7492 9 V M a = v v
7493
7494@end group
7495@end smallexample
7496@noindent
7497@smallexample
7498@group
74991: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7500 . .
7501
7502 V U * v v 1 |
7503@end group
7504@end smallexample
7505
7506@noindent
7507Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7508only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7509except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7510care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7511rightmost digit.
7512
7513@smallexample
7514@group
75152: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
75161: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7517 .
7518
7519 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7520@end group
7521@end smallexample
7522
7523@noindent
7524Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7525this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7526digits that generated them.
7527
7528Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7529
7530@smallexample
7531@group
75323: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
75332: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
75341: [100000000000, ... ] .
7535 .
7536
7537 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7538
7539@end group
7540@end smallexample
7541@noindent
7542@smallexample
7543@group
75441: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7545 . .
7546
7547 V M * V R +
7548@end group
7549@end smallexample
7550
7551@noindent
7552Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7553@w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7554
7555@smallexample
7556@group
75571: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7558 . .
7559
7560 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7561@end group
7562@end smallexample
7563
7564@node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7565@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7566
7567@noindent
7568For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7569which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7570then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7571compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7572
7573Here's a more correct method:
7574
7575@smallexample
7576@group
75771: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7578 . 1: 7
7579 .
7580
7581 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7582
7583@end group
7584@end smallexample
7585@noindent
7586@smallexample
7587@group
75881: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7589 . .
7590
7591 V M a = V R *
7592@end group
7593@end smallexample
7594
7595@node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7596@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7597
7598@noindent
7599The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7600@expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7601and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7602
7603We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7604commands.
7605
7606@smallexample
7607@group
76082: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
76091: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7610 . .
7611
7612 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7613
7614@end group
7615@end smallexample
7616@noindent
7617@smallexample
7618@group
76192: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
76201: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7621 . .
7622
7623 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7624@end group
7625@end smallexample
7626
7627Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7628get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7629
7630@smallexample
7631@group
76321: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7633 . . .
7634
7635 + 1 V M a < V R +
7636@end group
7637@end smallexample
7638
7639@noindent
7640The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7641
7642@smallexample
7643@group
76441: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7645 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7646
7647 100 / 4 * P /
7648@end group
7649@end smallexample
7650
7651@noindent
7652Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7653by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7654not very efficient!
7655
7656(Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7657will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7658
7659If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7660return to full-sized display of vectors.
7661
7662@node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7663@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7664
7665@noindent
7666This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7667symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7668@expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7669component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7670@texline @math{\theta},
7671@infoline @expr{theta},
7672and see if @expr{x} and
7673@texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7674@infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7675(which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7676The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7677numbers surround an integer.
7678
7679Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7680of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7681to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7682it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7683to estimate @cpi{}!)
7684
7685In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7686coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7687endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7688match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7689Pick random @expr{x} and
7690@texline @math{\theta},
7691@infoline @expr{theta},
7692compute
7693@texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7694@infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7695and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7696
7697We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7698commands.
7699
7700@smallexample
7701@group
77021: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7703 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7704 .
7705
7706v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7707@end group
7708@end smallexample
7709
7710@noindent
7711(The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7712
7713@smallexample
7714@group
77152: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
77161: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7717 .
7718
7719 m d V M C +
7720
7721@end group
7722@end smallexample
7723@noindent
7724@smallexample
7725@group
77261: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7727 . . .
7728
7729 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7730@end group
7731@end smallexample
7732
7733Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7734one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7735a random integer.
7736
7737@smallexample
7738@group
77392: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
77401: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7741 . .
7742
7743 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7744
7745@end group
7746@end smallexample
7747@noindent
7748@smallexample
7749@group
77501: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7751 . . .
7752
7753 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7754
7755@end group
7756@end smallexample
7757@noindent
7758@smallexample
7759@group
77601: 10.714 1: 3.273
7761 . .
7762
7763 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7764@end group
7765@end smallexample
7766
7767For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7768exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7769
7770If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7771return to full-sized display of vectors.
7772
7773@node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7774@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7775
7776@noindent
7777First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7778
7779@smallexample
7780@group
77811: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7782 .
7783
7784 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7785@end group
7786@end smallexample
7787
7788@noindent
7789Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7790there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7791we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7792like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7793
7794We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7795if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7796@expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7797it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7798
7799@smallexample
7800@group
78012: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
78021: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7803 . .
7804
7805 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7806
7807@end group
7808@end smallexample
7809@noindent
7810@smallexample
7811@group
78122: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
78131: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7814 .
7815
7816 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
7817@end group
7818@end smallexample
7819
7820@noindent
7821Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
7822But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
7823@kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
7824function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
7825plus its second argument.
7826
7827@smallexample
7828@group
78291: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
7830 . .
7831
7832 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
7833@end group
7834@end smallexample
7835
7836@noindent
7837If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
7838Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
7839except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
7840
7841Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
7842cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
7843and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
7844without affecting the result. While this means there are more
7845arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
7846the operations are faster.
7847
7848@smallexample
7849@group
78501: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
7851 . .
7852
7853 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
7854@end group
7855@end smallexample
7856
7857Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
7858@w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
7859subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
7860So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
7861
7862@ifnottex
7863@example
78643 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
7865@end example
7866@end ifnottex
7867@tex
7868\turnoffactive
7869\beforedisplay
7870$$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
7871\afterdisplay
7872@end tex
7873
7874@noindent
7875for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
7876the distributive law yields
7877
7878@ifnottex
7879@example
78809 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
7881@end example
7882@end ifnottex
7883@tex
7884\turnoffactive
7885\beforedisplay
7886$$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
7887\afterdisplay
7888@end tex
7889
7890@noindent
7891The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
7892contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
7893term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
7894@expr{n' = 3m + n},
7895
7896@ifnottex
7897@example
78989 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
7899@end example
7900@end ifnottex
7901@tex
7902\turnoffactive
7903\beforedisplay
7904$$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n' $$
7905\afterdisplay
7906@end tex
7907
7908@noindent
7909which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
7910the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
7911
7912Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
7913basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
7914modulo some value @var{m}.
7915
7916@node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
7917@subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
7918
7919We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
7920step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
7921otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
7922
7923@smallexample
7924@group
79252: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
79261: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
7927 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
7928 ...
7929
7930 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
7931@end group
7932@end smallexample
7933
7934Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
7935notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
7936before nesting even begins.
7937
7938We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
7939rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
7940to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
7941
7942@smallexample
7943@group
79442: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
79451: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
7946 .
7947
7948 v t v u g f
7949@end group
7950@end smallexample
7951
7952Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
7953independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
7954to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
7955
7956To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
7957a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
7958length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
7959we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
7960
7961@smallexample
7962@group
79632: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
79641: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
7965 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
7966 ...
7967
7968 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
7969@end group
7970@end smallexample
7971
7972Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
7973
7974An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
7975complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
7976In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
7977and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
7978angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
7979Schwartz.)
7980
7981@node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
7982@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
7983
7984@noindent
7985If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
7986then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
7987
7988@smallexample
7989@group
79901: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
7991 . . .
7992
7993 2 ^ P / c F
7994@end group
7995@end smallexample
7996
7997@noindent
7998Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
7999likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
8000happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
8001irrational number to within 12 digits.
8002
8003But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
8004precision slightly and try again:
8005
8006@smallexample
8007@group
80081: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
8009 . .
8010
8011 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
8012@end group
8013@end smallexample
8014
8015@noindent
8016Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
8017this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
8018@texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
8019@infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
8020
8021Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
8022precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
8023to the current precision before they begin.
8024
8025@node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8026@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
8027
8028@noindent
8029@samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
8030But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
8031
8032@samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
8033of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
8034far as Calc is concerned all infinities are as just as big.
8035In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
8036to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8037@expr{x} is not relevant here.
8038
8039@samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8040the input is infinite.
8041
8042@samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8043represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8044@samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8045The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8046because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8047
8048@samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8049direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8050right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8051so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8052
8053@samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8054@samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8055
8056@samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8057input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8058here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8059treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8060
8061@node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8062@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8063
8064@noindent
8065We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8066@expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8067infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8068values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8069(And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8070in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8071
8072In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8073@w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8074So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8075as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8076
8077The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8078indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8079for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8080Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8081unable to tell what the true answer is.
8082
8083@node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8084@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8085
8086@smallexample
8087@group
80882: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
80891: 17 .
8090 .
8091
8092 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8093@end group
8094@end smallexample
8095
8096@noindent
8097The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8098
8099@smallexample
8100@group
81012: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
81021: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8103 .
8104
8105 20" + 17 *
8106@end group
8107@end smallexample
8108
8109@noindent
8110The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8111
8112@node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8113@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8114
8115@noindent
8116Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8117to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8118We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8119
8120@smallexample
8121@group
81221: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8123 . . .
8124
8125 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8126@end group
8127@end smallexample
8128
8129@noindent
8130(Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8131
8132This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8133@kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8134vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8135``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8136argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8137
8138@smallexample
8139@group
81402: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
81411: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8142 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8143 .
8144
8145 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8146@end group
8147@end smallexample
8148
8149@noindent
8150Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8151
8152@smallexample
8153@group
81541: 242
8155 .
8156
8157' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8158@end group
8159@end smallexample
8160
8161@noindent
8162And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8163
8164@node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8165@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8166
8167@noindent
8168The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8169by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8170that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8171answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8172exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8173don't know the leap year rule.
8174
8175Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8176that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8177the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8178number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8179equal to the number of leap years there were.
8180
8181@smallexample
8182@group
81831: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8184 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8185 .
8186
8187 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8188
8189@end group
8190@end smallexample
8191@noindent
8192@smallexample
8193@group
81943: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
81952: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
81961: 1991 . .
8197 .
8198
8199 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8200@end group
8201@end smallexample
8202
8203@c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8204@noindent
8205There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8206of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8207unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8208background information in that regard.)
8209
8210@node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8211@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8212
8213@noindent
8214The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8215@samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8216
8217@smallexample
8218@group
82191: 1. 2: 1.
8220 . 1: 0.2
8221 .
8222
8223 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8224@end group
8225@end smallexample
8226
8227Now we simply chug through the formula.
8228
8229@smallexample
8230@group
82311: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8232 . . .
8233
8234 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8235@end group
8236@end smallexample
8237
8238It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8239well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8240
8241@smallexample
8242@group
82433: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
82442: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
82451: 706.21 .
8246 .
8247
8248 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8249@end group
8250@end smallexample
8251
8252@noindent
8253Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8254
8255@node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8256@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8257
8258@noindent
8259The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8260Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8261close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8262is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8263but with no upper bound.
8264
8265The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8266
8267Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8268@w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8269@w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8270is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8271
8272If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8273instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8274as a possible value.
8275
8276The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8277Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8278It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8279will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8280the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8281in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8282represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8283It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8284minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8285that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8286
8287@node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8288@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8289
8290@smallexample
8291@group
82921: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8293 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8294 . .
8295
8296 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8297@end group
8298@end smallexample
8299
8300@noindent
8301In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
83023, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8303of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8304
8305An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8306many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8307for different numbers.
8308
8309The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8310
8311@node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8312@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8313
8314@noindent
8315Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8316
8317@smallexample
8318@group
83191: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8320 . 811749612 .
8321 .
8322
8323 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8324@end group
8325@end smallexample
8326
8327@noindent
8328Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8329must not be prime.
8330
8331It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8332various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8333a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8334use this method to test the second number.
8335
8336@smallexample
8337@group
83382: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
83391: 15485863 .
8340 .
8341
8342 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8343@end group
8344@end smallexample
8345
8346@noindent
8347The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
834815485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8349
8350Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8351would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8352the power using full integer arithmetic.
8353
8354Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8355numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8356of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8357to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8358
8359@node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8360@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8361
8362@noindent
8363There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8364One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8365multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8366
8367@smallexample
8368@group
83691: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8370 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8371 .
8372
8373 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8374
8375@end group
8376@end smallexample
8377@noindent
8378@smallexample
8379@group
83802: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
83811: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8382 .
8383
8384 x time @key{RET} +
8385@end group
8386@end smallexample
8387
8388@noindent
8389It will be just after six in the morning.
8390
8391The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8392HMS form:
8393
8394@smallexample
8395@group
83961: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8397 . .
8398
8399 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8400@end group
8401@end smallexample
8402
8403@noindent
8404The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8405the actual number 3.14159...
8406
8407@node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8408@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8409
8410@noindent
8411As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8412each.
8413
8414@smallexample
8415@group
84162: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
84171: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8418 .
8419
8420 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8421
8422@end group
8423@end smallexample
8424@noindent
8425@smallexample
8426@group
84271: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8428 .
8429
8430 17 *
8431@end group
8432@end smallexample
8433
8434@noindent
8435No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8436
8437@node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8438@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8439
8440@noindent
8441Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8442
8443@node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8444@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8445
8446@noindent
8447How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8448to the other?
8449
8450@smallexample
8451@group
84521: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8453 . .
8454
8455 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8456@end group
8457@end smallexample
8458
8459@noindent
8460(Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8461
8462@smallexample
8463@group
84641: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356 ns / ns 1: 0.81356
84652: 4.1 ns . .
8466 .
8467
8468 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} / u s
8469@end group
8470@end smallexample
8471
8472@noindent
8473Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8474go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8475could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8476
8477@node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8478@subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8479
8480@noindent
8481The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8482find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8483
8484@smallexample
8485@group
84861: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8487 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8488 .
8489
8490 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8491@end group
8492@end smallexample
8493
8494The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8495number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8496answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8497
8498@smallexample
8499@group
85001: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8501 . 1: 2 .
8502 .
8503
8504 u s 2 B
8505@end group
8506@end smallexample
8507
8508@noindent
8509Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8510
8511@node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8512@subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8513
8514@noindent
8515@c [fix-ref Declarations]
8516The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8517Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8518if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8519simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8520that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8521that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8522
8523@node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8524@subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8525
8526@noindent
8527Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8528is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8529@expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8530will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8531familiar form.
8532
8533@smallexample
8534@group
85351: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8536 . .
8537
8538 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8539
8540@end group
8541@end smallexample
8542@noindent
8543@smallexample
8544@group
85451: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: (x - 1.19023) (x + 1.19023) x
8546 . .
8547
8548 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8549
8550@end group
8551@end smallexample
8552@noindent
8553@smallexample
8554@group
85551: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8556 . .
8557
8558 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8559@end group
8560@end smallexample
8561
8562@noindent
8563Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8564same as the original polynomial.
8565
8566@node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8567@subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8568
8569@smallexample
8570@group
85711: x sin(pi x) 1: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8572 . .
8573
8574 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8575
8576@end group
8577@end smallexample
8578@noindent
8579@smallexample
8580@group
85811: [y, 1]
85822: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8583 .
8584
8585 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8586
8587@end group
8588@end smallexample
8589@noindent
8590@smallexample
8591@group
85921: [(sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2, (sin(pi) - pi cos(pi)) / pi^2]
8593 .
8594
8595 V M $ @key{RET}
8596
8597@end group
8598@end smallexample
8599@noindent
8600@smallexample
8601@group
86021: (sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2 + (pi cos(pi) - sin(pi)) / pi^2
8603 .
8604
8605 V R -
8606
8607@end group
8608@end smallexample
8609@noindent
8610@smallexample
8611@group
86121: (sin(3.14159 y) - 3.14159 y cos(3.14159 y)) / 9.8696 - 0.3183
8613 .
8614
8615 =
8616
8617@end group
8618@end smallexample
8619@noindent
8620@smallexample
8621@group
86221: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8623 .
8624
8625 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8626@end group
8627@end smallexample
8628
8629@node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8630@subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8631
8632@noindent
8633The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8634the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8635coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8636coefficients. Here's one way:
8637
8638@smallexample
8639@group
86402: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
86411: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8642 . .
8643
8644 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8645
8646@end group
8647@end smallexample
8648@noindent
8649@smallexample
8650@group
86511: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8652 . .
8653
8654 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8655@end group
8656@end smallexample
8657
8658@noindent
8659Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8660eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8661
8662@smallexample
8663@group
86642: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
86651: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8666 .
8667
8668 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8669
8670@end group
8671@end smallexample
8672@noindent
8673@smallexample
8674@group
86752: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
86761: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8677 .
8678
8679 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8680@end group
8681@end smallexample
8682
8683@noindent
8684Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8685same thing.
8686
8687@smallexample
8688@group
86891: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8690 . . .
8691
8692 * .1 * 3 /
8693@end group
8694@end smallexample
8695
8696@noindent
8697Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8698
8699@node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8700@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8701
8702@noindent
8703We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8704
8705@smallexample
8706@group
8707 ___
8708 2 + V 2
87091: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: --------
8710 . ___
8711 1 + V 2
8712
8713 .
8714
8715 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8716@end group
8717@end smallexample
8718
8719@noindent
8720Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8721
8722@smallexample
8723@group
8724 ___ ___
87251: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8726 .
8727
8728 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8729
8730@end group
8731@end smallexample
8732@noindent
8733@smallexample
8734@group
8735 ___ ___
87361: 2 + V 2 - 2 1: V 2
8737 . .
8738
8739 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c a s
8740@end group
8741@end smallexample
8742
8743@noindent
8744(We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8745second step.)
8746
8747The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8748different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8749sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8750
8751@node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8752@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8753
8754@noindent
8755Here is the rule set:
8756
8757@smallexample
8758@group
8759[ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8760 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8761 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8762@end group
8763@end smallexample
8764
8765@noindent
8766The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8767into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8768second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8769is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8770says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8771then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8772numbers.
8773
8774Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8775conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8776the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8777the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8778extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8779
8780Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8781three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8782which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8783help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8784@samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8785function.
8786
8787@node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8788@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8789
8790@noindent
8791He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8792@w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8793apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8794@samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8795@samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8796around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8797to make sure the rule applied only once.
8798
8799(Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8800really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8801treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8802to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8803``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8804@samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8805@samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8806on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8807@samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8808
8809@node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8810@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8811
8812@noindent
8813@ignore
8814@starindex
8815@end ignore
8816@tindex seq
8817Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
8818
8819@smallexample
8820@group
8821[ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
8822 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
8823@end group
8824@end smallexample
8825
8826Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
8827rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
8828
8829@example
8830seq( 3, 1)
8831seq(10, 2)
8832seq( 5, 3)
8833seq(16, 4)
8834seq( 8, 5)
8835seq( 4, 6)
8836seq( 2, 7)
8837seq( 1, 8)
8838@end example
8839
8840@noindent
8841whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
8842
8843We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
8844
8845@smallexample
8846@group
8847[ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
8848 seq(1, c) := c,
8849 ... ]
8850@end group
8851@end smallexample
8852
8853@noindent
8854Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
8855as the result.
8856
8857The change to return a vector is quite simple:
8858
8859@smallexample
8860@group
8861[ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
8862 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
8863 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
8864 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
8865@end group
8866@end smallexample
8867
8868@noindent
8869Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
8870
8871Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
8872rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
8873But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
8874initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
8875
8876While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
8877was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
8878will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
8879the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
8880apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
8881
8882@node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8883@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
8884
8885@noindent
8886@ignore
8887@starindex
8888@end ignore
8889@tindex nterms
8890If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' must
8891be `@tfn{nterms(}@var{a}@tfn{)}' plus `@tfn{nterms(}@var{b}@tfn{)}'. If @expr{x}
8892is not a sum, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' = 1.
8893
8894@smallexample
8895@group
8896[ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
8897 nterms(x) := 1 ]
8898@end group
8899@end smallexample
8900
8901@noindent
8902Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
8903match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
8904already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
8905
8906@node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8907@subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
8908
8909@noindent
8910Here is a rule set that will do the job:
8911
8912@smallexample
8913@group
8914[ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
8915 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8916 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8917 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8918 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8919 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
8920 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
8921 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
8922@end group
8923@end smallexample
8924
8925If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
8926on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
8927testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
8928say, @code{O}, first.
8929
8930The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
8931rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
8932Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
8933apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
8934you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
8935
8936In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O.
8937The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
8938@samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
8939as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
8940
8941The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
8942
8943The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
8944is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
8945with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
8946
8947The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
8948(It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
8949is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
8950@w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
8951but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
8952
8953The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
8954
8955Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
8956that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
8957function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
8958a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
8959on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
8960objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
8961@code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
8962rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
8963you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
8964before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
8965although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
8966
8967@c [fix-ref Compositions]
8968Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
8969similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
8970like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
8971@var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
8972power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
8973and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
8974with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
8975objects have a special display format that makes them look like
8976@samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
8977for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
8978this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
8979in Lisp.)
8980
8981@node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8982@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
8983
8984@noindent
8985Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
8986@kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
8987variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
8988change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
8989to be used within @code{ninteg}.
8990
8991The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
8992(The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
8993
8994@node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8995@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
8996
8997@noindent
8998One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
8999it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
9000
9001Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
9002again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
9003
9004Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
9005command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
9006which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
9007
9008Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
9009@w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
9010
9011@node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
9012@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
9013
9014@noindent
9015Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
9016algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
9017
9018@noindent
9019Computing
9020@texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
9021@infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
9022
9023Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
9024
9025Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
9026
9027@noindent
9028Computing the logarithm:
9029
9030Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
9031
9032Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9033
9034@noindent
9035Computing the vector of integers:
9036
9037Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9038@kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9039from the stack.)
9040
9041Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9042number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9043next command.)
9044
9045Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9046
9047@node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9048@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9049
9050@noindent
9051Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9052
9053@node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9054@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9055
9056@smallexample
9057@group
90582: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
90591: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9060 . .
9061
9062 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9063@end group
9064@end smallexample
9065
9066@noindent
9067This answer is quite accurate.
9068
9069@node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9070@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9071
9072@noindent
9073Here is the matrix:
9074
9075@example
9076[ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9077 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9078@end example
9079
9080@noindent
9081Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9082and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9083
9084@example
9085C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9086@end example
9087
9088@noindent
9089This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9090matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9091@texline @math{\log_2 n}
9092@infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9093steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9094number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9095@kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9096required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9097
9098@node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9099@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9100
9101@noindent
9102The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9103the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9104a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9105
9106@smallexample
9107@group
91081: 1 2: 1 1: .
9109 . 1: 4
9110 .
9111
9112 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9113@end group
9114@end smallexample
9115
9116@noindent
9117The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9118so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9119itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9120count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9121the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9122the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9123loop counter exceeds 4.
9124
9125@smallexample
9126@group
91272: 31 3: 31
91281: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9129 . 1: 4.02724519544
9130 .
9131
9132 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9133@end group
9134@end smallexample
9135
9136Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9137harmonic number is 4.02.
9138
9139@node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9140@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9141
9142@noindent
9143The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9144the formula
9145@texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9146@infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9147
9148(Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9149below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9150entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9151keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9152pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9153just for purposes of illustration.)
9154
9155@smallexample
9156@group
91572: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
91581: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9159 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9160 .
9161
9162' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9163
9164@end group
9165@end smallexample
9166@noindent
9167@smallexample
9168@group
91692: 4.5
91701: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9171 .
9172
9173 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9174@end group
9175@end smallexample
9176
9177Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9178limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9179(Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9180repetitions are done.)
9181
9182@smallexample
9183@group
91841: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9185 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9186 1: 4.5 .
9187 .
9188
9189 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9190@end group
9191@end smallexample
9192
9193This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9194old one to see if we've converged.
9195
9196@smallexample
9197@group
91983: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
91992: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
92001: 4.5 .
9201 .
9202
9203 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9204@end group
9205@end smallexample
9206
9207The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9208the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9209
9210@smallexample
9211@group
92122: 5.26345856348
92131: 0.499999999997
9214 .
9215
9216 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9217@end group
9218@end smallexample
9219
9220Let's test the new definition again:
9221
9222@smallexample
9223@group
92242: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
92251: 1 .
9226 .
9227
9228 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9229@end group
9230@end smallexample
9231
9232Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9233
9234@example
9235@group
9236C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9237 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9238 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9239 Z >
9240 Z '
9241C-x )
9242@end group
9243@end example
9244
9245@c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9246It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9247repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9248to see how to use it.
9249
9250@c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9251Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9252method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9253@xref{Root Finding}.
9254
9255@node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9256@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9257
9258@noindent
9259The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9260``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9261reduce the problem using
9262@texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9263@infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9264on to compute
9265@texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9266@infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9267and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9268step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9269
9270(Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9271below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9272entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9273keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9274pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9275just for purposes of illustration.)
9276
9277@smallexample
9278@group
92791: 1. 1: 1.
9280 . .
9281
9282 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9283@end group
9284@end smallexample
9285
9286Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9287factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9288
9289(By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9290otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9291and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9292are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9293
9294@smallexample
9295@group
92963: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
92972: 1. 1: 1 .
92981: 5 .
9299 .
9300
9301 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9302@end group
9303@end smallexample
9304
9305Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9306@texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9307@infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9308minus the adjustment factor.
9309
9310@smallexample
9311@group
93122: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
93131: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9314 . .
9315
9316 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9317@end group
9318@end smallexample
9319
9320Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9321up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9322@kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9323
9324@smallexample
9325@group
93263: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
93272: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
93281: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9329 . . 1: 36.
9330 .
9331
9332 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9333
9334@end group
9335@end smallexample
9336@noindent
9337@smallexample
9338@group
93393: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
93402: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
93411: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9342 . .
9343
9344 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9345@end group
9346@end smallexample
9347
9348This is the value of
9349@texline @math{-\gamma},
9350@infoline @expr{- gamma},
9351with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9352a higher precision:
9353
9354@smallexample
9355@group
93562: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
93571: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9358
9359 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9360@end group
9361@end smallexample
9362
9363Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9364
9365@example
9366@group
9367C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9368 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9369 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9370 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9371 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9372 2 Z )
9373 Z '
9374C-x )
9375@end group
9376@end example
9377
9378@node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9379@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9380
9381@noindent
9382Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9383a term like
9384@texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9385@infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9386Taking the derivative of a constant
9387produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9388derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9389coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9390
9391(Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9392below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9393entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9394keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9395pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9396just for purposes of illustration.)
9397
9398@smallexample
9399@group
94002: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
94011: 6 2: 0
9402 . 1: 6
9403 .
9404
9405 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9406@end group
9407@end smallexample
9408
9409@noindent
9410Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9411
9412@smallexample
9413@group
94142: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
94151: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9416 . 1: 1 .
9417 .
9418
9419 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9420@end group
9421@end smallexample
9422
9423@noindent
9424Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9425in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9426have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9427
9428@smallexample
9429@group
94301: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9431 . . .
9432
9433 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9434@end group
9435@end smallexample
9436
9437To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9438against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9439
9440@smallexample
9441@group
94422: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
94431: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9444 . .
9445
9446 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9447
9448@end group
9449@end smallexample
9450@noindent
9451@smallexample
9452@group
94532: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
94541: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9455 .
9456
9457 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9458@end group
9459@end smallexample
9460
9461Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9462
9463@example
9464@group
9465C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9466 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9467 a d x @key{RET}
9468 1 Z ) r 1
9469 Z '
9470C-x )
9471
9472C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9473@end group
9474@end example
9475
9476@node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9477@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9478
9479@noindent
9480First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9481@w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9482return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9483sure the stack comes out right.
9484
9485@smallexample
9486@group
94872: 4 1: 4 2: 4
94881: 2 . 1: 2
9489 . .
9490
9491 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9492@end group
9493@end smallexample
9494
9495The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9496of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9497definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9498to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9499
9500(Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9501below. You can use @kbd{C-x * m} to load it from there.)
9502
9503@smallexample
9504@group
95052: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
95061: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9507 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9508 1: 2 .
9509 .
9510
9511 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9512
9513@end group
9514@end smallexample
9515@noindent
9516@smallexample
9517@group
95184: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
95193: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
95202: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
95211: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9522 . . .
9523
9524 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9525@end group
9526@end smallexample
9527
9528@noindent
9529(Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9530it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9531
9532@smallexample
9533@group
95343: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
95352: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
95361: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9537 . 1: 2 .
9538 .
9539
9540 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9541
9542@end group
9543@end smallexample
9544@noindent
9545@smallexample
9546@group
95471: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9548 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9549 . .
9550
9551 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9552@end group
9553@end smallexample
9554
9555Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9556bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9557the right answers.
9558
9559Here's the full program once again:
9560
9561@example
9562@group
9563C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9564 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9565 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9566 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9567 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9568 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9569 Z ]
9570 Z ]
9571C-x )
9572@end group
9573@end example
9574
9575You can read this definition using @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9576followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9577first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9578definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{C-x * m} is often
9579the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9580
9581@node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9582@subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9583
9584@noindent
9585This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9586denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9587
9588First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9589Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9590
9591@smallexample
9592s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9593[ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9594 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9595 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9596C-c C-c
9597@end smallexample
9598
9599Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9600
9601@smallexample
9602@group
96032: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
96041: 2 . .
9605 .
9606
9607 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9608@end group
9609@end smallexample
9610
9611As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9612rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9613the last rule.
9614
9615@c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9616@tex
9617\global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9618@end tex
9619
9620@c [reference]
9621
9622@node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9623@chapter Introduction
9624
9625@noindent
9626This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9627It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9628numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9629
9630@c [when-split]
9631@c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9632
9633@menu
9634* Basic Commands::
9635* Help Commands::
9636* Stack Basics::
9637* Numeric Entry::
9638* Algebraic Entry::
9639* Quick Calculator::
9640* Prefix Arguments::
9641* Undo::
9642* Error Messages::
9643* Multiple Calculators::
9644* Troubleshooting Commands::
9645@end menu
9646
9647@node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9648@section Basic Commands
9649
9650@noindent
9651@pindex calc
9652@pindex calc-mode
9653@cindex Starting the Calculator
9654@cindex Running the Calculator
9655To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9656By default this creates a pair of small windows, @samp{*Calculator*}
9657and @samp{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9658Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9659It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9660mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9661mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9662list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9663Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9664still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9665to turn the trail window off, but the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9666still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9667
9668@kindex C-x * c
9669@kindex C-x * *
9670@ignore
9671@mindex @null
9672@end ignore
9673In most installations, the @kbd{C-x * c} key sequence is a more
9674convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{C-x * *}
9675is a synonym for @kbd{C-x * c} unless you last used Calc
9676in its Keypad mode.
9677
9678@kindex x
9679@kindex M-x
9680@pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9681Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9682letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9683for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9684key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9685is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9686for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9687@kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9688
3bc88bc9
JB
9689Although Calc is designed to be used from the keyboard, some of
9690Calc's more common commands are available from a menu. In the menu, the
9691arguments to the functions are given by referring to their stack level
9692numbers.
9693
4009494e
GM
9694@cindex Extensions module
9695@cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9696The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}, the
9697Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9698contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9699auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9700functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9701of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9702little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9703extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9704extensions by using the @kbd{C-x * L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9705command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9706
9707If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{C-x * c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9708the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9709If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9710loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9711of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9712to auto-load the Calculator.
9713
9714@kindex C-x * b
9715@pindex full-calc
9716If you type @kbd{C-x * b}, then next time you use @kbd{C-x * c} you
9717will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9718When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{C-x * c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9719command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9720@samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9721as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9722like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9723
9724@kindex C-x * o
9725@pindex calc-other-window
9726The @kbd{C-x * o} command is like @kbd{C-x * c} except that the Calc
9727window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9728window, @kbd{C-x * o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9729@kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9730tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9731@kbd{C-x * o} takes care not to do.)
9732
9733@ignore
9734@mindex C-x * q
9735@end ignore
9736For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{C-x * q} (@code{quick-calc})
9737which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9738displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9739any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9740
9741@ignore
9742@mindex C-x * k
9743@end ignore
9744Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9745@kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9746``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9747the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9748
9749@kindex q
9750@pindex calc-quit
9751@cindex Quitting the Calculator
9752@cindex Exiting the Calculator
9753The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9754Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9755If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9756contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}
9757again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9758@code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{C-x * *} as toggling the
9759Calculator on and off.
9760
9761@kindex C-x * x
9762The @kbd{C-x * x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9763user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9764It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9765
9766@kindex d @key{SPC}
9767@pindex calc-refresh
9768@cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9769@cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9770The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9771of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9772buffer have been damaged somehow.
9773
9774@ignore
9775@mindex o
9776@end ignore
9777The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9778``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9779
9780@kindex <
9781@kindex >
9782@pindex calc-scroll-left
9783@pindex calc-scroll-right
9784@cindex Horizontal scrolling
9785@cindex Scrolling
9786@cindex Wide text, scrolling
9787The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9788@code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9789scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9790default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9791window whenever it can.)
9792
9793@kindex @{
9794@kindex @}
9795@pindex calc-scroll-down
9796@pindex calc-scroll-up
9797@cindex Vertical scrolling
9798The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9799and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9800height of the Calc window.
9801
9802@kindex C-x * 0
9803@pindex calc-reset
9804The @kbd{C-x * 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{C-x *} followed
9805by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9806the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9807that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9808caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9809values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9810its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9811With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of
9812the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9813negative prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of the
9814stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9815
4009494e
GM
9816@node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
9817@section Help Commands
9818
9819@noindent
9820@cindex Help commands
9821@kindex ?
9822@pindex calc-help
9823The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
9824Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs'
9825@key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
9826@kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
9827prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
9828to see additional commands for that prefix.)
9829
9830@kindex h h
9831@pindex calc-full-help
9832The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
9833responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
9834summary of Calc keystrokes.
9835
9836In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
9837provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
9838Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
9839
9840@kindex h i
9841@kindex C-x * i
9842@kindex i
9843@pindex calc-info
9844The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
9845to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
9846@kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
9847is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
9848manual. The @kbd{C-x * i} command is another way to read the Calc
9849manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
9850not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
9851@kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
9852different command in a future version of Calc.
9853
9854@kindex h t
9855@kindex C-x * t
9856@pindex calc-tutorial
9857The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
9858the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
9859except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
9860than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
9861node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
9862using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
9863The @kbd{C-x * t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
9864all times).
9865
9866@kindex h s
9867@kindex C-x * s
9868@pindex calc-info-summary
9869The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
9870on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{C-x * s}
9871key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
9872
9873@kindex h k
9874@pindex calc-describe-key
9875The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
9876sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
9877up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
9878command. This works by looking up the textual description of
9879the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
9880node indicated by the index.
9881
9882Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
9883strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
9884more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
9885(@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
9886
9887@kindex h c
9888@pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
9889The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
9890key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
9891the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
9892Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
9893there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
9894(@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
9895gives the description:
9896
9897@smallexample
9898H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
9899@end smallexample
9900
9901@noindent
9902which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
9903takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
9904then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
9905The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
9906additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
9907
9908@kindex h f
9909@pindex calc-describe-function
9910The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
9911algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
9912algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
9913Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
9914up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
9915symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
9916@samp{=>}.
9917
9918@kindex h v
9919@pindex calc-describe-variable
9920The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
9921variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
9922@code{PlotRejects}.
9923
9924@kindex h b
9925@pindex describe-bindings
9926The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
9927@kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
9928listed.
9929
9930@kindex h n
9931The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
9932the ``news'' or change history of Calc. This is kept in the file
9933@file{README}, which Calc looks for in the same directory as the Calc
9934source files.
9935
9936@kindex h C-c
9937@kindex h C-d
9938@kindex h C-w
9939The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
9940distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
9941pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
9942Bugs'' sections of the manual.
9943
9944@node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
9945@section Stack Basics
9946
9947@noindent
9948@cindex Stack basics
9949@c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
9950Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
9951Tutorial}.
9952
9953To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
9954@kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
9955(@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
9956The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
9957@kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
9958and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
9959further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
99603 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
9961
9962Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
9963of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
9964the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
9965directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
9966command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
9967@pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
9968
9969@kindex d l
9970@pindex calc-line-numbering
9971Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
9972the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
9973of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
9974whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
9975slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
9976
9977@kindex o
9978@pindex calc-realign
9979The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
9980the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
9981horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
9982argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
9983
9984The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
9985two consecutive numbers.
9986(After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
9987would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
9988right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
9989the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
9990
9991The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
9992The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
9993@xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
9994commands.
9995
9996@node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
9997@section Numeric Entry
9998
9999@noindent
10000@kindex 0-9
10001@kindex .
10002@kindex e
10003@cindex Numeric entry
10004@cindex Entering numbers
10005Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
10006minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
10007or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
10008pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
10009you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
10010
10011@cindex Minus signs
10012@cindex Negative numbers, entering
10013@kindex _
10014There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
10015typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
10016(change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
10017different keys for these operations, respectively:
10018@kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
10019the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
10020of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10021The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10022the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10023number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10024@kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10025
10026Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10027non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10028These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10029data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10030
10031During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10032
10033@node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10034@section Algebraic Entry
10035
10036@noindent
10037@kindex '
10038@pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10039@cindex Algebraic notation
10040@cindex Formulas, entering
8dc6104d
JB
10041The @kbd{'} (@code{calc-algebraic-entry}) command can be used to enter
10042calculations in algebraic form. This is accomplished by typing the
10043apostrophe key, ', followed by the expression in standard format:
4009494e
GM
10044
10045@example
10046' 2+3*4 @key{RET}.
10047@end example
10048
10049@noindent
10050This will compute
10051@texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10052@infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10053and push it on the stack. If you wish you can
10054ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10055expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10056clear previous results off the stack.
10057
10058You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
8dc6104d
JB
10059the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do
10060this would be to fix a typo, as the full Emacs cursor motion and editing
10061keys are available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
4009494e
GM
10062
10063In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10064press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10065you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10066@xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10067
10068@kindex m a
10069@pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10070@cindex Algebraic Mode
10071If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10072(@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10073digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10074start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10075you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10076begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10077but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10078@kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10079thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10080
10081@cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10082If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10083command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10084Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10085only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10086
10087@kindex m t
10088@pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10089@cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10090The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10091stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10092punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10093@w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10094@kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10095Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10096is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10097@kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10098mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10099that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10100@samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10101
10102Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10103algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10104modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10105
10106@kindex $
10107@cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10108Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10109represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10110contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10111stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10112stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10113@key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10114initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10115first character in the new formula.
10116
10117Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10118symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10119removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10120signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10121adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10122with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10123since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10124
10125A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10126sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10127like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10128to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10129@samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10130on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10131
10132If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10133is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10134those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10135@samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10136@samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10137@key{TAB} key.
10138
10139You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10140of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10141formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10142the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10143
10144If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10145instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables the default simplifications
10146(as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10147is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10148on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10149you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10150
10151@node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10152@section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10153
10154@noindent
10155@kindex C-x * q
10156@pindex quick-calc
10157@cindex Quick Calculator
10158There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10159is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{C-x * q} (or
10160@kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10161The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10162area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10163
10164You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10165refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10166not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10167Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10168forget what it was, just run @code{C-x * q} again and enter
10169@samp{$} as the formula.
10170
10171If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10172session, the @kbd{C-x * q} command will create the @code{*Calculator*}
10173buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10174refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10175Calculator refers to the @code{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10176settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10177Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10178the regular @kbd{p} command.
10179
10180If you use @code{C-x * q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10181effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10182
10183The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10184as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10185yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10186to yank the result into the next @kbd{C-x * q} input line as a more
10187explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10188into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{C-x * c}.
10189
10190If you finish your formula by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead
10191of @key{RET}, the result is inserted immediately into the current
10192buffer rather than going into the kill ring.
10193
10194Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10195key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10196If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10197@samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10198then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10199@xref{Store and Recall}.
10200
10201If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10202the number will also be displayed in hex, octal and binary formats. If
10203the integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10204an ASCII character.
10205
10206For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10207result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10208`x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10209is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10210running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10211result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10212decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10213
10214Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10215or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10216merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10217small calculations.
10218
10219@node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10220@section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10221
10222@noindent
10223Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10224@kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10225the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10226Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10227and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10228
10229As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10230which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10231operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10232on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10233on the entire stack.
10234
10235Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10236scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10237operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10238(that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10239conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10240@var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10241to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10242two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10243prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10244stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10245@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10246@var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10247(for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10248This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10249argument for some other purpose.
10250
10251Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10252a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10253or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10254@kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10255
10256@kindex ~
10257@pindex calc-num-prefix
10258You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10259top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10260For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10261(silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10262to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10263
10264Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10265pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10266
10267@node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10268@section Undoing Mistakes
10269
10270@noindent
10271@kindex U
10272@kindex C-_
10273@pindex calc-undo
10274@cindex Mistakes, undoing
10275@cindex Undoing mistakes
10276@cindex Errors, undoing
10277The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10278If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10279are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10280queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10281The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10282farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
10283specified number of operations. The undo history is cleared only by the
10284@kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command. (Recall that @kbd{C-x * c} is
10285synonymous with @code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this
10286also clears the undo history.)
10287
10288Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10289undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10290will need to reset the mode yourself.
10291
10292@kindex D
10293@pindex calc-redo
10294@cindex Redoing after an Undo
10295The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10296mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10297equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10298times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10299information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10300information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10301any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10302
10303@kindex M-@key{RET}
10304@pindex calc-last-args
10305@cindex Last-arguments feature
10306@cindex Arguments, restoring
10307The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10308it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10309however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10310prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10311command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10312onto the stack.
10313
10314The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10315to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10316
10317It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10318@xref{Trail Commands}.
10319
10320The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10321
10322@node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10323@section Error Messages
10324
10325@noindent
10326@kindex w
10327@pindex calc-why
10328@cindex Errors, messages
10329@cindex Why did an error occur?
10330Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10331simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10332@kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10333the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10334reasons for this to happen.
10335
10336When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10337produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10338surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10339Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10340if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10341the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10342will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10343
10344@kindex d w
10345@pindex calc-auto-why
10346The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10347are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10348after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10349``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10350@emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10351that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10352
10353@node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10354@section Multiple Calculators
10355
10356@noindent
10357@pindex another-calc
10358It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10359Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10360is similar to @kbd{C-x * c} except that if a @samp{*Calculator*}
10361buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10362form @samp{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10363command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10364this would ordinarily never be done.
10365
10366The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10367it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10368Calculator buffer.
10369
10370Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10371such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10372variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10373global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10374Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10375the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10376
10377There is only one trail buffer, @samp{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10378Calculator buffers.
10379
10380@node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10381@section Troubleshooting Commands
10382
10383@noindent
10384This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10385incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10386
10387@xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10388to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10389
10390@menu
10391* Autoloading Problems::
10392* Recursion Depth::
10393* Caches::
10394* Debugging Calc::
10395@end menu
10396
10397@node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10398@subsection Autoloading Problems
10399
10400@noindent
10401The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10402loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10403Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10404necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10405work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10406
10407@kindex C-x * L
10408@pindex calc-load-everything
10409If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{C-x * L}
10410(@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10411loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10412memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10413
10414@node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10415@subsection Recursion Depth
10416
10417@noindent
10418@kindex M
10419@kindex I M
10420@pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10421@pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10422@cindex Recursion depth
10423@cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10424@cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10425@cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10426Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10427variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10428possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10429ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10430ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10431to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10432calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10433
10434The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10435is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10436decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10437The default value is 1000.
10438
10439These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10440internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10441
10442@node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10443@subsection Caches
10444
10445@noindent
10446@cindex Caches
10447@cindex Flushing caches
10448Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10449example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10450constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10451is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10452approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10453unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10454logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10455@cpiover{4} and
10456@texline @math{\ln 2}.
10457@infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10458The visible effect of caching is that
10459high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10460Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10461functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10462data points computed by the graphing commands.
10463
10464@pindex calc-flush-caches
10465If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10466@code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10467(This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10468The @kbd{C-x * 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10469with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10470
10471@node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10472@subsection Debugging Calc
10473
10474@noindent
10475A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10476@xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10477your own Calc commands.
10478
10479@kindex Z T
10480@pindex calc-timing
10481The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10482in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10483Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10484to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10485accurate only to within one second.
10486
10487All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10488taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10489counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10490be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10491implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10492a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10493keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10494command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10495to execute the whole macro.
10496
10497Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10498executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10499So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10500that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10501this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10502to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10503@kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10504
10505Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10506@code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10507usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10508This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10509the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10510abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10511factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10512
10513Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10514extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10515the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10516exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10517stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10518Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10519in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10520error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10521errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10522will be lost.
10523
10524@node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10525@chapter Data Types
10526
10527@noindent
10528This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10529on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10530entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10531types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10532
10533Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10534numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10535types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10536or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10537arbitrarily:@: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10538Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10539matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10540
10541@menu
10542* Integers:: The most basic data type.
10543* Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10544* Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10545* Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10546* Infinities::
10547* Vectors and Matrices::
10548* Strings::
10549* HMS Forms::
10550* Date Forms::
10551* Modulo Forms::
10552* Error Forms::
10553* Interval Forms::
10554* Incomplete Objects::
10555* Variables::
10556* Formulas::
10557@end menu
10558
10559@node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10560@section Integers
10561
10562@noindent
10563@cindex Integers
10564The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10565subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10566integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10567integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10568floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10569@xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10570
10571A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10572sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10573insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10574must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10575
10576@kindex #
10577A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10578between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10579and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10580digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10581to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10582may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10583number, the current display radix is used.
10584
10585@node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10586@section Fractions
10587
10588@noindent
10589@cindex Fractions
10590A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10591written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10592performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10593@samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10594assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10595When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10596simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10597
10598Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10599represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10600display formats.
10601
10602Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10603@samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10604form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10605
10606@node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10607@section Floats
10608
10609@noindent
10610@cindex Floating-point numbers
10611A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10612notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10613governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10614range of acceptable values is from
10615@texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10616@infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10617(inclusive) to
10618@texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10619@infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10620(exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10621
10622Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10623as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10624messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10625indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10626that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10627by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10628overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10629(In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10630would have overflowed!)
10631
10632If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10633will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10634value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10635floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10636
10637Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10638exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10639including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10640of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10641For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10642or 0.235.
10643
10644Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10645all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10646displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10647available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10648
10649@cindex Accuracy of calculations
10650Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10651of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10652number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10653rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10654display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10655as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10656digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10657final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10658accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10659result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10660Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10661way.
10662
10663While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10664and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. Since a
10665float that is entered in a radix other that 10 will be converted to
10666decimal, the number that Calc stores may not be exactly the number that
10667was entered, it will be the closest decimal approximation given the
10668current precison. The notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}}
10669is a floating-point number whose digits are in the specified radix.
10670Note that the @samp{.} is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point''
10671than as a decimal point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is
10672defined as @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can
10673use @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific
10674notation. The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a
10675power of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above,
10676the letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10677out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10678Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10679
10680@node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10681@section Complex Numbers
10682
10683@noindent
10684@cindex Complex numbers
10685There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10686polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10687@samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10688@var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10689Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10690notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10691
10692Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10693@texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'
10694@infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'
10695where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10696@texline @math{\theta}
10697@infoline @var{theta}
10698is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10699@texline @math{\theta}
10700@infoline @var{theta}
10701depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10702generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10703in radians.
10704
10705Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10706@xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10707
10708Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10709results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10710are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10711a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10712type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10713
10714A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10715is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10716number.
10717
10718@node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10719@section Infinities
10720
10721@noindent
10722@cindex Infinity
10723@cindex @code{inf} variable
10724@cindex @code{uinf} variable
10725@cindex @code{nan} variable
10726@vindex inf
10727@vindex uinf
10728@vindex nan
10729The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10730Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10731@code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10732variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10733names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10734treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10735entered using algebraic entry.
10736
10737Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10738``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10739so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10740really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10741larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10742that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10743would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10744@samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10745@texline @math{e^x}
10746@infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10747grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10748stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10749@samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10750direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10751
10752The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10753really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10754approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10755tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10756positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10757@samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10758toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10759could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10760@samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10761@dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10762large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10763
10764Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10765Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10766already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10767error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10768command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10769@expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10770an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10771as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10772is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10773some cases.
10774
10775Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10776e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10777@samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10778adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10779Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10780that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10781Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10782note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10783notation.
10784
10785It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10786@samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10787came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10788formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10789or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10790or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10791to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10792comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10793arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10794misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10795infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10796cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10797and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10798expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10799@samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10800(as described above).
10801
10802Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10803@xref{Interval Forms}.
10804
10805@node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10806@section Vectors and Matrices
10807
10808@noindent
10809@cindex Vectors
10810@cindex Plain vectors
10811@cindex Matrices
10812The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10813list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10814whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10815themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10816A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10817
10818A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
10819in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
108203 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
10821numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10822During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
10823brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
10824vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
10825with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
10826when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
10827place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
10828this case.
10829
10830Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
10831@pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
10832Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
10833the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
10834of its elements.
10835
10836@ignore
10837@starindex
10838@end ignore
10839@tindex vec
10840Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
10841to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
10842@texline @math{n\times m}
10843@infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
10844matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
10845from 1 to @samp{n}.
10846
10847@node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
10848@section Strings
10849
10850@noindent
10851@kindex "
10852@cindex Strings
10853@cindex Character strings
10854Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
10855Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
10856elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
10857enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
10858marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
10859inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
10860
10861@example
10862@group
10863\a 7 \^@@ 0
10864\b 8 \^a-z 1-26
10865\e 27 \^[ 27
10866\f 12 \^\\ 28
10867\n 10 \^] 29
10868\r 13 \^^ 30
10869\t 9 \^_ 31
10870 \^? 127
10871@end group
10872@end example
10873
10874@noindent
10875Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
10876character from its ASCII code.
10877
10878@kindex d "
10879@pindex calc-display-strings
10880Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
10881@w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
10882which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
10883instead.
10884
10885The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
10886strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
10887you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
10888backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
10889for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
10890there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
10891
10892The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
10893@pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
10894way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
10895
10896@ignore
10897@starindex
10898@end ignore
10899@tindex string
10900There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
10901format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
10902is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
10903corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
10904marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
10905@samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
10906This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
10907only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
10908mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
10909
10910Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
10911Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
10912(same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
10913backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
10914
10915@ignore
10916@starindex
10917@end ignore
10918@tindex bstring
10919The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
10920the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
10921fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
10922character in the string.
10923
10924@node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
10925@section HMS Forms
10926
10927@noindent
10928@cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
10929@cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
10930@dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
10931argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
10932that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
10933degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
10934use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
10935degrees, minutes, and seconds.
10936
10937@kindex @@
10938@ignore
10939@mindex @null
10940@end ignore
10941@kindex ' (HMS forms)
10942@ignore
10943@mindex @null
10944@end ignore
10945@kindex " (HMS forms)
10946@ignore
10947@mindex @null
10948@end ignore
10949@kindex h (HMS forms)
10950@ignore
10951@mindex @null
10952@end ignore
10953@kindex o (HMS forms)
10954@ignore
10955@mindex @null
10956@end ignore
10957@kindex m (HMS forms)
10958@ignore
10959@mindex @null
10960@end ignore
10961@kindex s (HMS forms)
10962The default format for HMS values is
10963@samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
10964@samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
10965@samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
10966@samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
10967accepted in place of @samp{"}.
10968The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
10969The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
10970The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
10971(exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
10972@var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
10973as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
10974Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
10975
10976HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
10977the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
10978forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
10979two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
10980
10981@pindex calc-time
10982@cindex Time of day
10983Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
10984the stack as an HMS form.
10985
10986@node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
10987@section Date Forms
10988
10989@noindent
10990@cindex Date forms
10991A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
10992Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
10993produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
10994a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
10995computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
10996number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
10997are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
10998
10999Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
11000The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
11001or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
11002Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
11003notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
11004
11005Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
11006of days since midnight on the morning of January 1 of the year 1 AD.
11007If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
11008if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
11009a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991>}
11010is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
1101112 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
11012time can be stored without roundoff error.
11013
11014If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
11015additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
11016precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
11017decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11018time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11019if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11020issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11021forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11022never an issue for them.
11023
11024You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11025(@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11026of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11027
11028Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11029year numbers represent years BC. Calc uses a combination of the
11030Gregorian and Julian calendars, following the history of Great
11031Britain and the British colonies. This is the same calendar that
11032is used by the @code{cal} program in most Unix implementations.
11033
11034@cindex Julian calendar
11035@cindex Gregorian calendar
11036Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11037Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the gradual
11038drift caused by the lack of leap years in the calendar used
11039until that time. The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in
11040all years divisible by four. After some initial confusion, the
11041calendar was adopted around the year we call 8 AD. Some centuries
11042later it became apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was
11043itself not quite right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the
11044Gregorian calendar, which added the new rule that years divisible
11045by 100, but not by 400, were not to be considered leap years
11046despite being divisible by four. Many countries delayed adoption
11047of the Gregorian calendar because of religious differences;
11048in Britain it was put off until the year 1752, by which time
11049the Julian calendar had fallen eleven days behind the true
11050seasons. So the switch to the Gregorian calendar in early
11051September 1752 introduced a discontinuity: The day after
11052Sep 2, 1752 is Sep 14, 1752. Calc follows this convention.
11053To take another example, Russia waited until 1918 before
11054adopting the new calendar, and thus needed to remove thirteen
11055days (between Feb 1, 1918 and Feb 14, 1918). This means that
11056Calc's reckoning will be inconsistent with Russian history between
110571752 and 1918, and similarly for various other countries.
11058
11059Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second'' as
11060well, but Calc does not take these minor effects into account.
11061(If it did, it would have to report a non-integer number of days
11062between, say, @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11063@samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11064
11065Calc uses the Julian calendar for all dates before the year 1752,
11066including dates BC when the Julian calendar technically had not
11067yet been invented. Thus the claim that day number @mathit{-10000} is
11068called ``August 16, 28 BC'' should be taken with a grain of salt.
11069
11070Please note that there is no ``year 0''; the day before
11071@samp{<Sat Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Fri Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11072days 0 and @mathit{-1} respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme.
11073
11074@cindex Julian day counting
7c1a0036
GM
11075Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also called
11076``Julian.'' The Julian day number is the numbers of days since
1107712:00 noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC, which in Calc's scheme (in GMT)
db78a8cb 11078is @mathit{-1721423.5} (recall that Calc starts at midnight instead
7c1a0036
GM
11079of noon). Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by unpacking a
11080date form into a Julian day number, simply add 1721423.5 after
11081compensating for the time zone difference. The built-in @kbd{t J}
11082command performs this conversion for you.
11083
11084The Julian day number is based on the Julian cycle, which was invented
11085in 1583 by Joseph Justus Scaliger. Scaliger named it the Julian cycle
11086since it is involves the Julian calendar, but some have suggested that
11087Scaliger named it in honor of his father, Julius Caesar Scaliger. The
11088Julian cycle is based it on three other cycles: the indiction cycle,
11089the Metonic cycle, and the solar cycle. The indiction cycle is a 15
11090year cycle originally used by the Romans for tax purposes but later
11091used to date medieval documents. The Metonic cycle is a 19 year
11092cycle; 19 years is close to being a common multiple of a solar year
11093and a lunar month, and so every 19 years the phases of the moon will
11094occur on the same days of the year. The solar cycle is a 28 year
11095cycle; the Julian calendar repeats itself every 28 years. The
11096smallest time period which contains multiples of all three cycles is
11097the least common multiple of 15 years, 19 years and 28 years, which
11098(since they're pairwise relatively prime) is
11099@texline @math{15\times 19\times 28 = 7980} years.
11100@infoline 15*19*28 = 7980 years.
11101This is the length of a Julian cycle. Working backwards, the previous
11102year in which all three cycles began was 4713 BC, and so Scalinger
11103chose that year as the beginning of a Julian cycle. Since at the time
11104there were no historical records from before 4713 BC, using this year
11105as a starting point had the advantage of avoiding negative year
11106numbers. In 1849, the astronomer John Herschel (son of William
11107Herschel) suggested using the number of days since the beginning of
11108the Julian cycle as an astronomical dating system; this idea was taken
11109up by other astronomers. (At the time, noon was the start of the
11110astronomical day. Herschel originally suggested counting the days
11111since Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon Alexandria time; this was later amended to
11112noon GMT.) Julian day numbering is largely used in astronomy.
4009494e
GM
11113
11114@cindex Unix time format
11115The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11116seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11117value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11118for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11119seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11120integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11121day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11122719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11123to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11124Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11125need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11126for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11127counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11128conversions.
11129
11130@node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11131@section Modulo Forms
11132
11133@noindent
11134@cindex Modulo forms
11135A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11136an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11137often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11138`@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}',
11139where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11140@texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11141@infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11142In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11143integers but this is not required.
11144
11145@ignore
11146@mindex M
11147@end ignore
11148@kindex M (modulo forms)
11149@ignore
11150@mindex mod
11151@end ignore
11152@tindex mod (operator)
11153To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11154key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11155shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11156that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11157type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11158Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11159
11160Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11161The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11162the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11163The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11164further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11165the result always lies in the desired range.
11166
11167When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11168the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11169@expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11170the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11171possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11172to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11173are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11174actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11175
11176@cindex Modulo division
11177Two modulo forms `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'
11178can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11179integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11180`@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'. If
11181there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11182@expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11183division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11184roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11185@w{`@tfn{(}@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}@tfn{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11186in the sense of reducing
11187@texline @math{\sqrt a}
11188@infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11189modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11190number-theoretical point of view.)
11191
11192It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11193HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11194form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11195also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11196mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11197@w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
1119824 radians!
11199
11200Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11201enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11202to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11203
11204You can use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11205@xref{Packing and Unpacking}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11206
11207@ignore
11208@starindex
11209@end ignore
11210@tindex makemod
11211The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11212@w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11213
11214@node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11215@section Error Forms
11216
11217@noindent
11218@cindex Error forms
11219@cindex Standard deviations
11220An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11221deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11222@texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11223@infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} sigma'
11224stands for an uncertain value which follows
11225a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11226deviation or ``error''
11227@texline @math{\sigma}.
11228@infoline @expr{sigma}.
11229Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11230formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11231complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11232absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11233regular number by the Calculator.
11234
11235All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11236Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11237numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11238@texline @math{\sin x}
11239@infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11240is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11241evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11242@expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11243of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11244@tex
11245$$ \eqalign{
11246 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11247 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11248 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11249 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11250 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11251 \right| \right)^2
11252 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11253 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11254} $$
11255@end tex
11256Note that this
11257definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11258A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11259is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11260of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11261distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11262The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11263the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11264
11265Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11266of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11267nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11268are small. As an example, the error arising from
11269@texline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}@tfn{)}'
11270@infoline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}@tfn{)}'
11271is
11272@texline `@math{\sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11273@infoline `@var{sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11274When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11275@texline @math{\cos x}
11276@infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11277is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11278@texline @math{\sigma};
11279@infoline @expr{sigma};
11280this makes sense, since
11281@texline @math{\sin x}
11282@infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11283is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11284produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11285@texline @math{\cos x}
11286@infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11287is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11288small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11289has relatively little effect on the value of
11290@texline @math{\sin x}.
11291@infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11292However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11293Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11294we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11295analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11296@texline @math{\sin x}
11297@infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11298would indeed have been negligible.
11299
11300@ignore
11301@mindex p
11302@end ignore
11303@kindex p (error forms)
11304@tindex +/-
11305To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11306(``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11307typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11308@kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-+} to
11309type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11310
11311Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11312are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11313to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11314the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11315used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11316distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11317considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11318not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11319
11320Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11321the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11322
11323@ignore
11324@starindex
11325@end ignore
11326@tindex sdev
11327The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11328
11329@node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11330@section Interval Forms
11331
11332@noindent
11333@cindex Interval forms
11334An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11335the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11336inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11337obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11338you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11339number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11340from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11341of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11342set of possible values of the input.
11343
11344@ifnottex
11345Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11346intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11347@samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11348@emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11349uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11350terms,
11351@samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11352@samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11353@samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11354@samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11355@end ifnottex
11356@tex
11357Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11358intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11359\samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11360\emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11361uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11362terms,
11363$$ \eqalign{
11364 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11365 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11366 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11367 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11368} $$
11369@end tex
11370
11371The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11372(or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11373real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11374must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11375one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11376automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11377@samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11378guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11379interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11380or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11381In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11382the real infinities.
11383
11384Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11385formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11386In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11387left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11388rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11389get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11390a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11391
11392Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11393(@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11394as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11395@w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11396otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11397a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11398to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11399contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11400@samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11401
11402While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11403based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11404form
11405@texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11406@infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11407means a variable is random, and its value could
11408be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11409@texline @math{\sigma}
11410@infoline @var{sigma}
11411of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11412`@tfn{[}@var{a} @tfn{..@:} @var{b}@tfn{]}' means a
11413variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11414range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11415interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11416answer.
11417
11418Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11419HMS forms or date forms.
11420
11421@xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11422as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11423
11424@ignore
11425@starindex
11426@end ignore
11427@tindex intv
11428The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11429from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11430be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
114313 for @samp{[..]}.
11432
11433Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11434taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11435minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11436infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11437which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11438calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11439be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11440should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11441(slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11442error.
11443
11444@node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11445@section Incomplete Objects
11446
11447@noindent
11448@ignore
11449@mindex [ ]
11450@end ignore
11451@kindex [
11452@ignore
11453@mindex ( )
11454@end ignore
11455@kindex (
11456@kindex ,
11457@ignore
11458@mindex @null
11459@end ignore
11460@kindex ]
11461@ignore
11462@mindex @null
11463@end ignore
11464@kindex )
11465@cindex Incomplete vectors
11466@cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11467@cindex Incomplete interval forms
11468When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11469vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11470number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11471the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11472and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11473on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11474
11475As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11476pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11477pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11478
11479If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11480all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11481is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11482prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11483
11484As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11485@kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11486formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11487from the list.
11488
11489@kindex ;
11490The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11491numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11492creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11493equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11494
11495@kindex ..
11496@pindex calc-dots
11497Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11498@kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11499the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11500you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11501part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11502the @code{calc-dots} command.
11503
11504If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11505and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11506
11507@node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11508@section Variables
11509
11510@noindent
11511@cindex Variables, in formulas
11512A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11513calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11514variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11515or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11516Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11517(The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11518@code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11519Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11520formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11521@samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11522corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11523contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11524added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11525refer to the same variable.)
11526
11527In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11528name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11529convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11530@kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11531@w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11532@code{foo}.
11533
11534To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11535stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11536(@key{'}) key.
11537
11538@kindex =
11539@pindex calc-evaluate
11540@cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11541@cindex Variables, evaluation
11542@cindex Formulas, evaluation
11543The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11544replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11545@code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11546Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11547stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11548been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11549With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11550@var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11551the @var{n}th stack entry.
11552
11553@cindex @code{e} variable
11554@cindex @code{pi} variable
11555@cindex @code{i} variable
11556@cindex @code{phi} variable
11557@cindex @code{gamma} variable
11558@vindex e
11559@vindex pi
11560@vindex i
11561@vindex phi
11562@vindex gamma
11563A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11564@samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11565(@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11566their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11567or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11568simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11569
11570The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11571infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11572regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11573it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11574a value into any of these special variables.
11575
11576@xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11577
11578@node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11579@section Formulas
11580
11581@noindent
11582@cindex Formulas
11583@cindex Expressions
11584@cindex Operators in formulas
11585@cindex Precedence of operators
11586When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11587in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11588interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11589and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11590Parentheses may
11591be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11592that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11593Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11594with their equivalent function names, are:
11595
11596@samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11597
11598postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11599
0edd2970 11600prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
4009494e
GM
11601
11602@samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11603@samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11604
11605postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11606and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11607
11608@samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11609
0edd2970
JB
11610prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x});
11611
4009494e
GM
11612@samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11613
11614@samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11615@samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11616
11617infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11618
11619@samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11620
11621relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11622@samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11623
11624@samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11625
11626@samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11627
11628the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11629
11630@samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11631
11632@samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11633
11634@samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11635
11636@samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11637
11638@samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11639
11640@samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11641
11642Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11643strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11644@texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11645@infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11646
11647@cindex Multiplication, implicit
11648@cindex Implicit multiplication
11649The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11650if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11651expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11652same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11653the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11654as in @samp{f(x)},
11655is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11656cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11657same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11658is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11659@samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11660
11661@cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11662The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11663In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11664separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11665equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11666to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11667Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11668ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11669enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11670interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11671between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11672
11673Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11674brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11675of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11676separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11677@w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11678a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11679instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11680When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11681insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11682@w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11683
11684The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11685or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11686an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11687need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11688
11689@cindex Function call notation
11690A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11691@code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11692but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11693need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11694@code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11695If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11696call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11697left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11698and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11699single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11700use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11701
11702In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11703(@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11704command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11705represent the same operation.
11706
11707Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11708algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11709the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{C-x * g}
11710and @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11711``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11712use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11713(@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11714
11715When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11716which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11717you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11718ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11719
11720@example
11721[ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11722 c + d,
11723 %% last line is coming up:
11724 e + f ]
11725@end example
11726
11727@noindent
11728This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11729
11730@xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11731input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11732formats.
11733
11734@xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11735
11736@node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11737@chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11738
11739@noindent
11740This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11741stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11742type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11743
11744@menu
11745* Stack Manipulation::
11746* Editing Stack Entries::
11747* Trail Commands::
11748* Keep Arguments::
11749@end menu
11750
11751@node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11752@section Stack Manipulation Commands
11753
11754@noindent
11755@kindex @key{RET}
11756@kindex @key{SPC}
11757@pindex calc-enter
11758@cindex Duplicating stack entries
11759To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11760(two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11761Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11762several elements at the top of the stack.
11763Given a negative argument,
11764these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11765Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11766For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11767@key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11768@kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11769@kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11770@kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11771
11772@kindex @key{LFD}
11773@pindex calc-over
11774The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11775have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11776except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11777oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11778Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11779are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11780@samp{10 20 30 20}.
11781
11782@kindex @key{DEL}
11783@kindex C-d
11784@pindex calc-pop
11785@cindex Removing stack entries
11786@cindex Deleting stack entries
11787To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11788The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11789(If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11790last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11791several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11792element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11793stack is emptied.
11794For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11795@key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11796@kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11797@kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11798@kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11799
11800@kindex M-@key{DEL}
11801@pindex calc-pop-above
11802The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11803@key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11804prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11805Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11806leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11807the third stack element.
11808
11809@kindex @key{TAB}
11810@pindex calc-roll-down
11811To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11812(@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11813specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11814Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11815number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11816top-for-bottom.
11817For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11818@key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11819@kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11820@kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11821@kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11822
11823@kindex M-@key{TAB}
11824@pindex calc-roll-up
11825The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11826except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11827with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11828For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11829@kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11830@kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11831@kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11832@kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11833
11834A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11835terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11836With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11837element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11838intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11839element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11840which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11841
11842With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11843to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11844stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
11845rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @mathit{n}, also
11846putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
11847
11848@xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
11849any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
11850
11851@node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
11852@section Editing Stack Entries
11853
11854@noindent
11855@kindex `
11856@pindex calc-edit
11857@pindex calc-edit-finish
11858@cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
8dc6104d
JB
11859The @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary buffer
11860(@samp{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using regular
11861Emacs commands. Note that @kbd{`} is a backquote, not a quote. With a
11862numeric prefix argument, it edits the specified number of stack entries
11863at once. (An argument of zero edits the entire stack; a negative
11864argument edits one specific stack entry.)
4009494e
GM
11865
11866When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
11867to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
11868sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
11869usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
11870might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
11871
11872When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
11873the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
11874original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
11875then kills the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
11876continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
11877careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
11878also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
11879
11880The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
11881For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
11882@kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
11883finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
11884
11885If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
11886Calc will not kill the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
11887back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
11888should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
11889@kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
11890stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
11891rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
11892with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
11893(@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
11894
11895If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
11896each line of the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
11897separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
11898one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
11899@kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
11900
11901The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
11902text entered so far is moved to the @code{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
11903more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
11904
11905@node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
11906@section Trail Commands
11907
11908@noindent
11909@cindex Trail buffer
11910The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
11911beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
11912
11913@kindex t d
11914@pindex calc-trail-display
11915The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
11916trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
11917off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
11918turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
11919The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
11920the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
11921there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
11922off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
11923@kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
11924
11925@kindex t i
11926@pindex calc-trail-in
11927@kindex t o
11928@pindex calc-trail-out
11929The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
11930(@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
11931Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
11932shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
11933trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
11934in the Calculator window.
11935
11936@cindex Trail pointer
11937There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
11938any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
11939before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
11940trail pointer in various ways.
11941
11942@kindex t y
11943@pindex calc-trail-yank
11944@cindex Retrieving previous results
11945The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
11946the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
11947re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
11948prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
11949trail pointer.
11950
11951@kindex t <
11952@pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
11953@kindex t >
11954@pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
11955The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
11956(@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
11957window left or right by one half of its width.
11958
11959@kindex t n
11960@pindex calc-trail-next
11961@kindex t p
11962@pindex calc-trail-previous
11963@kindex t f
11964@pindex calc-trail-forward
11965@kindex t b
11966@pindex calc-trail-backward
11967The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
11968(@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
11969one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
11970(@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
11971one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
11972arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
11973
11974@kindex t [
11975@pindex calc-trail-first
11976@kindex t ]
11977@pindex calc-trail-last
11978@kindex t h
11979@pindex calc-trail-here
11980The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
11981(@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
11982last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
11983moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
11984commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
11985
11986@kindex t s
11987@pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
11988@kindex t r
11989@pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
11990@ifnottex
11991The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
11992(@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
11993search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
11994to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
11995If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
11996it was when the search began.
11997@end ifnottex
11998@tex
11999The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12000(@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
12001search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12002to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12003If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12004it was when the search began.
12005@end tex
12006
12007@kindex t m
12008@pindex calc-trail-marker
12009The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
12010line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
12011after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
12012added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
12013targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
12014
12015@kindex t k
12016@pindex calc-trail-kill
12017The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
12018from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
12019yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12020into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12021kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12022
12023The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12024elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12025
12026@node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12027@section Keep Arguments
12028
12029@noindent
12030@kindex K
12031@pindex calc-keep-args
12032The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12033the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12034arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12035the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12036the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12037
12038With the exception of keyboard macros, this works for all commands that
12039take arguments off the stack. (To avoid potentially unpleasant behavior,
12040a @kbd{K} prefix before a keyboard macro will be ignored. A @kbd{K}
12041prefix called @emph{within} the keyboard macro will still take effect.)
12042As another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12043simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12044formula (rather than replacing the original formula). Note that you
12045could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s}, copying the
12046formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference is that for a very
12047large formula the time taken to format the intermediate copy in
12048@kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s} would avoid this
12049extra work.
12050
12051Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12052popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12053so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12054
12055A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12056For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12057its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12058original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12059@kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12060command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12061
12062If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12063the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12064This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12065onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12066different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12067@samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12068
12069@node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12070@chapter Mode Settings
12071
12072@noindent
12073This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12074They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12075the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12076
12077@menu
12078* General Mode Commands::
12079* Precision::
12080* Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12081* Calculation Modes::
12082* Simplification Modes::
12083* Declarations::
12084* Display Modes::
12085* Language Modes::
12086* Modes Variable::
12087* Calc Mode Line::
12088@end menu
12089
12090@node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12091@section General Mode Commands
12092
12093@noindent
12094@kindex m m
12095@pindex calc-save-modes
12096@cindex Continuous memory
12097@cindex Saving mode settings
12098@cindex Permanent mode settings
12099@cindex Calc init file, mode settings
12100You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
12101(the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
12102@file{~/.calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command.
12103This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time it starts up.
12104The modes saved in the file include everything controlled by the @kbd{m}
12105and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current precision and binary word size,
12106whether or not the trail is displayed, the current height of the Calc
12107window, and more. The current interface (used when you type @kbd{C-x * *})
12108is also saved. If there were already saved mode settings in the
12109file, they are replaced. Otherwise, the new mode information is
12110appended to the end of the file.
12111
12112@kindex m R
12113@pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12114The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12115record all the mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12116time a mode setting changes. If the modes are saved this way, then this
12117``automatic mode recording'' mode is also saved.
12118Type @kbd{m R} again to disable this method of recording the mode
12119settings. To turn it off permanently, the @kbd{m m} command will also be
12120necessary. (If Embedded mode is enabled, other options for recording
12121the modes are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
12122
12123@kindex m F
12124@pindex calc-settings-file-name
12125The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12126choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12127for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12128You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12129their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12130if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12131use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
12132file name is @file{~/.calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
12133giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12134discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.
12135
12136If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12137@file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12138is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12139to reread. You can give
12140a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12141file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12142@kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12143tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12144which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12145modes present in the file you were using before.
12146
12147@kindex m x
12148@pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12149The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12150in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12151extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12152until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12153has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12154@kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12155once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{C-x * L}.
12156
12157@kindex m S
12158@pindex calc-shift-prefix
12159The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12160all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12161If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12162you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12163@kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12164be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12165now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12166that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12167the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12168prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12169shifted-prefix mode.
12170
12171@node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12172@section Precision
12173
12174@noindent
12175@kindex p
12176@pindex calc-precision
12177@cindex Precision of calculations
12178The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12179which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12180at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12181memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12182calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12183
12184The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12185can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12186
12187Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12188precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12189current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12190floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12191what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12192round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12193down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12194@kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12195existing value to a new precision.
12196
12197@cindex Accuracy of calculations
12198It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12199@dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12200123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12201The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12202or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12203The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12204(again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12205not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12206instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12207more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12208probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12209exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12210
12211The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12212are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12213and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12214(@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12215deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12216of the numbers involved.
12217
12218If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12219cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12220with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12221divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12222(actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12223would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12224
12225@xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12226issues.
12227
12228@node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12229@section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12230
12231@noindent
12232@kindex I
12233@pindex calc-inverse
12234There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12235Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12236the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12237The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12238is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12239
12240@kindex H
12241@pindex calc-hyperbolic
12242Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12243Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12244If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12245@code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12246non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12247instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12248
12249Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12250may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12251toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12252corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12253
12254The Inverse and Hyperbolic flags apply only to the next Calculator
12255command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They are also
12256cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits you
12257type after @kbd{I} or @kbd{H} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as prefix
12258arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The same
12259is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means to
12260subtract and keep arguments).
12261
12262The third Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
12263elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12264
12265@node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12266@section Calculation Modes
12267
12268@noindent
12269The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12270the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12271The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12272(@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12273
12274@menu
12275* Angular Modes::
12276* Polar Mode::
12277* Fraction Mode::
12278* Infinite Mode::
12279* Symbolic Mode::
12280* Matrix Mode::
12281* Automatic Recomputation::
12282* Working Message::
12283@end menu
12284
12285@node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12286@subsection Angular Modes
12287
12288@noindent
12289@cindex Angular mode
12290The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12291and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12292like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12293used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12294form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12295degrees-minutes-seconds.
12296
12297Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12298degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12299result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12300instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12301normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12302to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12303multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12304
12305@kindex m r
12306@pindex calc-radians-mode
12307@kindex m d
12308@pindex calc-degrees-mode
12309@kindex m h
12310@pindex calc-hms-mode
12311The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12312and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12313The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12314The default angular mode is Degrees.
12315
12316@node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12317@subsection Polar Mode
12318
12319@noindent
12320@cindex Polar mode
12321The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12322sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12323decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12324number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12325number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12326
12327@kindex m p
12328@pindex calc-polar-mode
12329The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12330preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12331of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12332
12333@node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12334@subsection Fraction Mode
12335
12336@noindent
12337@cindex Fraction mode
12338@cindex Division of integers
12339Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12340result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12341rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12342to use the @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command, which
12343divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fraction:
12344@kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 :} produces @expr{3:2} even though
12345@kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12346
12347@kindex m f
12348@pindex calc-frac-mode
12349To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12350divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12351For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12352but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12353Float mode.
12354
12355At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12356fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12357float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12358
12359@node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12360@subsection Infinite Mode
12361
12362@noindent
12363@cindex Infinite mode
12364The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12365formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12366put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12367results.
12368
12369@kindex m i
12370@pindex calc-infinite-mode
12371The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12372on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12373in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12374is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12375generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12376will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12377
12378With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12379an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12380difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12381evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12382functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12383@samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12384note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12385this calculation has infinity as an input.
12386
12387@cindex Positive Infinite mode
12388The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12389i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12390which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12391Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12392Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12393separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12394Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12395single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12396you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12397is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12398
12399@node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12400@subsection Symbolic Mode
12401
12402@noindent
12403@cindex Symbolic mode
12404@cindex Inexact results
12405Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12406For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12407algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12408number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12409@kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12410
12411@kindex m s
12412@pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12413In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12414command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12415left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12416@samp{sqrt(2)}.
12417
12418@kindex N
12419@pindex calc-eval-num
12420The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12421the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12422@code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12423Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12424sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12425of the command.
12426
12427To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12428contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12429@code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12430variables.)
12431
12432@node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12433@subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12434
12435@noindent
12436@cindex Matrix mode
12437@cindex Scalar mode
12438Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12439are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12440Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12441modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12442
12443@kindex m v
12444@pindex calc-matrix-mode
12445Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12446In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12447otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12448multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12449@samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12450rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12451mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
124520 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12453produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12454matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12455@samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12456identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12457dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12458form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12459with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12460a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12461if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12462will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12463
12464Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12465assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12466For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12467@samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12468as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12469another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12470non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12471
12472Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12473
12474If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12475get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12476unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12477Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12478matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix. Simply typing
12479@kbd{C-u m v} will get you a square Matrix mode, in which matrices of
12480unknown size are assumed to be square matrices of unspecified size.
12481
12482@cindex Declaring scalar variables
12483Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12484affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12485and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12486certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12487@xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12488
12489There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12490scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12491results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12492get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12493@samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12494for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12495your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12496
12497Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12498(@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12499your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12500of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12501change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12502under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12503
12504@node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12505@subsection Automatic Recomputation
12506
12507@noindent
12508The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12509property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12510whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12511are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12512
12513@kindex m C
12514@pindex calc-auto-recompute
12515The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12516automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12517not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12518attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12519be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12520you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12521recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12522to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12523
12524To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12525automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{C-x * u}}.
12526@xref{Embedded Mode}.
12527
12528@node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12529@subsection Working Messages
12530
12531@noindent
12532@cindex Performance
12533@cindex Working messages
12534Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12535designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12536The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12537echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12538operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12539intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12540be disabled if you find them distracting.
12541
12542@kindex m w
12543@pindex calc-working
12544Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12545disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12546only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12547see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12548the current mode.
12549
12550While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12551considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12552quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12553to turn the messages off.
12554
12555@node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12556@section Simplification Modes
12557
12558@noindent
12559The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12560are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12561Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12562results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12563form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12564are done by default but can be turned off when necessary.
12565
12566When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12567stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12568@expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12569rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12570
12571Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12572followed by a shifted letter.
12573
12574@kindex m O
12575@pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12576The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12577simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12578fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12579in this mode.
12580
12581@kindex m N
12582@pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12583The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12584of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12585example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12586simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12587is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12588because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12589constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12590A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12591error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12592elements are constant.
12593
12594@kindex m D
12595@pindex calc-default-simplify-mode
12596The @kbd{m D} (@code{calc-default-simplify-mode}) command restores the
12597default simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12598fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12599@expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12600@expr{@tfn{deriv}(x^2, x)} to @expr{2 x}.
12601
12602@kindex m B
12603@pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12604The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the default
12605simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12606uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12607to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12608are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12609results (after the default simplifications) are left alone.
12610
12611@kindex m A
12612@pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12613The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does algebraic
12614simplification; it applies all the default simplifications, and also
12615the more powerful (and slower) simplifications made by @kbd{a s}
12616(@code{calc-simplify}). @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12617
12618@kindex m E
12619@pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12620The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended''
12621algebraic simplification, as by the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended})
12622command. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12623
12624@kindex m U
12625@pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12626The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12627simplification; it applies the command @kbd{u s}
12628(@code{calc-simplify-units}), which in turn
12629is a superset of @kbd{a s}. In this mode, variable names which
12630are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12631are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12632
12633A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12634amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12635use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12636perform higher types of simplifications on demand. @xref{Algebraic
12637Definitions}, for another sample use of No-Simplification mode.
12638
12639@node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12640@section Declarations
12641
12642@noindent
12643A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12644use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12645give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12646take the fully general situation into account.
12647
12648@menu
12649* Declaration Basics::
12650* Kinds of Declarations::
12651* Functions for Declarations::
12652@end menu
12653
12654@node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12655@subsection Declaration Basics
12656
12657@noindent
12658@kindex s d
12659@pindex calc-declare-variable
12660The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12661way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12662the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12663at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12664You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12665type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12666the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12667
12668A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12669@dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12670you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12671For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12672be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12673declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12674(Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12675provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12676
12677@cindex @code{Decls} variable
12678@vindex Decls
12679Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12680This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12681the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12682vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12683specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12684edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12685@xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12686and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12687permanently if you wish.
12688
12689Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12690the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12691values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12692command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12693declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12694
12695For example, the declaration matrix
12696
12697@smallexample
12698@group
12699[ [ foo, real ]
12700 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12701 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12702@end group
12703@end smallexample
12704
12705@noindent
12706declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12707and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12708returns a real number in the interval shown.
12709
12710@vindex All
12711If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12712declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12713It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12714@samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12715are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12716The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12717response to the variable-name prompt.
12718
12719@node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12720@subsection Kinds of Declarations
12721
12722@noindent
12723The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12724in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12725vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12726more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12727for the variable.
12728
12729@smallexample
12730@group
12731[ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12732 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12733 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12734@end group
12735@end smallexample
12736
12737Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12738@code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12739since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12740interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12741nearly equivalent (see below).
12742
12743The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12744nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12745as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12746@code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12747
12748The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12749If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12750is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12751as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12752malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12753the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12754
12755The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12756stored in a variable:
12757
12758@table @code
12759@item int
12760Integers.
12761@item numint
12762Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12763@item frac
12764Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12765@item rat
12766Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12767@item float
12768Floating-point numbers.
12769@item real
12770Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12771intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12772reals here.)
12773@item pos
12774Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12775@item nonneg
12776Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12777@item number
12778Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12779@end table
12780
12781Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12782of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12783simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12784@samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12785However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12786to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12787real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12788deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12789of the formula.
12790
12791Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12792For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12793has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12794integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12795Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12796it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12797
12798Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12799because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12800nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12801this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12802@samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12803
12804One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12805@code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12806Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12807@kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12808@samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12809simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12810
12811If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12812they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12813function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12814@code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12815(note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12816@code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12817the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12818redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12819deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12820@samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12821
12822Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12823used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12824
12825The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12826@samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12827In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12828the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12829that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12830Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12831and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12832
12833If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12834results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12835where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12836type symbol.
12837
12838``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12839like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12840is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12841polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12842roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12843
12844``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12845only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12846shown above).
12847
12848Another command that makes use of declarations is @kbd{a s}, when
12849simplifying equations and inequalities. It will cancel @code{x}
12850from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
12851is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
12852To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
12853use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
12854current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
12855real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
12856including cancelling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
12857not known to be nonzero.
12858
12859Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
12860
12861@table @code
12862@item scalar
12863The value is not a vector.
12864@item vector
12865The value is a vector.
12866@item matrix
12867The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
12868@item sqmatrix
12869The value is a square matrix.
12870@end table
12871
12872These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
12873described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
12874is a matrix of integers.
12875
12876Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
12877algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
12878is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
12879it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
12880other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
12881but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
12882and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
12883never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
12884declarations.)
12885
12886@xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
12887Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
12888or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
12889
12890One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
12891command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
12892
12893@table @code
12894@item const
12895The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
12896@end table
12897
12898Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
12899a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
12900been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
12901unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
12902if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
12903was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
12904simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
12905using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
12906or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
12907declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
12908
12909@node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
12910@subsection Functions for Declarations
12911
12912@noindent
12913Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
12914in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
12915can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
12916can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
12917left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
12918rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
12919(@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
12920algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
12921that perform other tests not related to declarations.
12922
12923For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
12924do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
12925@code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
12926Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
12927own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
12928
12929@ignore
12930@starindex
12931@end ignore
12932@tindex dint
12933@ignore
12934@starindex
12935@end ignore
12936@tindex dnumint
12937@ignore
12938@starindex
12939@end ignore
12940@tindex dnatnum
12941The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
12942The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
12943number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
12944checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
12945integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
12946data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
12947suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
12948are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
12949
12950@ignore
12951@starindex
12952@end ignore
12953@tindex drat
12954The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
12955an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
12956and error forms do not.
12957
12958@ignore
12959@starindex
12960@end ignore
12961@tindex dreal
12962The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
12963includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
12964
12965@ignore
12966@starindex
12967@end ignore
12968@tindex dimag
12969The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
12970i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
12971
12972@ignore
12973@starindex
12974@end ignore
12975@tindex dpos
12976@ignore
12977@starindex
12978@end ignore
12979@tindex dneg
12980@ignore
12981@starindex
12982@end ignore
12983@tindex dnonneg
12984The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
12985The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
12986function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
12987equal to zero. Note that the @kbd{a s} command can simplify an
12988expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}, and that
12989@kbd{a s} is effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules,
12990so the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
12991are rarely necessary.
12992
12993@ignore
12994@starindex
12995@end ignore
12996@tindex dnonzero
12997The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
12998This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
12999do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
13000elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
13001deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
13002represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
13003also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
13004
13005@ignore
13006@starindex
13007@end ignore
13008@tindex deven
13009@ignore
13010@starindex
13011@end ignore
13012@tindex dodd
13013The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
13014an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
13015is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
13016The @kbd{a s} command uses this to simplify a test of the form
13017@samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
13018
13019@ignore
13020@starindex
13021@end ignore
13022@tindex drange
13023The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13024of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13025the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13026a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13027from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13028expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13029etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13030the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13031remains unevaluated.
13032
13033@ignore
13034@starindex
13035@end ignore
13036@tindex dscalar
13037The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13038scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13039unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13040mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13041if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13042(say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13043``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13044provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13045is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13046information to tell.
13047
13048@node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13049@section Display Modes
13050
13051@noindent
13052The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13053@kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13054(@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13055@pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13056Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13057@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13058
13059One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13060@kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13061refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13062will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13063reflect the latest mode settings.
13064
13065@kindex d @key{RET}
13066@pindex calc-refresh-top
13067The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13068top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13069arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13070reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13071@kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13072For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13073but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13074
13075The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13076is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13077to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13078words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13079
13080@menu
13081* Radix Modes::
13082* Grouping Digits::
13083* Float Formats::
13084* Complex Formats::
13085* Fraction Formats::
13086* HMS Formats::
13087* Date Formats::
13088* Truncating the Stack::
13089* Justification::
13090* Labels::
13091@end menu
13092
13093@node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13094@subsection Radix Modes
13095
13096@noindent
13097@cindex Radix display
13098@cindex Non-decimal numbers
13099@cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13100Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13101notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13102When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13103digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13104potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13105
13106@kindex d 2
13107@kindex d 8
13108@kindex d 6
13109@kindex d 0
13110@cindex Hexadecimal integers
13111@cindex Octal integers
13112The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13113binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13114respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13115current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13116digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13117as decimal.
13118
13119@kindex d r
13120@pindex calc-radix
13121To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13122an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13123argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13124
13125@kindex d z
13126@pindex calc-leading-zeros
13127@cindex Leading zeros
13128Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13129represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13130command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13131current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13132word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13133are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13134@texline @math{2^w-1}
13135@infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13136in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13137entirety.)
13138
13139@node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13140@subsection Grouping Digits
13141
13142@noindent
13143@kindex d g
13144@pindex calc-group-digits
13145@cindex Grouping digits
13146@cindex Digit grouping
13147Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13148example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13149(@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13150are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13151separated by commas.
13152
13153The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13154With a numeric prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13155the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13156with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13157digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13158before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13159grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13160
13161@kindex d ,
13162@pindex calc-group-char
13163The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13164character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13165If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13166commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13167This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13168uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13169@samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13170
13171Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13172if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{C-x * y} and @kbd{C-x * g}.
13173(@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13174the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13175is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13176
13177@node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13178@subsection Float Formats
13179
13180@noindent
13181Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13182form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13183or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13184in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13185formats for floats.
13186
13187@kindex d n
13188@pindex calc-normal-notation
13189The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13190display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13191With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13192that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13193the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13194precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13195current precision is 12.)
13196
13197@kindex d f
13198@pindex calc-fix-notation
13199The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13200notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13201decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13202notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13203way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13204for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13205to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13206
13207@kindex d s
13208@pindex calc-sci-notation
13209@cindex Scientific notation, display of
13210The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13211notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13212displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13213point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13214The default is to display all significant digits.
13215
13216@kindex d e
13217@pindex calc-eng-notation
13218@cindex Engineering notation, display of
13219The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13220notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13221exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13222digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13223number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13224
13225It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13226the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13227and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13228significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13229calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13230but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13231Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13232except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-x * y} which operate on the
13233actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13234
13235@kindex d .
13236@pindex calc-point-char
13237The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13238as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13239may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13240style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13241numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13242
13243@node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13244@subsection Complex Formats
13245
13246@noindent
13247@kindex d c
13248@pindex calc-complex-notation
13249There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13250form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13251and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13252(@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13253
13254@kindex d i
13255@pindex calc-i-notation
13256@kindex d j
13257@pindex calc-j-notation
13258The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13259numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13260(@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13261in some disciplines.
13262
13263@cindex @code{i} variable
13264@vindex i
13265Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13266If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13267the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13268this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13269will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13270to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13271interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13272@xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13273
13274@node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13275@subsection Fraction Formats
13276
13277@noindent
13278@kindex d o
13279@pindex calc-over-notation
13280Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13281(@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13282eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13283prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13284that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13285@samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13286used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13287for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13288
13289If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13290notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13291as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13292the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13293and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13294
13295It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13296a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13297Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13298denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13299be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13300the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13301displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13302and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13303affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13304format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13305integers as @expr{n:1}.
13306
13307The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13308stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13309never affects floats.
13310
13311@node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13312@subsection HMS Formats
13313
13314@noindent
13315@kindex d h
13316@pindex calc-hms-notation
13317The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13318HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13319consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13320``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13321Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13322marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13323seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13324
13325The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13326@samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13327value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13328keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13329The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13330@kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13331already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13332(@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13333@kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13334The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13335@kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13336entry.
13337
13338@node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13339@subsection Date Formats
13340
13341@noindent
13342@kindex d d
13343@pindex calc-date-notation
13344The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13345of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13346contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13347To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13348date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13349marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13350guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13351pure dates.
13352
13353The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13354An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13355If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13356reestablished.
13357
13358Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13359dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13360functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13361
13362@menu
13363* Date Formatting Codes::
13364* Free-Form Dates::
13365* Standard Date Formats::
13366@end menu
13367
13368@node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, Date Formats, Date Formats
13369@subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13370
13371@noindent
13372When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13373characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13374copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13375@samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13376date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13377below.
13378
13379When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13380match the input string to the current format either with or without
13381the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13382match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13383the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13384simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13385since Jan 1, 1 AD. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13386flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13387
13388Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13389
13390Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13391from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13392entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13393@samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13394entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13395
13396Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13397
13398@table @asis
13399@item Y
13400Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13401@item YY
13402Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13403@item BY
13404Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13405@item YYY
13406Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13407@item YYYY
13408Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13409@item aa
13410Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13411@item AA
13412Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13413@item aaa
13414Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13415@item AAA
13416Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13417@item aaaa
13418Year: ``a.d.'' or blank.
13419@item AAAA
13420Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13421@item bb
13422Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13423@item BB
13424Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13425@item bbb
13426Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13427@item BBB
13428Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13429@item bbbb
13430Year: ``b.c.'' or blank.
13431@item BBBB
13432Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13433@item M
13434Month: ``8'' for August.
13435@item MM
13436Month: ``08'' for August.
13437@item BM
13438Month: `` 8'' for August.
13439@item MMM
13440Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13441@item Mmm
13442Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13443@item mmm
13444Month: ``aug'' for August.
13445@item MMMM
13446Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13447@item Mmmm
13448Month: ``August'' for August.
13449@item D
13450Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13451@item DD
13452Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13453@item BD
13454Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13455@item W
13456Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13457@item WWW
13458Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13459@item Www
13460Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13461@item www
13462Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13463@item WWWW
13464Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13465@item Wwww
13466Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13467@item d
13468Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13469@item ddd
13470Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13471@item bdd
13472Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13473@item h
13474Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13475@item hh
13476Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13477@item bh
13478Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13479@item H
13480Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13481@item HH
13482Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13483@item BH
13484Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13485@item p
13486AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13487@item P
13488AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13489@item pp
13490AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13491@item PP
13492AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13493@item pppp
13494AM/PM: ``a.m.'' or ``p.m.''.
13495@item PPPP
13496AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13497@item m
13498Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13499@item mm
13500Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13501@item bm
13502Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13503@item s
13504Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13505@item ss
13506Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13507@item bs
13508Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13509@item SS
13510Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13511@item BS
13512Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13513@item N
13514Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13515@item n
13516Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13517@item J
13518Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13519@item j
13520Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13521@item U
13522Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13523@item X
13524Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13525causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13526when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13527required for algebraic entry.
13528@end table
13529
13530If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13531colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13532
13533If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13534appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13535without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13536exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13537@samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13538
13539The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13540``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13541reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13542punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13543many digits as there are letters in the format.
13544
13545The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13546adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13547@samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13548
13549@node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13550@subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13551
13552@noindent
13553When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13554on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13555match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13556``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13557but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13558
13559Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13560while interpreting dates.
13561
13562First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13563text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13564the date.
13565
13566A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13567part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
1356812-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13569omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13570@samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13571abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13572@samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13573@samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13574The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13575recognized with no number attached.
13576
13577If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13578format.
13579
13580To read the date portion, all words and numbers are isolated
13581from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must
13582be either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which
13583are ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13584abbreviations.
13585
13586Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13587are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13588greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13589number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13590assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13591appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13592current year is taken from the system clock.
13593
13594If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13595words, then the input is rejected.
13596
13597If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13598the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13599like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13600date components when the date was formatted.
13601
13602One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13603may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13604minus sign on the year value.
13605
13606If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13607of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13608
13609@node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13610@subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13611
13612@noindent
13613There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13614Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13615you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13616to select the other formats.
13617
13618To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13619argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13620enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13621number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13622You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13623command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13624
13625@table @asis
13626@item 0
13627@samp{N} (Numerical format)
13628@item 1
13629@samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13630@item 2
13631@samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13632@item 3
13633@samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13634@item 4
13635@samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13636@item 5
13637@samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13638@item 6
13639@samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13640@item 7
13641@samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13642@item 8
13643@samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13644@item 9
13645@samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13646@end table
13647
13648@node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13649@subsection Truncating the Stack
13650
13651@noindent
13652@kindex d t
13653@pindex calc-truncate-stack
13654@cindex Truncating the stack
13655@cindex Narrowing the stack
13656The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13657line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13658The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13659the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13660operations (although still visible to the user). This is similar to the
13661Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except that the values below the @samp{.}
13662are @emph{visible}, just temporarily frozen. This feature allows you to
13663keep several independent calculations running at once in different parts
13664of the stack, or to apply a certain command to an element buried deep in
13665the stack.
13666
13667Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13668is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13669these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13670With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13671bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13672all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13673values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13674
13675@kindex d [
13676@pindex calc-truncate-up
13677@kindex d ]
13678@pindex calc-truncate-down
13679The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13680(@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13681line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13682
13683@node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13684@subsection Justification
13685
13686@noindent
13687@kindex d <
13688@pindex calc-left-justify
13689@kindex d =
13690@pindex calc-center-justify
13691@kindex d >
13692@pindex calc-right-justify
13693Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13694control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13695@kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13696(@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13697stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13698window.
13699
13700If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13701@kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13702text.
13703
13704Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13705notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13706together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13707
13708With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13709a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13710horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13711specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13712Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13713breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13714origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13715mode.
13716
13717In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13718given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13719maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13720otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13721line is indented to the origin.
13722
13723In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13724character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13725window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13726for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13727specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13728specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13729
13730In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13731each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13732allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13733break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13734line width or Calc window width is used.
13735
13736Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13737is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13738number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13739positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13740when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13741case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13742shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13743
13744@node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13745@subsection Labels
13746
13747@noindent
13748@kindex d @{
13749@pindex calc-left-label
13750The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13751then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13752entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13753appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13754greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13755or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13756affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13757
13758Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13759
13760@kindex d @}
13761@pindex calc-right-label
13762The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13763label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13764the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13765a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13766stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13767justified to the line width.
13768
13769One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13770formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13771document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13772typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13773left or right as you prefer.
13774
13775@node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13776@section Language Modes
13777
13778@noindent
13779The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13780entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13781other common language such as Pascal or La@TeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13782stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13783in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13784another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13785
13786The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13787trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13788affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13789and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13790
13791For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13792program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13793with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13794to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u C-x * g} to grab the formula
13795into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13796to the first variable, and @kbd{C-x * y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13797back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13798repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13799
13800Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13801the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13802@code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13803and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13804multiplication) which would not have been valid for a C program.
13805
13806As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a La@TeX{}
13807document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13808formula from the program in C mode, switch to La@TeX{} mode, and yank the
13809formula into the document in La@TeX{} math-mode format.
13810
13811Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13812shifted letter key.
13813
13814@menu
13815* Normal Language Modes::
13816* C FORTRAN Pascal::
13817* TeX and LaTeX Language Modes::
13818* Eqn Language Mode::
4e320733
JB
13819* Yacas Language Mode::
13820* Maxima Language Mode::
13821* Giac Language Mode::
4009494e
GM
13822* Mathematica Language Mode::
13823* Maple Language Mode::
13824* Compositions::
13825* Syntax Tables::
13826@end menu
13827
13828@node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13829@subsection Normal Language Modes
13830
13831@noindent
13832@kindex d N
13833@pindex calc-normal-language
13834The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
13835notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
13836Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
13837objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
13838keyboard.
13839
13840@kindex d O
13841@pindex calc-flat-language
13842@cindex Matrix display
13843The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
13844identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
13845one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
13846form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
13847
13848@kindex d b
13849@pindex calc-line-breaking
13850@cindex Line breaking
13851@cindex Breaking up long lines
13852Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
13853across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
13854The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
13855feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
13856If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
13857command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
13858long lines.
13859
13860@kindex d B
13861@pindex calc-big-language
13862The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
13863which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
13864such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
13865
13866@example
13867 ____________
13868 | a + 1 2
13869 | ----- + c
13870\| b
13871@end example
13872
13873@noindent
13874in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
13875
13876Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
13877mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
13878are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
13879@samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
13880notation.
13881
13882One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
13883
13884@example
13885 3
13886- -
13887 4
13888@end example
13889
13890@noindent
13891can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
13892actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
13893never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
13894@expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
13895typical use.
13896
13897Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
13898way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
13899though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
13900Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
13901in Big mode.
13902
13903In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
13904readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
13905You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
13906@kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
13907one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
13908
13909Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
13910Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
13911to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
13912even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
13913
13914@kindex d U
13915@pindex calc-unformatted-language
13916The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
13917the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
13918shown above would be displayed:
13919
13920@example
13921sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
13922@end example
13923
13924These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
13925expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
13926all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
13927(except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
13928parentheses).
13929
13930@node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
13931@subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
13932
13933@noindent
13934@kindex d C
13935@pindex calc-c-language
13936@cindex C language
13937The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
13938of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
13939the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
13940particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
13941place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
13942in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
13943@samp{pow(a,b)}.
13944
13945In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
13946Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
13947rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
13948translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
13949mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
13950turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
13951using the @samp{:=} symbol.
13952
13953The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
13954and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
13955@samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
13956typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
13957names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
13958display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
13959formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
13960as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
13961
13962@kindex d P
13963@pindex calc-pascal-language
13964@cindex Pascal language
13965The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
13966conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
13967a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
13968displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
13969@kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
13970@kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.) not followed by digits works the same as
13971always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
13972vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
13973of handling these in Pascal.
13974
13975@kindex d F
13976@pindex calc-fortran-language
13977@cindex FORTRAN language
13978The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
13979conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
13980equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
13981entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
13982parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
13983both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
13984upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
702dbfd9
JB
13985If the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
13986@code{vector} or @code{matrix}, however, then @samp{a(i)} will be
13987parsed as a subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't
13988matter, though; if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and
13989Calc interprets it as a function call, you'll never know the difference
13990unless you switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an
13991actual vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
4009494e
GM
13992function!).
13993
13994Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
13995language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
13996Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
13997
13998FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
13999formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
14000positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
14001modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
14002convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
14003convert to lower-case for display and input.
14004
14005@node TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
14006@subsection @TeX{} and La@TeX{} Language Modes
14007
14008@noindent
14009@kindex d T
14010@pindex calc-tex-language
14011@cindex TeX language
14012@kindex d L
14013@pindex calc-latex-language
14014@cindex LaTeX language
14015The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
14016of ``math mode'' in Donald Knuth's @TeX{} typesetting language,
14017and the @kbd{d L} (@code{calc-latex-language}) command selects the
14018conventions of ``math mode'' in La@TeX{}, a typesetting language that
14019uses @TeX{} as its formatting engine. Calc's La@TeX{} language mode can
14020read any formula that the @TeX{} language mode can, although La@TeX{}
14021mode may display it differently.
14022
14023Formulas are entered and displayed in the appropriate notation;
14024@texline @math{\sin(a/b)}
14025@infoline @expr{sin(a/b)}
0cbe9c78 14026will appear as @samp{\sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)} in @TeX{} mode and
4009494e
GM
14027@samp{\sin\left(\frac@{a@}@{b@}\right)} in La@TeX{} mode.
14028Math formulas are often enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{} and
14029La@TeX{}; these should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc,
14030the @samp{$} sign has the same meaning it always does in algebraic
14031formulas (a reference to an existing entry on the stack).
14032
14033Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14034quotients are written using @code{\over} in @TeX{} mode (as in
14035@code{@{a \over b@}}) and @code{\frac} in La@TeX{} mode (as in
14036@code{\frac@{a@}@{b@}}); binomial coefficients are written with
14037@code{\choose} in @TeX{} mode (as in @code{@{a \choose b@}}) and
14038@code{\binom} in La@TeX{} mode (as in @code{\binom@{a@}@{b@}}).
14039Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and error forms are
14040written with @code{\pm}. Absolute values are written as in
14041@samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and ceiling functions are written with
14042@code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc. The words @code{\left} and
14043@code{\right} are ignored when reading formulas in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14044modes. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written as @code{\infty};
14045when read, @code{\infty} always translates to @code{inf}.
14046
14047Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14048by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{}
14049and La@TeX{} have special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces
14050instead of parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly
14051braces and parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the
14052document is formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the
14053printed result is
14054@texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14055@infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14056but
14057@texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14058@infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14059
14060Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14061are simply written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in
14062italic letters in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or
14063@kbd{d L} with a positive numeric prefix argument, names of more than
14064one character will instead be enclosed in a protective commands that
14065will prevent them from being typeset in the math italics; they will be
14066written @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}} in @TeX{} mode and
14067@samp{\text@{@var{name}@}} in La@TeX{} mode. The
14068@samp{\hbox@{ @}} and @samp{\text@{ @}} notations are ignored during
14069reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function names are
14070written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin with @code{\} during
14071reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that in this mode, long
14072variable names are still written with @code{\hbox} or @code{\text}.
14073However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar} in
14074any @TeX{} mode.)
14075
14076During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14077by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14078@code{\bmatrix}. In La@TeX{} mode this also applies to
14079@samp{\begin@{matrix@} ... \end@{matrix@}},
14080@samp{\begin@{bmatrix@} ... \end@{bmatrix@}},
14081@samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} ... \end@{pmatrix@}}, as well as
14082@samp{\begin@{smallmatrix@} ... \end@{smallmatrix@}}.
14083The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14084and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14085During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14086format in @TeX{} mode and in
14087@samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} a & b \\ c & d \end@{pmatrix@}} format in
14088La@TeX{} mode; you may need to edit this afterwards to change to your
14089preferred matrix form. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or @kbd{d L} with an
14090argument of 2 or -2, then matrices will be displayed in two-dimensional
14091form, such as
14092
14093@example
14094\begin@{pmatrix@}
14095a & b \\
14096c & d
14097\end@{pmatrix@}
14098@end example
14099
14100@noindent
14101This may be convenient for isolated matrices, but could lead to
14102expressions being displayed like
14103
14104@example
14105\begin@{pmatrix@} \times x
14106a & b \\
14107c & d
14108\end@{pmatrix@}
14109@end example
14110
14111@noindent
14112While this wouldn't bother Calc, it is incorrect La@TeX{}.
14113(Similarly for @TeX{}.)
14114
14115Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14116calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14117sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14118to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14119a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14120in Calc, @TeX{}, La@TeX{} and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14121
17587b1b 14122@ignore
4009494e
GM
14123@iftex
14124@begingroup
14125@let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14126@let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14127@end iftex
4009494e
GM
14128@starindex
14129@end ignore
14130@tindex acute
14131@ignore
14132@starindex
14133@end ignore
14134@tindex Acute
14135@ignore
14136@starindex
14137@end ignore
14138@tindex bar
14139@ignore
14140@starindex
14141@end ignore
14142@tindex Bar
14143@ignore
14144@starindex
14145@end ignore
14146@tindex breve
14147@ignore
14148@starindex
14149@end ignore
14150@tindex Breve
14151@ignore
14152@starindex
14153@end ignore
14154@tindex check
14155@ignore
14156@starindex
14157@end ignore
14158@tindex Check
14159@ignore
14160@starindex
14161@end ignore
14162@tindex dddot
14163@ignore
14164@starindex
14165@end ignore
14166@tindex ddddot
14167@ignore
14168@starindex
14169@end ignore
14170@tindex dot
14171@ignore
14172@starindex
14173@end ignore
14174@tindex Dot
14175@ignore
14176@starindex
14177@end ignore
14178@tindex dotdot
14179@ignore
14180@starindex
14181@end ignore
14182@tindex DotDot
14183@ignore
14184@starindex
14185@end ignore
14186@tindex dyad
14187@ignore
14188@starindex
14189@end ignore
14190@tindex grave
14191@ignore
14192@starindex
14193@end ignore
14194@tindex Grave
14195@ignore
14196@starindex
14197@end ignore
14198@tindex hat
14199@ignore
14200@starindex
14201@end ignore
14202@tindex Hat
14203@ignore
14204@starindex
14205@end ignore
14206@tindex Prime
14207@ignore
14208@starindex
14209@end ignore
14210@tindex tilde
14211@ignore
14212@starindex
14213@end ignore
14214@tindex Tilde
14215@ignore
14216@starindex
14217@end ignore
14218@tindex under
14219@ignore
14220@starindex
14221@end ignore
14222@tindex Vec
14223@ignore
14224@starindex
14225@end ignore
14226@tindex VEC
17587b1b 14227@ignore
4009494e
GM
14228@iftex
14229@endgroup
14230@end iftex
17587b1b 14231@end ignore
4009494e
GM
14232@example
14233Calc TeX LaTeX eqn
14234---- --- ----- ---
14235acute \acute \acute
14236Acute \Acute
14237bar \bar \bar bar
14238Bar \Bar
14239breve \breve \breve
14240Breve \Breve
14241check \check \check
14242Check \Check
14243dddot \dddot
14244ddddot \ddddot
14245dot \dot \dot dot
14246Dot \Dot
14247dotdot \ddot \ddot dotdot
14248DotDot \Ddot
14249dyad dyad
14250grave \grave \grave
14251Grave \Grave
14252hat \hat \hat hat
14253Hat \Hat
14254Prime prime
14255tilde \tilde \tilde tilde
14256Tilde \Tilde
14257under \underline \underline under
14258Vec \vec \vec vec
14259VEC \Vec
14260@end example
14261
14262The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14263@samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14264alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14265top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14266is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14267word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14268You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14269at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14270
14271@example
14272\def\evalto@{@}
14273\def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14274@end example
14275
14276The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14277way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14278printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14279Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14280which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14281@xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14282
14283The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14284reading is:
14285
14286@example
14287\hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14288\, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14289\displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14290\scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14291\rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14292\cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14293\evalto
14294@end example
14295
14296Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} or
14297La@TeX{} formula into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and
14298font information.
14299
14300Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14301the same as @samp{*}.
14302
14303@ifnottex
14304The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14305end of this section.
14306@end ifnottex
14307@iftex
14308Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14309
14310@example
14311@group
14312sin(a^2 / b_i)
14313\sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14314@end group
14315@end example
14316@tex
14317$$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14318@end tex
14319@sp 1
14320
14321@example
14322@group
14323[(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14324[3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14325@end group
14326@end example
14327@tex
14328\turnoffactive
14329$$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14330@end tex
14331@sp 1
14332
14333@example
14334@group
14335[abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14336[|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14337 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14338@end group
14339@end example
14340@tex
14341$$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14342 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14343@end tex
14344@sp 1
14345
14346@example
14347@group
14348[sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14349[\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14350 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14351@end group
14352@end example
14353@tex
14354\turnoffactive
14355$$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14356@end tex
14357@sp 2
14358
14359First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14360@kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14361@samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14362
14363@example
14364@group
14365[f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14366[f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14367[f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14368[f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14369@end group
14370@end example
14371@tex
14372$$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14373$$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14374$$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14375@end tex
14376@sp 2
14377
14378First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14379
14380@example
14381@group
143822 + 3 => 5
14383\evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14384@end group
14385@end example
14386@tex
14387\turnoffactive
14388$$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14389$$ 5 $$
14390@end tex
14391@sp 2
14392
14393First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14394
14395@example
14396@group
14397[2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14398[@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14399@end group
14400@end example
14401@tex
14402\turnoffactive
14403$$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14404{\let\to\Rightarrow
14405$$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14406@end tex
14407@sp 2
14408
14409Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14410
14411@example
14412@group
14413[ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14414\matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14415\pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14416@end group
14417@end example
14418@tex
14419\turnoffactive
14420$$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14421$$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14422@end tex
14423@sp 2
14424@end iftex
14425
702dbfd9 14426@node Eqn Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Language Modes
4009494e
GM
14427@subsection Eqn Language Mode
14428
14429@noindent
14430@kindex d E
14431@pindex calc-eqn-language
14432@dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14433designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14434with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14435command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14436
14437The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14438a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14439@samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14440@code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14441grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14442required only when the argument contains spaces.
14443
14444In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14445delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14446above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14447@code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14448@samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14449in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14450with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14451
14452Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14453peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14454words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14455braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14456(The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14457recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14458the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14459case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14460names, too.)
14461
14462Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14463operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14464treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14465symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14466the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14467
14468As in La@TeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14469arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14470``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14471braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14472
14473Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14474(like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14475@dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14476@code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14477are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14478@samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14479of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14480
14481Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14482function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally.
14483@xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a table of these accent
14484functions. The @code{prime} accent is treated specially if it occurs on
14485a variable or function name: @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is
14486stored internally as @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the
14487derivative of @samp{f(2 x)} with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2
14488x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14489
14490Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14491and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14492@samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a discussion
14493of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14494recognized for these operators during reading.
14495
14496Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14497matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14498The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14499for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14500if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14501
702dbfd9
JB
14502@node Yacas Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14503@subsection Yacas Language Mode
14504
14505@noindent
14506@kindex d Y
14507@pindex calc-yacas-language
14508@cindex Yacas language
14509The @kbd{d Y} (@code{calc-yacas-language}) command selects the
14510conventions of Yacas, a free computer algebra system. While the
14511operators and functions in Yacas are similar to those of Calc, the names
14512of built-in functions in Yacas are capitalized. The Calc formula
14513@samp{sin(2 x)}, for example, is entered and displayed @samp{Sin(2 x)}
14514in Yacas mode, and `@samp{arcsin(x^2)} is @samp{ArcSin(x^2)} in Yacas
14515mode. Complex numbers are written are written @samp{3 + 4 I}.
14516The standard special constants are written @code{Pi}, @code{E},
14517@code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio} and @code{Gamma}. @code{Infinity}
14518represents both @code{inf} and @code{uinf}, and @code{Undefined}
14519represents @code{nan}.
14520
14521Certain operators on functions, such as @code{D} for differentiation
14522and @code{Integrate} for integration, take a prefix form in Yacas. For
14523example, the derivative of @w{@samp{e^x sin(x)}} can be computed with
14524@w{@samp{D(x) Exp(x)*Sin(x)}}.
14525
14526Other notable differences between Yacas and standard Calc expressions
14527are that vectors and matrices use curly braces in Yacas, and subscripts
14528use square brackets. If, for example, @samp{A} represents the list
14529@samp{@{a,2,c,4@}}, then @samp{A[3]} would equal @samp{c}.
14530
14531
14532@node Maxima Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, Language Modes
14533@subsection Maxima Language Mode
14534
14535@noindent
14536@kindex d X
14537@pindex calc-maxima-language
14538@cindex Maxima language
14539The @kbd{d X} (@code{calc-maxima-language}) command selects the
14540conventions of Maxima, another free computer algebra system. The
14541function names in Maxima are similar, but not always identical, to Calc.
14542For example, instead of @samp{arcsin(x)}, Maxima will use
14543@samp{asin(x)}. Complex numbers are written @samp{3 + 4 %i}. The
14544standard special constants are written @code{%pi}, @code{%e},
14545@code{%i}, @code{%phi} and @code{%gamma}. In Maxima, @code{inf} means
14546the same as in Calc, but @code{infinity} represents Calc's @code{uinf}.
14547
14548Underscores as well as percent signs are allowed in function and
14549variable names in Maxima mode. The underscore again is equivalent to
14550the @samp{#} in Normal mode, and the percent sign is equivalent to
14551@samp{o'o}.
14552
14553Maxima uses square brackets for lists and vectors, and matrices are
14554written as calls to the function @code{matrix}, given the row vectors of
14555the matrix as arguments. Square brackets are also used as subscripts.
14556
14557@node Giac Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Language Modes
14558@subsection Giac Language Mode
14559
14560@noindent
14561@kindex d A
14562@pindex calc-giac-language
14563@cindex Giac language
14564The @kbd{d A} (@code{calc-giac-language}) command selects the
14565conventions of Giac, another free computer algebra system. The function
14566names in Giac are similar to Maxima. Complex numbers are written
14567@samp{3 + 4 i}. The standard special constants in Giac are the same as
14568in Calc, except that @code{infinity} represents both Calc's @code{inf}
14569and @code{uinf}.
14570
14571Underscores are allowed in function and variable names in Giac mode.
14572Brackets are used for subscripts. In Giac, indexing of lists begins at
145730, instead of 1 as in Calc. So if @samp{A} represents the list
14574@samp{[a,2,c,4]}, then @samp{A[2]} would equal @samp{c}. In general,
14575@samp{A[n]} in Giac mode corresponds to @samp{A_(n+1)} in Normal mode.
14576
14577The Giac interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14578Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]} and
14579writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot see
14580the difference between an open and a closed interval while in Giac mode.
14581
14582@node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Language Modes
4009494e
GM
14583@subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14584
14585@noindent
14586@kindex d M
14587@pindex calc-mathematica-language
14588@cindex Mathematica language
14589The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14590conventions of Mathematica. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14591are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14592calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14593formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14594Mathematica mode.
14595
14596Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14597are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14598written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14599@code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14600Mathematica mode.
14601Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14602numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14603Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14604
14605@node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14606@subsection Maple Language Mode
14607
14608@noindent
14609@kindex d W
14610@pindex calc-maple-language
14611@cindex Maple language
14612The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14613conventions of Maple.
14614
14615Maple's language is much like C. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14616names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14617multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14618denote powers.
14619
14620Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14621interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14622brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14623pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14624to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14625and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14626
702dbfd9
JB
14627The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} is like Giac's interval
14628notation, and is handled the same by Calc.
4009494e
GM
14629
14630Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14631are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14632@code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14633Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14634
14635Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14636various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14637inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14638
14639@node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14640@subsection Compositions
14641
14642@noindent
14643@cindex Compositions
14644There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14645displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14646mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14647placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14648are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14649
14650Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14651@xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14652@samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14653the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14654@samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14655example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14656select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14657deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14658
14659The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14660(although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14661language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14662which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14663The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14664the language modes.
14665
14666@menu
14667* Composition Basics::
14668* Horizontal Compositions::
14669* Vertical Compositions::
14670* Other Compositions::
14671* Information about Compositions::
14672* User-Defined Compositions::
14673@end menu
14674
14675@node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14676@subsubsection Composition Basics
14677
14678@noindent
14679Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14680horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14681themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14682to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14683@dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14684decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14685For example, in the Big mode formula
14686
14687@example
14688@group
14689 2
14690 a + b
1469117 + ------
14692 c
14693@end group
14694@end example
14695
14696@noindent
14697the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14698its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14699is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14700
14701@tex
14702\bigskip
14703@end tex
14704
14705Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14706an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14707For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14708which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14709parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14710
14711The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14712following precedences:
14713
14714@example
0edd2970
JB
14715_ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14716% 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14717! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
4009494e
GM
14718mod 400
14719+/- 300
14720!! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14721! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14722^ 200
0edd2970 14723- 197 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
4009494e
GM
14724* 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14725/ % \ 190
14726+ - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14727| 170
14728< = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14729&& 110
14730|| 100
14731? : 90
14732!!! 85
14733&&& 80
14734||| 75
14735:= 50
14736:: 45
14737=> 40
14738@end example
14739
14740The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14741occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14742the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14743expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14744components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14745normally never get additional parentheses).
14746
14747For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14748argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14749in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14750but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14751Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14752with one-higher precedence.
14753
14754@ignore
14755@starindex
14756@end ignore
14757@tindex cprec
14758The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14759precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14760sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14761this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14762precedence than multiplication).
14763
14764@tex
14765\bigskip
14766@end tex
14767
14768A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14769different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14770A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14771(not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14772mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14773exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14774window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14775view them.
14776
14777Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14778lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14779composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14780general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14781move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14782didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14783structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14784it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14785For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14786
14787@example
14788@group
14789[ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14790 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14791@end group
14792@end example
14793
14794@noindent
14795If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14796But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14797of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14798only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14799itself been too large to fit.
14800
14801Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14802generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14803also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14804space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14805end of the string.
14806
14807Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14808hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14809@code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14810if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14811@code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14812in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14813will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14814object.
14815
14816@node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14817@subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14818
14819@noindent
14820@ignore
14821@starindex
14822@end ignore
14823@tindex choriz
14824The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14825them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14826as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14827
14828@example
14829@group
14830 a b
1483117---d
14832 c
14833@end group
14834@end example
14835
14836@noindent
14837in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
14838function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
14839either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
14840@var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
14841each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
14842the precedence from the surrounding environment.
14843
14844@var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
14845be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
14846of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
14847will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
14848If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
14849(unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
14850
14851For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
14852formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
14853to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
14854enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
14855formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
14856
14857The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
14858baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
14859
14860@node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
14861@subsubsection Vertical Compositions
14862
14863@noindent
14864@ignore
14865@starindex
14866@end ignore
14867@tindex cvert
14868The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
14869component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
14870the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
14871For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
14872formats in Big mode as
14873
14874@example
14875@group
14876f( a , 2 )
14877 bb a + 1
14878 ccc 2
14879 b
14880@end group
14881@end example
14882
14883@ignore
14884@starindex
14885@end ignore
14886@tindex cbase
14887There are several special composition functions that work only as
14888components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
14889controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
14890will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
14891in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
14892cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
14893
14894@example
14895@group
14896 2
14897 a + 1
14898 a 2
14899f(bb , b )
14900 ccc
14901@end group
14902@end example
14903
14904@ignore
14905@starindex
14906@end ignore
14907@tindex ctbase
14908@ignore
14909@starindex
14910@end ignore
14911@tindex cbbase
14912There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
14913make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
14914or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
14915Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
14916cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
14917
14918@example
14919@group
14920 a
14921a -
14922- + a + b
14923b -
14924 b
14925@end group
14926@end example
14927
14928There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
14929function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
14930be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
14931which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
14932@samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
14933item.
14934
14935@ignore
14936@starindex
14937@end ignore
14938@tindex crule
14939The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
14940across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
14941characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
14942e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
14943vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
14944width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
14945with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
14946
14947@example
14948@group
14949a + 1
14950=====
14951 2
14952 b
14953@end group
14954@end example
14955
14956@ignore
14957@starindex
14958@end ignore
14959@tindex clvert
14960@ignore
14961@starindex
14962@end ignore
14963@tindex crvert
14964Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
14965like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
14966in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
14967gives:
14968
14969@example
14970@group
14971a + a
14972bb bb
14973ccc ccc
14974@end group
14975@end example
14976
14977Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
14978which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
14979Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
14980
14981@node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
14982@subsubsection Other Compositions
14983
14984@noindent
14985@ignore
14986@starindex
14987@end ignore
14988@tindex csup
14989The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
14990example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
14991language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
14992@samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
14993bottom line is one above the baseline.
14994
14995@ignore
14996@starindex
14997@end ignore
14998@tindex csub
14999Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
15000This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
15001bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
15002@code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
15003@code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
15004
15005@ignore
15006@starindex
15007@end ignore
15008@tindex cflat
15009The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
15010as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
15011or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
15012@samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
15013to improve its readability.
15014
15015@ignore
15016@starindex
15017@end ignore
15018@tindex cspace
15019The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
15020@samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
15021A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
15022instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
15023looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
15024it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
15025are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
15026
15027@example
15028@group
15029 2 2 2 2
15030a a a a
15031@end group
15032@end example
15033
15034@noindent
15035If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
15036
15037@ignore
15038@starindex
15039@end ignore
15040@tindex cvspace
15041The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
15042stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
15043baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
15044argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
15045height if used in a vertical composition.
15046
15047@ignore
15048@starindex
15049@end ignore
15050@tindex ctspace
15051@ignore
15052@starindex
15053@end ignore
15054@tindex cbspace
15055There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
15056create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
15057of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
15058Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
15059displays as:
15060
15061@example
15062@group
15063 a
15064 -
15065a b
15066- a a
15067b + - + -
15068a b b
15069- a
15070b -
15071 b
15072@end group
15073@end example
15074
15075@node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
15076@subsubsection Information about Compositions
15077
15078@noindent
15079The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
15080arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
15081then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
15082
15083@ignore
15084@starindex
15085@end ignore
15086@tindex cwidth
15087The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
15088composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
15089@samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
15090@TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
15091the composition functions described in this section.
15092
15093@ignore
15094@starindex
15095@end ignore
15096@tindex cheight
15097The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
15098This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
15099
15100@ignore
15101@starindex
15102@end ignore
15103@tindex cascent
15104@ignore
15105@starindex
15106@end ignore
15107@tindex cdescent
15108The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15109of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15110the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15111always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15112@samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15113For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15114returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15115is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15116
15117@node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15118@subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15119
15120@noindent
15121@kindex Z C
15122@pindex calc-user-define-composition
15123The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15124define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15125formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15126Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15127language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15128replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15129replaced.
15130
15131Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15132that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15133argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15134the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15135literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15136affect the display at all.
15137
15138You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15139defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15140which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15141You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15142number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15143Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15144for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15145none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15146neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15147function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15148
15149If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15150formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15151mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15152
15153For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15154@samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15155
15156@example
15157@group
15158 n
15159( )
15160 m
15161@end group
15162@end example
15163
15164@noindent
15165You might prefer the notation,
15166
15167@example
15168@group
15169 C
15170n m
15171@end group
15172@end example
15173
15174@noindent
15175To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15176then put the formula
15177
15178@smallexample
15179choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15180@end smallexample
15181
15182@noindent
15183on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15184@code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15185of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15186@key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15187off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15188as an algebraic entry.
15189
15190@example
15191@group
15192 C + C
15193a b 7 3
15194@end group
15195@end example
15196
15197As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15198numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15199the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15200instead of parentheses.
15201
15202@smallexample
15203choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15204@end smallexample
15205
15206Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15207@samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15208
15209The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15210functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15211onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15212the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15213This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15214purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15215it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15216formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15217Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15218parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15219(Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15220it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15221
15222The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15223composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15224evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15225@samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15226as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15227regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15228@code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15229@kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15230operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15231rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15232Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15233symbolic form.
15234
15235It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15236It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15237example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15238there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15239@samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15240case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15241the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15242have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15243produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15244
15245You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15246command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15247
15248@node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15249@subsection Syntax Tables
15250
15251@noindent
15252@cindex Syntax tables
15253@cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15254Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15255allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15256Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15257
15258(Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15259unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15260
15261@kindex Z S
15262@pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15263The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15264syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15265syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15266mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15267@kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15268the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15269@pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15270
15271@menu
15272* Syntax Table Basics::
15273* Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15274* Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15275* Conditional Syntax Rules::
15276@end menu
15277
15278@node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15279@subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15280
15281@noindent
15282@dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15283such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15284Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15285into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15286like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15287ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15288the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15289syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15290followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15291zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15292
15293A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15294which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15295favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15296table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15297language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15298algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15299its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15300and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15301resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15302completely different.)
15303
15304A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15305Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15306matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15307
15308@example
15309foo ( ) := 2+3
15310@end example
15311
15312@noindent
15313would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15314were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15315as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15316for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15317the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15318as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15319not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15320zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15321also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15322formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15323instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15324calls would no longer recognize it!
15325
15326While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15327and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15328break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15329
15330The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15331On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15332be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15333matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15334rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15335and postfix operator, respectively:
15336
15337@example
15338foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15339foo # := myprefix(#1)
15340# foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15341# foo := mypostfix(#1)
15342@end example
15343
15344Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15345will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15346
15347It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15348because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15349pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15350match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15351is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15352never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15353written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15354@samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15355ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15356the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15357exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15358if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15359
15360Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15361The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15362token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15363a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15364patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15365two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15366expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15367expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15368
15369As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15370@samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15371recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15372rule,
15373
15374@example
15375sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15376@end example
15377
15378@noindent
15379to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15380read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15381define these operators quite easily:
15382
15383@example
15384# *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15385# ++ := postinc(#1)
15386++ # := preinc(#1)
15387@end example
15388
15389@noindent
15390To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15391and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15392Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15393operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15394
15395You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15396interpretation in syntax patterns:
15397
15398@example
15399# ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15400@end example
15401
15402Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15403again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15404an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15405token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15406backslashes in tokens.)
15407
15408@example
15409# "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15410@end example
15411
15412@noindent
15413This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15414
15415The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15416it is not valid to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15417tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15418@samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15419the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15420usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15421respectively).
15422
15423Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15424the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15425
15426@node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15427@subsubsection Precedence
15428
15429@noindent
15430Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15431By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15432
15433@example
15434# foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15435@end example
15436
15437@noindent
15438will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15439will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15440precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15441place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15442For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15443@samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15444
15445@example
15446#/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15447@end example
15448
15449@noindent
15450then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15451Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15452precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15453@samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15454By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15455can create a right-associative operator.
15456
15457@xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15458standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15459language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15460
15461@node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15462@subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15463
15464@noindent
15465To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15466write
15467
15468@example
15469foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15470foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15471foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15472@end example
15473
15474@noindent
15475but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15476Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15477``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15478
15479@example
15480foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15481@end example
15482
15483The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15484One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15485ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15486or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15487In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15488separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15489Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15490several expressions separated by commas.
15491
15492A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15493items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15494match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15495The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15496of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15497arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15498
15499If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15500(or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15501strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15502does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15503always be an empty vector.
15504
15505@example
15506foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15507foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15508@end example
15509
15510@noindent
15511will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15512@samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15513some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15514@samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15515rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15516
15517@example
15518foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15519@end example
15520
15521@noindent
15522will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15523@samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15524
15525The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15526just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15527count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15528
15529@example
15530foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15531foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15532@end example
15533
15534@noindent
15535Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15536which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15537empty vector is produced.
15538
15539Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15540optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15541rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15542algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15543the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15544for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15545rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15546this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15547Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15548argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15549prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15550as optional.
15551
15552Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15553patterns will not work as you might expect:
15554
15555@example
15556foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15557@end example
15558
15559@noindent
15560Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15561@samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15562first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15563pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15564pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15565doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15566point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15567
15568@example
15569foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15570foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15571@end example
15572
15573More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15574part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15575If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15576``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15577backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15578backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15579the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15580
15581@node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15582@subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15583
15584@noindent
15585It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15586example, the rules
15587
15588@example
15589foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15590foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15591@end example
15592
15593@noindent
15594will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15595@samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15596number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15597rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15598nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15599functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15600
15601The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15602rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15603@samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15604conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15605as if by the @w{@kbd{a s}} algebra command (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15606Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15607that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15608results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15609@samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15610result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15611goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15612
15613Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15614exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15615@xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15616condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15617variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15618expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15619
15620@example
15621foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15622@end example
15623
15624@noindent
15625The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15626integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15627This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15628like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15629
15630The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15631variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15632rules.
15633
15634The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15635rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15636@xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15637meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15638conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15639@code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15640
15641@example
15642sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15643@end example
15644
15645@noindent
15646This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15647In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15648@samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15649its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15650the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15651Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15652must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15653will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15654
15655@node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15656@section The @code{Modes} Variable
15657
15658@noindent
15659@kindex m g
15660@pindex calc-get-modes
15661The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15662a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15663are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15664@var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15665macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15666on the current mode settings.
15667
15668@cindex @code{Modes} variable
15669@vindex Modes
15670The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15671@code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15672It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15673@code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15674command will continue to work, however.)
15675
15676In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15677prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15678that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15679a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15680
15681The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15682
15683@enumerate
15684@item
15685Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15686
15687@item
15688Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15689
15690@item
15691Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15692This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15693
15694@item
15695Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15696
15697@item
15698Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15699constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
1570020000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15701These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15702command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15703@kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15704identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15705produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15706@kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15707will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15708
15709@item
15710Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15711and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15712
15713@item
15714Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15715
15716@item
15717Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15718
15719@item
15720Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15721Command is @kbd{m p}.
15722
15723@item
15724Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15725mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, @mathit{-3} for square Matrix mode,
15726or @var{N} for
15727@texline @math{N\times N}
15728@infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15729Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15730
15731@item
15732Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
157330 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15734or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15735
15736@item
15737Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15738or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15739@end enumerate
15740
15741For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15742precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15743Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15744stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15745keyboard macro.)
15746
15747As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15748oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15749
15750Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15751to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15752in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15753would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15754do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15755programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15756
15757@node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15758@section The Calc Mode Line
15759
15760@noindent
15761@cindex Mode line indicators
15762This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15763Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15764stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15765
15766The basic mode line format is:
15767
15768@example
92e15881 15769--%*-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
4009494e
GM
15770@end example
15771
92e15881 15772The @samp{%*} indicates that the buffer is ``read-only''; it shows that
4009494e
GM
15773regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15774as if it were text.
15775
15776The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15777is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15778that are in effect.
15779
15780The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15781The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15782@code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15783
15784Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15785on the mode line:
15786
15787@table @code
15788@item Alg
15789Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15790
15791@item Alg[(
15792Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15793
15794@item Alg*
15795Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15796
15797@item Symb
15798Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15799
15800@item Matrix
15801Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15802
15803@item Matrix@var{n}
15804Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15805
15806@item SqMatrix
15807Square Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15808
15809@item Scalar
15810Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15811
15812@item Polar
15813Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15814
15815@item Frac
15816Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15817
15818@item Inf
15819Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15820
15821@item +Inf
15822Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15823
15824@item NoSimp
15825Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15826
15827@item NumSimp
15828Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15829
15830@item BinSimp@var{w}
15831Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
15832
15833@item AlgSimp
15834Algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m A}).
15835
15836@item ExtSimp
15837Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
15838
15839@item UnitSimp
15840Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
15841
15842@item Bin
15843Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15844
15845@item Oct
15846Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
15847
15848@item Hex
15849Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
15850
15851@item Radix@var{n}
15852Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
15853
15854@item Zero
15855Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15856
15857@item Big
15858Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15859
15860@item Flat
15861One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
15862
15863@item Unform
15864Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
15865
15866@item C
15867C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
15868
15869@item Pascal
15870Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
15871
15872@item Fortran
15873FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
15874
15875@item TeX
15876@TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15877
15878@item LaTeX
15879La@TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d L}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15880
15881@item Eqn
15882@dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
15883
15884@item Math
15885Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
15886
15887@item Maple
15888Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
15889
15890@item Norm@var{n}
15891Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
15892
15893@item Fix@var{n}
15894Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
15895
15896@item Sci
15897Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
15898
15899@item Sci@var{n}
15900Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
15901
15902@item Eng
15903Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
15904
15905@item Eng@var{n}
15906Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
15907
15908@item Left@var{n}
15909Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
15910
15911@item Right
15912Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
15913
15914@item Right@var{n}
15915Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
15916
15917@item Center
15918Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
15919
15920@item Center@var{n}
15921Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
15922
15923@item Wid@var{n}
15924Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15925
15926@item Wide
15927No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
15928
15929@item Break
15930Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15931
15932@item Save
15933Record modes in @file{~/.calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
15934
15935@item Local
15936Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15937
15938@item LocEdit
15939Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15940
15941@item LocPerm
15942Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15943
15944@item Global
15945Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15946
15947@item Manual
15948Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
15949Recomputation}).
15950
15951@item Graph
15952GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
15953
15954@item Sel
15955Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15956
15957@item Dirty
15958The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
15959
15960@item Inv
15961``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
15962
15963@item Hyp
15964``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
15965
15966@item Keep
15967``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
15968
15969@item Narrow
15970Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
15971@end table
15972
15973In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
15974as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
15975
15976@node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
15977@chapter Arithmetic Functions
15978
15979@noindent
15980This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
15981on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
15982commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
15983performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
15984stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
15985formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
15986is invalid) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
15987
15988Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
15989Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
15990the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
15991
15992@xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
15993prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
15994interpret a prefix argument.
15995
15996@menu
15997* Basic Arithmetic::
15998* Integer Truncation::
15999* Complex Number Functions::
16000* Conversions::
16001* Date Arithmetic::
16002* Financial Functions::
16003* Binary Functions::
16004@end menu
16005
16006@node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16007@section Basic Arithmetic
16008
16009@noindent
16010@kindex +
16011@pindex calc-plus
16012@ignore
16013@mindex @null
16014@end ignore
16015@tindex +
16016The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
16017be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
16018onto the stack.
16019
16020If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
16021the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
16022other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
16023elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
16024number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
16025to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
16026you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
16027the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
16028safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
16029to every element of a vector.
16030
16031If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
16032be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
16033the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
16034mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
16035conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
16036
16037If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
16038the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
16039is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
16040degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
16041and then the two HMS forms are added.
16042
16043If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
16044real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
16045an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
16046Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
16047Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
16048subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
16049negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
16050are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
16051
16052If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
16053with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
16054error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
16055Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
16056adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
16057error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
16058work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
16059write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
16060
16061If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
16062or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
16063result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
16064the two values.
16065
16066If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
16067which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
16068one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
16069@w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
16070
16071If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
16072result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
16073the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
16074infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
16075
16076@kindex -
16077@pindex calc-minus
16078@ignore
16079@mindex @null
16080@end ignore
16081@tindex -
16082The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
16083number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
16084computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
16085available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
16086
16087@kindex *
16088@pindex calc-times
16089@ignore
16090@mindex @null
16091@end ignore
16092@tindex *
16093The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
16094argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
16095the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
16096are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
16097vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
16098done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
16099vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
16100dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
16101is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16102
16103If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16104HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16105HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16106forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16107see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16108or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16109independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16110whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16111
16112@kindex /
16113@pindex calc-divide
16114@ignore
16115@mindex @null
16116@end ignore
16117@tindex /
16118The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers.
16119
16120When combining multiplication and division in an algebraic formula, it
16121is good style to use parentheses to distinguish between possible
16122interpretations; the expression @samp{a/b*c} should be written
16123@samp{(a/b)*c} or @samp{a/(b*c)}, as appropriate. Without the
16124parentheses, Calc will interpret @samp{a/b*c} as @samp{a/(b*c)}, since
16125in algebraic entry Calc gives division a lower precedence than
16126multiplication. (This is not standard across all computer languages, and
16127Calc may change the precedence depending on the language mode being used.
16128@xref{Language Modes}.) This default ordering can be changed by setting
16129the customizable variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} to
16130@code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}); this will give multiplication and
16131division equal precedences. Note that Calc's default choice of
16132precedence allows @samp{a b / c d} to be used as a shortcut for
16133@smallexample
16134@group
16135a b
16136---.
16137c d
16138@end group
16139@end smallexample
16140
16141When dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the
16142computation performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This
16143also occurs if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the
16144effect is to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}.
16145If @expr{B} is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a
16146plain vector (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the
16147equation @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}.
16148Otherwise, if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of
16149@emph{columns} as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If
16150you wish a vector @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be
16151solved as @expr{X A = B}, make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1
16152v p} first. To force a left-handed solution with a square matrix
16153@expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and @expr{B} before dividing, then
16154transpose the result.
16155
16156HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16157forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16158values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16159form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16160encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16161interval.
16162
16163@kindex ^
16164@pindex calc-power
16165@ignore
16166@mindex @null
16167@end ignore
16168@tindex ^
16169The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16170the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16171multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16172logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16173powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16174the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16175
16176@kindex I ^
16177@tindex nroot
16178If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16179computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16180(This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16181
16182@kindex \
16183@pindex calc-idiv
16184@tindex idiv
16185@ignore
16186@mindex @null
16187@end ignore
16188@tindex \
16189The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16190to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16191@key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16192more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16193operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16194@kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16195
16196@kindex %
16197@pindex calc-mod
16198@ignore
16199@mindex @null
16200@end ignore
16201@tindex %
16202The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16203operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16204for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16205positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16206@expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16207If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16208must be positive real number.
16209
16210@kindex :
16211@pindex calc-fdiv
16212@tindex fdiv
16213The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command
16214divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16215result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16216@kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16217the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16218you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16219this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16220as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16221
16222@kindex n
16223@pindex calc-change-sign
16224The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16225of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16226forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16227
16228@kindex A
16229@pindex calc-abs
16230@tindex abs
16231The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16232value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16233real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16234With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16235the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16236elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16237the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16238The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16239an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16240
16241@kindex f A
16242@pindex calc-abssqr
16243@tindex abssqr
16244The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16245absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16246
16247@kindex f s
16248@pindex calc-sign
16249@tindex sign
16250The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16251argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16252argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16253which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16254zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16255
16256@kindex &
16257@pindex calc-inv
16258@tindex inv
16259@cindex Reciprocal
16260The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16261reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16262matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16263
16264@kindex Q
16265@pindex calc-sqrt
16266@tindex sqrt
16267The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16268root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16269complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16270
16271@kindex f h
16272@pindex calc-hypot
16273@tindex hypot
16274The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16275root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16276is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16277and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16278magnitudes are used.
16279
16280@kindex f Q
16281@pindex calc-isqrt
16282@tindex isqrt
16283The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16284integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16285number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16286produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16287integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16288is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16289the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16290
16291@kindex f n
16292@kindex f x
16293@pindex calc-min
16294@tindex min
16295@pindex calc-max
16296@tindex max
16297The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16298[@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16299respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16300intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16301take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16302all the arguments.)
16303
16304@kindex f M
16305@kindex f X
16306@pindex calc-mant-part
16307@tindex mant
16308@pindex calc-xpon-part
16309@tindex xpon
16310The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16311the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16312(@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16313@expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16314@texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16315@infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16316where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16317@expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16318and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16319returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16320used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16321mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16322a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16323
16324@kindex f S
16325@pindex calc-scale-float
16326@tindex scf
16327The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16328by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16329real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16330may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16331or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16332
16333@kindex f [
16334@kindex f ]
16335@pindex calc-decrement
16336@pindex calc-increment
16337@tindex decr
16338@tindex incr
16339The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16340(@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16341a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16342floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16343For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16344is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
163458 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16346@samp{0.0} produces
16347@texline @math{10^{-p}},
16348@infoline @expr{10^-p},
16349where @expr{p} is the current
16350precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16351With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16352
16353Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16354almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
163556 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16356will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16357One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16358way floating-point numbers work.
16359
16360Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16361Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16362
16363@node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16364@section Integer Truncation
16365
16366@noindent
16367There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16368differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16369commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16370is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16371to integer form.
16372
16373If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16374expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16375
16376@cindex Integer part of a number
16377@kindex F
16378@pindex calc-floor
16379@tindex floor
16380@tindex ffloor
16381@ignore
16382@mindex @null
16383@end ignore
16384@kindex H F
16385The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16386truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16387infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16388@mathit{-4}.
16389
16390@kindex I F
16391@pindex calc-ceiling
16392@tindex ceil
16393@tindex fceil
16394@ignore
16395@mindex @null
16396@end ignore
16397@kindex H I F
16398The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16399command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
164004, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16401
16402@kindex R
16403@pindex calc-round
16404@tindex round
16405@tindex fround
16406@ignore
16407@mindex @null
16408@end ignore
16409@kindex H R
16410The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16411rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16412this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16413Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16414but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16415
16416@kindex I R
16417@pindex calc-trunc
16418@tindex trunc
16419@tindex ftrunc
16420@ignore
16421@mindex @null
16422@end ignore
16423@kindex H I R
16424The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16425command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16426everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16427@kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16428
16429These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16430do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16431modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16432these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16433Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16434representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16435
16436@ignore
16437@starindex
16438@end ignore
16439@tindex rounde
16440@ignore
16441@starindex
16442@end ignore
16443@tindex roundu
16444@ignore
16445@starindex
16446@end ignore
16447@tindex frounde
16448@ignore
16449@starindex
16450@end ignore
16451@tindex froundu
16452There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16453algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16454except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16455part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16456Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16457rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16458@samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16459The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16460after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16461subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16462already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16463begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16464of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16465argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16466@code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16467
16468Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16469a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16470decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16471produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16472produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16473the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16474no second argument at all.
16475
16476@cindex Fractional part of a number
16477To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16478added to `@tfn{floor(}@var{n}@tfn{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16479modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16480
16481Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16482and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16483@kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16484arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16485
16486@node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16487@section Complex Number Functions
16488
16489@noindent
16490@kindex J
16491@pindex calc-conj
16492@tindex conj
16493The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16494complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16495complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16496this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16497this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16498
16499@kindex G
16500@pindex calc-argument
16501@tindex arg
16502The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16503``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16504notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16505@texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'.
16506@infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'.
16507The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16508be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16509(inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16510
16511@pindex calc-imaginary
16512The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16513top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16514command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16515on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16516
16517@kindex f r
16518@pindex calc-re
16519@tindex re
16520The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16521by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16522added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16523the value part.)
16524
16525@kindex f i
16526@pindex calc-im
16527@tindex im
16528The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16529by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16530or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16531
16532@ignore
16533@mindex v p
16534@end ignore
16535@kindex v p (complex)
16536@pindex calc-pack
16537The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16538the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16539a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16540with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16541(Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16542
16543@ignore
16544@mindex v u
16545@end ignore
16546@kindex v u (complex)
16547@pindex calc-unpack
16548The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16549(or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16550into its separate components.
16551
16552@node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16553@section Conversions
16554
16555@noindent
16556The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16557to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16558
16559@kindex c f
16560@pindex calc-float
16561@tindex pfloat
16562The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16563number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16564@expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16565@expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16566object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16567converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16568in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16569on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16570format may lose information.
16571
16572As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16573are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16574you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16575Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16576it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16577@xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16578
16579The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16580applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16581algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16582changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16583
16584@kindex H c f
16585@tindex float
16586With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16587only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16588argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16589is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16590
16591You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16592value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16593would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16594that appear right now.
16595
16596@kindex c F
16597@pindex calc-fraction
16598@tindex pfrac
16599The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16600floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16601produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16602input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16603numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16604if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16605as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16606is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16607a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16608precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16609fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16610
16611@kindex H c F
16612@tindex frac
16613The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16614There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16615which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16616
16617@kindex c d
16618@pindex calc-to-degrees
16619@tindex deg
16620The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16621number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16622HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16623will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16624
16625@kindex c r
16626@pindex calc-to-radians
16627@tindex rad
16628The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16629HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16630
16631@kindex c h
16632@pindex calc-to-hms
16633@tindex hms
16634The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16635number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16636form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16637function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16638(The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16639
16640@pindex calc-from-hms
16641The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16642stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16643
16644@kindex c p
16645@kindex I c p
16646@pindex calc-polar
16647@tindex polar
16648@tindex rect
16649The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16650the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16651to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16652This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16653functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16654conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16655already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16656@kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16657
16658@kindex c c
16659@pindex calc-clean
16660@tindex pclean
16661The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16662number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16663according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16664components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16665are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16666angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16667produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16668operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16669number (i.e., pervasively).
16670
16671If the simplification mode is set below the default level, it is raised
16672to the default level for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c}
16673applies the default simplifications even if their automatic application
16674is disabled. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16675
16676@cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16677A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16678to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16679least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16680prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16681
16682@kindex c 0-9
16683@pindex calc-clean-num
16684The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16685to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16686errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16687decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16688
16689The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16690through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16691numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16692of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16693if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16694@samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16695Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16696
16697If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16698you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16699(The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16700does not clip small numbers.)
16701
16702One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16703a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16704plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16705produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16706numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16707you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16708
16709@kindex H c 0-9
16710@kindex H c c
16711@tindex clean
16712With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16713operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16714
16715@node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16716@section Date Arithmetic
16717
16718@noindent
16719@cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16720The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16721and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16722use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16723letters.
16724
16725The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16726commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16727date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16728form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16729date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16730described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16731
16732Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16733plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16734additional argument from the top of the stack.
16735
16736@menu
16737* Date Conversions::
16738* Date Functions::
16739* Time Zones::
16740* Business Days::
16741@end menu
16742
16743@node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16744@subsection Date Conversions
16745
16746@noindent
16747@kindex t D
16748@pindex calc-date
16749@tindex date
16750The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16751date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD. The
16752result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16753fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16754argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16755
16756With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16757(up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16758of the following ways:
16759
16760The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16761builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16762day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16763such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16764an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
167651 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16766@var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16767month will be used.
16768
16769The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16770pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16771real-time clock.
16772
16773The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16774function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16775
16776The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16777@var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16778@var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16779@var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16780@var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16781The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16782
16783@kindex t J
16784@pindex calc-julian
16785@tindex julian
16786@cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16787The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16788a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
7c1a0036
GM
16789since noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC. A pure date is converted to an
16790integer Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form
16791is converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
4009494e
GM
16792interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16793day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16794you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16795zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16796are never time-zone adjusted.
16797
16798This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16799count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16800the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16801current or specified time zone.
16802
16803@kindex t U
16804@pindex calc-unix-time
16805@tindex unixtime
16806@cindex Unix time format, conversions
16807The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16808converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16809seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16810will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16811precisions, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16812digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16813is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16814in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16815numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16816suppress the adjustment if so.
16817
16818@kindex t C
16819@pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16820@tindex tzconv
16821@cindex Time Zones, converting between
16822The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16823command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16824are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16825any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16826If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16827zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16828prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16829stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
16830
16831@node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
16832@subsection Date Functions
16833
16834@noindent
16835@kindex t N
16836@pindex calc-now
16837@tindex now
16838The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
16839current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
16840reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
16841argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
16842
16843@kindex t P
16844@pindex calc-date-part
16845The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
16846of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
16847argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
16848The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
16849
16850@tindex year
16851The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
16852from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
16853following functions will also accept a real number for an
16854argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
16855Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
168561 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
16857
16858@tindex month
16859The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
16860from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
16861
16862@tindex day
16863The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
16864from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
16865
16866@tindex hour
16867The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
16868a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
16869that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
16870date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
16871HMS forms as input.
16872
16873@tindex minute
16874The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
16875from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
16876
16877@tindex second
16878The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
16879from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
16880the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
16881precisions, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
16882
16883@tindex weekday
16884The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
16885number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
16886to 6 (Saturday).
16887
16888@tindex yearday
16889The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
16890number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
16891to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
16892
16893@tindex time
16894The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
16895of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
16896for a pure date form.
16897
16898@kindex t M
16899@pindex calc-new-month
16900@tindex newmonth
16901The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
16902computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
16903specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
16904form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
16905With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
16906@kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
16907is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
16908@var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
16909
16910@kindex t Y
16911@pindex calc-new-year
16912@tindex newyear
16913The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
16914computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
16915the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
16916of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
16917@var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
16918@var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
16919years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
16920year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
16921@mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
16922
16923@kindex t W
16924@pindex calc-new-week
16925@tindex newweek
16926The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
16927computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
16928the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
16929use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
16930the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
16931subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
16932
16933Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
16934Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
16935will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
16936will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
16937of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
16938this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
16939exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
16940if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
16941to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
16942the time to midnight; hint:@: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
16943of the @code{weekday} function?).
16944
16945@ignore
16946@starindex
16947@end ignore
16948@tindex pwday
16949The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
16950day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
16951two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
16952number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
16953specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
169547 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
16955in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
16956@samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
16957@samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
16958With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
16959for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
16960
16961@kindex t I
16962@pindex calc-inc-month
16963@tindex incmonth
16964The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
16965increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
16966months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
16967if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
16968same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
16969number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
16970@samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
16971Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
16972the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
16973in this case).
16974
16975@ignore
16976@starindex
16977@end ignore
16978@tindex incyear
16979The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
16980a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
16981any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
16982is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
16983simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
16984months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
16985argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
16986command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
16987
16988There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
16989serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
16990@code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
16991
16992@xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
16993which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
16994
16995@node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
16996@subsection Business Days
16997
16998@noindent
16999Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
17000where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
17001arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
17002consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
17003subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
17004(assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
17005
17006@kindex t +
17007@kindex t -
17008@tindex badd
17009@tindex bsub
17010@pindex calc-business-days-plus
17011@pindex calc-business-days-minus
17012The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
17013and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
17014commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
17015one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
17016number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
17017then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
17018days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
17019evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
17020possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
17021half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
17022date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
17023case the result is the number of business days between the two
17024dates.
17025
17026@cindex @code{Holidays} variable
17027@vindex Holidays
17028By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
17029Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
17030additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
17031(There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
17032variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
17033@samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
17034be any of the following kinds of objects:
17035
17036@itemize @bullet
17037@item
17038Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
17039particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
17040
17041@item
17042Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
17043which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
17044
17045@item
17046Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
17047considered to be a holiday.
17048
17049@item
17050Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
17051If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
17052yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
17053numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
17054Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
17055Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
17056If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
17057takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
17058a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
17059
17060@item
17061A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
17062a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
17063
17064@item
17065An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
17066years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
17067business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
17068in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
17069list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
17070want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
17071where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
17072limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
17073@samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
17074for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
17075
17076@item
17077An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
17078are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
17079range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
17080the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
17081on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
17082four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
17083Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
17084fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
17085as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
17086be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
17087the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
17088(Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
17089treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
17090so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
17091@end itemize
17092
17093If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
17094@kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
17095then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
17096
17097Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
17098list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
17099sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
17100@samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
17101Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17102the number of holidays between two dates.)
17103
17104Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
171052737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17106list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17107in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17108worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17109calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17110only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17111holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17112
17113If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17114weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17115recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17116Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17117subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17118effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17119day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17120difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17121equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17122conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17123business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17124original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17125completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17126might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17127producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17128
17129@ignore
17130@starindex
17131@end ignore
17132@tindex holiday
17133There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17134any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17135holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17136business day.
17137
17138@node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17139@subsection Time Zones
17140
17141@noindent
17142@cindex Time zones
17143@cindex Daylight saving time
17144Time zones and daylight saving time are a complicated business.
17145The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17146compute the correct time zone and daylight saving adjustment to use,
17147provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17148Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17149do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17150can't determine the right correction to use.
17151
17152Adjustments for time zones and daylight saving time are done by
17153@kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17154commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17155to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-saving
17156transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17157@samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17158and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight saving time: using Calc's
17159default daylight saving time rule (see the explanation below),
17160@samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17161evaluates to @samp{29.95833} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17162because one hour was lost when daylight saving commenced on
17163April 7, 1991.
17164
17165In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17166computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17167@samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17168days between two dates without taking daylight saving into account.
17169
17170@pindex calc-time-zone
17171@ignore
17172@starindex
17173@end ignore
17174@tindex tzone
17175The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17176zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17177seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17178is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17179Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17180Daylight Saving time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17181the normal difference.
17182
17183If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17184date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17185zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17186and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17187stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17188adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17189it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17190For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17191(for Pacific standard and daylight saving times, respectively).
17192
17193North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17194note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17195another for daylight saving time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17196in which the daylight saving adjustment is computed from context.
17197
17198@smallexample
17199@group
17200YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17201 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17202
17203YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17204 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17205
17206YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
172079/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17208@end group
17209@end smallexample
17210
17211@vindex math-tzone-names
17212To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17213you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17214is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17215structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17216Pacific Time look like this:
17217
17218@smallexample
17219@group
17220( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17221 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight saving adjustment.
17222 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17223@end group
17224@end smallexample
17225
17226@cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17227@vindex TimeZone
17228With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} will by
17229default get the time zone and daylight saving information from the
17230calendar (@pxref{Daylight Saving,Calendar/Diary,The Calendar and the Diary,
17231emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}). To use a different time zone, or if the
17232calendar does not give the desired result, you can set the Calc variable
17233@code{TimeZone} (which is by default @code{nil}) to an appropriate
17234time zone name. (The easiest way to do this is to edit the
17235@code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T} command, then use the
17236@kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save the value of
17237@code{TimeZone} permanently.)
17238If the time zone given by @code{TimeZone} is a generalized time zone,
17239e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc examines the date being converted to tell whether
17240to use standard or daylight saving time. But if the current time zone
17241is explicit, e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is
17242used exactly and Calc's daylight saving algorithm is not consulted.
17243The special time zone name @code{local}
17244is equivalent to no argument; i.e., it uses the information obtained
17245from the calendar.
17246
17247The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17248arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}; namely, use the
17249information from the calendar if @code{TimeZone} is @code{nil},
17250otherwise use the time zone given by @code{TimeZone}.
17251
17252@vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17253@findex math-std-daylight-savings
17254When Calc computes the daylight saving information itself (i.e., when
17255the @code{TimeZone} variable is set), it will by default consider
17256daylight saving time to begin at 2 a.m.@: on the second Sunday of March
17257(for years from 2007 on) or on the last Sunday in April (for years
17258before 2007), and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of
17259November. (for years from 2007 on) or the last Sunday in October (for
17260years before 2007). These are the rules that have been in effect in
17261much of North America since 1966 and take into account the rule change
17262that began in 2007. If you are in a country that uses different rules
17263for computing daylight saving time, you have two choices: Write your own
17264daylight saving hook, or control time zones explicitly by setting the
17265@code{TimeZone} variable and/or always giving a time-zone argument for
17266the conversion functions.
17267
17268The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17269name of a function that is used to compute the daylight saving
17270adjustment for a given date. The default is
17271@code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17272(either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17273
17274The daylight saving hook function is called with four arguments:
17275The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17276a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17277hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17278the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17279and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17280converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17281
17282@findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17283The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17284daylight saving computations. This is an internal version of
17285the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17286section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17287the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17288and the weekday number (0-6).
17289
17290The default daylight saving hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17291more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17292time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17293depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17294algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17295daylight saving hook:
17296
17297@smallexample
17298(defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17299 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17300 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17301 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17302 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17303 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17304 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17305 (t -1))))
17306 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17307 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17308 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17309 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17310 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17311 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17312 (t 0))))
17313 (t 0))
17314)
17315@end smallexample
17316
17317@noindent
17318The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17319from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17320It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17321adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17322and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17323
17324There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17325beginning of daylight saving time; converting a date/time form that
17326falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17327from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight saving time, the
17328hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17329form that falls in this hour results in a time value for the first
17330manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour
17331later).
17332
17333If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17334daylight saving adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17335
17336In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17337computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17338given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17339generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17340daylight saving computation is applied to it as it appears.
17341If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17342daylight-saving version of @var{zone} before being given to
17343the daylight saving hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17344that the daylight-saving computation is always done in
17345local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17346is typically represented in.
17347
17348@ignore
17349@starindex
17350@end ignore
17351@tindex dsadj
17352The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17353daylight saving adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17354time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17355daylight saving time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17356@var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17357the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17358the computation is done for the current time zone.
17359
4009494e
GM
17360@node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17361@section Financial Functions
17362
17363@noindent
17364Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17365key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17366a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17367
17368Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17369functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17370both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17371in months will give you very wrong answers!
17372
17373It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17374you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17375last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17376of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17377
17378@menu
17379* Percentages::
17380* Future Value::
17381* Present Value::
17382* Related Financial Functions::
17383* Depreciation Functions::
17384* Definitions of Financial Functions::
17385@end menu
17386
17387@node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17388@subsection Percentages
17389
17390@kindex M-%
17391@pindex calc-percent
17392@tindex %
17393@tindex percent
17394The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17395say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17396@kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17397@key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17398
17399Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17400You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17401@samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17402100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17403@samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17404(The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17405@code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17406@samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17407
17408The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
174090.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17410the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17411uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17412The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17413but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17414
17415In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17416for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17417but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17418represents a rate of 540 percent!
17419
17420The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17421For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
1742268 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17423
17424@kindex c %
17425@pindex calc-convert-percent
17426The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17427value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17428For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17429@samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17430differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17431this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17432to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17433
17434To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17435use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17436@samp{25%}.
17437
17438@kindex b %
17439@pindex calc-percent-change
17440@tindex relch
17441The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17442calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17443For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17444since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17445decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
1744620% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17447because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17448in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17449of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17450the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17451
17452@node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17453@subsection Future Value
17454
17455@noindent
17456@kindex b F
17457@pindex calc-fin-fv
17458@tindex fv
17459The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17460the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17461from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17462If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17463years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17464year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17465worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17466have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17467in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17468occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17469
17470@kindex I b F
17471@tindex fvb
17472The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17473but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17474Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17475earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17476in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17477Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17478Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17479@kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17480as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17481
17482@kindex H b F
17483@tindex fvl
17484The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17485of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17486those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17487they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17488
17489The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17490fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17491of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17492@var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17493+ fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17494
17495To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17496do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17497final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17498deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17499five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17500deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
175011234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17502year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17503these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17504by @code{fvb} directly.
17505
17506What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17507are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17508as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17509lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17510now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17511a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
175125870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17513
17514@node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17515@subsection Present Value
17516
17517@noindent
17518@kindex b P
17519@pindex calc-fin-pv
17520@tindex pv
17521The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17522the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17523three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17524It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17525Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17526pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17527these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17528You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17529to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17530from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17531result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17532say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17533put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17534
17535Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17536trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17537considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17538the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17539@code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17540you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17541finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17542@code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17543the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17544
17545@kindex I b P
17546@tindex pvb
17547The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17548but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17549It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17550to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17551a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17552earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17553
17554@kindex H b P
17555@tindex pvl
17556The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17557an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17558period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17559four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17560less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17561on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17562@code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17563
17564You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17565and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17566fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17567
17568@kindex b N
17569@pindex calc-fin-npv
17570@tindex npv
17571The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17572the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17573The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17574a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17575at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17576a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17577from the first year, second year, and so on.
17578
17579Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17580Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17581not all the same!
17582
17583The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17584Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17585vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17586@xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17587payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17588values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17589A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17590payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17591
17592@kindex I b N
17593@tindex npvb
17594The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17595value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17596rather than at the end.
17597
17598@node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17599@subsection Related Financial Functions
17600
17601@noindent
17602The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17603present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17604
17605@kindex b M
17606@pindex calc-fin-pmt
17607@tindex pmt
17608The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17609the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17610Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17611value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17612@var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17613
17614@kindex I b M
17615@tindex pmtb
17616The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17617but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17618@code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17619represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17620
17621@kindex H b M
17622The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17623the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17624
17625@kindex b #
17626@pindex calc-fin-nper
17627@tindex nper
17628The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17629the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17630Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17631the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17632@var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17633ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17634the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17635
17636@kindex I b #
17637@tindex nperb
17638The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17639but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17640lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17641rather slow in the four-argument case.
17642
17643@kindex H b #
17644@tindex nperl
17645The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17646using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17647can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17648@code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17649bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17650
17651@kindex b T
17652@pindex calc-fin-rate
17653@tindex rate
17654The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17655the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17656@code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17657@var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17658@var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17659
17660@kindex I b T
17661@kindex H b T
17662@tindex rateb
17663@tindex ratel
17664The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17665commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17666in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17667accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17668To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17669@code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17670interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17671
17672@kindex b I
17673@pindex calc-fin-irr
17674@tindex irr
17675The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17676analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17677Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17678computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17679this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17680
17681@kindex I b I
17682@tindex irrb
17683The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17684return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17685
17686@node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17687@subsection Depreciation Functions
17688
17689@noindent
17690The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17691the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17692are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17693of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17694of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17695(or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17696
17697There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17698the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17699
17700@kindex b S
17701@pindex calc-fin-sln
17702@tindex sln
17703The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17704``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17705by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17706@samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17707initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17708per year.
17709
17710@kindex b Y
17711@pindex calc-fin-syd
17712@tindex syd
17713The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17714accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17715is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17716depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17717parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17718If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17719return zero.
17720
17721@kindex b D
17722@pindex calc-fin-ddb
17723@tindex ddb
17724The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17725accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17726It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17727
17728For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17729parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17730return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17731
17732For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17733and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17734ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17735the three depreciation methods:
17736
17737@example
17738@group
17739[ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17740 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17741 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17742 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17743 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17744@end group
17745@end example
17746
17747@noindent
17748(Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17749We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17750@kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17751and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17752
17753Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17754the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17755difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17756
17757@node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17758@subsection Definitions
17759
17760@noindent
17761For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17762Calc's financial functions.
17763
17764Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17765@var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17766be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17767formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17768(@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17769integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17770
17771@ifnottex
17772These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17773mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17774linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17775
17776@example
17777 n
17778 (1 + rate) - 1
17779fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17780 rate
17781
17782 n
17783 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17784fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17785 rate
17786
17787 n
17788fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17789
17790 -n
17791 1 - (1 + rate)
17792pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17793 rate
17794
17795 -n
17796 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17797pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17798 rate
17799
17800 -n
17801pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17802
17803 -1 -2 -3
17804npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17805
17806 -1 -2
17807npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17808
17809 -n
17810 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17811pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17812 -n
17813 1 - (1 + rate)
17814
17815 -n
17816 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17817pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17818 -n
17819 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17820
17821 amt * rate
17822nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17823 pmt
17824
17825 amt * rate
17826nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17827 pmt * (1 + rate)
17828
17829 amt
17830nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
17831 pmt
17832
17833 1/n
17834 pmt
17835ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
17836 1/n
17837 amt
17838
17839 cost - salv
17840sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
17841 life
17842
17843 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
17844syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
17845 life * (life + 1) / 2
17846
17847 book * 2
17848ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
17849 life
17850@end example
17851@end ifnottex
17852@tex
17853\turnoffactive
17854$$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
17855$$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17856$$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
17857$$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
17858$$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17859$$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
17860$$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
17861$$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
17862$$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
17863$$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
17864 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
17865$$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
17866$$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
17867$$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
17868$$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
17869$$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
17870$$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
17871$$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
17872@end tex
17873
17874@noindent
17875In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
17876
17877These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
17878intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
17879above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
17880all sorts of inputs.
17881
17882Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
17883negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
17884returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
17885
17886@samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
17887@samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
17888(@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
17889for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
17890that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
17891directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
17892
17893Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
17894for @samp{rate}.
17895
17896If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
17897will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
17898guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
17899
17900A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
17901calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
17902The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
17903
17904The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
17905starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
17906formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
17907would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
17908and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
17909function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
17910period.
17911
17912@node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
17913@section Binary Number Functions
17914
17915@noindent
17916The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
17917the @kbd{b} prefix.
17918
17919@cindex Binary numbers
17920The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
17921displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
17922like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
17923commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
17924zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
17925
17926@cindex Word size for binary operations
17927The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
17928arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
17929of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
17930particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
17931@expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
17932
17933If the word size is negative, binary operations produce 2's complement
17934integers from
17935@texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
17936@infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
17937to
17938@texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
17939@infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
17940inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
17941@expr{w} affects only the results produced.
17942
17943@kindex b c
17944@pindex calc-clip
17945@tindex clip
17946The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
17947[@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
17948@expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
17949their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
17950addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
17951generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
17952@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
17953bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
17954size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
17955
17956@kindex b w
17957@pindex calc-word-size
17958The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
17959rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
17960operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
17961top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
17962To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
17963This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
17964immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
17965
17966When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
17967optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
17968@samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
17969will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
17970@mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
17971in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
17972integer-valued floats.
17973
17974If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
17975power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
17976numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
17977consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
17978
17979@kindex b a
17980@pindex calc-and
17981@tindex and
17982The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
17983AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
17984of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
17985bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
17986@samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
17987
17988@kindex b o
17989@pindex calc-or
17990@tindex or
17991The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
17992inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
17993both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
17994
17995@kindex b x
17996@pindex calc-xor
17997@tindex xor
17998The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
17999exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
18000is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
18001
18002@kindex b d
18003@pindex calc-diff
18004@tindex diff
18005The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
18006difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
18007so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
18008
18009@kindex b n
18010@pindex calc-not
18011@tindex not
18012The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
18013NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
18014
18015@kindex b l
18016@pindex calc-lshift-binary
18017@tindex lsh
18018The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
18019number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18020prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
18021in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
18022is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
18023Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
18024
18025@kindex H b l
18026@kindex H b r
18027@ignore
18028@mindex @idots
18029@end ignore
18030@kindex H b L
18031@ignore
18032@mindex @null
18033@end ignore
18034@kindex H b R
18035@ignore
18036@mindex @null
18037@end ignore
18038@kindex H b t
18039The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
18040from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
18041bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
18042the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
18043has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
18044
18045@kindex b r
18046@pindex calc-rshift-binary
18047@tindex rsh
18048The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
18049number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18050prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
18051
18052@kindex b L
18053@pindex calc-lshift-arith
18054@tindex ash
18055The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
18056number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
18057is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
18058is performed as described below.
18059
18060@kindex b R
18061@pindex calc-rshift-arith
18062@tindex rash
18063The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
18064an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
18065to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
18066This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
18067as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
18068and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
18069size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
18070performs a standard left shift.
18071
18072@kindex b t
18073@pindex calc-rotate-binary
18074@tindex rot
18075The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
18076number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
18077word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
18078numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
18079or right.
18080
18081@xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
18082pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
18083unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
18084@samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
18085bits in a binary integer.
18086
18087Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
18088is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
18089unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
18090with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
18091into a binary integer.
18092
18093@node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
18094@chapter Scientific Functions
18095
18096@noindent
18097The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18098calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18099full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18100flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18101
18102@kindex P
18103@pindex calc-pi
18104@cindex @code{pi} variable
18105@vindex pi
18106@kindex H P
18107@cindex @code{e} variable
18108@vindex e
18109@kindex I P
18110@cindex @code{gamma} variable
18111@vindex gamma
18112@cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18113@cindex Euler's gamma constant
18114@kindex H I P
18115@cindex @code{phi} variable
18116@cindex Phi, golden ratio
18117@cindex Golden ratio
18118One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18119the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18120Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18121With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18122@texline @math{\gamma}
18123@infoline @expr{gamma}
18124(about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18125pushes the ``golden ratio''
18126@texline @math{\phi}
18127@infoline @expr{phi}
18128(about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18129to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18130In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18131actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18132respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18133
18134@ignore
18135@mindex Q
18136@end ignore
18137@ignore
18138@mindex I Q
18139@end ignore
18140@kindex I Q
18141@tindex sqr
18142The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18143@pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18144computes the square of the argument.
18145
18146@xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18147prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18148interpret a prefix argument.
18149
18150@menu
18151* Logarithmic Functions::
18152* Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18153* Advanced Math Functions::
18154* Branch Cuts::
18155* Random Numbers::
18156* Combinatorial Functions::
18157* Probability Distribution Functions::
18158@end menu
18159
18160@node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18161@section Logarithmic Functions
18162
18163@noindent
18164@kindex L
18165@pindex calc-ln
18166@tindex ln
18167@ignore
18168@mindex @null
18169@end ignore
18170@kindex I E
18171The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18172logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18173the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18174this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18175
18176@kindex E
18177@pindex calc-exp
18178@tindex exp
18179@ignore
18180@mindex @null
18181@end ignore
18182@kindex I L
18183The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18184exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18185The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18186the @code{calc-ln} command.
18187
18188@kindex H L
18189@kindex H E
18190@pindex calc-log10
18191@tindex log10
18192@tindex exp10
18193@ignore
18194@mindex @null
18195@end ignore
18196@kindex H I L
18197@ignore
18198@mindex @null
18199@end ignore
18200@kindex H I E
18201The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18202(base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18203it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18204complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18205by
18206@texline @math{\ln10}.
18207@infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18208
18209@kindex B
18210@kindex I B
18211@pindex calc-log
18212@tindex log
18213@tindex alog
18214The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18215to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18216@texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18217@infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18218In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18219will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18220mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18221similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18222
18223@kindex f I
18224@pindex calc-ilog
18225@tindex ilog
18226The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18227integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18228themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18229down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18230range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18231integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18232@samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18233
18234@kindex f E
18235@pindex calc-expm1
18236@tindex expm1
18237The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18238@texline @math{e^x - 1},
18239@infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18240but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18241answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18242@texline @math{e^x}
18243@infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18244is close to one.
18245
18246@kindex f L
18247@pindex calc-lnp1
18248@tindex lnp1
18249The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18250@texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18251@infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18252producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18253
18254@node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18255@section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18256
18257@noindent
18258@kindex S
18259@pindex calc-sin
18260@tindex sin
18261The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18262of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18263as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18264to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18265on complex numbers.
18266
18267Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18268@code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18269all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18270simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18271of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18272
18273Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18274arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18275the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command recognizes many such
18276formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18277mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18278@xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18279have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18280reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18281the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18282Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18283
18284The @kbd{a s} command knows all angles which are integer multiples of
18285@cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18286analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18287degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18288
18289@kindex I S
18290@pindex calc-arcsin
18291@tindex arcsin
18292With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18293available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18294function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18295notation depending on the current angular mode.
18296
18297@kindex H S
18298@pindex calc-sinh
18299@tindex sinh
18300@kindex H I S
18301@pindex calc-arcsinh
18302@tindex arcsinh
18303With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18304sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18305Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18306(@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18307
18308@kindex C
18309@pindex calc-cos
18310@tindex cos
18311@ignore
18312@mindex @idots
18313@end ignore
18314@kindex I C
18315@pindex calc-arccos
18316@ignore
18317@mindex @null
18318@end ignore
18319@tindex arccos
18320@ignore
18321@mindex @null
18322@end ignore
18323@kindex H C
18324@pindex calc-cosh
18325@ignore
18326@mindex @null
18327@end ignore
18328@tindex cosh
18329@ignore
18330@mindex @null
18331@end ignore
18332@kindex H I C
18333@pindex calc-arccosh
18334@ignore
18335@mindex @null
18336@end ignore
18337@tindex arccosh
18338@ignore
18339@mindex @null
18340@end ignore
18341@kindex T
18342@pindex calc-tan
18343@ignore
18344@mindex @null
18345@end ignore
18346@tindex tan
18347@ignore
18348@mindex @null
18349@end ignore
18350@kindex I T
18351@pindex calc-arctan
18352@ignore
18353@mindex @null
18354@end ignore
18355@tindex arctan
18356@ignore
18357@mindex @null
18358@end ignore
18359@kindex H T
18360@pindex calc-tanh
18361@ignore
18362@mindex @null
18363@end ignore
18364@tindex tanh
18365@ignore
18366@mindex @null
18367@end ignore
18368@kindex H I T
18369@pindex calc-arctanh
18370@ignore
18371@mindex @null
18372@end ignore
18373@tindex arctanh
18374The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18375of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18376computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18377variants of these functions.
18378
18379@kindex f T
18380@pindex calc-arctan2
18381@tindex arctan2
18382The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18383numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18384result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18385(inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18386result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18387value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18388since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18389components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18390which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18391@samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18392
18393@pindex calc-sincos
18394@ignore
18395@starindex
18396@end ignore
18397@tindex sincos
18398@ignore
18399@starindex
18400@end ignore
18401@ignore
18402@mindex arc@idots
18403@end ignore
18404@tindex arcsincos
18405The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18406cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18407@samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18408With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18409vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18410(This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18411
18412@pindex calc-sec
18413@tindex sec
18414@pindex calc-csc
18415@tindex csc
18416@pindex calc-cot
18417@tindex cot
18418@pindex calc-sech
18419@tindex sech
18420@pindex calc-csch
18421@tindex csch
18422@pindex calc-coth
18423@tindex coth
18424The remaining trigonometric functions, @code{calc-sec} [@code{sec}],
4bb49b43 18425@code{calc-csc} [@code{csc}] and @code{calc-cot} [@code{cot}], are also
4009494e
GM
18426available. With the Hyperbolic flag, these compute their hyperbolic
18427counterparts, which are also available separately as @code{calc-sech}
4bb49b43 18428[@code{sech}], @code{calc-csch} [@code{csch}] and @code{calc-coth}
9c264403 18429[@code{coth}]. (These commands do not accept the Inverse flag.)
4009494e
GM
18430
18431@node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18432@section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18433
18434@noindent
18435Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18436various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18437this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18438will work to arbitrarily large precisions. They can not at present
18439handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18440
18441NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18442accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18443current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18444using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18445slow for some values of the arguments.
18446
18447@kindex f g
18448@pindex calc-gamma
18449@tindex gamma
18450The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18451gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18452factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18453arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18454integral:
18455@texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18456@infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18457(The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18458
18459@kindex f G
18460@tindex gammaP
18461@ignore
18462@mindex @idots
18463@end ignore
18464@kindex I f G
18465@ignore
18466@mindex @null
18467@end ignore
18468@kindex H f G
18469@ignore
18470@mindex @null
18471@end ignore
18472@kindex H I f G
18473@pindex calc-inc-gamma
18474@ignore
18475@mindex @null
18476@end ignore
18477@tindex gammaQ
18478@ignore
18479@mindex @null
18480@end ignore
18481@tindex gammag
18482@ignore
18483@mindex @null
18484@end ignore
18485@tindex gammaG
18486The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18487the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18488the integral,
18489@texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18490@infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18491This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18492definition of the normal gamma function).
18493
18494Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18495The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18496some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18497You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18498@expr{x} to infinity.
18499
18500@ifnottex
18501The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18502and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18503factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18504(where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18505letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18506and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18507@end ifnottex
18508@tex
18509\turnoffactive
18510The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18511and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18512factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18513You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18514\kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18515@end tex
18516
18517@kindex f b
18518@pindex calc-beta
18519@tindex beta
18520The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18521Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18522@texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18523@infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18524or by
18525@texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18526@infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18527
18528@kindex f B
18529@kindex H f B
18530@pindex calc-inc-beta
18531@tindex betaI
18532@tindex betaB
18533The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18534the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18535@texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18536@infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18537Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18538un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18539
18540@kindex f e
18541@kindex I f e
18542@pindex calc-erf
18543@tindex erf
18544@tindex erfc
18545The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18546error function
18547@texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18548@infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18549The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18550is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18551@texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18552@infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18553
18554@kindex f j
18555@kindex f y
18556@pindex calc-bessel-J
18557@pindex calc-bessel-Y
18558@tindex besJ
18559@tindex besY
18560The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18561(@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18562functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18563In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18564@expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18565Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18566precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18567Use with care!
18568
18569@node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18570@section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18571
18572@noindent
18573@cindex Branch cuts
18574@cindex Principal values
18575All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18576defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18577This section describes the values
18578returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18579Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18580second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18581function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18582diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18583
18584Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
5a83c46e
JB
18585changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Recent
18586versions of Calc follow the second edition.
4009494e
GM
18587
18588The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18589They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18590@code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18591and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18592Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18593or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18594
18595Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18596are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18597efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18598and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18599
18600For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18601or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18602negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18603in the right half of the complex plane.
18604
18605For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18606The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18607Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18608negative real axis.
18609
18610The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18611If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18612the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18613Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18614occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18615
18616@smallexample
18617 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18618----------------------------------------
18619 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18620 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18621 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18622 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18623@end smallexample
18624
18625For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18626One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18627not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18628number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18629of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18630less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18631
18632For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18633The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18634
18635For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18636or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18637the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18638
18639For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18640@samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18641imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18642
18643For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18644The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18645above @expr{i}.
18646
18647For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18648@samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18649real axis less than 1.
18650
18651For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18652The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18653
18654The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18655@code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18656hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18657
18658@smallexample
18659 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18660-------------------------------------------------------
18661 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18662 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18663 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18664 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18665 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18666 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18667 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18668 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18669 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18670@end smallexample
18671
18672@smallexample
18673 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18674-----------------------------------------------------
18675 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18676 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18677 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18678 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18679 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18680 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18681 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18682 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18683 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18684@end smallexample
18685
18686@smallexample
18687 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18688-----------------------------------------------------
18689 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18690 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18691 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18692 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18693 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18694 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18695 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18696@end smallexample
18697
18698Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18699between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18700are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18701
18702@smallexample
18703sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18704cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18705tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18706sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18707@end smallexample
18708
18709The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18710for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18711are not rigorously specified at present.
18712
18713@node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18714@section Random Numbers
18715
18716@noindent
18717@kindex k r
18718@pindex calc-random
18719@tindex random
18720The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18721random numbers of various sorts.
18722
18723Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18724integer @expr{N} in the range
18725@texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18726@infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
f10d0e80 18727Each possible value @expr{N} appears with equal probability.
4009494e
GM
18728
18729With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18730from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18731the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18732while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18733taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18734the result is a random integer in the range
18735@texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18736@infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18737
18738If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18739is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18740@texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18741@infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18742or
18743@texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18744@infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18745according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18746
18747If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18748number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18749of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18750every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18751
18752If @expr{M} is an error form
18753@texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18754@infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18755where @var{m} and
18756@texline @math{\sigma}
18757@infoline @var{s}
18758are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18759@var{m} and standard deviation
18760@texline @math{\sigma}.
18761@infoline @var{s}.
18762
18763If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18764acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18765the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18766is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18767range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18768not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18769intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18770with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18771million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18772additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18773extremely small.)
18774
18775If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18776the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18777
18778@vindex RandSeed
18779The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18780default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18781the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18782sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18783@code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18784to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18785@code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18786sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18787from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18788before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18789of random numbers as before.
18790
18791@pindex calc-rrandom
18792The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18793number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18794
18795@kindex k a
18796@pindex calc-random-again
18797The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18798number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18799prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18800that value of @expr{M}.
18801
18802@kindex k h
18803@pindex calc-shuffle
18804@tindex shuffle
18805The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18806random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18807specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18808of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18809gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18810prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18811stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18812
18813If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18814that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18815there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18816@kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18817of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18818a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18819number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18820elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18821If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18822than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18823each make it into the result vector.)
18824
18825One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18826if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18827@kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18828@samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18829@var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18830by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18831a small discrete set of possibilities.
18832
18833To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
18834given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
18835prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
18836@kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
18837elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
18838
18839@menu
18840* Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
18841@end menu
18842
18843@node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
18844@subsection Random Number Generator
18845
18846Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
18847the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
18848Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
18849of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
18850characterization.
18851
18852If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs' built-in
18853@code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
18854then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
18855random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
18856
18857When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
18858the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
18859random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
18860
18861Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
18862returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
18863several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
18864the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
18865near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
18866four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
18867bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
18868generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
18869
18870If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
18871seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
18872computing
18873@texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
18874@infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
18875This method expands the seed
18876value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
18877@code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
18878to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
18879@code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
18880continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
18881way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
18882so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
18883from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
18884same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
18885@kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
18886to reseed the generator with that number.
18887
18888Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
18889of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
18890to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
18891index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
18892random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
18893obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
18894the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
18895supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
18896generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
18897provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
18898damage its randomness.
18899
18900To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
18901builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
18902of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
18903(which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
18904or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
18905value.
18906
18907To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
18908simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
18909@texline @math{10^{-p}}.
18910@infoline @expr{10^-p}.
18911The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
18912that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
18913In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
18914numbers on the order of
18915@texline @math{10^{-9}}
18916@infoline @expr{10^-9}
18917or
18918@texline @math{10^{-10}},
18919@infoline @expr{10^-10},
18920but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
18921correspond to small integers times
18922@texline @math{10^{-12}}.
18923@infoline @expr{10^-12}.
18924
18925To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
18926counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
18927additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
18928power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
18929the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
18930if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
18931modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
18932numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
18933modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
18934ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
18935
18936The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
18937``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C. This method
18938generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
18939other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
18940
18941@node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
18942@section Combinatorial Functions
18943
18944@noindent
18945Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
18946@kbd{k} key prefix.
18947
18948@kindex k g
18949@pindex calc-gcd
18950@tindex gcd
18951The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
18952Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
18953the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
18954numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
18955consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
18956integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
18957the operation is left in symbolic form.
18958
18959@kindex k l
18960@pindex calc-lcm
18961@tindex lcm
18962The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
18963Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
18964the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
18965numbers.
18966
18967@kindex k E
18968@pindex calc-extended-gcd
18969@tindex egcd
18970The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
18971the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
18972@expr{[g, a, b]} where
18973@texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
18974@infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
18975
18976@kindex !
18977@pindex calc-factorial
18978@tindex fact
18979@ignore
18980@mindex @null
18981@end ignore
18982@tindex !
18983The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
18984factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
18985integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
18986integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
18987the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
18988as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
18989large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
18990since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
18991the commands in this section.
18992
18993@kindex k d
18994@pindex calc-double-factorial
18995@tindex dfact
18996@ignore
18997@mindex @null
18998@end ignore
18999@tindex !!
19000The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
19001computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
19002this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
19003integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
19004the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
19005approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
19006The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
19007
19008@kindex k c
19009@pindex calc-choose
19010@tindex choose
19011The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
19012binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
19013on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
19014are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
19015floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
19016real numbers by
19017@texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
19018@infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
19019
19020@kindex H k c
19021@pindex calc-perm
19022@tindex perm
19023@ifnottex
19024The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
19025number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
19026@end ifnottex
19027@tex
19028The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
19029number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
19030@end tex
19031
19032@kindex k b
19033@kindex H k b
19034@pindex calc-bernoulli-number
19035@tindex bern
19036The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
19037computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
19038is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
19039is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
19040taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
19041top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
19042a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
19043
19044@kindex k e
19045@kindex H k e
19046@pindex calc-euler-number
19047@tindex euler
19048The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
19049computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
19050Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
19051functions.
19052
19053@kindex k s
19054@kindex H k s
19055@pindex calc-stirling-number
19056@tindex stir1
19057@tindex stir2
19058The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
19059computes a Stirling number of the first
19060@texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
19061@infoline kind,
19062given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
19063[@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
19064@texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
19065@infoline kind.
19066These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
19067and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
19068non-empty sets, respectively.
19069
19070@kindex k p
19071@pindex calc-prime-test
19072@cindex Primes
19073The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
19074the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
19075answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
19076probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
19077The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
19078any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
19079discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
19080certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
19081a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
19082(Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
19083even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
19084the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
19085or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
19086
19087@ignore
19088@starindex
19089@end ignore
19090@tindex prime
19091The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
19092test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
19093additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
19094the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
19095@samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
19096is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19097
19098@kindex k f
19099@pindex calc-prime-factors
19100@tindex prfac
19101The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19102attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19103to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19104result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19105inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19106last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19107million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19108element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19109@mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19110
19111@kindex k n
19112@pindex calc-next-prime
19113@ignore
19114@mindex nextpr@idots
19115@end ignore
19116@tindex nextprime
19117The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19118the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19119@code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19120passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19121but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19122slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19123of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19124the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19125matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19126@kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19127prime.
19128
19129@kindex I k n
19130@pindex calc-prev-prime
19131@ignore
19132@mindex prevpr@idots
19133@end ignore
19134@tindex prevprime
19135The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19136analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19137
19138@kindex k t
19139@pindex calc-totient
19140@tindex totient
19141The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19142Euler ``totient''
19143@texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19144@infoline function,
19145the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19146are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19147
19148@kindex k m
19149@pindex calc-moebius
19150@tindex moebius
19151The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19152@texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19153@infoline Moebius ``mu''
19154function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19155distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19156duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19157the result is zero.
19158
19159@node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19160@section Probability Distribution Functions
19161
19162@noindent
19163The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19164For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19165density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19166tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19167tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19168For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19169from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19170from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19171
19172To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19173function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19174Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19175lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19176(``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19177or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19178
19179@kindex k B
19180@kindex I k B
19181@pindex calc-utpb
19182@tindex utpb
19183@tindex ltpb
19184The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19185binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19186then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19187probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19188of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19189trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19190the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19191
19192The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19193form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19194and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19195@var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19196the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19197distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19198order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19199arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19200the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19201k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19202recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19203
19204@kindex k C
19205@pindex calc-utpc
19206@tindex utpc
19207@ignore
19208@mindex @idots
19209@end ignore
19210@kindex I k C
19211@ignore
19212@mindex @null
19213@end ignore
19214@tindex ltpc
19215The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19216@texline @math{\nu}
19217@infoline @expr{v}
19218degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19219correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19220
19221@kindex k F
19222@pindex calc-utpf
19223@tindex utpf
19224@ignore
19225@mindex @idots
19226@end ignore
19227@kindex I k F
19228@ignore
19229@mindex @null
19230@end ignore
19231@tindex ltpf
19232The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19233various statistical tests. The parameters
19234@texline @math{\nu_1}
19235@infoline @expr{v1}
19236and
19237@texline @math{\nu_2}
19238@infoline @expr{v2}
19239are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19240respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19241
19242@kindex k N
19243@pindex calc-utpn
19244@tindex utpn
19245@ignore
19246@mindex @idots
19247@end ignore
19248@kindex I k N
19249@ignore
19250@mindex @null
19251@end ignore
19252@tindex ltpn
19253The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19254with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19255@texline @math{\sigma}.
19256@infoline @expr{s}.
19257It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19258would exceed @expr{x}.
19259
19260@kindex k P
19261@pindex calc-utpp
19262@tindex utpp
19263@ignore
19264@mindex @idots
19265@end ignore
19266@kindex I k P
19267@ignore
19268@mindex @null
19269@end ignore
19270@tindex ltpp
19271The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19272mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19273Poisson random events will occur.
19274
19275@kindex k T
19276@pindex calc-ltpt
19277@tindex utpt
19278@ignore
19279@mindex @idots
19280@end ignore
19281@kindex I k T
19282@ignore
19283@mindex @null
19284@end ignore
19285@tindex ltpt
19286The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19287with
19288@texline @math{\nu}
19289@infoline @expr{v}
19290degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19291t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19292(Note: This computes the distribution function
19293@texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19294@infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19295where
19296@texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19297@infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19298and
19299@texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19300@infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19301The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19302returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19303
19304While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19305functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19306Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19307to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19308@xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19309
19310@node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19311@chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19312
19313@noindent
19314Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19315(For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19316The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19317apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19318has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19319
19320Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19321Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19322(Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19323three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19324vector of matrices, and so on.)
19325
19326@menu
19327* Packing and Unpacking::
19328* Building Vectors::
19329* Extracting Elements::
19330* Manipulating Vectors::
19331* Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19332* Set Operations::
19333* Statistical Operations::
19334* Reducing and Mapping::
19335* Vector and Matrix Formats::
19336@end menu
19337
19338@node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19339@section Packing and Unpacking
19340
19341@noindent
19342Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19343composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19344described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19345vectors.
19346
19347@kindex v p
19348@pindex calc-pack
19349The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19350elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19351form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19352object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19353If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19354length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19355five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19356elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19357
19358The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19359vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19360the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19361then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19362
19363Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19364
19365@table @cite
19366@item -1
19367Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19368@kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19369@expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19370number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19371i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19372will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19373other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19374components are not suitable.)
19375
19376@item -2
19377Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19378The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19379in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19380mode.
19381
19382@item -3
19383Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19384two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19385integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19386number.
19387
19388@item -4
19389Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19390may be real numbers or formulas.
19391
19392@item -5
19393Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19394must be real numbers.
19395
19396@item -6
19397Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19398The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19399
19400@item -7
19401Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19402
19403@item -8
19404Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19405
19406@item -9
19407Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19408
19409@item -10
19410Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19411
19412@item -11
19413Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19414The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19415integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19416times ten to the power of the exponent.
19417
19418@item -12
19419This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19420When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19421is desired.
19422
19423@item -13
19424A real number is converted into a date form.
19425
19426@item -14
19427Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19428
19429@item -15
19430Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19431@end table
19432
19433With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19434of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19435length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19436elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19437other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19438element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19439could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19440into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19441a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19442numbers modulo @var{M}.
19443
19444If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19445the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19446be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19447@kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19448enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19449
19450If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19451matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19452which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19453@samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19454returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19455
19456If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19457packing are done at that level as described above. For
19458example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19459@texline @math{2\times3}
19460@infoline 2x3
19461matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19462Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19463error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19464
19465@ignore
19466@starindex
19467@end ignore
19468@tindex pack
19469There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19470@samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19471packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19472is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19473to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19474yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19475left in symbolic form if the packing mode is invalid, or if the
19476number of data items does not match the number of items required
19477by the mode.
19478
19479@kindex v u
19480@pindex calc-unpack
19481The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19482number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19483``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19484objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19485at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19486each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19487
19488You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19489to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19490negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19491will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19492For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19493the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19494@samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19495
19496Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19497not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19498@kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19499when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19500and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19501and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19502number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19503is not a composite object.
19504
19505Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19506an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19507(except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19508Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19509and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19510is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19511the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19512to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19513
19514Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19515A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19516except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19517a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19518Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19519original object.
19520
19521A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19522re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19523to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19524unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19525
19526@ignore
19527@starindex
19528@end ignore
19529@tindex unpack
19530There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19531The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19532@var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19533a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19534integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19535returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19536
19537@ignore
19538@starindex
19539@end ignore
19540@tindex unpackt
19541The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19542of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19543two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19544@samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19545and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19546The identity for re-building the original object is
19547@samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19548@code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19549name and a vector of arguments.)
19550
19551@cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19552Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19553of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19554number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19555
19556@node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19557@section Building Vectors
19558
19559@noindent
19560Vectors and matrices can be added,
19561subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19562
19563@kindex |
19564@pindex calc-concat
19565@ignore
19566@mindex @null
19567@end ignore
19568@tindex |
19569The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) [@code{vconcat}] command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19570into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19571will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19572are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19573rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19574of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19575
19576If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19577like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19578produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19579matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19580one-row matrix.
19581
19582@kindex H |
19583@tindex append
19584The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19585two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19586Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19587argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19588See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19589
19590@kindex I |
19591@kindex H I |
19592The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19593two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19594to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19595
19596@kindex v d
19597@pindex calc-diag
19598@tindex diag
19599The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19600square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19601and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19602vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19603prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19604the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19605the prefix argument is required.
19606
19607To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19608@texline @math{3\times3}
19609@infoline 3x3
19610matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19611matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19612alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19613
19614@kindex v i
19615@pindex calc-ident
19616@tindex idn
19617The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19618matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19619where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19620this command prompts for one.
19621
19622In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19623except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19624If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19625identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19626such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19627whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19628matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19629argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19630Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19631identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19632dimensions.
19633
19634@kindex v x
19635@pindex calc-index
19636@tindex index
19637The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19638of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19639prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19640prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19641is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19642
19643With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19644three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19645@var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19646by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19647is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19648floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19649of numbers or formulas.
19650
19651When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19652different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19653sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19654@samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19655@samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19656is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19657
19658@kindex v b
19659@pindex calc-build-vector
19660@tindex cvec
19661The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19662vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19663is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19664can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19665(Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19666to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19667
19668@kindex v h
19669@kindex I v h
19670@pindex calc-head
19671@pindex calc-tail
19672@tindex head
19673@tindex tail
19674The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19675element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19676function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19677cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19678
19679@kindex v k
19680@pindex calc-cons
19681@tindex cons
19682The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19683and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19684@var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19685if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19686whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19687
19688@kindex H v h
19689@tindex rhead
19690@ignore
19691@mindex @idots
19692@end ignore
19693@kindex H I v h
19694@ignore
19695@mindex @null
19696@end ignore
19697@kindex H v k
19698@ignore
19699@mindex @null
19700@end ignore
19701@tindex rtail
19702@ignore
19703@mindex @null
19704@end ignore
19705@tindex rcons
19706Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19707@code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19708the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19709representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19710@samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19711Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19712@samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19713
19714@node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19715@section Extracting Vector Elements
19716
19717@noindent
19718@kindex v r
19719@pindex calc-mrow
19720@tindex mrow
19721The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19722the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19723the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19724prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19725The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19726form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19727
19728@cindex Permutations, applying
19729With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19730the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19731from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19732integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19733input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19734This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19735
19736With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19737it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19738submatrix is returned.
19739
19740@cindex Subscript notation
19741@kindex a _
19742@pindex calc-subscript
19743@tindex subscr
19744@tindex _
19745Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19746Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19747Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19748@expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19749(@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19750access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19751The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19752formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19753``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19754purely as an algebraic notation.)
19755
19756@tindex mrrow
19757Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19758element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19759@kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19760replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19761In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19762
19763@tindex getdiag
19764Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19765of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19766function is called @code{getdiag}.
19767
19768@kindex v c
19769@pindex calc-mcol
19770@tindex mcol
19771@tindex mrcol
19772The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19773the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19774it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19775index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19776matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19777retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19778
19779To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19780extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19781from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19782use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19783of matrix @expr{m}.
19784
19785@kindex v s
19786@pindex calc-subvector
19787@tindex subvec
19788The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19789a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19790index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19791position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19792to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19793range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19794the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19795@samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19796
19797If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19798interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19799@samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19800the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19801is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19802end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19803has this effect when used as the ending index.
19804
19805@kindex I v s
19806@tindex rsubvec
19807With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19808from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19809normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19810produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19811@code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19812
19813@xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19814vectors one element at a time.
19815
19816@node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
19817@section Manipulating Vectors
19818
19819@noindent
19820@kindex v l
19821@pindex calc-vlength
19822@tindex vlen
19823The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
19824length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
19825Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
19826command.
19827
19828@kindex H v l
19829@tindex mdims
19830With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
19831of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
19832example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
19833its argument is a
19834@texline @math{2\times3}
19835@infoline 2x3
19836matrix.
19837
19838@kindex v f
19839@pindex calc-vector-find
19840@tindex find
19841The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
19842along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
19843is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
19844If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
19845Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
19846allows you to select any starting index for the search.
19847
19848@kindex v a
19849@pindex calc-arrange-vector
19850@tindex arrange
19851@cindex Arranging a matrix
19852@cindex Reshaping a matrix
19853@cindex Flattening a matrix
19854The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
19855rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
19856numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
19857provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
19858The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
19859plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
19860then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
19861If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
19862in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
19863suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
19864@samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
19865@samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
19866@texline @math{1\times4}
19867@infoline 1x4
19868matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
19869@texline @math{4\times1}
19870@infoline 4x1
19871matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
19872@texline @math{2\times2}
19873@infoline 2x2
19874matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
19875matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
19876@samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
19877
19878@cindex Sorting data
19879@kindex V S
19880@kindex I V S
19881@pindex calc-sort
19882@tindex sort
19883@tindex rsort
19884The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
19885a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
19886constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
19887kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
19888come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
19889to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
19890one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
19891unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
19892are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
19893(@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
19894alphabetical order by this command.
19895
19896The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
19897
19898@cindex Permutation, inverse of
19899@cindex Inverse of permutation
19900@cindex Index tables
19901@cindex Rank tables
19902@kindex V G
19903@kindex I V G
19904@pindex calc-grade
19905@tindex grade
19906@tindex rgrade
19907The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
19908produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
19909input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
19910A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
19911each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
19912matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
19913grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
19914with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
19915is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
19916be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
19917a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
19918vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
19919table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
19920
19921With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
19922sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
19923use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
19924will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
19925to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
19926but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
19927example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
19928you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
19929are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
19930by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
19931phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
19932
19933@cindex Histograms
19934@kindex V H
19935@pindex calc-histogram
19936@ignore
19937@mindex histo@idots
19938@end ignore
19939@tindex histogram
19940The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
19941histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
19942integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
19943bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
19944command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
19945each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
19946are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
19947range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
19948that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
19949input vector.)
19950
19951@kindex H V H
19952With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
19953The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
19954vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
19955of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
19956the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
19957vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
19958
19959@kindex v t
19960@pindex calc-transpose
19961@tindex trn
19962The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
19963the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
19964is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
19965a one-column matrix.
19966
19967@kindex v v
19968@pindex calc-reverse-vector
19969@tindex rev
19970The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{rev}] command reverses
19971a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
19972(To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
19973principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
19974a matrix.)
19975
19976@kindex v m
19977@pindex calc-mask-vector
19978@tindex vmask
19979The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
19980one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
19981is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
19982the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
19983the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
19984to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
19985@samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
19986@xref{Logical Operations}.
19987
19988@kindex v e
19989@pindex calc-expand-vector
19990@tindex vexp
19991The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
19992expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
19993vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
19994by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
19995vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
19996target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
19997vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
19998unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
19999produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
20000
20001@kindex H v e
20002With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
20003top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
20004second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
20005zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
20006@samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
20007then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
20008interleave two vectors according to the mask:
20009@samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
20010@samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
20011
20012Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
20013with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
20014You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
20015operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
20016the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
20017masking using vectors.
20018
20019@node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
20020@section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
20021
20022@noindent
20023Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
20024for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
20025the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
20026matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
20027@xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
20028
20029The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
20030vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
20031@code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
20032@code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
20033
20034@kindex V J
20035@pindex calc-conj-transpose
20036@tindex ctrn
20037The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
20038the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
20039
20040@ignore
20041@mindex A
20042@end ignore
20043@kindex A (vectors)
20044@pindex calc-abs (vectors)
20045@ignore
20046@mindex abs
20047@end ignore
20048@tindex abs (vectors)
20049The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
20050Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
20051root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
20052elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
20053a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
20054from that point to the origin.
20055
20056@kindex v n
20057@pindex calc-rnorm
20058@tindex rnorm
a8b14149
JB
20059The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes the
20060infinity-norm of a vector, or the row norm of a matrix. For a plain
20061vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements. For
20062a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums, i.e., of
20063the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the various rows.
4009494e
GM
20064
20065@kindex V N
20066@pindex calc-cnorm
20067@tindex cnorm
20068The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
a8b14149 20069the one-norm of a vector, or column norm of a matrix. For a plain
4009494e
GM
20070vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
20071For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
20072General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
a8b14149
JB
20073not provided. However, the 2-norm (or Frobenius norm) is provided for
20074vectors by the @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) command.
4009494e
GM
20075
20076@kindex V C
20077@pindex calc-cross
20078@tindex cross
20079The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
20080right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
20081exactly three elements.
20082
20083@ignore
20084@mindex &
20085@end ignore
20086@kindex & (matrices)
20087@pindex calc-inv (matrices)
20088@ignore
20089@mindex inv
20090@end ignore
20091@tindex inv (matrices)
20092The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
20093inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
20094operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
20095that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
20096computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20097quickly in the future.
20098
20099If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20100command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20101@samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20102by a matrix.
20103
20104@kindex V D
20105@pindex calc-mdet
20106@tindex det
20107The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20108determinant of a square matrix.
20109
20110@kindex V L
20111@pindex calc-mlud
20112@tindex lud
20113The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20114LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20115which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20116The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20117algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20118and the third is upper-triangular.
20119
20120@kindex V T
20121@pindex calc-mtrace
20122@tindex tr
20123The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20124trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20125elements of the matrix.
20126
629f618d
JB
20127@kindex V K
20128@pindex calc-kron
20129@tindex kron
20130The @kbd{V K} (@code{calc-kron}) [@code{kron}] command computes
20131the Kronecker product of two matrices.
20132
4009494e
GM
20133@node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20134@section Set Operations using Vectors
20135
20136@noindent
20137@cindex Sets, as vectors
20138Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20139objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20140only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20141sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20142such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20143equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20144the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20145are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20146attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20147from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20148the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20149expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20150
20151If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20152real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20153of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20154numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20155there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20156all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20157
20158If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20159@var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20160The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20161single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20162
20163@xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20164a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20165is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20166
20167@kindex V +
20168@pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20169@tindex rdup
20170The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20171converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20172the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20173@kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20174reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20175necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20176other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20177them.
20178
20179@kindex V V
20180@pindex calc-set-union
20181@tindex vunion
20182The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20183the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20184only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20185accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20186then using @kbd{V +}.)
20187
20188@kindex V ^
20189@pindex calc-set-intersect
20190@tindex vint
20191The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20192the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20193and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20194sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20195will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20196and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20197notation for set
20198@texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20199@infoline union
20200and
20201@texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20202@infoline intersection.
20203
20204@kindex V -
20205@pindex calc-set-difference
20206@tindex vdiff
20207The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20208the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20209@expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20210Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20211@samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20212as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20213all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20214Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20215your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20216enough to express in a few intervals).
20217
20218@kindex V X
20219@pindex calc-set-xor
20220@tindex vxor
20221The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20222the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20223An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20224if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20225occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20226
20227@kindex V ~
20228@pindex calc-set-complement
20229@tindex vcompl
20230The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20231computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20232Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20233For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20234@samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20235
20236@kindex V F
20237@pindex calc-set-floor
20238@tindex vfloor
20239The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20240reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20241and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20242intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20243integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20244complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20245the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20246@kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20247
20248@kindex V E
20249@pindex calc-set-enumerate
20250@tindex venum
20251The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20252converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20253the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20254the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20255do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20256
20257@kindex V :
20258@pindex calc-set-span
20259@tindex vspan
20260The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20261set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20262The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20263limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20264returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20265
20266@kindex V #
20267@pindex calc-set-cardinality
20268@tindex vcard
20269The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20270the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20271that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20272more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20273
20274@cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20275Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20276cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20277in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20278particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20279@xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20280binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20281direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20282@kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20283@kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20284respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20285convenient to you.
20286
20287@kindex b p
20288@kindex b u
20289@pindex calc-pack-bits
20290@pindex calc-unpack-bits
20291@tindex vpack
20292@tindex vunpack
20293The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20294converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20295in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20296returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20297it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20298Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20299values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20300(binary) prefix key.
20301
20302The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20303converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20304a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20305the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20306not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20307set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20308that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20309representation
20310@texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20311@infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20312
20313@node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20314@section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20315
20316@noindent
20317@cindex Statistical functions
20318The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20319various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20320references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20321@emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20322and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20323Vetterling.
20324
20325The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20326a shifted letter or other character.
20327
20328@xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20329(@code{calc-histogram}).
20330
20331@xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20332least-squares fits to statistical data.
20333
20334@xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20335probability distribution functions.
20336
20337@menu
20338* Single-Variable Statistics::
20339* Paired-Sample Statistics::
20340@end menu
20341
20342@node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20343@subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20344
20345@noindent
20346These functions do various statistical computations on single
20347vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20348@var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20349vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20350vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20351@kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20352is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20353
20354If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20355variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20356has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20357the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20358
20359These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20360are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20361a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20362arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20363of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20364not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20365error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20366
20367Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20368or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20369normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20370by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20371the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20372particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20373distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20374An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20375distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20376@samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20377
20378@kindex u #
20379@pindex calc-vector-count
20380@tindex vcount
20381The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20382computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20383For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20384If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20385simply computes the length of the vector.
20386
20387@kindex u +
20388@kindex u *
20389@pindex calc-vector-sum
20390@pindex calc-vector-prod
20391@tindex vsum
20392@tindex vprod
20393@cindex Summations (statistical)
20394The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20395computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20396(@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20397product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20398these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20399(@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20400
20401@kindex u X
20402@kindex u N
20403@pindex calc-vector-max
20404@pindex calc-vector-min
20405@tindex vmax
20406@tindex vmin
20407The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20408computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20409(@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20410If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20411value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20412described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20413plus or minus infinity.
20414
20415@kindex u M
20416@pindex calc-vector-mean
20417@tindex vmean
20418@cindex Mean of data values
20419The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20420computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20421If the inputs are error forms
20422@texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20423@infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20424this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20425@texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20426@infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20427@tex
20428\turnoffactive
20429$$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20430 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20431@end tex
20432If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20433values divided by the count of the values.
20434
20435Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20436error
20437@texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20438@infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20439If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20440plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20441plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20442above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20443has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20444weight is completely negligible.)
20445
20446This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20447intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @tfn{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20448@expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20449and maximum values of the interval.
20450
20451@kindex I u M
20452@pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20453@tindex vmeane
20454The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20455command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20456error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20457the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20458root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20459of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20460sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20461@tex
20462\turnoffactive
20463$$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20464@end tex
20465If the inputs are plain
20466numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20467divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20468out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20469then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20470deviation.)
20471@tex
20472\turnoffactive
20473$$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20474@end tex
20475
20476@kindex H u M
20477@pindex calc-vector-median
20478@tindex vmedian
20479@cindex Median of data values
20480The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20481command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20482first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20483value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20484the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20485The median function is different from the other functions in
20486this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20487variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20488(Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20489any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20490ignored.
20491
20492The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20493(error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20494the same as the mean.
20495
20496@kindex H I u M
20497@pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20498@tindex vhmean
20499@cindex Harmonic mean
20500The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20501command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20502defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20503of the values.
20504@tex
20505\turnoffactive
20506$$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20507@end tex
20508
20509@kindex u G
20510@pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20511@tindex vgmean
20512@cindex Geometric mean
20513The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20514command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20515is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20516equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20517of the data values.
20518@tex
20519\turnoffactive
20520$$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20521 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20522@end tex
20523
20524@kindex H u G
20525@tindex agmean
20526The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20527mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20528replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20529mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20530@tex
20531\turnoffactive
20532$$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20533@end tex
20534
20535@cindex Root-mean-square
20536Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20537for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20538
20539@kindex u S
20540@pindex calc-vector-sdev
20541@tindex vsdev
20542@cindex Standard deviation
20543@cindex Sample statistics
20544The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20545computes the standard
20546@texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20547@infoline deviation
20548of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20549as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20550deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20551the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20552divided by @expr{N-1}.
20553@tex
20554\turnoffactive
20555$$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20556@end tex
20557
20558This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20559of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20560of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20561limits, divided by
20562@texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20563@infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20564The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20565standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20566
20567@kindex I u S
20568@pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20569@tindex vpsdev
20570@cindex Population statistics
20571The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20572command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20573It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20574by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20575deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20576data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20577is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20578data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20579only an estimate of the true mean.
20580@tex
20581\turnoffactive
20582$$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20583@end tex
20584
20585For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20586exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20587population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20588
20589@kindex H u S
20590@kindex H I u S
20591@pindex calc-vector-variance
20592@pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20593@tindex vvar
20594@tindex vpvar
20595@cindex Variance of data values
20596The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20597@kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20598commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20599is the
20600@texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20601@infoline square
20602of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20603squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20604(This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20605
20606@ignore
20607@starindex
20608@end ignore
20609@tindex vflat
20610The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20611arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20612in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20613returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20614
20615@node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20616@subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20617
20618@noindent
20619The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20620vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20621way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20622prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20623the stack, which must be an
20624@texline @math{N\times2}
20625@infoline Nx2
20626matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20627of actual vectors and matrices.
20628
20629@kindex u C
20630@pindex calc-vector-covariance
20631@tindex vcov
20632@cindex Covariance
20633The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20634computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20635of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20636differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20637times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20638and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20639the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20640with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20641errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20642are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20643is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20644input errors.
20645@tex
20646\turnoffactive
20647$$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20648$$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20649 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20650 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20651 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20652$$
20653@end tex
20654
20655@kindex I u C
20656@pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20657@tindex vpcov
20658The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20659command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20660sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20661instead of @expr{N-1}.
20662
20663@kindex H u C
20664@pindex calc-vector-correlation
20665@tindex vcorr
20666@cindex Correlation coefficient
20667@cindex Linear correlation
20668The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20669command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20670This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20671product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20672between sample or population statistics here.)
20673@tex
20674\turnoffactive
20675$$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20676@end tex
20677
20678@node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20679@section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20680
20681@noindent
20682The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20683elements of vectors.
20684
20685@kindex V A
20686@pindex calc-apply
20687@tindex apply
20688The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20689[@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20690For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20691@w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20692Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20693@samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20694error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20695
20696While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20697@kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20698
20699@menu
20700* Specifying Operators::
20701* Mapping::
20702* Reducing::
20703* Nesting and Fixed Points::
20704* Generalized Products::
20705@end menu
20706
20707@node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20708@subsection Specifying Operators
20709
20710@noindent
20711Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20712corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20713list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20714sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20715the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20716uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20717expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20718element as its argument.)
20719
20720You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20721function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20722have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20723Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20724defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20725Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20726can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20727is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20728the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20729@kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20730looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20731if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20732the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20733if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20734type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20735
20736It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20737formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20738@kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20739You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20740list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20741order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20742The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20743this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20744be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20745way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20746
20747Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20748@kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20749has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20750automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20751may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20752entry interacts with the stack.)
20753
20754If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20755the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20756instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20757then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20758prompted for an argument list.
20759
20760@cindex Nameless functions
20761@cindex Generic functions
20762A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20763which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20764argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20765are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20766placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20767colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20768Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20769to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20770Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20771cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20772can get it back later if you wish.
20773
20774If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20775(Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20776that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20777@samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
20778begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
20779
20780You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
20781the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
20782argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
20783argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
20784omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
20785so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
20786which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
20787
20788@cindex Lambda expressions
20789@ignore
20790@starindex
20791@end ignore
20792@tindex lambda
20793The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
20794(The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
20795functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
20796ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
20797@code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
20798used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
20799to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
20800
20801(Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
20802are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
20803will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
20804called.)
20805
20806@tindex add
20807@tindex sub
20808@ignore
20809@mindex @idots
20810@end ignore
20811@tindex mul
20812@ignore
20813@mindex @null
20814@end ignore
20815@tindex div
20816@ignore
20817@mindex @null
20818@end ignore
20819@tindex pow
20820@ignore
20821@mindex @null
20822@end ignore
20823@tindex neg
20824@ignore
20825@mindex @null
20826@end ignore
20827@tindex mod
20828@ignore
20829@mindex @null
20830@end ignore
20831@tindex vconcat
20832As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
20833For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
20834@samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
20835and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
20836or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
20837written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
20838@code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
20839@code{vconcat}.
20840
20841@ignore
20842@starindex
20843@end ignore
20844@tindex call
20845The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
20846@samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
20847in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
20848like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
20849function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
20850as @samp{x + 2y}).
20851
20852(Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
20853a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
20854@code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
20855automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
20856about it.)
20857
20858@node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
20859@subsection Mapping
20860
20861@noindent
20862@kindex V M
20863@pindex calc-map
20864@tindex map
20865The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
20866operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
20867@code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
20868elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
20869the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
20870pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
20871is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
20872@kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
20873With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
20874two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
20875stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
20876be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
20877
20878If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
20879across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
20880@expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
20881produce another
20882@texline @math{3\times2}
20883@infoline 3x2
20884matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
20885
20886@tindex mapr
20887The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
20888operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
20889the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
20890a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
20891namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
20892defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
20893Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
20894@kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
20895of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
20896
20897Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
20898happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
20899want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
20900their individual elements.
20901
20902@tindex mapc
20903The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
20904transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
20905matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
20906values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
20907and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
20908@expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
20909
20910(The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
20911and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
20912operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
20913to type after @kbd{V M}.)
20914
20915The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
20916not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
20917effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
20918plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
20919matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
20920a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
20921
20922If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
20923rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
20924arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
20925column.
20926
20927Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
20928to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
20929to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
20930row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
20931@kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
20932otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
20933you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
20934a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
20935@kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
20936mapped over the elements of each row.)
20937
20938@tindex mapa
20939@tindex mapd
20940Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
20941that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
20942@kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
20943functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
20944Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
20945set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
20946it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
20947mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
20948
20949@xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
20950@kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
20951@xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
20952variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
20953
20954@node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20955@subsection Reducing
20956
20957@noindent
20958@kindex V R
20959@pindex calc-reduce
20960@tindex reduce
20961The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
20962binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
20963a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
20964example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
20965of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
20966the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
20967and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
20968produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
20969
20970@kindex I V R
20971@tindex rreduce
20972The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
20973that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
20974@kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
20975but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
20976or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
20977in power series expansions.
20978
20979@kindex V U
20980@tindex accum
20981The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
20982accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
20983operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
20984a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
20985the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
20986@samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
20987
20988@kindex I V U
20989@tindex raccum
20990The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
20991For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
20992vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
20993
20994@tindex reducea
20995@tindex rreducea
20996@tindex reduced
20997@tindex rreduced
20998As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
20999example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
21000compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
21001@kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
21002command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
21003as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
21004matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
21005[@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
21006b + e, c + f]}.
21007
21008@tindex reducer
21009@tindex rreducer
21010There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
21011useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
21012the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
21013matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
21014row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
21015would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
21016while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
21017
21018These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
21019but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
21020
21021@tindex reducec
21022@tindex rreducec
21023The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
21024supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
21025
21026The commands @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are equivalent to typing
21027@kbd{C-x * r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
21028@kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
21029rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
21030
21031@node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
21032@subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
21033
21034@noindent
21035@kindex H V R
21036@tindex nest
21037The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
21038argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
21039the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
21040function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
21041is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
21042negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
21043example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
21044
21045@kindex H V U
21046@tindex anest
21047The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
21048@code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
21049@samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
21050@samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
21051form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
21052
21053@kindex H I V R
21054@tindex fixp
21055@cindex Fixed points
21056The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
21057that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
21058applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
21059no longer changes.
21060
21061@kindex H I V U
21062@tindex afixp
21063The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
21064The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
21065the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
21066by @code{fixp}.
21067
21068For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
21069@samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
210701.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
21071version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
210720.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
21073to converge to 0.739085.)
21074
21075Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
21076to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
21077initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
21078function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
21079and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
210802.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
21081command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
21082
21083These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
21084the function until two successive results are equal to within the
21085current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
21086imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
21087@samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
21088applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
21089It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
21090if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
21091
21092The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
21093and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
21094and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
21095default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
21096specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
21097formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
21098between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
21099(This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
21100exactly equal.)
21101
21102Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21103computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21104stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21105when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21106
21107@node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21108@subsection Generalized Products
21109
21110@kindex V O
21111@pindex calc-outer-product
21112@tindex outer
21113The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21114a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21115vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21116and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21117@samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21118the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21119of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21120
21121@kindex V I
21122@pindex calc-inner-product
21123@tindex inner
21124The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21125the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21126``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21127actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21128respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21129@var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21130multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21131column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21132operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21133vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21134generalized dot product.
21135
21136Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21137you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21138use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21139first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21140and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21141
21142@node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21143@section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21144
21145@noindent
21146Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21147instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21148particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21149in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21150influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21151@pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21152
21153@kindex V <
21154@pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
21155@kindex V =
21156@pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
21157@kindex V >
21158@pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21159The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21160(@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21161(@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21162are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21163
21164@kindex V [
21165@pindex calc-vector-brackets
21166@kindex V @{
21167@pindex calc-vector-braces
21168@kindex V (
21169@pindex calc-vector-parens
21170The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21171brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21172and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21173(@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21174respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21175be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21176Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21177@pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21178display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21179and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21180
21181@kindex V ]
21182@pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21183The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
21184``big'' style display of matrices. It prompts for a string of code
21185letters; currently implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables
21186brackets on each row of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer
21187brackets in opposite corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which
21188enables commas or semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last.
21189The default format is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format
21190was fixed at @samp{ROC}.) Here are some example matrices:
21191
21192@example
21193@group
21194[ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21195 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21196 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21197
21198 RO ROC
21199
21200@end group
21201@end example
21202@noindent
21203@example
21204@group
21205 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21206 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21207 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21208
21209 O OC
21210
21211@end group
21212@end example
21213@noindent
21214@example
21215@group
21216 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21217 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21218 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21219
21220 R @r{blank}
21221@end group
21222@end example
21223
21224@noindent
21225Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21226@samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21227the others are useful for display only.
21228
21229@kindex V ,
21230@pindex calc-vector-commas
21231The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21232off in vector and matrix display.
21233
21234In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21235turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21236otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21237of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21238variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21239case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21240(to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21241ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21242give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21243
21244@kindex V .
21245@pindex calc-full-vectors
21246The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21247display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21248or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21249be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21250three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21251When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21252improve Calc's display speed.
21253
21254@kindex t .
21255@pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21256The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21257similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21258this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21259more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21260Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21261unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21262large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21263that involve the trail.
21264
21265@kindex V /
21266@pindex calc-break-vectors
21267The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21268vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21269row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21270line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21271displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21272vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21273
21274@node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21275@chapter Algebra
21276
21277@noindent
21278This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21279algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21280mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21281commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21282described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21283is discussed.
21284
21285The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21286commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21287for anything else'') prefix.
21288
21289@xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21290using regular Emacs editing commands.
21291
21292When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21293modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21294or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21295Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21296Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21297of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21298@xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21299
21300@menu
21301* Selecting Subformulas::
21302* Algebraic Manipulation::
21303* Simplifying Formulas::
21304* Polynomials::
21305* Calculus::
21306* Solving Equations::
21307* Numerical Solutions::
21308* Curve Fitting::
21309* Summations::
21310* Logical Operations::
21311* Rewrite Rules::
21312@end menu
21313
21314@node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21315@section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21316
21317@noindent
21318@cindex Selections
21319@cindex Sub-formulas
21320@cindex Parts of formulas
21321When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21322manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21323whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21324the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21325entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21326surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21327
21328One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21329on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21330``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21331
21332@menu
21333* Making Selections::
21334* Changing Selections::
21335* Displaying Selections::
21336* Operating on Selections::
21337* Rearranging with Selections::
21338@end menu
21339
21340@node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21341@subsection Making Selections
21342
21343@noindent
21344@kindex j s
21345@pindex calc-select-here
21346To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21347sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21348highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21349character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21350all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21351display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21352Suppose you enter the following formula:
21353
21354@smallexample
21355@group
21356 3 ___
21357 (a + b) + V c
213581: ---------------
21359 2 x + 1
21360@end group
21361@end smallexample
21362
21363@noindent
21364(by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21365cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21366to
21367
21368@smallexample
21369@group
21370 . ...
21371 .. . b. . . .
213721* ...............
21373 . . . .
21374@end group
21375@end smallexample
21376
21377@noindent
21378Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
21379to a dot. The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
21380the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21381obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21382the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21383may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21384
21385If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21386the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21387
21388@smallexample
21389@group
21390 . ...
21391 (a + b) . . .
213921* ...............
21393 . . . .
21394@end group
21395@end smallexample
21396
21397@noindent
21398The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21399formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21400formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21401would have had the same effect.
21402
21403(Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21404the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21405in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21406sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21407
21408If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21409expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21410the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21411@samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21412and so on.
21413
21414If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21415numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21416
21417If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21418(i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21419formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21420on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21421cursor on any stack entry.
21422
21423@kindex j a
21424@pindex calc-select-additional
21425The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21426current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21427sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21428press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21429is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21430select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21431
21432@kindex j o
21433@pindex calc-select-once
21434The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21435exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21436last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21437@kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21438by the cursor.
21439
21440(A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21441such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21442the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21443commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21444
21445@kindex j S
21446@kindex j O
21447@pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21448@pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21449The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21450(@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21451and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21452has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21453behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21454@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21455used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21456commands.
21457
21458Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21459@samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21460If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21461on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21462entire four-term sum.
21463
21464@kindex j b
21465@pindex calc-break-selections
21466The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21467in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
45b778a6
JB
21468through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as
21469@samp{((a + b) - c) + d} and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain
21470obscure reasons, by default Calc treats multiplication as
21471right-associative.) Once you have enabled @kbd{j b} mode, selecting
21472with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would only select the @samp{a + b -
21473c} portion, which makes sense when the deep structure of the sum is
21474considered. There is no way to select the @samp{b - c + d} portion;
21475although this might initially look like just as legitimate a sub-formula
21476as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d
21477U} command can be used to view the deep structure of any formula
21478(@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
4009494e
GM
21479
21480When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21481generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21482you get.
21483
21484@kindex j u
21485@pindex calc-unselect
21486The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21487that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21488this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21489unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21490position.
21491
21492@kindex j c
21493@pindex calc-clear-selections
21494The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21495stack elements.
21496
21497@node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21498@subsection Changing Selections
21499
21500@noindent
21501@kindex j m
21502@pindex calc-select-more
21503Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21504@w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21505selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21506
21507@smallexample
21508@group
21509 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21510 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
215111* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21512 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21513@end group
21514@end smallexample
21515
21516@noindent
21517In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21518the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21519differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21520
21521With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21522times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21523with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21524@kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21525is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21526
21527Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21528cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21529which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21530is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21531
21532@kindex j l
21533@pindex calc-select-less
21534The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21535selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21536immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21537cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21538current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21539
21540@kindex j 1-9
21541@pindex calc-select-part
21542The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21543select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21544like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21545rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21546For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21547@kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21548@kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21549these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21550
21551If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21552the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21553the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21554sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21555@w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21556
21557@kindex j n
21558@kindex j p
21559@pindex calc-select-next
21560@pindex calc-select-previous
21561The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21562(@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21563to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21564if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21565selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21566even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21567it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21568same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21569the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21570@w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21571
21572Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21573sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21574arguments to move several steps at a time.
21575
21576It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21577Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21578organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21579analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21580@kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21581(Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21582The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21583@kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21584of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21585
21586@node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21587@subsection Displaying Selections
21588
21589@noindent
21590@kindex j d
21591@pindex calc-show-selections
21592The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21593selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21594illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21595to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21596by @samp{#} signs:
21597
21598@smallexample
21599@group
21600 3 ... # ___
21601 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
216021* ............... 1* ---------------
21603 . . . . 2 x + 1
21604@end group
21605@end smallexample
21606
21607@node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21608@subsection Operating on Selections
21609
21610@noindent
21611Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21612on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21613instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21614at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21615given stack element.)
21616
21617@kindex j e
21618@pindex calc-enable-selections
21619The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21620effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21621still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21622This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21623the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21624reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21625
21626To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21627sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21628stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21629element.
21630
21631To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21632new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21633the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21634the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21635portion to the top of the stack.
21636
21637@smallexample
21638@group
21639 3 ... ... ___
21640 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
216412* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21642 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21643
21644 3 3
216451: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21646@end group
21647@end smallexample
21648
21649In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21650enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21651the complete, edited formula.
21652
21653If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21654selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21655
21656@kindex j '
21657@pindex calc-enter-selection
21658The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21659to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21660entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21661the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21662the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21663selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21664the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21665the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21666do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21667
21668@kindex j `
21669@pindex calc-edit-selection
21670The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21671analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21672selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21673selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21674
21675To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21676the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21677it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21678deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21679
21680@smallexample
21681@group
21682 ###
21683 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
216841* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21685 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21686@end group
21687@end smallexample
21688
21689In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21690accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21691resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21692since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21693and resimplifies.
21694
21695If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21696element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21697an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21698
21699@kindex j @key{DEL}
21700@pindex calc-del-selection
21701The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21702@key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21703@kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21704indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21705deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21706
21707@kindex j @key{RET}
21708@pindex calc-grab-selection
21709(There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21710command.)
21711
21712Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21713select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21714denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21715press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21716
21717@smallexample
21718@group
21719 .. . .. . .. . .. .
217201* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21721 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21722 V 4 - 2 x
21723@end group
21724@end smallexample
21725
21726Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21727example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21728the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21729shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21730which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21731this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21732the command will abort with an error message.
21733
21734Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21735in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21736of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21737(@code{calc-change-sign}).
21738
21739@smallexample
21740@group
21741 .. . .. .
217421* .......... 1* ...........
21743 ......... ..........
21744 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
21745@end group
21746@end smallexample
21747
21748Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
21749normally have cancelled out with the subtraction automatically, has
21750not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
21751selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
21752any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
21753to be simplified.
21754
21755@smallexample
21756@group
21757 17 y 17 y
217581: ----------- 1: ----------
21759 __________ _________
21760 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
21761@end group
21762@end smallexample
21763
21764@node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21765@subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
21766
21767@noindent
21768@kindex j R
21769@pindex calc-commute-right
21770The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
21771sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
21772selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
21773rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
21774
21775As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
21776if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
21777in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
21778cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
21779
21780@smallexample
217811: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
21782@end smallexample
21783
21784@noindent
21785Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
21786the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
21787terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
21788mathematical meaning of the formula.
21789
21790The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
21791of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
21792In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
21793course be drastically changed.
21794
21795@smallexample
217961: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
21797
217981: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
21799@end smallexample
21800
21801@kindex j L
21802@pindex calc-commute-left
21803The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
21804except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
21805
21806With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
21807term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
21808term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
21809With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
21810selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
21811
21812@kindex j D
21813@pindex calc-sel-distribute
21814The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
21815sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
21816law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
21817selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
21818products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
21819transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
21820where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
21821to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
21822
21823For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
21824at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
21825with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
21826repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
21827numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
21828times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
21829
21830@vindex DistribRules
21831The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
21832@xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
21833the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
21834these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
21835displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
21836to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
21837or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
21838
21839To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
21840as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
21841this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
21842@xref{Operations on Variables}.
21843
21844@kindex j M
21845@pindex calc-sel-merge
21846@vindex MergeRules
21847The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
21848of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
21849@samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
21850again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
21851and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
21852the relevant rules.
21853
21854@kindex j C
21855@pindex calc-sel-commute
21856@vindex CommuteRules
21857The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
21858of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
21859if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
21860treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
21861If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
21862@samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
21863result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
21864will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
21865in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
21866
21867You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
21868command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
21869commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
21870simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
21871you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
21872manipulations described in this section.
21873
21874@kindex j N
21875@pindex calc-sel-negate
21876@vindex NegateRules
21877The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
21878term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
21879formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
21880@samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
21881@samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
21882regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
21883term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
21884of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
21885
21886@kindex j &
21887@pindex calc-sel-invert
21888@vindex InvertRules
21889The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
21890except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
21891given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
21892@samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
21893
21894@kindex j E
21895@pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
21896@vindex JumpRules
21897The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
21898selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
21899@samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
21900@samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
21901term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
21902relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
21903
21904@kindex j I
21905@kindex H j I
21906@pindex calc-sel-isolate
21907The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
21908selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
21909(@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
21910Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
21911When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
21912It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
21913as well as equations.
21914
21915@kindex j *
21916@kindex j /
21917@pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
21918@pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
21919The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
21920formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
21921selected quotient or equation by that formula. It simplifies each
21922side with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) before re-forming the
21923quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
5fafc247 21924providing a prefix argument: @kbd{C-u j *}. There is also a @kbd{j /}
4009494e
GM
21925(@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
21926dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
21927
5fafc247
JB
21928If the selection is a quotient with numerator 1, then Calc's default
21929simplifications would normally cancel the new factors. To prevent
21930this, when the @kbd{j *} command is used on a selection whose numerator is
219311 or -1, the denominator is expanded at the top level using the
21932distributive law (as if using the @kbd{C-u 1 a x} command). Suppose the
21933formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (a + 1)} and you wish to multiplying the
21934top and bottom by @samp{a - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
21935normally change the result @samp{(a - 1) /(a + 1) (a - 1)} back
21936to the original form by cancellation; when @kbd{j *} is used, Calc
21937expands the denominator to @samp{a (a - 1) + a - 1} to prevent this.
21938
21939If you wish the @kbd{j *} command to completely expand the denominator
21940of a quotient you can call it with a zero prefix: @kbd{C-u 0 j *}. For
21941example, if the formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, you may
21942wish to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying
21943the top and bottom by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. If you did this simply by using
21944a simple @kbd{j *} command, you would get
21945@samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/ (sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1)}. Instead,
21946you would probably want to use @kbd{C-u 0 j *}, which would expand the
21947bottom and give you the desired result @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/(a-1)}. More
21948generally, if @kbd{j *} is called with an argument of a positive
21949integer @var{n}, then the denominator of the expression will be
21950expanded @var{n} times (as if with the @kbd{C-u @var{n} a x} command).
4009494e
GM
21951
21952If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
21953accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
21954is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
21955of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
21956for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
21957negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
21958will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
21959message.
21960
21961For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
21962these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
21963multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
21964back by the formula.
21965
21966@kindex j +
21967@kindex j -
21968@pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
21969@pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
21970The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
21971(@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
21972subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
21973types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
21974prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
21975results.
21976
21977@kindex j U
21978@pindex calc-sel-unpack
21979The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
21980selected function call with its argument. For example, given
21981@samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
21982is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
21983wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
21984now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
21985
21986@kindex j v
21987@pindex calc-sel-evaluate
21988The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
21989normal default simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
21990These are the simplifications that are normally done automatically
21991on all results, but which may have been partially inhibited by
21992previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
21993by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
21994version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
21995
21996With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
21997the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command to the selected
21998sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
21999applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
22000@xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
22001it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
22002Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
22003sub-formula.
22004
22005@kindex j "
22006@pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
22007The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
22008(@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
22009
22010You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
22011to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22012
22013@node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
22014@section Algebraic Manipulation
22015
22016@noindent
22017The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
22018manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
22019stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
22020formula).
22021
22022Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
22023answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
22024from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
22025from the second-to-top stack level.
22026
22027@kindex a v
22028@pindex calc-alg-evaluate
22029The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
22030default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
22031changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
22032automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
22033you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
22034command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
22035
22036It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
22037but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
22038Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
22039
22040If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
22041as if in Algebraic Simplification mode. This is equivalent to typing
22042@kbd{a s}; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}. If you give a numeric prefix
22043of 3 or more, it uses Extended Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
22044
22045If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
22046it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
22047function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
22048simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
22049@samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
22050@samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
22051in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
2205210; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
22053(@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
22054
22055@tindex evalv
22056@tindex evalvn
22057The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
22058the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
22059disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
22060to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
22061arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
22062the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
22063it as a temporary different working precision.)
22064
22065The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
22066as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
22067integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
22068a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
22069precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
22070precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
22071result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
22072afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
22073of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
22074will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
22075is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
22076will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
22077
22078@kindex a "
22079@pindex calc-expand-formula
22080The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
22081into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
22082@samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
22083like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
22084and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
22085functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
22086created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
22087Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
22088distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
22089hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
22090affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
22091argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
22092various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
22093top-level function call.
22094
22095@kindex a M
22096@pindex calc-map-equation
22097@tindex mapeq
22098The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
22099a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
22100to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
22101@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
22102@samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
22103@samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
22104With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
22105sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
22106respective sides of a new equation.
22107
22108Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
22109produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
22110with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
22111@samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
22112If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22113are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22114match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22115reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22116combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the @kbd{a s} command can
22117then simplify to get @samp{2 < b}.
22118
22119Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22120or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22121Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22122@kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22123though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22124
22125@kindex H a M
22126@tindex mapeqp
22127With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22128mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22129Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22130(This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22131fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22132
22133@kindex I a M
22134@tindex mapeqr
22135With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22136the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22137change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22138working with small positive angles.
22139
22140@kindex a b
22141@pindex calc-substitute
22142@tindex subst
22143The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22144all occurrences
22145of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22146sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22147in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22148@samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22149Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22150the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22151@samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22152doing substitutions.
22153
22154The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22155one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22156prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22157then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22158blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22159and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22160target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22161
22162Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22163associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22164@samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22165because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22166structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22167(@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22168a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22169these limitations.
22170
22171As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22172Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22173evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22174you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22175turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22176
22177@node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22178@section Simplifying Formulas
22179
22180@noindent
22181@kindex a s
22182@pindex calc-simplify
22183@tindex simplify
22184The @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command applies
22185various algebraic rules to simplify a formula. This includes rules which
22186are not part of the default simplifications because they may be too slow
22187to apply all the time, or may not be desirable all of the time. For
22188example, non-adjacent terms of sums are combined, as in @samp{a + b + 2 a}
22189to @samp{b + 3 a}, and some formulas like @samp{sin(arcsin(x))} are
22190simplified to @samp{x}.
22191
22192The sections below describe all the various kinds of algebraic
22193simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22194simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22195they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22196less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22197must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22198and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22199@xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22200
22201@xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22202simplification occurs automatically. Normally only the ``default
22203simplifications'' occur.
22204
22205@menu
22206* Default Simplifications::
22207* Algebraic Simplifications::
22208* Unsafe Simplifications::
22209* Simplification of Units::
22210@end menu
22211
22212@node Default Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22213@subsection Default Simplifications
22214
22215@noindent
22216@cindex Default simplifications
22217This section describes the ``default simplifications,'' those which are
22218normally applied to all results. For example, if you enter the variable
22219@expr{x} on the stack twice and push @kbd{+}, Calc's default
22220simplifications automatically change @expr{x + x} to @expr{2 x}.
22221
22222The @kbd{m O} command turns off the default simplifications, so that
22223@expr{x + x} will remain in this form unless you give an explicit
22224``simplify'' command like @kbd{=} or @kbd{a v}. @xref{Algebraic
22225Manipulation}. The @kbd{m D} command turns the default simplifications
22226back on.
22227
22228The most basic default simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22229For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)}
22230is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22231to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@tfn{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22232range (@expr{@tfn{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@tfn{tan}(3,5)}),
22233or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@tfn{f}(5)}), or if
22234Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22235(@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2)}).
22236
22237Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22238simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22239simplified to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22240itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22241@code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22242operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22243operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22244does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22245
22246Most commands apply the default simplifications to all arguments they
22247take from the stack, perform a particular operation, then simplify
22248the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the common special
22249case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}],
22250the arguments are simply popped from the stack and collected into a
22251suitable function call, which is then simplified (the arguments being
22252simplified first as part of the process, as described above).
22253
22254The default simplifications are too numerous to describe completely
22255here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22256major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22257nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22258a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22259
22260@tex
22261\bigskip
22262@end tex
22263
22264As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22265any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22266will also be applied before any built-in default simplifications.
22267@xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22268
22269@tex
22270\bigskip
22271@end tex
22272
22273And now, on with the default simplifications:
22274
22275Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22276arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22277more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22278a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
45b778a6
JB
22279(by default) a right-associative form for products,
22280@expr{a * (b * (c * d))}. Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are
22281rearranged to left-associative form, though this rarely matters since
22282Calc's algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of sums
22283and products as much as possible. Sums and products in their proper
22284associative form will be written without parentheses in the examples
22285below.
4009494e
GM
22286
22287Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22288commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22289special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22290rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22291see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22292Calc assumes you have put the terms into the order you want
22293and generally leaves that order alone, with the consequence
22294that formulas like the above will only be simplified if you
22295explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command. @xref{Algebraic
22296Simplifications}.
22297
22298Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22299for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22300is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22301represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22302``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22303@expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22304negative-looking.
22305
22306Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22307@expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22308negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22309@expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22310@expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22311(This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22312cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22313simplifications.)
22314
22315The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22316@expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22317a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22318and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22319@kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22320using the distributive law.
22321
22322The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22323for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22324is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22325is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22326sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22327square of the number of terms; Calc relegates potentially slow
22328operations like this to commands that have to be invoked
22329explicitly, like @kbd{a s}.
22330
22331Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22332A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22333to @expr{-a}.
22334
22335@tex
22336\bigskip
22337@end tex
22338
22339The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22340@expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22341@expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22342in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22343is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22344infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22345
22346Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22347where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22348numbers.
22349
22350Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22351@expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22352
22353The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22354@expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22355@expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22356@expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22357rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22358
22359The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22360terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22361@texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22362@infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22363where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22364or the implicit one-half of @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22365@expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22366if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22367If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22368@expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22369
22370The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22371power is changed to use division:
22372@texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22373@infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22374goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22375in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22376case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22377
22378Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22379@expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22380
22381@tex
22382\bigskip
22383@end tex
22384
22385Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22386The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22387exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22388and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22389respectively.
22390
22391The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22392infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22393@xref{Infinite Mode}.
22394
22395The expression
22396@texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22397@infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22398is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22399power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22400@texline @math{b^{-c}}
22401@infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22402for any power @expr{c}.
22403
22404Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22405@expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22406goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22407rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22408@expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22409
22410The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22411@expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22412Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22413described for multiplication.
22414
22415Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22416numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22417is cancelled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22418again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22419to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22420
22421Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22422to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22423to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22424
22425@tex
22426\bigskip
22427@end tex
22428
22429The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22430in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22431unless @expr{x} is a negative number, complex number or zero.
22432If @expr{x} is negative, complex or @expr{0.0}, @expr{0^x} is an
22433infinity or an unsimplified formula according to the current infinite
22434mode. The expression @expr{0^0} is simplified to @expr{1}.
22435
22436Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22437are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22438is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22439real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22440@texline @math{a^{b c}}
22441@infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22442only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22443evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22444would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22445(In other words,
22446@texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22447@infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22448is safe to simplify, but
22449@texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22450@infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22451is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22452variables satisfy these requirements.
22453
22454As a special case of this rule, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22455@texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22456@infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22457only for even integers @expr{n}.
22458
22459If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22460@expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22461simplified to @expr{@tfn{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22462
22463Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22464even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22465for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22466
22467Square roots @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22468@texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22469@infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22470for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22471
22472Also, note that
22473@texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22474@infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22475is changed to
22476@texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22477@infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22478but @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22479
22480@tex
22481\bigskip
22482@end tex
22483
22484Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22485following rules: @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22486is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22487@expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + @tfn{idn}(b)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a + b)};
22488@expr{-@tfn{idn}(a)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22489@expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22490if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22491@expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22492@code{idn}; and @expr{@tfn{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a^n)} where
22493@expr{n} is an integer.
22494
22495@tex
22496\bigskip
22497@end tex
22498
22499The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22500vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22501@expr{@tfn{floor}(@tfn{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@tfn{round}(x)}.
22502Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22503and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22504ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22505
22506The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}.
22507The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(@tfn{abs}(x))} changes to
22508@expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22509@expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22510(@pxref{Declarations}).
22511
22512While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22513imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22514@expr{@tfn{arg}(@tfn{i})} and @expr{@tfn{arg}(-@tfn{i})} just for convenience.
22515
22516The expression @expr{@tfn{conj}(@tfn{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22517Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22518@code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22519provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22520@expr{@tfn{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22521@expr{@tfn{conj}(a) - @tfn{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22522and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22523
22524Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22525any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22526for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The @kbd{a s} command
22527described in the next section does provide some simplifications for
22528these functions, though.
22529
22530One important simplification that does occur is that
22531@expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)} is
22532simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22533stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22534be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22535
22536Among the logical functions, @tfn{!(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22537@tfn{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22538are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22539and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22540@expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22541@expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22542
22543Most other Calc functions have few if any default simplifications
22544defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22545suitable numbers.
22546
22547@node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Default Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22548@subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22549
22550@noindent
22551@cindex Algebraic simplifications
22552The @kbd{a s} command makes simplifications that may be too slow to
22553do all the time, or that may not be desirable all of the time.
22554If you find these simplifications are worthwhile, you can type
22555@kbd{m A} to have Calc apply them automatically.
22556
22557This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22558the @kbd{a s} command. Note that these occur in addition to the
22559default simplifications; even if the default simplifications have
22560been turned off by an @kbd{m O} command, @kbd{a s} will turn them
22561back on temporarily while it simplifies the formula.
22562
22563There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22564to be applied by @kbd{a s}. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22565but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22566@samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22567expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22568the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22569the original expression, the process repeats with the default
22570simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22571then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22572
22573@tex
22574\bigskip
22575@end tex
22576
22577Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22578end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22579The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22580from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22581commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22582
22583Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22584@expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22585adjacent terms, but @kbd{a s} compares all pairs of terms including
22586non-adjacent ones.
22587
22588@tex
22589\bigskip
22590@end tex
22591
22592Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22593law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22594This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the default
22595simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22596but @kbd{a s} will; it first rewrites the sum to @expr{x y + x y},
22597and then the default simplifications are able to recognize a sum
22598of identical terms.
22599
22600The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22601property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22602come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22603command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22604
22605Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22606turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22607two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22608
22609Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22610terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22611use for adjacent terms of products.
22612
22613Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22614taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22615Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22616A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22617be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22618one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22619that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22620
22621A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22622a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22623done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22624is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22625on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22626
22627@tex
22628\bigskip
22629@end tex
22630
22631Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22632with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22633the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22634cancel @expr{x^2} from the top and bottom to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22635(The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22636as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22637factor in the numerator and denominator, it is cancelled out;
22638for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22639
22640Non-constant common factors are not found even by @kbd{a s}. To
22641cancel the factor @expr{a} in @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first
22642use @kbd{j M} on the product @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to
22643@expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be simplified successfully.
22644
22645@tex
22646\bigskip
22647@end tex
22648
22649Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22650to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22651than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22652will no longer occur. This is done by @kbd{a s} instead of by default
22653in case someone (unwisely) uses the name @code{i} for a variable
22654unrelated to complex numbers; it would be unfortunate if Calc
22655quietly and automatically changed this formula for reasons the
22656user might not have been thinking of.
22657
22658Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22659several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22660Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22661pulled out so that @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22662@texline @math{2\,@tfn{sqrt}(2)}.
22663@infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22664Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22665and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22666efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22667
22668Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22669numerator: @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22670The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22671@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22672
22673@tex
22674\bigskip
22675@end tex
22676
22677The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22678when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22679the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22680@expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22681example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22682
22683If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22684has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22685cancelled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22686@samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22687is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22688not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22689about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22690
22691If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22692evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22693often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22694above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22695@samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22696can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22697declared to be an integer.
22698
22699@tex
22700\bigskip
22701@end tex
22702
22703Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. Whenever a
22704products of two trigonometric functions can be replaced by a single
22705function, the replacement is made; for example,
22706@expr{@tfn{tan}(x) @tfn{cos}(x)} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{sin}(x)}.
22707Reciprocals of trigonometric functions are replaced by their reciprocal
22708function; for example, @expr{1/@tfn{sec}(x)} is simplified to
22709@expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. The corresponding simplifications for the
22710hyperbolic functions are also handled.
22711
22712Trigonometric functions of their inverse functions are
22713simplified. The expression @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arcsin}(x))} is
22714simplified to @expr{x}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22715Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22716functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arccos}(x))}
22717to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22718
22719If the argument to @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22720@expr{-@tfn{sin}(x)}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22721Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22722@pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22723
22724Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22725arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22726hyperbolic functions.
22727
22728No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22729functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
22730@code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
22731@expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
22732@expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
22733@texline @math{2 \pi}
22734@infoline @expr{2 pi}
22735radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@tfn{arcsinh}(@tfn{sinh}(x))} is
22736simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22737
22738Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
22739are that @expr{@tfn{exp}(@tfn{ln}(x))},
22740@texline @tfn{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
22741@infoline @expr{e^@tfn{ln}(x)},
22742and
22743@texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
22744@infoline @expr{10^@tfn{log10}(x)}
22745all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))}, etc., can
22746reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
22747@expr{@tfn{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
22748is a suitable multiple of
22749@texline @math{\pi i}
22750@infoline @expr{pi i}
22751(as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
22752@expr{@tfn{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
22753@expr{@tfn{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
22754@code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
22755negative imaginary.
22756
22757The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
22758their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
22759function.
22760
22761@tex
22762\bigskip
22763@end tex
22764
22765Equations and inequalities are simplified by cancelling factors
22766of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
22767change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is cancelled.
22768Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
22769cancelled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
22770because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
22771are cancelled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
22772sign is known.
22773
22774Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
227751 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
22776declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
22777than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
22778all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
22779By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
22780as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22781
22782@node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22783@subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
22784
22785@noindent
22786@cindex Unsafe simplifications
22787@cindex Extended simplification
22788@kindex a e
22789@pindex calc-simplify-extended
22790@ignore
22791@mindex esimpl@idots
22792@end ignore
22793@tindex esimplify
22794The @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
22795is like @kbd{a s}
22796except that it applies some additional simplifications which are not
22797``safe'' in all cases. Use this only if you know the values in your
22798formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these simplifications
22799are valid. The symbolic integrator uses @kbd{a e};
22800one effect of this is that the integrator's results must be used with
22801caution. Where an integral table will often attach conditions like
22802``for positive @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic
22803integration programs) will simply produce an unqualified result.
22804
22805Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
22806to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
22807on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
22808In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
22809to any specific part of a formula.
22810
22811The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22812the @kbd{a e} command. These are applied in addition to
22813@code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
22814step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
22815
22816Following is a complete list of ``unsafe'' simplifications performed
22817by @kbd{a e}.
22818
22819@tex
22820\bigskip
22821@end tex
22822
22823Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
22824corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified
22825by @kbd{a e}. For example, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} changes
22826to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{cos}(x))} and
22827@expr{@tfn{arccos}(@tfn{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@tfn{pi}/2 - x}.
22828These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
22829values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
22830are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
22831functions always produce.
22832
22833Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
22834@texline @math{x^{a b}}
22835@infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
22836for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
22837in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
22838@texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
22839@infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
22840the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
22841of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
22842
22843Similarly, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
22844simplified (possibly unsafely) to
22845@texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
22846@infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
22847
22848Forms like @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
22849@expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
22850@code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
22851
22852Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
22853squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
22854@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
22855@expr{a b @tfn{sqrt}(a+b)}.
22856
22857The simplifications of @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))},
22858@expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)}, and @expr{@tfn{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
22859unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
22860simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
22861
22862Common factors are cancelled from products on both sides of an
22863equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
22864to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never cancelled from
22865inequalities: Even @kbd{a e} is not bold enough to reduce
22866@expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
22867on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
22868The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
22869both sides of an inequality.
22870
22871@node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22872@subsection Simplification of Units
22873
22874@noindent
22875The simplifications described in this section are applied by the
22876@kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command. These are in addition
22877to the regular @kbd{a s} (but not @kbd{a e}) simplifications described
22878earlier. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
22879
22880The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22881the @kbd{u s} command. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
22882and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
22883
22884Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
22885@xref{Matrix Mode}.
22886
22887Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
22888units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
22889@expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
22890using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
22891is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
22892in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
22893
22894If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
22895which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
22896leading unit are modified accordingly.
22897
22898When cancelling and combining units in products and quotients,
22899Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
22900For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
22901However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
22902are not combined in this way.
22903
22904Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
22905if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
22906computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
22907
22908Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
22909of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
22910units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
22911units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
22912@samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
22913
22914Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
22915a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
22916number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
22917
22918For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
22919@expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
22920and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
22921@texline @math{a^{b c}}
22922@infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22923are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
22924of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
22925real.)
22926
22927Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
22928base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
22929multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
22930is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
22931according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
22932is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
22933is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
22934@code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
22935replaced by approximately
22936@texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
22937@infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
22938which is then changed to
22939@texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
22940@infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
22941then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
22942
22943The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
22944as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
22945applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
22946simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
22947@samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
22948and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
22949
22950The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
22951that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
22952simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
22953with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
22954
22955@node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
22956@section Polynomials
22957
22958A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
22959various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
22960is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
22961polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
22962is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
22963are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
22964involving the base variable.
22965
22966@kindex a f
22967@pindex calc-factor
22968@tindex factor
22969The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
22970polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
22971@expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
22972example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
22973@expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
22974
22975Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
22976linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
22977merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
22978polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
22979coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
22980terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
22981(@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
22982which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
22983rewrite mechanism.
22984
22985Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
22986root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
22987polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
22988or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
22989quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
22990arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
22991integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
22992Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
22993found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
22994(A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
22995version of Calc.)
22996
22997@vindex FactorRules
22998@ignore
22999@starindex
23000@end ignore
23001@tindex thecoefs
23002@ignore
23003@starindex
23004@end ignore
23005@ignore
23006@mindex @idots
23007@end ignore
23008@tindex thefactors
23009The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
23010@code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
23011operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
23012to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
23013@expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
23014cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
23015@samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
23016base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
23017(which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
23018i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
23019changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
23020where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
23021Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
23022factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
23023@code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
23024polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
23025the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
23026as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
23027
23028@kindex H a f
23029@tindex factors
23030The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
23031but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
23032product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
23033of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
23034@expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
23035in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
23036If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
23037The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
23038when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
23039respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
23040respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
23041
23042@kindex a c
23043@pindex calc-collect
23044@tindex collect
23045The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
23046formula as a
23047polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
23048variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
23049the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
23050and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
23051The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
23052necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
23053@expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
23054not be expanded.
23055
23056The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
23057expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
23058by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
23059in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
23060treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
23061
23062@kindex a x
23063@pindex calc-expand
23064@tindex expand
23065The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
23066expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
23067products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
23068distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
23069the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
23070the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
23071
23072The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
23073@kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
23074Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
23075the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
23076@kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
23077also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
23078@samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
23079do not do.)
23080
23081Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
23082expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
23083to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
23084to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
23085simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
23086simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
23087@kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
23088the way in one step.
23089
23090@kindex a a
23091@pindex calc-apart
23092@tindex apart
23093The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
23094rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
23095quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
23096sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
23097notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
23098specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
23099chooses the base variable automatically.
23100
23101@kindex a n
23102@pindex calc-normalize-rat
23103@tindex nrat
23104The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
23105attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
23106For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
23107@expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
23108@kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
23109out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
23110
23111@kindex a \
23112@pindex calc-poly-div
23113@tindex pdiv
23114The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23115two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23116@expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23117considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23118with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23119powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23120dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23121The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23122of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23123
23124Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23125variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23126If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23127the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23128above.
23129
23130@kindex a %
23131@pindex calc-poly-rem
23132@tindex prem
23133The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23134two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23135@expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23136results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23137(This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23138integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23139
23140@kindex a /
23141@kindex H a /
23142@pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23143@tindex pdivrem
23144@tindex pdivide
23145The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23146divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23147remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23148command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23149@expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23150this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23151
23152@kindex a g
23153@pindex calc-poly-gcd
23154@tindex pgcd
23155The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23156the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23157is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23158choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23159command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23160of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23161definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23162leaving a remainder.)
23163
23164While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23165often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23166deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23167Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23168applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23169automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23170integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23171
23172Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23173(@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23174polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23175
23176@xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23177extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23178
23179@node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23180@section Calculus
23181
23182@noindent
23183The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23184inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23185to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23186to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23187readable way.
23188
23189@menu
23190* Differentiation::
23191* Integration::
23192* Customizing the Integrator::
23193* Numerical Integration::
23194* Taylor Series::
23195@end menu
23196
23197@node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23198@subsection Differentiation
23199
23200@noindent
23201@kindex a d
23202@kindex H a d
23203@pindex calc-derivative
23204@tindex deriv
23205@tindex tderiv
23206The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23207the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23208some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23209in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23210considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23211the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23212instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23213unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23214of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23215are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23216@code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23217
23218With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23219@var{n}th derivative.
23220
23221When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23222Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23223in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23224answer!
23225
23226If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23227you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23228of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23229@texline @math{x=x_0}.
23230@infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23231
23232If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23233not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23234primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23235produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23236derivative of @code{f}.
23237
23238For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23239the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23240also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23241@samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23242the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23243@samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23244define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23245result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23246
23247For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23248to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23249respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23250Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23251@samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23252@samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23253argument once).
23254
23255@node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23256@subsection Integration
23257
23258@noindent
23259@kindex a i
23260@pindex calc-integral
23261@tindex integ
23262The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23263indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23264respect to a prompted-for variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to
23265work for all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several
23266large classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational
23267function (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable.
23268(Rational functions don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23269@texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23270@infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23271is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23272@expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23273@expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23274integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23275hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23276
23277With an argument (@kbd{C-u a i}), this command will compute the definite
23278integral of the expression on top of the stack. In this case, the
23279command will again prompt for an integration variable, then prompt for a
23280lower limit and an upper limit.
23281
23282@ifnottex
23283If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23284you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23285indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23286With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23287integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23288@end ifnottex
23289@tex
23290If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23291you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23292indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23293With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23294integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23295@end tex
23296
23297Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23298produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23299be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23300@texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23301@infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23302is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23303returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23304equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23305an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23306write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23307Calc's solution for
23308@texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23309@infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23310differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23311constant factor of
23312@texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23313@infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23314due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23315
23316The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23317change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23318from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23319suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23320@code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23321
23322@vindex IntegLimit
23323Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23324parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23325If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23326a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23327command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23328has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23329of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23330will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23331this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23332it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23333by creating an Emacs buffer called @code{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23334exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23335
23336If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23337set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23338table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23339rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23340and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23341
23342@node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23343@subsection Customizing the Integrator
23344
23345@noindent
23346@vindex IntegRules
23347Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23348@code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23349methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23350Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23351@samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23352integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23353rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23354Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23355the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23356integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23357Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23358will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23359automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23360to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23361@samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23362in your @code{IntegRules}.
23363
23364@cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23365@ignore
23366@starindex
23367@end ignore
23368@tindex Ei
23369As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23370integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23371integral'' function
23372@texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23373@infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23374was invented to describe it.
23375We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23376function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23377to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23378and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23379work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23380integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23381involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23382integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23383and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23384
23385Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23386example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23387to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23388Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23389is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23390with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23391to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23392also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23393unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still valid
23394to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23395if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23396integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23397then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23398
23399If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23400@var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23401nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23402substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23403integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23404@samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23405a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23406@samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23407Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23408appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23409as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23410it need not be.
23411
23412When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23413equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23414refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23415match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23416of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23417derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23418extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23419general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23420@var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23421written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23422derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23423specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23424own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23425work only in very specific, simple cases.
23426
23427Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23428in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23429set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23430example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23431forever!)
23432
23433@vindex IntegSimpRules
23434Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23435every time the integrator uses @kbd{a s} to simplify an intermediate
23436result. For example, putting the rule @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into
23437@code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to convert the @code{twice}
23438function into a form it knows whenever integration is attempted.
23439
23440One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23441the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23442integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23443defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23444be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23445systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23446do this.)
23447
23448@vindex IntegAfterRules
23449Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23450expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23451this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23452above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23453you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23454runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23455an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23456(It also does an @kbd{a s}, without @code{IntegSimpRules}, after that
23457to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23458sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23459the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23460form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23461@code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23462of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23463@code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23464finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23465@code{IntegSimpRules}.
23466
23467@node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23468@subsection Numerical Integration
23469
23470@noindent
23471@kindex a I
23472@pindex calc-num-integral
23473@tindex ninteg
23474If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23475use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23476command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23477upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23478that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23479value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23480
23481Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23482the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23483that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23484it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23485the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23486integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23487have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23488determine the value of the integral.
23489
23490Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23491best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23492before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23493@kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23494to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23495well-behaved in the specified interval.
23496
23497It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23498infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23499internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23500limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23501The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23502by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23503because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23504
23505@node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23506@subsection Taylor Series
23507
23508@noindent
23509@kindex a t
23510@pindex calc-taylor
23511@tindex taylor
23512The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23513power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23514variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23515the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23516of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23517You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23518otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23519many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23520may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23521
23522If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23523function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23524Taylor series.
23525
23526@node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23527@section Solving Equations
23528
23529@noindent
23530@kindex a S
23531@pindex calc-solve-for
23532@tindex solve
23533@cindex Equations, solving
23534@cindex Solving equations
23535The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23536an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23537expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23538will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23539input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23540form @expr{X = 0}.
23541
23542This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23543Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23544be; for example, solving
23545@texline @math{a < b \, c}
23546@infoline @expr{a < b c}
23547for @expr{b} is impossible
23548without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23549produce the result
23550@texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23551@infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23552(using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23553inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23554@texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23555@infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23556is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23557Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23558
23559Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23560@kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23561to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23562another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23563
23564@menu
23565* Multiple Solutions::
23566* Solving Systems of Equations::
23567* Decomposing Polynomials::
23568@end menu
23569
23570@node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23571@subsection Multiple Solutions
23572
23573@noindent
23574@kindex H a S
23575@tindex fsolve
23576Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23577(@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23578general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23579@code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23580@code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23581signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23582flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23583one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23584and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23585the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23586(@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23587of these variables.
23588
23589For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23590get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23591equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23592think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23593two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23594single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23595Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23596the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23597
23598There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23599we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23600to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23601some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23602Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23603in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23604solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23605happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23606
23607@cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23608@vindex GenCount
23609@ignore
23610@starindex
23611@end ignore
23612@tindex an
23613@ignore
23614@starindex
23615@end ignore
23616@tindex as
23617If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23618then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23619arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23620where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23621@code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23622integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23623new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23624arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23625session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23626of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23627you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23628using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23629on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23630command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23631
23632The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23633way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23634
23635If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23636in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23637@code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23638
23639@kindex I a S
23640@kindex H I a S
23641@tindex finv
23642@tindex ffinv
23643With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23644on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23645to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23646For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23647You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23648fully general inverse, as described above.
23649
23650@kindex a P
23651@pindex calc-poly-roots
23652@tindex roots
23653Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23654of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23655command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23656all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23657variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23658a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23659values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23660For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23661@samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23662polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23663(If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23664variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23665reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23666
23667Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23668symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23669note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23670to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23671can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23672can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23673which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23674for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23675@expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23676into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23677list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23678is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23679@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23680formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23681@kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23682are all numbers (real or complex).
23683
23684@node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23685@subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23686
23687@noindent
23688@cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23689You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23690simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23691specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23692the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23693at the prompt.)
23694
23695For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23696and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23697@samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23698have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23699will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23700are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23701@expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23702command.
23703
23704Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23705time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23706substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23707possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23708first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23709equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23710and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23711equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23712solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23713nonlinear systems.
23714
23715@ignore
23716@starindex
23717@end ignore
23718@tindex elim
23719Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23720give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23721of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23722typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23723would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
23724express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
23725the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
23726variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
23727variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
23728the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
23729For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
23730@samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
23731
23732If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
23733Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
23734and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
23735@kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
23736eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
23737by one.
23738
23739Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
23740equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
23741to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
23742number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
23743the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
23744the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
23745variables you requested.)
23746
23747Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
23748equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
23749to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
23750
23751@node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
23752@subsection Decomposing Polynomials
23753
23754@noindent
23755@ignore
23756@starindex
23757@end ignore
23758@tindex poly
23759The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
23760arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
23761coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
23762@expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
23763the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
23764not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
23765of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
23766coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
23767The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
23768note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
23769Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
23770@samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
23771
23772@cindex Coefficients of polynomial
23773@cindex Degree of polynomial
23774To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
23775@samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
23776use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
23777returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
23778gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
23779
23780@ignore
23781@starindex
23782@end ignore
23783@tindex gpoly
23784One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
23785formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
23786made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
23787is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
23788If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
23789this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
23790where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
23791vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
23792and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
23793@samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
23794@var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
23795guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
23796(i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
23797considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
23798and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
23799their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
23800is considered trivial.
23801
23802For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
23803since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
23804
23805The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
23806done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
23807@samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
23808since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
23809a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
23810
23811A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
23812discover:
23813
23814@smallexample
23815sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
23816x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
23817x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
23818x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
23819x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
23820x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
23821(exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
23822@end smallexample
23823
23824The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
23825which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
23826If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
23827or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
23828call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
23829can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
23830@samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
23831can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
23832
23833@ignore
23834@starindex
23835@end ignore
23836@tindex pdeg
23837The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
23838@samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
23839@code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
23840much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
23841then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
23842(e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
23843It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
23844@samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
23845polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
23846that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
23847the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
23848(minus infinity).
23849
23850@ignore
23851@starindex
23852@end ignore
23853@tindex plead
23854The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
23855Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
23856though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
23857returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
23858value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
23859
23860@ignore
23861@starindex
23862@end ignore
23863@tindex pcont
23864The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
23865is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
23866With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
23867to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
23868GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
23869@samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
23870basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
23871exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
23872coefficient.
23873
23874With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
23875content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
23876coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
23877is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
23878the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
23879denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
23880Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
23881denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
23882numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
23883if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
23884
23885@ignore
23886@starindex
23887@end ignore
23888@tindex pprim
23889The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
23890polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
23891if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
23892coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
23893terms.
23894
23895@node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
23896@section Numerical Solutions
23897
23898@noindent
23899Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
23900section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
23901instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
23902numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
23903good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
23904
23905(@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
23906on numerical data.)
23907
23908@menu
23909* Root Finding::
23910* Minimization::
23911* Numerical Systems of Equations::
23912@end menu
23913
23914@node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
23915@subsection Root Finding
23916
23917@noindent
23918@kindex a R
23919@pindex calc-find-root
23920@tindex root
23921@cindex Newton's method
23922@cindex Roots of equations
23923@cindex Numerical root-finding
23924The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
23925numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
23926inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
23927of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
23928
23929The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
23930stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
23931solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
23932that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
23933a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
23934evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
23935value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
23936this command.
23937
23938When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
23939by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
23940solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
23941righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
23942number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
23943slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
23944number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
23945the equation yourself.)
23946
23947The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
23948the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
23949
23950The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
23951for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
23952case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
23953solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
23954to real numbers inside that interval.
23955
23956Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
23957If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
23958differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
23959appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
23960can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
23961with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
23962complex number, the function must be differentiable.
23963
23964If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
23965is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
23966the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
23967Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
23968positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
23969an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
23970
23971@kindex H a R
23972@tindex wroot
23973The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
23974that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
23975the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
23976Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
23977you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
23978
23979If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
23980instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
23981process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
23982@emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
23983require a bounding interval in order to work.)
23984
23985If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
23986form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
23987no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
23988(@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
23989
23990@node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
23991@subsection Minimization
23992
23993@noindent
23994@kindex a N
23995@kindex H a N
23996@kindex a X
23997@kindex H a X
23998@pindex calc-find-minimum
23999@pindex calc-find-maximum
24000@tindex minimize
24001@tindex maximize
24002@cindex Minimization, numerical
24003The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
24004finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
24005to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
24006guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
24007may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
24008the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
24009value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
24010with the minimum value itself.
24011
24012Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
24013have more than one minimum; some, like
24014@texline @math{x \sin x},
24015@infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
24016have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
24017``global'' minimum of
24018@texline @math{x \sin x}
24019@infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
24020but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
24021for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
24022finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
24023and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
24024
24025If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
24026occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
24027that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
24028over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
24029@expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
24030use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
24031range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
24032any, that happens to lie in that range.
24033
24034Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
24035of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
24036variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
24037you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
24038answer.
24039
24040@ignore
24041@mindex wmin@idots
24042@end ignore
24043@tindex wminimize
24044@ignore
24045@mindex wmax@idots
24046@end ignore
24047@tindex wmaximize
24048The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
24049expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
24050that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
24051
24052The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
24053@kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
24054negative of the formula you supply.
24055
24056The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
24057interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
24058the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
24059over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
24060be minimized over the reals.
24061
24062@node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
24063@subsection Systems of Equations
24064
24065@noindent
24066@cindex Systems of equations, numerical
24067The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
24068case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
24069guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
24070supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
24071can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
24072equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
24073work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
24074values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
24075between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
24076There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
24077only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
24078no effect when solving a system of equations.
24079
24080It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
24081(or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
24082be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
24083be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
24084multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
24085still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
24086multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
24087
24088@node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
24089@section Curve Fitting
24090
24091@noindent
24092The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
24093such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
24094to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
24095no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
24096case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
24097possible fit. The model formula can be entered in various ways after
24098the key sequence @kbd{a F} is pressed.
24099
24100If the letter @kbd{P} is pressed after @kbd{a F} but before the model
24101description is entered, the data as well as the model formula will be
24102plotted after the formula is determined. This will be indicated by a
24103``P'' in the minibuffer after the help message.
24104
24105@menu
24106* Linear Fits::
24107* Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
24108* Error Estimates for Fits::
24109* Standard Nonlinear Models::
24110* Curve Fitting Details::
24111* Interpolation::
24112@end menu
24113
24114@node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24115@subsection Linear Fits
24116
24117@noindent
24118@kindex a F
24119@pindex calc-curve-fit
24120@tindex fit
24121@cindex Linear regression
24122@cindex Least-squares fits
24123The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24124to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24125straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24126moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24127will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24128fit for the data.
24129
24130In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24131data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24132by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24133values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24134@expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24135instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24136we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24137@expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24138
24139In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24140the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24141variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24142the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24143
24144The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24145By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24146for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24147@texline @math{2\times N}
24148@infoline 2xN
24149matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24150row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24151shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24152@expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24153
24154If you happen to have an
24155@texline @math{N\times2}
24156@infoline Nx2
24157matrix instead of a
24158@texline @math{2\times N}
24159@infoline 2xN
24160matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24161
24162After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24163linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24164
24165Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24166high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24167low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24168variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24169by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24170independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24171name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24172
24173For example, suppose the data matrix
24174
24175@ifnottex
24176@example
24177@group
24178[ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24179 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24180@end group
24181@end example
24182@end ifnottex
24183@tex
24184\turnoffactive
24185\turnoffactive
24186\beforedisplay
24187$$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24188 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24189$$
24190\afterdisplay
24191@end tex
24192
24193@noindent
24194is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24195@kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24196the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3. + 2. x}
24197on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24198then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24199data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24200substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24201formula.
24202
24203The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24204always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24205a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24206@expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24207than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24208to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24209
24210Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24211resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24212Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24213the equations that go into the trail.
24214
24215@tex
24216\bigskip
24217@end tex
24218
24219To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24220the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24221The result is:
24222
24223@example
242242.6 + 2.2 x
24225@end example
24226
24227Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24228a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24229
24230@example
24231[4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24232@end example
24233
24234Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24235Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24236the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24237error measure
24238
24239@ifnottex
24240@example
24241chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24242@end example
24243@end ifnottex
24244@tex
24245\turnoffactive
24246\beforedisplay
24247$$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24248\afterdisplay
24249@end tex
24250
24251@noindent
24252which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24253and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24254corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24255summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24256@texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24257@infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24258Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24259for which the error
24260@texline @math{\chi^2}
24261@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24262is as small as possible.
24263
24264Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24265formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24266
24267@tex
24268\bigskip
24269@end tex
24270
24271A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24272data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24273will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24274of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24275is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24276
24277A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24278items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24279vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24280the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24281in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24282
24283@node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24284@subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24285
24286@noindent
24287To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24288digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24289we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24290(with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24291@kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24292
24293@example
242942.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24295@end example
24296
24297Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24298data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24299for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24300to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24301an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24302Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24303the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24304won't help.)
24305
24306Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24307gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24308line slightly to improve the fit.
24309
24310@example
243110.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24312@end example
24313
24314An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24315is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24316of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24317Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24318a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24319
24320@example
243210.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24322@end example
24323
24324The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24325@expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24326It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24327digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24328Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24329results.
24330
24331You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24332the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24333columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24334automatically.
24335
24336Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24337a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24338wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24339if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24340extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24341command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24342
24343@tex
24344\bigskip
24345@end tex
24346
24347Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24348@expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24349@expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24350selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24351is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24352
24353Given the data matrix,
24354
24355@example
24356@group
24357[ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24358 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24359 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24360@end group
24361@end example
24362
24363@noindent
24364the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24365second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24366model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24367
24368@example
243698. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24370@end example
24371
24372Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24373(i.e., with any number of data rows).
24374
24375@tex
24376\bigskip
24377@end tex
24378
24379Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24380the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24381means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24382case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24383case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24384a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24385@kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24386This will be indicated by an ``h'' in the minibuffer after the help
24387message.
24388
24389It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24390like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24391key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24392any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24393would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24394
24395Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24396are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24397
24398@node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24399@subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24400
24401@noindent
24402@kindex H a F
24403@tindex efit
24404With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24405fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24406forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24407with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24408
24409@example
244103. + 2. x
244112.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24412@end example
24413
24414In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24415fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24416moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24417
24418It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24419contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24420or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24421go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24422row contains error forms
24423@texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24424@infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24425then the
24426@texline @math{\chi^2}
24427@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24428statistic is now,
24429
24430@ifnottex
24431@example
24432chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24433@end example
24434@end ifnottex
24435@tex
24436\turnoffactive
24437\beforedisplay
24438$$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24439\afterdisplay
24440@end tex
24441
24442@noindent
24443so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24444the fitting operation.
24445
24446If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24447errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24448sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24449@texline @math{\sigma_i}
24450@infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24451used for the data point.
24452
24453Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24454matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24455probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24456estimates.
24457
24458If the input contains error forms but all the
24459@texline @math{\sigma_i}
24460@infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24461values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24462will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24463@texline (@math{\chi^2}
24464@infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24465is simply scaled uniformly by
24466@texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24467@infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24468which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24469a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24470@kbd{H a F}.
24471
24472Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24473of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24474interpreted.
24475
24476@tex
24477\bigskip
24478@end tex
24479
24480@kindex I a F
24481@tindex xfit
24482With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24483information. The result is a vector of six items:
24484
24485@enumerate
24486@item
24487The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24488parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24489produced.
24490
24491@item
24492A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24493polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24494same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24495@kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24496will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24497
24498@item
24499The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24500an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24501@texline @math{C_{jj}}
24502@infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24503are the variances
24504@texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24505@infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24506of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24507@texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24508@infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24509that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24510set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24511@texline @math{r_{ij}},
24512@infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24513are defined as
24514@texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24515@infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24516
24517@item
24518A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24519meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24520will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24521polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24522
24523@item
24524The value of
24525@texline @math{\chi^2}
24526@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24527for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24528measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24529@texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24530@infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24531to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24532data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24533
24534@item
24535A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24536This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24537function using
24538@texline @math{\chi^2}
24539@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24540with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24541value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24542@expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24543particular,
24544@texline @math{\chi^2}
24545@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24546statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24547follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24548have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24549
24550The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24551estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24552for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24553@texline @math{\chi^2}
24554@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24555value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24556in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24557over to use for a confidence test.
24558@end enumerate
24559
24560@node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24561@subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24562
24563@noindent
24564The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24565lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24566abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24567
24568Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24569
24570@table @kbd
24571@item 1
24572Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24573@item 2-9
24574Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24575@item e
24576Exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24577@item E
24578Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24579@item x
24580Exponential (alternate notation). @tfn{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24581@item X
24582Base-10 exponential (alternate). @tfn{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24583@item l
24584Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24585@item L
24586Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24587@item ^
24588General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24589@item p
24590Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24591@item q
24592Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24593@item g
24594Gaussian.
24595@texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24596@infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24597@item s
24598Logistic @emph{s} curve.
24599@texline @math{a/(1+e^{b(x-c)})}.
24600@infoline @mathit{a/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))}.
24601@item b
24602Logistic bell curve.
24603@texline @math{ae^{b(x-c)}/(1+e^{b(x-c)})^2}.
24604@infoline @mathit{a exp(b (x - c))/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))^2}.
24605@item o
24606Hubbert linearization.
24607@texline @math{{y \over x} = a(1-x/b)}.
24608@infoline @mathit{(y/x) = a (1 - x/b)}.
24609@end table
24610
24611All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24612letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24613result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24614values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24615the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24616
24617All models except Gaussian, logistics, Hubbert and polynomials can
24618generalize as shown to any number of independent variables. Also, all
24619the built-in models except for the logistic and Hubbert curves have an
24620additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24621which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24622before the model key.
24623
24624Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24625the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24626the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24627each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24628with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24629matches the problem.
24630
24631The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24632fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24633These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24634@samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24635@expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24636@expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24637
24638@tex
24639\bigskip
24640@end tex
24641
24642If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24643(the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24644formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24645will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24646
24647The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24648In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24649equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24650(@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24651and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24652do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24653implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24654model.
24655
24656When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24657the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24658default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24659(in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24660Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24661and thus does not need a name.
24662
24663For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24664and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24665Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24666data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24667enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24668as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24669variables.
24670
24671You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24672different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24673those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24674be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24675and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24676If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24677in the model formula will become parameters.
24678
24679If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24680for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24681will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24682another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24683a linear model.
24684
24685If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24686Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24687appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24688choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24689which are parameters.
24690
24691Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24692two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24693@expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24694and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24695(If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24696those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24697
24698When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24699describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24700
24701@tex
24702\bigskip
24703@end tex
24704
24705@vindex Model1
24706@vindex Model2
24707Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24708@code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24709@kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24710the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24711accept for a model on the stack.
24712
24713@tex
24714\bigskip
24715@end tex
24716
24717Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24718and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24719the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24720form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24721returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24722equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24723believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24724so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24725@texline @math{3\times360}
24726@infoline @mathit{3*360}
24727degrees.
24728The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
24729true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
24730would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
24731@samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
24732the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
24733No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
24734even approximately.
24735
24736There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
24737restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
24738doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
24739Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
24740Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
24741(Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
24742taking Fourier and related transforms.)
24743
24744@node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
24745@subsection Curve Fitting Details
24746
24747@noindent
24748Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
24749models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
24750@expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
24751are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
24752(of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
24753
24754In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
24755to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
24756is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
24757and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
24758
24759For most other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
24760to try to put the problem into the form
24761
24762@smallexample
24763Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
24764@end smallexample
24765
24766@noindent
24767where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
24768@expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
24769does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
24770and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
24771in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
24772
24773A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
24774We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
24775model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
24776can be rewritten as follows:
24777
24778@example
24779y = a x^b
24780y = a exp(b ln(x))
24781y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
24782ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
24783@end example
24784
24785@noindent
24786which matches the desired form with
24787@texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
24788@infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
24789@texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
24790@infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
24791@expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
24792@texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
24793@infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
24794Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
24795does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
24796@texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
24797@infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
24798and @expr{b = B}.
24799
24800Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
24801be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
24802
24803@example
24804y = a + b*(x - c)^2
24805y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
24806@end example
24807
24808@noindent
24809which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
24810@expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
24811have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
24812@expr{H = x^2}.
24813
24814The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
24815shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
24816exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
24817
24818The logistic models cannot be put into general linear form. For these
24819models, and the Hubbert linearization, Calc computes a rough
24820approximation for the parameters, then uses the Levenberg-Marquardt
24821iterative method to refine the approximations.
24822
24823Another model that cannot be put into general linear
24824form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
24825@expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
24826this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
24827constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
24828manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
24829graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
24830@kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
24831Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
24832Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
24833(the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
24834deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
24835
24836To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
24837store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
24838from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
24839
24840@tex
24841\bigskip
24842@end tex
24843
24844A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
24845@code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
24846functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
24847@texline @math{\chi^2}
24848@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24849sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
24850command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
24851special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
24852command can do the same thing by brute force.
24853
24854A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
24855fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
24856which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
24857to be minimized would be the value of
24858@texline @math{\chi^2}
24859@infoline @expr{chi^2}
24860returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
24861
24862@smallexample
24863minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
24864@end smallexample
24865
24866@noindent
24867where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
24868@code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
24869the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
24870This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
24871rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
24872were used by itself to solve the problem).
24873
24874@tex
24875\bigskip
24876@end tex
24877
24878The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
24879nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
24880vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
24881covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
24882The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
24883is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
24884as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
24885and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
24886in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
24887parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
24888of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
24889parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
24890@samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
24891and so on.
24892
24893When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
24894@samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
24895parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
24896evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
24897values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
24898@kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
24899Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
24900matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
24901standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
24902
24903If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
24904that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
24905@emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
24906figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
24907nontrivial filter functions.
24908
24909Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
24910Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
24911@expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
24912data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
24913of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
24914and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
24915form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
24916linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
24917form. The error part of that result is used for
24918@texline @math{\sigma_i}
24919@infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24920for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
24921an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
24922@texline @math{\sigma_i}.
24923@infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
24924Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
24925for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
24926the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
24927arithmetic with no error forms.
24928
24929(While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
24930the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
24931depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
24932often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
24933and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
24934@texline @math{\sigma}
24935@infoline @expr{sigma}
24936for the data point with no further ado.)
24937
24938@tex
24939\bigskip
24940@end tex
24941
24942@vindex FitRules
24943It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
24944but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
24945its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
24946rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
24947variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
24948a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
24949@xref{Operations on Variables}.
24950
24951@xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
24952
24953@ignore
24954@starindex
24955@end ignore
24956@tindex fitvar
24957@ignore
24958@starindex
24959@end ignore
24960@ignore
24961@mindex @idots
24962@end ignore
24963@tindex fitparam
24964@ignore
24965@starindex
24966@end ignore
24967@ignore
24968@mindex @null
24969@end ignore
24970@tindex fitmodel
24971@ignore
24972@starindex
24973@end ignore
24974@ignore
24975@mindex @null
24976@end ignore
24977@tindex fitsystem
24978@ignore
24979@starindex
24980@end ignore
24981@ignore
24982@mindex @null
24983@end ignore
24984@tindex fitdummy
24985Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
24986to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
24987call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
24988function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
24989Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
24990@samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
24991to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
24992is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
24993model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
24994
24995@smallexample
24996@group
24997fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
24998@end group
24999@end smallexample
25000
25001Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
25002(The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
25003changes are possible.)
25004
25005When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
25006been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
25007
25008@example
25009fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
25010@end example
25011
25012@noindent
25013where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
25014@var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
25015and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
25016raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
25017for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
25018the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
25019parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
25020
25021The power law model eventually boils down to
25022
25023@smallexample
25024@group
25025fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
25026 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
25027 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
25028@end group
25029@end smallexample
25030
25031The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
25032proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
25033to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
25034@code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
25035can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
25036be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
25037non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
25038and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
25039Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
25040@samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
25041are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
25042linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
25043will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
25044
25045Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
25046and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
25047form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
25048initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
25049to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
25050from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
25051calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
25052this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
25053four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
25054@var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
25055empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
25056raw parameters, for now.)
25057
25058Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
25059of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
25060terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
25061is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
25062factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
25063that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
25064is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
25065complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
25066with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
25067using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
25068raw parameters needed.
25069
25070Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
25071@var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
25072were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
25073computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
25074time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
25075removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
25076to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
25077least-squares solver wants to see.
25078
25079@ignore
25080@starindex
25081@end ignore
25082@ignore
25083@mindex hasfit@idots
25084@end ignore
25085@tindex hasfitparams
25086@ignore
25087@starindex
25088@end ignore
25089@ignore
25090@mindex @null
25091@end ignore
25092@tindex hasfitvars
25093Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
25094are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
25095whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
25096respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
25097argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
25098calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
25099nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
25100returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
25101or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
25102
25103@tex
25104\bigskip
25105@end tex
25106
25107The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
25108arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
25109where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
25110@kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
25111independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
25112and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
25113must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
25114an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
25115a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25116allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25117
25118If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25119@var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25120is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25121@var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25122and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25123
25124Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25125where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25126and variables, as discussed previously.
25127
25128If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25129in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25130message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25131linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25132
25133The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25134(for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25135
25136@node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25137@subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25138
25139@kindex a p
25140@pindex calc-poly-interp
25141@tindex polint
25142The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25143a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25144two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25145@kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25146value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25147then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25148approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25149use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25150efficient and more numerically stable.)
25151
25152The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25153value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25154estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25155@expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25156in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25157value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25158
25159A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25160y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25161
25162If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25163interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25164have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25165If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25166remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25167a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25168
25169In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25170on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25171
25172@kindex H a p
25173@tindex ratint
25174The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25175interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25176uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25177@expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25178each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25179have degree one higher than the numerator).
25180
25181Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25182describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25183goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25184goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25185function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25186is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25187
25188There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25189used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25190explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25191capabilities to fit.)
25192
25193@node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25194@section Summations
25195
25196@noindent
25197@cindex Summation of a series
25198@kindex a +
25199@pindex calc-summation
25200@tindex sum
25201The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25202the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25203is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25204name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25205sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25206enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25207any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25208the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25209produces the result 55.
25210@tex
25211\turnoffactive
25212$$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25213@end tex
25214
25215The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25216use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25217@code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25218in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25219as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25220be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25221If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25222@w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25223(@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25224
25225A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25226than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25227yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25228argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25229step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25230a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25231@kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25232the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25233upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25234
25235Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25236@samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25237this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25238exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25239transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25240and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25241and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25242lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25243just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25244whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25245
25246The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25247@samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25248If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25249omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25250is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25251and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25252
25253Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25254returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25255form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25256formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25257for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25258infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25259solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25260symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25261
25262As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25263described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25264expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25265the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25266valid subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25267@samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25268
25269The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25270@samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25271Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25272@samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25273after simplification as if by @kbd{a s}, evaluate to an integer.
25274
25275If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25276not come out to an integer, the sum is invalid and will be left
25277in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25278you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25279substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25280@samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25281evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25282the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25283
25284If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25285positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25286Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25287exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25288of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25289but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25290if Calc used a closed form solution.
25291
25292Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25293and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25294used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25295@samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25296prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25297its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25298as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25299@samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25300squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25301there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25302closed form.
25303
25304As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25305sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25306one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25307@samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25308the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25309this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25310formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25311Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25312@samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25313an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25314@texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25315@infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25316then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25317will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25318
25319@cindex Alternating sums
25320@kindex a -
25321@pindex calc-alt-summation
25322@tindex asum
25323The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25324computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25325are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25326to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25327are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25328@samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25329if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25330series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25331(Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25332it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25333Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25334namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25335
25336@cindex Product of a sequence
25337@kindex a *
25338@pindex calc-product
25339@tindex prod
25340The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25341the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25342some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25343Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25344or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25345
25346@kindex a T
25347@pindex calc-tabulate
25348@tindex table
25349The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25350evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25351like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25352vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25353produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25354
25355@node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25356@section Logical Operations
25357
25358@noindent
25359The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25360where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25361a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25362rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25363nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25364for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25365which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25366Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25367portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25368``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25369provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25370have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25371unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25372false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25373
25374@kindex a =
25375@pindex calc-equal-to
25376@tindex eq
25377@tindex =
25378@tindex ==
25379The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25380(which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25381formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25382are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25383numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
253841.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25385the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25386operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25387a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25388
25389Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25390For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25391an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25392(@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25393function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25394multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25395@kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25396@samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25397zero if not.
25398
25399The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25400or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25401algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25402neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25403same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25404one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25405variables).
25406
25407@kindex a #
25408@pindex calc-not-equal-to
25409@tindex neq
25410@tindex !=
25411The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25412@samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25413This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25414tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25415distinct numbers.
25416
25417@kindex a <
25418@tindex lt
25419@ignore
25420@mindex @idots
25421@end ignore
25422@kindex a >
25423@ignore
25424@mindex @null
25425@end ignore
25426@kindex a [
25427@ignore
25428@mindex @null
25429@end ignore
25430@kindex a ]
25431@pindex calc-less-than
25432@pindex calc-greater-than
25433@pindex calc-less-equal
25434@pindex calc-greater-equal
25435@ignore
25436@mindex @null
25437@end ignore
25438@tindex gt
25439@ignore
25440@mindex @null
25441@end ignore
25442@tindex leq
25443@ignore
25444@mindex @null
25445@end ignore
25446@tindex geq
25447@ignore
25448@mindex @null
25449@end ignore
25450@tindex <
25451@ignore
25452@mindex @null
25453@end ignore
25454@tindex >
25455@ignore
25456@mindex @null
25457@end ignore
25458@tindex <=
25459@ignore
25460@mindex @null
25461@end ignore
25462@tindex >=
25463The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25464operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25465are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25466@kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25467@kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25468
25469While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25470than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25471equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25472(See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25473of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25474of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25475@samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25476involve both equalities and inequalities, are not allowed.
25477
25478@kindex a .
25479@pindex calc-remove-equal
25480@tindex rmeq
25481The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25482the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25483stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25484@samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25485@samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25486variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25487Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25488assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25489righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25490taking the lefthand side.
25491
25492@kindex a &
25493@pindex calc-logical-and
25494@tindex land
25495@tindex &&
25496The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25497function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25498non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25499@expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25500zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25501
25502@kindex a |
25503@pindex calc-logical-or
25504@tindex lor
25505@tindex ||
25506The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25507function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25508The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25509are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25510zero.
25511
25512@kindex a !
25513@pindex calc-logical-not
25514@tindex lnot
25515@tindex !
25516The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25517function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25518true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25519number.
25520
25521@kindex a :
25522@pindex calc-logical-if
25523@tindex if
25524@ignore
25525@mindex ? :
25526@end ignore
25527@tindex ?
25528@ignore
25529@mindex @null
25530@end ignore
25531@tindex :
25532@cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25533The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25534function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25535number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25536left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25537any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25538whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25539is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25540@code{condition}.
25541
25542One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25543will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25544as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25545@samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25546
25547As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25548and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25549as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25550@expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25551is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25552vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25553with all elements of @expr{a}.
25554
25555@kindex a @{
25556@pindex calc-in-set
25557@tindex in
25558The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25559the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25560If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25561encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25562equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25563intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25564plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25565@xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25566of this sort.
25567
25568@ignore
25569@starindex
25570@end ignore
25571@tindex typeof
25572The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25573characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25574the result will be one of the following numbers:
25575
25576@example
25577 1 Integer
25578 2 Fraction
25579 3 Floating-point number
25580 4 HMS form
25581 5 Rectangular complex number
25582 6 Polar complex number
25583 7 Error form
25584 8 Interval form
25585 9 Modulo form
2558610 Date-only form
2558711 Date/time form
2558812 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25589100 Variable
25590101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25591102 Matrix
25592@end example
25593
25594Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25595represents the name of the top-level function call.
25596
25597@ignore
25598@starindex
25599@end ignore
25600@tindex integer
25601@ignore
25602@starindex
25603@end ignore
25604@tindex real
25605@ignore
25606@starindex
25607@end ignore
25608@tindex constant
25609The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25610The @samp{real(a)} function
25611is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25612float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25613any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25614code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25615an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25616Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25617special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25618
25619@xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25620formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25621is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25622@samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25623literally an integer constant.
25624
25625@ignore
25626@starindex
25627@end ignore
25628@tindex refers
25629The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25630@expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25631tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25632even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25633@code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25634variable (different from @expr{b}).
25635
25636@ignore
25637@starindex
25638@end ignore
25639@tindex negative
25640The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25641because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25642or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25643This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25644evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25645be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25646first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25647as a rewrite rule condition).
25648
25649@ignore
25650@starindex
25651@end ignore
25652@tindex variable
25653The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25654or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25655in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25656are considered variables like any others by this test.
25657
25658@ignore
25659@starindex
25660@end ignore
25661@tindex nonvar
25662The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25663If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25664actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25665commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25666often good enough.
25667
25668@ignore
25669@starindex
25670@end ignore
25671@tindex lin
25672@ignore
25673@starindex
25674@end ignore
25675@tindex linnt
25676@ignore
25677@starindex
25678@end ignore
25679@tindex islin
25680@ignore
25681@starindex
25682@end ignore
25683@tindex islinnt
25684@cindex Linearity testing
25685The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25686check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25687@expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25688variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25689if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25690example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25691@samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25692is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25693@expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25694@expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25695@expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25696generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25697e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25698argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25699returns true.
25700
25701The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25702but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25703@expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25704returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25705but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25706(in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25707linear in @expr{x}).
25708
25709All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25710argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25711formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25712trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25713recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25714@samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25715returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25716first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25717@code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25718case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25719
25720@ignore
25721@starindex
25722@end ignore
25723@tindex istrue
25724The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25725number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25726Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25727used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25728declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
25729@code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
25730it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
25731in symbolic form.)
25732
25733@node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
25734@section Rewrite Rules
25735
25736@noindent
25737@cindex Rewrite rules
25738@cindex Transformations
25739@cindex Pattern matching
25740@kindex a r
25741@pindex calc-rewrite
25742@tindex rewrite
25743The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
25744substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
25745known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
25746matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
25747matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
25748rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
25749@samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
25750it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
25751name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
25752
25753Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
25754@xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
25755similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
25756entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
25757Calc formulas.
25758
25759@menu
25760* Entering Rewrite Rules::
25761* Basic Rewrite Rules::
25762* Conditional Rewrite Rules::
25763* Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
25764* Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
25765* Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
25766* Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
25767* Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
25768* Selections with Rewrite Rules::
25769* Matching Commands::
25770* Automatic Rewrites::
25771* Debugging Rewrites::
25772* Examples of Rewrite Rules::
25773@end menu
25774
25775@node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25776@subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
25777
25778@noindent
25779Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
25780@samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
25781This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
25782The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
25783assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
25784Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
25785assignments in special ways.
25786
25787For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
25788every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
25789square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
25790on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
25791it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
25792
25793To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
25794rules.
25795
25796When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
25797in several ways:
25798
25799@enumerate
25800@item
25801With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
25802@item
25803With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
25804(You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
25805@item
25806With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
25807@kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
25808@item
25809With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
25810will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
25811and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
25812@kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
25813@item
25814With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
25815will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
25816rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
25817@end enumerate
25818
25819If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
25820in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
25821can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
25822
25823It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
25824invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
25825(@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
25826rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
25827(@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
25828@pxref{Operations on Variables}.
25829
25830Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
25831matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
25832every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
25833through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
25834along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
25835reason to store your rules in a variable.
25836
25837Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
25838@samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
25839vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
25840
25841@node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25842@subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
25843
25844@noindent
25845To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
25846@samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
25847the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
25848treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
25849may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
25850would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
25851@samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
25852@samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
25853@samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
25854that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
25855the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
25856
25857If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
25858corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
25859the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
25860@samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
25861(@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
25862
25863Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
25864and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
25865the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
25866pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
25867@samp{sin(a)+y}.
25868
25869The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
25870@samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
25871literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
25872@samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
25873
25874If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
25875formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
25876of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
25877that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
25878to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
25879
25880The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
25881throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
25882(up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
25883change at a time.
25884
25885@node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25886@subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
25887
25888@noindent
25889A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
25890@samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
25891form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
25892is present in the
25893rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
25894the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
25895to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
25896meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
25897with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}). If the result is a nonzero
25898number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
25899the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
25900formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
25901@xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
259021 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
25903
25904For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
25905is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
25906@expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
25907the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
25908@samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
25909(assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
25910@samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
25911the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
25912to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
25913
25914While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
25915formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
25916For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
25917of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
25918@samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
25919meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
25920@samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
25921reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
25922the condition.
25923
25924The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
25925function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
25926the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
25927
25928If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
25929or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
25930
25931It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
25932@samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
25933convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
25934effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
25935decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
25936matched.
25937
25938Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
25939system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
25940meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
25941@samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
25942is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
25943replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
25944where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
25945@samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
25946since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
25947
25948An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
25949will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
25950because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
25951evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
25952remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
25953number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
25954But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
25955is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
25956evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
25957
25958Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
25959condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
25960For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
25961the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
25962where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
25963lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
25964the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
25965the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
25966it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
25967
25968@node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25969@subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
25970
25971@noindent
25972The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
25973like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
25974the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
25975account:
25976
25977@smallexample
25978+ - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
25979@end smallexample
25980
25981For example, the rewrite rule:
25982
25983@example
25984a x + b x := (a + b) x
25985@end example
25986
25987@noindent
25988will match formulas of the form,
25989
25990@example
25991a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
25992@end example
25993
25994Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
25995operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
25996
25997@example
25998a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
25999@end example
26000
26001@noindent
26002by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
26003
26004Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
26005pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
26006will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
26007
26008In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
26009will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
26010like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
26011of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
26012being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
26013If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
26014four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
26015like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
26016
26017Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
26018rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
26019Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
26020literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
26021current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
26022if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
26023If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
26024enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
26025from occurring.
26026
26027The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
26028the rule
26029
26030@example
26031f(-x) := -f(x)
26032@end example
26033
26034@noindent
26035will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
26036a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
26037condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
26038``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
26039because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
26040condition is:
26041
26042@example
26043f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
26044f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
26045@end example
26046
26047In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
26048by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
26049
26050The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
26051@samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
26052will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
26053@samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
26054
26055Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
26056@samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
26057@samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
26058though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
26059Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
26060constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
26061and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
26062because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
26063for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
26064of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
26065
26066Even more subtle is the rule set
26067
26068@example
26069[ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
26070@end example
26071
26072@noindent
26073attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
26074will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
26075the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
26076Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
26077first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
26078does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
26079meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
26080not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
26081tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
26082@samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
26083rule will have to be added.
26084
26085Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
26086The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
26087involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
26088it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
26089of the above rule for complex numbers would be
26090
26091@example
26092myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
26093@end example
26094
26095@noindent
26096(Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
26097of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
26098@samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
26099without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
26100righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
26101conjugate of a real number.)
26102
26103It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
26104
26105@example
26106opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
26107@end example
26108
26109@noindent
26110will match the formula
26111
26112@example
261135 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
26114@end example
26115
26116@noindent
26117in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26118formulas like
26119
26120@example
26121x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26122@end example
26123
26124@noindent
26125producing, respectively,
26126
26127@example
26128f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26129@end example
26130
26131(The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26132have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26133
26134The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26135for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26136quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26137with @samp{a = -1}.
26138
26139In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26140
26141@example
26142opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26143@end example
26144
26145@noindent
26146so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26147
26148The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26149are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26150functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26151Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26152rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26153@samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26154but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26155for a multiplication, not a division.
26156
26157As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26158by 1,
26159
26160@example
26161sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26162@end example
26163
26164@noindent
26165misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26166an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26167
26168@example
26169opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26170@end example
26171
26172Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26173because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26174
26175Calc automatically converts a rule like
26176
26177@example
26178f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26179@end example
26180
26181@noindent
26182into the form
26183
26184@example
26185f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26186@end example
26187
26188@noindent
26189(where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26190doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26191match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26192respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26193@samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26194
26195However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26196following rule,
26197
26198@example
26199f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26200@end example
26201
26202@noindent
26203will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26204but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26205of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26206then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26207last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26208:= g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26209actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26210
26211A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26212You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26213@code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26214
26215@example
26216f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26217@end example
26218
26219Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26220which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26221only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26222elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26223careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26224which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26225@samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26226@samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26227
26228@smallexample
26229+ - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26230max min re im conj arg
26231@end smallexample
26232
26233You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26234section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26235This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26236matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26237negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26238``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26239For example,
26240
26241@example
26242plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26243@end example
26244
26245@noindent
26246will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26247marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26248commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26249the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26250@samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26251further and use
26252
26253@example
26254plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26255@end example
26256
26257@noindent
26258which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26259
26260By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26261function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26262The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26263
26264@example
26265quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26266@end example
26267
26268@noindent
26269will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26270
26271@example
26272quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26273@end example
26274
26275@noindent
26276will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26277effect!
26278
26279A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26280meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26281in the rule
26282
26283@example
26284a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26285@end example
26286
26287@noindent
26288matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26289taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26290righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26291the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26292special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26293default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26294a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26295If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26296marker on the righthand side:
26297
26298@example
26299a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26300@end example
26301
26302@noindent
26303In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26304use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26305always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26306
26307@node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26308@subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26309
26310@noindent
26311Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26312Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26313markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26314work in the righthand side of a rule.
26315
26316@ignore
26317@starindex
26318@end ignore
26319@tindex import
26320One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26321rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26322rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26323imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26324f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26325then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26326all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26327slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26328the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26329@texline @math{v_1},
26330@infoline @expr{v1},
26331as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26332@texline @math{x_1}
26333@infoline @expr{x1}
26334and so on. (If
26335@texline @math{v_1}
26336@infoline @expr{v1}
26337is used as a function name, then
26338@texline @math{x_1}
26339@infoline @expr{x1}
26340must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26341function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26342import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26343@samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26344import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26345
26346The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26347
26348@table @samp
26349@item quote(x)
26350@ignore
26351@starindex
26352@end ignore
26353@tindex quote
26354This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26355not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26356numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26357@samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26358(Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26359The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26360The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26361as a result in this case.)
26362
26363@item plain(x)
26364@ignore
26365@starindex
26366@end ignore
26367@tindex plain
26368Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26369pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26370argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26371function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26372associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26373are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26374as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26375@samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26376
26377@item opt(x,def)
26378@ignore
26379@starindex
26380@end ignore
26381@tindex opt
26382Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26383argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26384the argument or element is optional.
26385As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26386or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26387may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26388binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26389matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26390zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26391
26392For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26393must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26394the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26395@samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26396or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26397supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26398the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26399case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26400In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26401
26402@item condition(x,c)
26403@ignore
26404@starindex
26405@end ignore
26406@tindex condition
26407@tindex ::
26408This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26409@expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26410
26411@item pand(x,y)
26412@ignore
26413@starindex
26414@end ignore
26415@tindex pand
26416@tindex &&&
26417This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26418pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26419@pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26420
26421@item por(x,y)
26422@ignore
26423@starindex
26424@end ignore
26425@tindex por
26426@tindex |||
26427This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26428pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26429
26430@item pnot(x)
26431@ignore
26432@starindex
26433@end ignore
26434@tindex pnot
26435@tindex !!!
26436This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26437It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26438
26439@item cons(h,t)
26440@ignore
26441@mindex cons
26442@end ignore
26443@tindex cons (rewrites)
26444This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26445element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26446elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26447length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26448@samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26449to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26450
26451@item rcons(t,h)
26452@ignore
26453@mindex rcons
26454@end ignore
26455@tindex rcons (rewrites)
26456This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26457is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26458to @expr{t}.
26459
26460@item apply(f,args)
26461@ignore
26462@mindex apply
26463@end ignore
26464@tindex apply (rewrites)
26465This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26466the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26467of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26468matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26469do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26470@samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26471matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26472matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26473@samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26474to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26475way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26476need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26477would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26478Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26479
26480@example
26481apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26482 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26483@end example
26484
26485Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26486set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26487the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26488if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26489rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26490function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26491the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26492
26493Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26494considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26495with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26496
26497You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26498on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26499is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26500@samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26501Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26502when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26503evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26504Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26505or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26506@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26507
26508@item select(x)
26509@ignore
26510@starindex
26511@end ignore
26512@tindex select
26513This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26514@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26515@end table
26516
26517Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26518
26519@table @samp
26520@item quote(x)
26521The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26522righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26523@code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26524property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26525while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26526on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26527to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26528protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26529(@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26530protecting rules from evaluation.)
26531
26532@item plain(x)
26533Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26534@expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26535is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26536shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26537not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26538@samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26539rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26540
26541@item cons(h,t)
26542Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26543vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26544Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26545is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26546side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26547have been turned off.
26548
26549@item rcons(t,h)
26550Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26551the vector @expr{t}.
26552
26553@item apply(f,args)
26554Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26555is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26556is also a regular Calc function.
26557
26558@item eval(x)
26559@ignore
26560@starindex
26561@end ignore
26562@tindex eval
26563The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26564default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26565been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26566similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26567treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26568with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26569whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26570
26571@item evalsimp(x)
26572@ignore
26573@starindex
26574@end ignore
26575@tindex evalsimp
26576The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26577way, then algebraically simplified as if by the @kbd{a s} command.
26578
26579@item evalextsimp(x)
26580@ignore
26581@starindex
26582@end ignore
26583@tindex evalextsimp
26584The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26585way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26586
26587@item select(x)
26588@xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26589@end table
26590
26591There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26592
26593@table @samp
26594@item let(v := x)
26595@ignore
26596@starindex
26597@end ignore
26598@tindex let
26599The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26600The @kbd{a s} command's simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26601default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26602@code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26603of simplification. The
26604result of @expr{x} is then bound to the meta-variable @expr{v}. As
26605usual, if this meta-variable has already been matched to something
26606else the two values must be equal; if the meta-variable is new then
26607it is bound to the result of the expression. This variable can then
26608appear in later conditions, and on the righthand side of the rule.
26609In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26610evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26611meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26612can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26613@samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26614an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26615
26616The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26617Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26618assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26619in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26620
26621As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26622replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26623that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26624singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26625@samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26626then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26627to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26628Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26629in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26630because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26631be bound to @code{ia}.
26632
26633Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26634terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26635The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26636or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26637call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26638so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26639the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26640(It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26641righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26642rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26643
26644@ignore
26645@starindex
26646@end ignore
26647@tindex ierf
26648Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26649function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26650@code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26651where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26652is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26653@code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26654
26655@example
26656ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26657@end example
26658
26659@item matches(v,p)
26660The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26661to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26662@var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26663can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26664as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26665extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26666inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26667rule.
26668
26669The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26670@samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26671the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26672
26673@item remember
26674@vindex remember
26675This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26676appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26677the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26678front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26679was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26680lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26681contains any variables.
26682
26683For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26684to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26685of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26686differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26687the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26688Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26689
26690It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26691@code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26692:: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26693the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26694@code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26695be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26696@code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26697
26698@item remember(c)
26699@ignore
26700@starindex
26701@end ignore
26702@tindex remember
26703Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26704is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26705rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26706is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26707@end table
26708
26709@node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26710@subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26711
26712@noindent
26713There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26714that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26715combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26716these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26717and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26718
26719Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26720form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26721the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26722
26723The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26724matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26725when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26726here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26727
26728@example
26729f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
26730@end example
26731
26732This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
26733
26734@example
26735f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
26736@end example
26737
26738@ignore
26739@starindex
26740@end ignore
26741@tindex ends
26742Here's another interesting example:
26743
26744@example
26745ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
26746@end example
26747
26748@noindent
26749which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
26750the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
26751vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
26752
26753@example
26754ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
26755@end example
26756
26757@noindent
26758would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
26759one-element vector.
26760
26761@tex
26762\bigskip
26763@end tex
26764
26765The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
26766matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
26767against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
26768
26769@ignore
26770@starindex
26771@end ignore
26772@tindex curve
26773A simple example of @samp{|||} is
26774
26775@example
26776curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
26777@end example
26778
26779@noindent
26780which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
26781
26782Here is a larger example:
26783
26784@example
26785log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
26786@end example
26787
26788This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
26789Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
26790that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
26791
26792(In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
26793omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
26794
26795While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
26796conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
26797variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
26798bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
26799@samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
26800condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
26801Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
26802@code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
26803
26804Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
26805on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
26806you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
26807meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
26808
26809@example
26810f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
26811@end example
26812
26813Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
26814the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
26815
26816@tex
26817\bigskip
26818@end tex
26819
26820The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
26821match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
26822@var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
26823
26824For example,
26825
26826@example
26827f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
26828@end example
26829
26830@noindent
26831converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
26832error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
26833a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
26834
26835If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
26836then an equivalent rule would be:
26837
26838@example
26839f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
26840@end example
26841
26842@noindent
26843where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
26844Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
26845would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
26846returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
26847plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
26848@samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
26849the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
26850
26851It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
26852elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
26853
26854@example
26855f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
26856@end example
26857
26858@noindent
26859matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
26860this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
26861
26862If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
26863contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
26864matched last. Thus
26865
26866@example
26867f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
26868@end example
26869
26870@noindent
26871will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
26872before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
26873first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
26874disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
26875would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
26876therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
26877
26878@node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26879@subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
26880
26881@noindent
26882When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
26883the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
26884to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
26885and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
26886For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
26887they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
26888sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
26889to the @var{new} part of the rule.
26890
26891Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
26892The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
26893it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
26894so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
26895rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
26896(in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
26897to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
26898anywhere in the formula.
26899
26900It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
26901most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
26902because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
26903side actually comes out to something different than the original
26904formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
26905had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
26906@samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
26907run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
26908forms.
26909
26910To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
26911made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
26912but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
26913computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
26914halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
26915
26916To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
26917In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
26918useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
26919rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
26920
26921@ignore
26922@starindex
26923@end ignore
26924@ignore
26925@mindex iter@idots
26926@end ignore
26927@tindex iterations
26928You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
26929in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
26930the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
26931number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
26932@samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
26933A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
26934rule set.
26935
26936@example
26937[ iterations(1),
26938 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
26939@end example
26940
26941More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
26942where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
26943righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
26944default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
26945that was matched.
26946
26947A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
26948
26949Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
26950substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
26951will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
26952
26953In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
26954does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
26955being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
26956variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
26957iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
26958integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
26959the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
26960are omitted, 100 is used.
26961
26962@node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26963@subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
26964
26965@noindent
26966It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
26967During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
26968will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
26969phases occur during the rewriting process.
26970
26971@ignore
26972@starindex
26973@end ignore
26974@tindex phase
26975@vindex all
26976If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
26977vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
26978members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
26979Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
26980@samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
26981this is the default at the start of the rule set.
26982
26983If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
26984numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
26985ascending order. For example, the rule set
26986
26987@example
26988@group
26989[ f0(x) := g0(x),
26990 phase(1),
26991 f1(x) := g1(x),
26992 phase(2),
26993 f2(x) := g2(x),
26994 phase(3),
26995 f3(x) := g3(x),
26996 phase(1,2),
26997 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
26998@end group
26999@end example
27000
27001@noindent
27002has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
27003@code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
27004@code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
27005and @code{f3}.
27006
27007When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
27008the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
27009possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
27010until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
27011When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
27012assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
27013rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
27014early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
27015100 by default, is reached.)
27016
27017During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
27018formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
27019Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
27020way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
27021The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
27022in the formula.
27023
27024@ignore
27025@starindex
27026@end ignore
27027@tindex schedule
27028A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
27029conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
27030In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
27031for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
27032arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
27033@samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
27034reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
27035no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
27036would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
27037moving on to phase 3.
27038
27039Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
27040numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
27041described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
27042in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
27043tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
27044to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
27045further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
27046touches.
27047
27048Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
27049numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
27050to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
27051says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
27052call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
27053Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
27054phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
27055
27056Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
27057a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
27058and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
27059will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
27060Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
27061spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
27062
27063There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
27064rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
27065examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
27066command to convert a model expression to linear form.
27067@xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
27068The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
27069easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
27070linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
27071opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
27072If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
27073into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
27074
27075Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
27076then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
27077fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
27078If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
27079rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
27080before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
27081two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
27082
27083@node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27084@subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
27085
27086@noindent
27087If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
27088@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
27089command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
27090prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
27091specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
27092
27093@kindex j r
27094@pindex calc-rewrite-selection
27095The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
27096sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
27097the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
27098rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
27099of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
27100first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
27101(Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
27102this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
27103
27104For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
27105and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
27106be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
27107rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
27108include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
27109the selected sub-formula should appear.
27110
27111If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
27112the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
27113the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
27114formula will be unselected.
27115
27116You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27117of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27118allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27119Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27120the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27121work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27122to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27123stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27124
27125The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27126@kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27127argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27128@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27129
27130As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27131entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27132@samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27133at stack level 1.)
27134
27135If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27136top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27137cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27138rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27139target and the rewrite rules).
27140
27141If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27142the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27143command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27144the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27145markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27146to apply anywhere in the formula.
27147
27148As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27149@samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27150above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27151the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27152purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27153will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27154both with and without selections.
27155
27156@node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27157@subsection Matching Commands
27158
27159@noindent
27160@kindex a m
27161@pindex calc-match
27162@tindex match
27163The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27164vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27165a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27166prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27167a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27168vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27169you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27170from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27171and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27172patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27173of the patterns.
27174
27175For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27176will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27177
27178The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27179
27180The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27181which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27182all the positive vector elements.
27183
27184@kindex I a m
27185@tindex matchnot
27186With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27187vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27188
27189@ignore
27190@starindex
27191@end ignore
27192@tindex matches
27193There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27194evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27195to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27196conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27197
27198@ignore
27199@starindex
27200@end ignore
27201@tindex vmatches
27202The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27203that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27204the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27205@samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27206If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27207
27208@node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27209@subsection Automatic Rewrites
27210
27211@noindent
27212@cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27213@vindex EvalRules
27214It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27215results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27216simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27217variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27218for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27219
27220For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27221to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27222similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27223set would be,
27224
27225@smallexample
27226@group
27227[ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27228 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27229@end group
27230@end smallexample
27231
27232To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27233@code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27234to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27235variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27236sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27237the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27238@samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27239
27240As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27241@code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27242Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27243Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27244rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27245the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27246applies rules from the top down.
27247
27248Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27249override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27250
27251It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27252loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27253appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27254unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27255will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27256zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27257Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27258@samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27259@samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27260occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27261or ran too long'' message.
27262
27263Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27264concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27265example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27266already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27267if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27268further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27269get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27270replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27271@samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27272continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27273to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27274again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27275say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27276
27277(What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27278meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27279result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27280the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27281(and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27282form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27283same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27284are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27285this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27286see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27287rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27288the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27289the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27290
27291The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27292not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27293only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27294The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27295
27296The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27297but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27298nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27299to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27300might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27301to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27302rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27303will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27304
27305Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27306functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27307When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27308functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27309number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27310the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27311than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27312@code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27313would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27314@samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27315root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27316number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27317then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27318evaluated exactly to 5.)
27319
27320One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27321@code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27322of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27323effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27324then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27325reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27326For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27327attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27328the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27329an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27330a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27331@samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27332been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27333
27334If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27335anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27336
27337Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27338rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27339@code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27340particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27341function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27342only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27343but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27344
27345@smallexample
27346apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27347@end smallexample
27348
27349@noindent
27350may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27351@code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27352with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27353@emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27354
27355@cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27356@vindex AlgSimpRules
27357Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27358but only when @kbd{a s} is used to simplify the formula. The variable
27359@code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose. The @kbd{a s} command
27360will apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as
27361well as all of its built-in simplifications.
27362
27363Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27364@code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27365command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of @kbd{a s}.
27366It then applies its own built-in simplifications throughout the
27367formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with applying the
27368default simplifications) until no further changes are possible.
27369
27370@cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27371@cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27372@vindex ExtSimpRules
27373@vindex UnitSimpRules
27374There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27375that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27376also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27377@code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27378only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27379
27380@node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27381@subsection Debugging Rewrites
27382
27383@noindent
27384If a buffer named @samp{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27385record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27386formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27387and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27388noted.
27389
27390Calc always appends to @samp{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27391yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27392
27393Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27394@samp{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27395the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27396buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27397existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27398be needlessly slow.
27399
27400@node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27401@subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27402
27403@noindent
27404Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27405@samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27406@samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27407finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27408@samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27409if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27410but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27411
27412Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27413To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27414easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27415you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27416select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27417ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27418(@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27419
27420A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27421This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27422be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27423@samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27424Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27425evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27426useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27427@samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27428
27429As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27430with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27431this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27432a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27433to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27434stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27435be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27436the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27437the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27438@code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27439
27440@cindex Quaternions
27441The following rule set, contributed by
27442@texline Fran\c cois
27443@infoline Francois
27444Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27445complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27446represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27447@var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27448collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27449are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27450or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27451formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27452defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27453@key{RET}}.
27454
27455@smallexample
27456[ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27457 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27458 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27459 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27460 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27461 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27462 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27463 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27464 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27465 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27466 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27467 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27468 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27469 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27470 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27471 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27472 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27473 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27474 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27475@end smallexample
27476
27477Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27478In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27479@expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27480rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27481product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27482to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27483operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27484
27485These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27486it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27487results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27488@samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27489of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27490in @code{EvalRules}.)
27491
27492@node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27493@chapter Operating on Units
27494
27495@noindent
27496One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27497For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27498per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27499manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27500begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27501
27502@menu
27503* Basic Operations on Units::
27504* The Units Table::
27505* Predefined Units::
27506* User-Defined Units::
27507@end menu
27508
27509@node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27510@section Basic Operations on Units
27511
27512@noindent
27513A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27514multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27515optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27516be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27517expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27518where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27519formula.
27520
27521A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27522or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27523or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27524A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27525@pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27526@pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27527
27528Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27529it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27530formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27531display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27532representation of one millimeter.
27533
27534You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27535with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27536to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27537
27538@kindex u s
27539@pindex calc-simplify-units
27540@ignore
27541@mindex usimpl@idots
27542@end ignore
27543@tindex usimplify
27544The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27545simplifies a units
27546expression. It uses @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) to simplify the
27547expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27548features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27549to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27550simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27551added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27552lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27553automatically at all times.
27554
27555Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27556dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27557powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27558@samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27559@code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27560@code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27561applied to units expressions, in which case
27562the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27563expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27564of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27565
27566@kindex u c
27567@pindex calc-convert-units
27568The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27569expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27570expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27571@samp{24.5872 m/s}. If you have previously converted a units expression
27572with the same type of units (in this case, distance over time), you will
27573be offered the previous choice of new units as a default. Continuing
27574the above example, entering the units expression @samp{100 km/hr} and
27575typing @kbd{u c @key{RET}} (without specifying new units) produces
27576@samp{27.7777777778 m/s}.
27577
27578While many of Calc's conversion factors are exact, some are necessarily
27579approximate. If Calc is in fraction mode (@pxref{Fraction Mode}), then
27580unit conversions will try to give exact, rational conversions, but it
27581isn't always possible. Given @samp{55 mph} in fraction mode, typing
27582@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces @samp{15367:625 m/s}, for example,
27583while typing @kbd{u c au/yr @key{RET}} produces
27584@samp{5.18665819999e-3 au/yr}.
27585
27586If the units you request are inconsistent with the original units, the
27587number will be converted into your units times whatever ``remainder''
27588units are left over. For example, converting @samp{55 mph} into acres
27589produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}. (Recall that multiplication binds
27590more strongly than division in Calc formulas, so the units here are
27591acres per meter-second.) Remainder units are expressed in terms of
27592``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and @samp{s}, regardless of the
27593input units.
27594
27595One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27596a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27597that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27598remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27599given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27600change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27601The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27602changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27603
27604You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27605to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27606For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27607@kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27608(For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27609in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27610
27611In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27612units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27613For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27614International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27615converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27616except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27617whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27618
27619@cindex Composite units
27620The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27621are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27622example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27623feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27624sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27625It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27626using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27627to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27628may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27629standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27630@code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27631Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27632@samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27633
27634If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27635prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27636to have, then for the new units. Assuming the old and new units you
27637give are consistent with each other, the result also will not contain
285f0d3a
JB
27638any units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}}
27639converts the number 2 on the stack to 5.08.
4009494e
GM
27640
27641@kindex u b
27642@pindex calc-base-units
27643The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27644@kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27645stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27646units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27647
27648The @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u b} commands treat temperature units (like
27649@samp{degC} and @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example,
27650@kbd{u c} converts @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10
27651degrees Celsius corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit.
27652
27653@kindex u t
27654@pindex calc-convert-temperature
27655@cindex Temperature conversion
27656The @kbd{u t} (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command converts
27657absolute temperatures. The value on the stack must be a simple units
27658expression with units of temperature only. This command would convert
27659@samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the equivalent temperature on the
27660Fahrenheit scale.
27661
27662@kindex u r
27663@pindex calc-remove-units
27664@kindex u x
27665@pindex calc-extract-units
27666The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27667formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27668(@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27669formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27670that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27671constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27672
27673@kindex u a
27674@pindex calc-autorange-units
27675The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27676mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27677applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27678range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27679except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27680will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27681some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27682undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27683(Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27684
27685Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27686Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27687than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27688would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27689Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27690to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27691exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27692is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27693Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27694but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27695``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27696@samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27697Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27698is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27699be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27700(1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27701
27702@node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27703@section The Units Table
27704
27705@noindent
27706@kindex u v
27707@pindex calc-enter-units-table
27708The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27709in another buffer called @code{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27710gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27711of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27712the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27713units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27714meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27715and steradians.
27716
27717The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27718two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
27719prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
27720prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
27721or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
27722wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
27723
27724The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
27725new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
27726argument to @kbd{u v}.
27727
27728@kindex u V
27729@pindex calc-view-units-table
27730The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
27731that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
27732type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
27733return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{C-x * c}
27734again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
27735command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
27736the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
27737
27738@kindex u g
27739@pindex calc-get-unit-definition
27740The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
27741defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
27742@kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
27743same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
27744Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
27745will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
27746really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
27747definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
27748unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
27749
27750@kindex u e
27751@pindex calc-explain-units
27752The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
27753description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
27754for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
27755``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
27756command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
27757column of the Units Table.
27758
27759@node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
27760@section Predefined Units
27761
27762@noindent
285f0d3a
JB
27763The definitions of many units have changed over the years. For example,
27764the meter was originally defined in 1791 as one ten-millionth of the
27765distance from the equator to the north pole. In order to be more
27766precise, the definition was adjusted several times, and now a meter is
27767defined as the distance that light will travel in a vacuum in
277681/299792458 of a second; consequently, the speed of light in a
27769vacuum is exactly 299792458 m/s. Many other units have been
27770redefined in terms of fundamental physical processes; a second, for
27771example, is currently defined as 9192631770 periods of a certain
27772radiation related to the cesium-133 atom. The only SI unit that is not
27773based on a fundamental physical process (although there are efforts to
27774change this) is the kilogram, which was originally defined as the mass
27775of one liter of water, but is now defined as the mass of the
27776International Prototype Kilogram (IPK), a cylinder of platinum-iridium
27777kept at the Bureau International des Poids et Mesures in S@`evres,
27778France. (There are several copies of the IPK throughout the world.)
27779The British imperial units, once defined in terms of physical objects,
27780were redefined in 1963 in terms of SI units. The US customary units,
27781which were the same as British units until the British imperial system
27782was created in 1824, were also defined in terms of the SI units in 1893.
27783Because of these redefinitions, conversions between metric, British
27784Imperial, and US customary units can often be done precisely.
27785
4009494e
GM
27786Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
27787years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
27788their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
27789unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
27790different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
27791Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
27792note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
27793ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
27794
27795The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
27796(Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
27797temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
27798command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
27799of the various temperature scales.
27800
27801The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
27802@code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
27803
27804The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
27805@tex
27806for \AA ngstroms.
27807@end tex
27808@ifnottex
27809for Angstroms.
27810@end ifnottex
27811
27812The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
27813a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. This is
27814slightly different than the point defined by the American Typefounder's
27815Association in 1886, but the point used by Calc has become standard
27816largely due to its use by the PostScript page description language.
27817There is also @code{texpt}, which stands for a printer's point as
27818defined by the @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 texpt = 1 in}.
27819Other units used by @TeX{} are available; they are @code{texpc} (a pica),
27820@code{texbp} (a ``big point'', equal to a standard point which is larger
27821than the point used by @TeX{}), @code{texdd} (a Didot point),
27822@code{texcc} (a Cicero) and @code{texsp} (a scaled @TeX{} point,
27823all dimensions representable in @TeX{} are multiples of this value).
27824
27825The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
27826because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
27827@expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
27828preferable to @code{e}.
27829
27830The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
27831one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
27832Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
27833
27834The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
27835a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
27836
27837The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
27838time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
27839
27840Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
27841represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
27842constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
27843@samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
27844meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
27845the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
27846in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
27847units.
27848
27849Two units, @code{pi} and @code{alpha} (the fine structure constant,
27850approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
27851commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
27852values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
27853number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
27854convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
27855``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
27856really is unitless.)
27857
27858@c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
27859
27860@node User-Defined Units, , Predefined Units, Units
27861@section User-Defined Units
27862
27863@noindent
27864Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
27865units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
27866
27867@kindex u 0-9
27868@pindex calc-quick-units
27869@vindex Units
27870@cindex @code{Units} variable
27871@cindex Quick units
27872To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
27873expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
27874through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
27875to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
27876number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
27877specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
27878first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
27879stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
27880to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
27881is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
27882expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
27883to @samp{2.5 ft}.
27884
27885The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
27886Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
27887variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
27888a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
27889@kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
27890variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27891
27892@kindex u d
27893@pindex calc-define-unit
27894@cindex User-defined units
27895The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
27896expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
27897user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
27898typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
2789916.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
27900treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
27901prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
4043c194
JB
27902appear in the Units Table. If you wish the definition of this unit to
27903be displayed in a special way in the Units Table buffer (such as with an
27904asterisk to indicate an approximate value), then you can call this
27905command with an argument, @kbd{C-u u d}; you will then also be prompted
27906for a string that will be used to display the definition.
4009494e
GM
27907
27908@kindex u u
27909@pindex calc-undefine-unit
27910The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
27911unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
27912however.
27913
27914If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
27915will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
27916predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
27917``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
27918@kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
27919
27920To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
27921as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
27922other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
27923You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
27924defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
27925will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
27926Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
27927each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
27928@kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
27929
27930Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
27931possible to create user-defined temperature units.
27932
27933@kindex u p
27934@pindex calc-permanent-units
27935@cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
27936The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
27937units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
27938@code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so that the
27939units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
27940was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
27941is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
27942tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
27943
27944@node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
27945@chapter Storing and Recalling
27946
27947@noindent
27948Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
27949or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
27950section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
27951to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
27952
27953@menu
27954* Storing Variables::
27955* Recalling Variables::
27956* Operations on Variables::
27957* Let Command::
27958* Evaluates-To Operator::
27959@end menu
27960
27961@node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
27962@section Storing Variables
27963
27964@noindent
27965@kindex s s
27966@pindex calc-store
27967@cindex Storing variables
27968@cindex Quick variables
27969@vindex q0
27970@vindex q9
27971The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
27972the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
27973name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
27974immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
27975@code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
27976
27977@kindex s t
27978@pindex calc-store-into
27979The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
27980also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
27981value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
27982
27983If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
27984@samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
27985assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
27986@kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
27987value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
27988a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
27989its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
27990with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
27991
27992In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
27993assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
27994default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
27995righthand sides simultaneously.
27996
27997It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
27998the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
27999In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
28000symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
28001stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
28002and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
28003
28004@kindex s 0-9
28005@kindex t 0-9
28006The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
28007digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
28008equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
28009for trail and time/date commands.)
28010
28011@kindex s +
28012@kindex s -
28013@ignore
28014@mindex @idots
28015@end ignore
28016@kindex s *
28017@ignore
28018@mindex @null
28019@end ignore
28020@kindex s /
28021@ignore
28022@mindex @null
28023@end ignore
28024@kindex s ^
28025@ignore
28026@mindex @null
28027@end ignore
28028@kindex s |
28029@ignore
28030@mindex @null
28031@end ignore
28032@kindex s n
28033@ignore
28034@mindex @null
28035@end ignore
28036@kindex s &
28037@ignore
28038@mindex @null
28039@end ignore
28040@kindex s [
28041@ignore
28042@mindex @null
28043@end ignore
28044@kindex s ]
28045@pindex calc-store-plus
28046@pindex calc-store-minus
28047@pindex calc-store-times
28048@pindex calc-store-div
28049@pindex calc-store-power
28050@pindex calc-store-concat
28051@pindex calc-store-neg
28052@pindex calc-store-inv
28053@pindex calc-store-decr
28054@pindex calc-store-incr
28055There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
28056@kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
28057variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
28058@kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
28059@kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
28060and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
28061
28062All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
28063order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
28064variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
28065@w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
28066@texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
28067@infoline @expr{v := v - a},
28068but @kbd{I s -} assigns
28069@texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
28070@infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
28071While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
28072useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
28073arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
28074forwards and backwards:
28075
28076@example
28077@group
28078s + v := v + a v := a + v
28079s - v := v - a v := a - v
28080s * v := v * a v := a * v
28081s / v := v / a v := a / v
28082s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
28083s | v := v | a v := a | v
28084s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
28085s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
28086s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
28087s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
28088@end group
28089@end example
28090
28091In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
28092place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
28093a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
28094minus-two minus the variable.
28095
28096The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
28097etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
28098arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
28099
28100All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
28101Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
28102previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
28103turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
28104arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
28105@xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
28106these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
28107
28108@kindex s m
28109@pindex calc-store-map
28110The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
28111using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
28112@kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
28113how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
28114all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
28115function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
28116key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
28117equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
28118of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
28119reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
28120takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
28121
28122If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
28123arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
28124is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
28125on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
28126Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
28127argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
28128equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
28129
28130@kindex s x
28131@pindex calc-store-exchange
28132The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
28133of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
28134variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
28135
28136You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
28137command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
28138pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
28139
28140@kindex s u
28141@pindex calc-unstore
28142@cindex Void variables
28143@cindex Un-storing variables
28144Until you store something in them, most variables are ``void,'' that is,
28145they contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula
28146they will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
28147The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
28148void state.
28149
28150@kindex s c
28151@pindex calc-copy-variable
28152The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28153value of one variable to another. One way it differs from a simple
28154@kbd{s r} followed by an @kbd{s t} (aside from saving keystrokes) is
28155that the value never goes on the stack and thus is never rounded,
28156evaluated, or simplified in any way; it is not even rounded down to the
28157current precision.
28158
28159The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
28160@code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
28161to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
28162although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
28163variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
28164you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
28165special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
28166normally void).
28167
28168Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored in it,
28169but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{} at the current
28170precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and @code{phi} evaluate
28171according to the current precision or polar mode. If you recall a value
28172from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic property will be lost. The
28173magic property is preserved, however, when a variable is copied with
28174@kbd{s c}.
28175
28176@kindex s k
28177@pindex calc-copy-special-constant
28178If one of the ``special constants'' is redefined (or undefined) so that
28179it no longer has its magic property, the property can be restored with
28180@kbd{s k} (@code{calc-copy-special-constant}). This command will prompt
28181for a special constant and a variable to store it in, and so a special
28182constant can be stored in any variable. Here, the special constant that
28183you enter doesn't depend on the value of the corresponding variable;
28184@code{pi} will represent 3.14159@dots{} regardless of what is currently
28185stored in the Calc variable @code{pi}. If one of the other special
28186variables, @code{inf}, @code{uinf} or @code{nan}, is given a value, its
28187original behavior can be restored by voiding it with @kbd{s u}.
28188
28189@node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28190@section Recalling Variables
28191
28192@noindent
28193@kindex s r
28194@pindex calc-recall
28195@cindex Recalling variables
28196The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28197is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28198for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28199of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28200an error to try to recall a void variable.
28201
28202It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28203formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28204the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28205former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28206latter will produce an error message.
28207
28208@kindex r 0-9
28209The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
538c2573 28210equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}.
4009494e
GM
28211
28212@node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28213@section Other Operations on Variables
28214
28215@noindent
28216@kindex s e
28217@pindex calc-edit-variable
28218The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28219value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28220or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28221the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28222editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28223empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28224be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28225description of editing.
28226
28227The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28228rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28229contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28230actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28231where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28232if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28233replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28234not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28235editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28236as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28237
28238@kindex s A
28239@kindex s D
28240@ignore
28241@mindex @idots
28242@end ignore
28243@kindex s E
28244@ignore
28245@mindex @null
28246@end ignore
28247@kindex s F
28248@ignore
28249@mindex @null
28250@end ignore
28251@kindex s G
28252@ignore
28253@mindex @null
28254@end ignore
28255@kindex s H
28256@ignore
28257@mindex @null
28258@end ignore
28259@kindex s I
28260@ignore
28261@mindex @null
28262@end ignore
28263@kindex s L
28264@ignore
28265@mindex @null
28266@end ignore
28267@kindex s P
28268@ignore
28269@mindex @null
28270@end ignore
28271@kindex s R
28272@ignore
28273@mindex @null
28274@end ignore
28275@kindex s T
28276@ignore
28277@mindex @null
28278@end ignore
28279@kindex s U
28280@ignore
28281@mindex @null
28282@end ignore
28283@kindex s X
28284@pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28285@pindex calc-store-Decls
28286@pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28287@pindex calc-store-FitRules
28288@pindex calc-store-GenCount
28289@pindex calc-store-Holidays
28290@pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28291@pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28292@pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28293@pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28294@pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28295@pindex calc-store-Units
28296@pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28297There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28298use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28299
28300@table @kbd
28301@item s A
28302Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28303@item s D
28304Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28305@item s E
28306Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Default Simplifications}.
28307@item s F
28308Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28309@item s G
28310Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28311@item s H
28312Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28313@item s I
28314Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28315@item s L
28316Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28317@item s P
28318Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28319@item s R
28320Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28321@item s T
28322Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28323@item s U
28324Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28325@item s X
28326Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28327@end table
28328
28329These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28330names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28331
28332@kindex s p
28333@pindex calc-permanent-variable
28334@cindex Storing variables
28335@cindex Permanent variables
28336@cindex Calc init file, variables
28337The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28338variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
28339the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so
28340that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28341can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28342only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28343by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28344use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28345
28346If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28347@kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28348are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28349@code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28350and @code{PlotRejects};
28351@code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28352rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28353by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28354explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28355
28356@kindex s i
28357@pindex calc-insert-variables
28358The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28359the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28360The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28361Lisp @code{setq} commands
28362which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28363in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28364would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28365omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28366is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28367stores in a more human-readable format.)
28368
28369@node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28370@section The Let Command
28371
28372@noindent
28373@kindex s l
28374@pindex calc-let
28375@cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28376@cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28377If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28378compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28379then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28380of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28381
28382The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28383@emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28384top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28385second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28386in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28387the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28388@kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28389The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28390by these commands.
28391
28392The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28393a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28394analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28395
28396Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28397assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28398and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28399
28400The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28401a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
28402rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
28403example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
28404produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
28405since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
28406
28407@node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
28408@section The Evaluates-To Operator
28409
28410@noindent
28411@tindex evalto
28412@tindex =>
28413@cindex Evaluates-to operator
28414@cindex @samp{=>} operator
28415The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
28416operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
28417other language modes like Pascal and La@TeX{}.) This is a binary
28418operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
28419although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
28420
28421A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
28422follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
28423way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
28424formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
28425command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
28426and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
28427
28428For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
28429The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
28430unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
28431
28432@kindex s =
28433@pindex calc-evalto
28434You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
28435entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
28436going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
28437(@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
28438and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
28439
28440Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
28441recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
28442values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
28443if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
28444if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
28445@samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
28446@samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
28447dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
28448@samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
28449of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
28450to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
28451make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
28452(Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
28453which provides a slightly different format of display. You
28454can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
28455
28456@kindex m C
28457@pindex calc-auto-recompute
28458The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
28459turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
28460recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
28461operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
28462pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
28463a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
28464before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
28465
28466Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
28467as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
28468work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
28469to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
28470the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
28471to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
28472@kbd{j u} to unselect.
28473
28474All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
28475including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
28476formula @samp{x + y + x} is not handled by Calc's default
28477simplifications, but the @kbd{a s} command will reduce it to
28478the simpler form @samp{y + 2 x}. You can also type @kbd{m A}
28479to enable an Algebraic Simplification mode in which the
28480equivalent of @kbd{a s} is used on all of Calc's results.
28481If you enter @samp{x + y + x =>} normally, the result will
28482be @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x}. If you change to
28483Algebraic Simplification mode, the result will be
28484@samp{x + y + x => y + 2 x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a s}
28485once will have no effect on @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x},
28486because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
28487and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
28488affected by commands like @kbd{a s}.
28489
28490The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
28491with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
28492second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
28493a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
28494if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
28495side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
28496fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
28497to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
28498that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
28499entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
28500
28501@smallexample
28502@group
285032: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
285041: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
28505 . . .
28506
28507 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
28508@end group
28509@end smallexample
28510
28511Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
28512thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
28513influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
28514(@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
28515operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
28516side effects.
28517
28518@kindex s :
28519@pindex calc-assign
28520@tindex assign
28521@tindex :=
28522Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
28523the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
28524assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
28525assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
28526by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
28527of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
28528operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
28529(@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
28530and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
28531
28532@xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
28533@TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
28534treatment to @samp{=>}.
28535
28536@node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
28537@chapter Graphics
28538
28539@noindent
28540The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
28541uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or later to do graphics. These commands will only work
28542if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
28543a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
28544However, it is free software. It can be obtained from
28545@samp{http://www.gnuplot.info}.)
28546
28547@vindex calc-gnuplot-name
28548If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
28549find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable
28550in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some Lisp
28551variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
28552are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are
28553using the X window system, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
28554automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later and you are not using X,
28555Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display graphs using simple character
28556graphics that will work on any terminal.
28557
28558@menu
28559* Basic Graphics::
28560* Three Dimensional Graphics::
28561* Managing Curves::
28562* Graphics Options::
28563* Devices::
28564@end menu
28565
28566@node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
28567@section Basic Graphics
28568
28569@noindent
28570@kindex g f
28571@pindex calc-graph-fast
28572The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
28573This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
28574The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
28575the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
28576represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
28577GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
28578commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
28579be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
28580to indicate the points themselves.
28581
28582The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
28583``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
28584the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
28585
28586The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
28587sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
28588(Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
28589
28590The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
28591uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
28592the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
28593The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
28594values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
28595computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
28596Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
28597@kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
28598or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
28599
28600@ignore
28601@starindex
28602@end ignore
28603@tindex xy
28604If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
28605@samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
28606parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
28607are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
28608In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
28609visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
28610and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
28611will be a circle.
28612
28613Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
28614looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
28615variables.
28616
28617The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
28618calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
28619be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). One exception to this
28620is that the ``y'' entry can consist of a vector of numbers combined with
28621error forms, in which case the points will be plotted with the
28622appropriate error bars. Other than this, if either the ``x''
28623value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
28624data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
28625of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
28626
28627See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
28628numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
28629
28630@cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
28631@vindex PlotRejects
28632If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
28633(i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
28634this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
28635``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
28636a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
28637``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
28638@xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
28639current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
28640for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
28641@code{PlotRejects}.
28642
28643@kindex g c
28644@pindex calc-graph-clear
28645To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
28646If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
28647Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
28648to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
28649or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
28650window if there is one.
28651
28652@node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
28653@section Three-Dimensional Graphics
28654
28655@kindex g F
28656@pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
28657The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
28658graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
28659you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
28660
28661The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
28662``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
28663are several options for these values.
28664
28665In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
28666the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
28667``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
28668in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
28669result is a surface plot where
28670@texline @math{z_{ij}}
28671@infoline @expr{z_ij}
28672is the height of the point
28673at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
28674be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
28675viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
28676buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT documentation for a
28677description of the @samp{set view} command.
28678
28679Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
28680and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
28681
28682In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
28683length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
28684where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
28685of values from the input vectors.
28686
28687In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
28688``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
28689with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
28690order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
28691values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
286923D surface.
28693
28694@ignore
28695@starindex
28696@end ignore
28697@tindex xyz
28698If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
28699@samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
28700``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
28701taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
28702``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
28703to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
28704@samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
28705will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
287065 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
28707sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
28708increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
28709vectors with more than 5 elements.
28710
28711It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
28712evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
28713a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
28714@samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
28715helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
28716
28717As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
28718variables containing the relevant data.
28719
28720@node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
28721@section Managing Curves
28722
28723@noindent
28724The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
28725@kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
28726@kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
28727by using these commands directly.
28728
28729@kindex g a
28730@pindex calc-graph-add
28731The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
28732represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
28733graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
28734you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
28735on the same axes.
28736
28737The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
28738will cause a special buffer, @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
28739in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
28740be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
28741@kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
28742@kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
28743Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
28744buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
28745directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
28746must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
28747in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
28748configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
28749the contents of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28750
28751@vindex PlotData1
28752@vindex PlotData2
28753If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
28754variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
28755the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
28756go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
28757that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
28758can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
28759That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
28760itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
28761
28762A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
28763stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
28764argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
28765for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
28766the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
28767argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
28768
28769A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
28770``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
28771``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
28772
28773A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
28774the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
28775This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
28776that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
28777values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
28778they are to look nice on the same graph.)
28779
28780For example, to plot
28781@texline @math{\sin n x}
28782@infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
28783for integers @expr{n}
28784from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
28785(@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
28786across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
28787for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
28788command.
28789
28790@kindex g A
28791@pindex calc-graph-add-3d
28792The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
28793to the graph. It is not valid to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
28794single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
28795and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
28796takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
28797separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
28798but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
28799prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
28800The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
28801command to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28802
28803(Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
28804@samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
28805before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
28806evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
28807@kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
28808check for this.)
28809
28810@kindex g d
28811@pindex calc-graph-delete
28812The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
28813recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
28814no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
28815it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
28816
28817@kindex g H
28818@pindex calc-graph-hide
28819The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
28820the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
28821the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
28822point styles will be retained.
28823
28824@kindex g j
28825@pindex calc-graph-juggle
28826The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
28827at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
28828front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
28829@w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
28830with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
28831affect the last curve in the list.
28832
28833@kindex g p
28834@pindex calc-graph-plot
28835The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
28836the graph described in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
28837GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
28838are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
28839command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
28840are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
28841plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
28842for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
28843files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
28844
28845If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
28846it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
28847Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
28848that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
28849mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
28850force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
28851numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
28852
28853Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
28854This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
28855a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
28856the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
28857function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
28858each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
28859but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
28860
28861Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
28862numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
28863the current graph is three-dimensional.
28864
28865@kindex g P
28866@pindex calc-graph-print
28867The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
28868except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
28869screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
28870or @samp{set output} commands in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
28871lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
28872ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
28873uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
28874controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
28875Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
28876the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
28877always plot to the printer.
28878
28879@node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
28880@section Graphics Options
28881
28882@noindent
28883@kindex g g
28884@pindex calc-graph-grid
28885The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
28886on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
28887edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
28888across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
28889changes the setting in @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
28890of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
28891
28892@kindex g b
28893@pindex calc-graph-border
28894The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
28895(the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
28896This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
28897
28898@kindex g k
28899@pindex calc-graph-key
28900The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
28901on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
28902shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
28903off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
28904curves on the same graph.
28905
28906@kindex g N
28907@pindex calc-graph-num-points
28908The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
28909to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
28910curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
28911Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
28912With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
28913With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
28914a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
28915graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
28916With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
28917the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
28918Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
28919will be computed for the surface.
28920
28921Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
28922precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
28923time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
28924it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
28925interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
28926to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
28927@samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
28928at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
28929there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
28930
28931@kindex g h
28932@pindex calc-graph-header
28933The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
28934for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
28935The default title is blank (no title).
28936
28937@kindex g n
28938@pindex calc-graph-name
28939The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
28940individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
28941affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
28942list in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
28943the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
28944with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
28945Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
28946not used.
28947
28948@kindex g t
28949@kindex g T
28950@pindex calc-graph-title-x
28951@pindex calc-graph-title-y
28952The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
28953(@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
28954and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
28955tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
28956Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
28957but you can edit them into the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
28958you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
28959
28960@kindex g r
28961@kindex g R
28962@pindex calc-graph-range-x
28963@pindex calc-graph-range-y
28964The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
28965(@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
28966``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
28967suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
28968form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
28969default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
28970in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
28971Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
28972vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
28973
28974@kindex g l
28975@kindex g L
28976@pindex calc-graph-log-x
28977@pindex calc-graph-log-y
28978The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
28979commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
28980be logarithmic instead of linear.
28981
28982@kindex g C-l
28983@kindex g C-r
28984@kindex g C-t
28985@pindex calc-graph-log-z
28986@pindex calc-graph-range-z
28987@pindex calc-graph-title-z
28988For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
28989letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
28990for the ``z'' axis.
28991
28992@kindex g z
28993@kindex g Z
28994@pindex calc-graph-zero-x
28995@pindex calc-graph-zero-y
28996The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
28997(@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
28998drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
28999dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
29000turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
29001may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
29002not available for 3D plots.
29003
29004@kindex g s
29005@pindex calc-graph-line-style
29006The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
29007lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
29008the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
29009toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
29010turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
29011start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
29012GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
29013available for any device.
29014
29015@kindex g S
29016@pindex calc-graph-point-style
29017The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
29018the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
29019If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
29020tiny dots. If the ``y'' values being plotted contain error forms and
29021the connecting lines are turned off, then this command will also turn
29022the error bars on or off.
29023
29024@cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
29025@cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
29026@vindex LineStyles
29027@vindex PointStyles
29028Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
29029@code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
29030values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
29031the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
29032instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
29033An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
29034the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
29035altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
29036last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
29037you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
29038
29039For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
29040to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
29041lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
29042still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
29043@code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
29044
29045@node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
29046@section Graphical Devices
29047
29048@noindent
29049@kindex g D
29050@pindex calc-graph-device
29051The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
29052(or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
29053on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
29054If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
29055Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
29056
29057With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
29058the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
29059not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
29060blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
29061name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
29062the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
29063@code{DISPLAY} environment variable), or otherwise @code{dumb} under
29064GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or @code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0.
29065This is the initial default value.
29066
29067The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
29068terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
29069picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
29070to a buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
29071The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
29072dumb terminals will be
29073@texline @math{80\times24}
29074@infoline 80x24
29075characters. The graph is displayed in
29076an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
29077the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
29078device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29079
29080The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
29081spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
29082characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
29083but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
29084screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
29085graph. In the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
29086@kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
29087of the four directions.
29088
29089With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
29090the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
29091is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
29092printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
29093plot on any text-only printer.
29094
29095@kindex g O
29096@pindex calc-graph-output
29097The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of
29098the output file used by GNUPLOT. For some devices, notably @code{x11},
29099there is no output file and this information is not used. Many other
29100``devices'' are really file formats like @code{postscript}; in these
29101cases the output in the desired format goes into the file you name
29102with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout @key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write
29103to its standard output stream, i.e., to @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}.
29104This is the default setting.
29105
29106Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
29107is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
29108which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
29109graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
29110this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
29111sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
29112typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
29113the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
29114to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
29115
29116Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
29117sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
29118case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
29119file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
29120will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
29121name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
29122
29123The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
29124permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
29125default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
29126(see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
29127saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
29128of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29129
29130@vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
29131@vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
29132@vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
29133@vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
29134@vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
29135@vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
29136You may wish to configure the default and
29137printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
29138Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
29139and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
29140file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
29141expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
29142
29143Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
29144@code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
29145display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
29146@code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
29147@samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
29148Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
29149to display or print the output. These variables are customizable
29150(@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29151
29152@kindex g x
29153@pindex calc-graph-display
29154The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
29155on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
29156a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
29157effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
29158
29159@kindex g X
29160@pindex calc-graph-geometry
29161The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
29162command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
29163The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
29164window manager will let you place the window interactively.
29165Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
29166window in the upper-left corner of the screen.
29167
29168The buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
29169session with GNUPLOT. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
29170GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
29171error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
29172this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
29173something has gone wrong.
29174
29175@kindex g C
29176@pindex calc-graph-command
29177The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
29178enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
29179GNUPLOT process. The @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
29180like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29181Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29182
29183@kindex g v
29184@kindex g V
29185@pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29186@pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29187The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29188(@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29189and @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29190This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29191will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29192or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
29193buffer is hidden again.
29194
29195One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29196@samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29197@kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29198@samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29199annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29200you have to add them to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29201yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29202that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29203To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29204You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29205``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29206Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29207reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29208to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29209line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29210with @kbd{g p}.
29211
29212@kindex g q
29213@pindex calc-graph-quit
29214You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29215process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29216start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29217the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29218running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29219exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29220
29221@kindex g K
29222@pindex calc-graph-kill
29223The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29224except that it also views the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29225you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29226killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29227
29228@node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29229@chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29230
29231@noindent
29232The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29233other Emacs editing buffers.
29234
29235In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29236work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29237
29238@menu
29239* Killing From Stack::
29240* Yanking Into Stack::
538c2573
JB
29241* Saving Into Registers::
29242* Inserting From Registers::
4009494e
GM
29243* Grabbing From Buffers::
29244* Yanking Into Buffers::
29245* X Cut and Paste::
29246@end menu
29247
29248@node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29249@section Killing from the Stack
29250
29251@noindent
29252@kindex C-k
29253@pindex calc-kill
29254@kindex M-k
29255@pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29256@kindex C-w
29257@pindex calc-kill-region
29258@kindex M-w
29259@pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
aee08080 29260@kindex M-C-w
4009494e 29261@cindex Kill ring
aee08080
JB
29262@dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the ``kill
29263ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y} command.
29264Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which kills
29265one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point, and
29266@kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29267deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too,
29268although in the Calculator they operate on whole stack entries, so they
29269``round up'' the specified region to encompass full lines. (To copy
29270only parts of lines, the @kbd{M-C-w} command in the Calculator will copy
29271the region to the kill ring without any ``rounding up'', just like the
29272@kbd{M-w} command in normal Emacs.) Also, @kbd{M-k} has been provided
29273to complete the set; it puts the current line into the kill ring without
29274deleting anything.
4009494e
GM
29275
29276The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
aee08080
JB
29277of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below
29278the bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack.
29279Otherwise, they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. The
29280text is copied into the kill ring exactly as it appears on the screen,
29281including line numbers if they are enabled.
4009494e
GM
29282
29283A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29284of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29285lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29286current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29287@kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29288with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29289@kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29290newline.
29291
538c2573 29292@node Yanking Into Stack, Saving Into Registers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
4009494e
GM
29293@section Yanking into the Stack
29294
29295@noindent
29296@kindex C-y
29297@pindex calc-yank
29298The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29299Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29300the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29301or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29302the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29303itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29304set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29305then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29306full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29307number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29308show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29309difference.)
29310
538c2573
JB
29311@node Saving Into Registers, Inserting From Registers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29312@section Saving into Registers
29313
29314@noindent
29315@kindex r s
29316@pindex calc-copy-to-register
29317@pindex calc-prepend-to-register
29318@pindex calc-append-to-register
29319@cindex Registers
29320An alternative to killing and yanking stack entries is using
29321registers in Calc. Saving stack entries in registers is like
29322saving text in normal Emacs registers; although, like Calc's kill
29323commands, register commands always operate on whole stack
29324entries.
29325
29326Registers in Calc are places to store stack entries for later use;
29327each register is indexed by a single character. To store the current
29328region (rounded up, of course, to include full stack entries) into a
29329register, use the command @kbd{r s} (@code{calc-copy-to-register}).
29330You will then be prompted for a register to use, the next character
29331you type will be the index for the register. To store the region in
29332register @var{r}, the full command will be @kbd{r s @var{r}}. With an
29333argument, @kbd{C-u r s @var{r}}, the region being copied to the
29334register will be deleted from the Calc buffer.
29335
29336It is possible to add additional stack entries to a register. The
29337command @kbd{M-x calc-append-to-register} will prompt for a register,
29338then add the stack entries in the region to the end of the register
29339contents. The command @kbd{M-x calc-prepend-to-register} will
29340similarly prompt for a register and add the stack entries in the
29341region to the beginning of the register contents. Both commands take
29342@kbd{C-u} arguments, which will cause the region to be deleted after being
29343added to the register.
29344
29345@node Inserting From Registers, Grabbing From Buffers, Saving Into Registers, Kill and Yank
29346@section Inserting from Registers
29347@noindent
29348@kindex r i
29349@pindex calc-insert-register
29350The command @kbd{r i} (@code{calc-insert-register}) will prompt for a
29351register, then insert the contents of that register into the
29352Calculator. If the contents of the register were placed there from
29353within Calc, then the full internal structure of the contents will be
29354inserted into the Calculator, otherwise whatever text is in the
29355register is reparsed and then inserted into the Calculator.
29356
29357@node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Inserting From Registers, Kill and Yank
4009494e
GM
29358@section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29359
29360@noindent
29361@kindex C-x * g
29362@pindex calc-grab-region
29363The @kbd{C-x * g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29364point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29365vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29366@samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29367then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29368of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29369If the @kbd{C-x * g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29370@kbd{C-x * c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29371
29372A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29373point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29374@expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 C-x * g} grabs from point
29375to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29376back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29377that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29378delete given that prefix argument.
29379
29380A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29381line.
29382
29383A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29384as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29385@kbd{C-x * g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29386values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u C-x * g} on the same region
29387reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29388(The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29389vector of one element by plain @kbd{C-x * g} because the interpretation
29390@samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29391
29392If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29393the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
29394
29395@kindex C-x * r
29396@pindex calc-grab-rectangle
29397The @kbd{C-x * r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
29398point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
29399are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
29400entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
29401whose contents are parsed.
29402
29403Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
29404will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
29405only if every row contains the same number of values.
29406
29407If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
29408braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
29409of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
29410is ignored.
29411
29412Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
29413were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
29414format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
29415force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
29416portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
29417@kbd{C-x * r} command.
29418
29419If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
29420line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
29421a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will be a
29422one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
29423expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} will interpret this as
29424@samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
29425one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will interpret this row
29426as @samp{[2*a]}.
29427
29428If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
29429will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
29430separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
29431@w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
29432would correctly split the line into two error forms.
29433
29434@xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
29435constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
29436@texline @math{1\times1}
29437@infoline 1x1
29438matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
29439
29440@kindex C-x * :
29441@kindex C-x * _
29442@pindex calc-grab-sum-across
29443@pindex calc-grab-sum-down
29444@cindex Summing rows and columns of data
29445The @kbd{C-x * :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
29446grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
29447typing @kbd{C-x * r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
29448command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
29449result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
29450in the input data. The @kbd{C-x * _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
29451similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
29452
29453As well as being more convenient, @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are also
29454much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
29455the stack. In a @kbd{C-x * r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
29456for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
29457(unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
29458
29459For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
29460wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
29461set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{C-x * :}. Since there
29462is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
29463(You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
29464you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
29465
29466To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
29467it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
29468Use @kbd{C-x * r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
29469the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
29470handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
29471@xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
29472an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
29473
29474@node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
29475@section Yanking into Other Buffers
29476
29477@noindent
29478@kindex y
29479@pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
29480The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
29481at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
29482(More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
29483in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
29484such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
29485and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
29486without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
29487normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
29488
29489With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
29490A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
29491of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
29492top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
29493that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
29494with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
29495latter strips off the trailing newline.
29496
29497With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
29498region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
29499Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
29500@kbd{C-x * g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
29501data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
29502original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
29503display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
29504display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
29505that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
29506@kbd{C-x * g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{C-x * r}).
29507
29508If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
29509and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
29510overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
29511before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
29512are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
29513a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
29514object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
29515lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
29516Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
29517number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
29518make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
29519number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
29520``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
29521to overwriting one complete number with another.
29522
29523@kindex C-x * y
29524The @kbd{C-x * y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
29525it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
29526way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
29527
29528@node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
29529@section X Cut and Paste
29530
29531@noindent
29532If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
29533way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
29534Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
29535
29536The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
29537to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
29538select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
29539the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
29540clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
29541window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
29542to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
29543middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
29544paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
29545entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
29546new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
29547
29548The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
29549shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
29550So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
29551Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
29552left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
29553whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
29554just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
29555in the Calc window.
29556
29557@node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Top
29558@chapter Keypad Mode
29559
29560@noindent
29561@kindex C-x * k
29562@pindex calc-keypad
29563The @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
29564and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
29565the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
29566keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
29567The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
29568you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
29569calculations with the mouse.
29570
29571@pindex full-calc-keypad
29572If you have used @kbd{C-x * b} first, @kbd{C-x * k} instead invokes
29573the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
29574Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
29575trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
29576Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
29577
29578If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
29579the @samp{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
29580``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
29581is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
29582
29583Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
29584keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
29585keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
29586
29587Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
29588at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
29589to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
29590stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
29591To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
29592[@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
29593until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
29594is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
29595
29596You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
29597Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
29598Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
29599original buffer.
29600
29601@menu
29602* Keypad Main Menu::
29603* Keypad Functions Menu::
29604* Keypad Binary Menu::
29605* Keypad Vectors Menu::
29606* Keypad Modes Menu::
29607@end menu
29608
29609@node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
29610@section Main Menu
29611
29612@smallexample
29613@group
5a83c46e 29614|----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
4009494e
GM
29615|FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
29616|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29617| LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
29618|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29619|SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
29620|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29621| ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
29622|-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
29623| INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
29624|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29625| HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
29626|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29627|EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
29628|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29629| OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
29630|-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
29631@end group
29632@end smallexample
29633
29634@noindent
29635This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
29636It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
29637Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
29638screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
29639
29640The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
29641entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
29642exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
29643number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
29644or any other function key.
29645
29646The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
29647numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
29648At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
29649stack.
29650
29651The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
29652having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
29653defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
29654below and in the following sections.
29655
29656The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
29657duplicates the top entry on the stack.
29658
29659The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
29660@kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
29661``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
29662
29663The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
29664At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
29665clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
29666the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
29667
29668The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
29669that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
29670numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
29671switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
29672nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
29673
29674The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
29675functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
29676reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
29677integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
29678
29679The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
29680give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
29681is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
29682unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
29683
29684@table @kbd
29685@item INV +/-
29686is the same as @key{1/x}.
29687@item INV +
29688is the same as @key{SQRT}.
29689@item INV -
29690is the same as @key{CONJ}.
29691@item INV *
29692is the same as @key{y^x}.
29693@item INV /
29694is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
29695@item HYP/INV 1
29696are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
29697@item HYP/INV 2
29698are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
29699@item HYP/INV 3
29700are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
29701@item INV/HYP 4
29702are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
29703@item INV/HYP 5
29704are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
29705@item INV 6
29706is the same as @key{ABS}.
29707@item INV 7
29708is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
29709@item INV 8
29710is the same as @key{CLN2}.
29711@item INV 9
29712is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
29713@item INV 0
29714is the same as @key{IMAG}.
29715@item INV .
29716is the same as @key{PREC}.
29717@item INV ENTER
29718is the same as @key{SWAP}.
29719@item HYP ENTER
29720is the same as @key{RLL3}.
29721@item INV HYP ENTER
29722is the same as @key{OVER}.
29723@item HYP +/-
29724packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
29725@item HYP EEX
29726packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
29727@item INV EEX
29728creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
29729of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
29730by the two limits of the interval.
29731@end table
29732
29733The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{C-x * k} or @kbd{C-x * *}
29734again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
29735hitting @kbd{C-x * c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
29736running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
29737command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
29738@kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
29739
29740@node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
29741@section Functions Menu
29742
29743@smallexample
29744@group
29745|----+----+----+----+----+----2
29746|IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
29747|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29748|IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
29749|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29750|GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
29751|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29752@end group
29753@end smallexample
29754
29755@noindent
29756This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
29757prefix keys.
29758
29759@key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
29760number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
29761
29762@key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
29763extracts the imaginary part.
29764
29765@key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
29766a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
29767number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
29768again'' command; it computes another random number using the
29769same limit as last time.
29770
29771@key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
29772
29773@key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
29774@texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29775@infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29776
29777@key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
29778@kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
29779
29780@key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
29781finds the previous prime.
29782
29783@node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
29784@section Binary Menu
29785
29786@smallexample
29787@group
29788|----+----+----+----+----+----3
29789|AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
29790|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29791|DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
29792|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29793| A | B | C | D | E | F |
29794|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29795@end group
29796@end smallexample
29797
29798@noindent
29799The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
29800Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
29801@key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
29802
29803The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
29804The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
29805
29806The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
29807current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
29808octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
29809for entering hexadecimal numbers.
29810
29811The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
29812and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
29813using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
29814The initial word size is 32 bits.
29815
29816@node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
29817@section Vectors Menu
29818
29819@smallexample
29820@group
29821|----+----+----+----+----+----4
29822|SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
29823|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29824|MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
29825|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29826|PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
29827|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29828@end group
29829@end smallexample
29830
29831@noindent
29832The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
29833
29834@key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
29835the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
29836which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
29837@kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
29838@samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
29839on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
29840rows into a matrix.
29841
29842@key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
29843components separately.
29844
29845@key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
29846integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
29847from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
29848and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
29849value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
29850
29851@key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
29852identity matrix.
29853
29854@key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
29855
29856@key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
29857
29858@key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
29859inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
29860
29861@key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
29862equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
29863@key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
29864@key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
29865
29866@key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
29867minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
29868@key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
29869
29870@key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
29871@key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
29872@key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
29873
29874@key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
29875to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
29876The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
29877and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
29878all the elements of a vector.
29879
29880@key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
29881vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
29882several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
29883second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
29884alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
29885the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
29886the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
29887For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
29888the formula @samp{x^y}.
29889
29890The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
29891stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
29892key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
29893suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
29894With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
29895@kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
29896@expr{t}, respectively.
29897
29898@node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
29899@section Modes Menu
29900
29901@smallexample
29902@group
29903|----+----+----+----+----+----5
29904|FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
29905|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29906|RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
29907|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29908|SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
29909|----+----+----+----+----+----|
29910@end group
29911@end smallexample
29912
29913@noindent
29914The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
29915
29916The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
29917floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
29918@key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
29919others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
29920keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
29921
29922The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
29923@kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
29924well as to the left.
29925
29926The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
29927for trigonometric functions.
29928
29929The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
29930whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
29931fractional or floating-point results.
29932
29933The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
29934polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
29935
29936The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
29937operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
29938are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
29939
29940The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
29941the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
29942
29943The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
29944The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
29945The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
29946The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
29947
29948The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
29949@kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
29950@key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
29951variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
29952for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
29953
29954@node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
29955@chapter Embedded Mode
29956
29957@noindent
29958Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
29959and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
29960stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
29961linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
29962
29963@menu
29964* Basic Embedded Mode::
29965* More About Embedded Mode::
29966* Assignments in Embedded Mode::
29967* Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
29968* Customizing Embedded Mode::
29969@end menu
29970
29971@node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
29972@section Basic Embedded Mode
29973
29974@noindent
29975@kindex C-x * e
29976@pindex calc-embedded
29977To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
29978formula in any buffer and press @kbd{C-x * e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
29979Note that @kbd{C-x * e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
29980like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
29981are visiting your own files.
29982
29983Calc will try to guess an appropriate language based on the major mode
29984of the editing buffer. (@xref{Language Modes}.) If the current buffer is
29985in @code{latex-mode}, for example, Calc will set its language to La@TeX{}.
29986Similarly, Calc will use @TeX{} language for @code{tex-mode},
29987@code{plain-tex-mode} and @code{context-mode}, C language for
29988@code{c-mode} and @code{c++-mode}, FORTRAN language for
29989@code{fortran-mode} and @code{f90-mode}, Pascal for @code{pascal-mode},
29990and eqn for @code{nroff-mode} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29991These can be overridden with Calc's mode
29992changing commands (@pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}). If no
29993suitable language is available, Calc will continue with its current language.
29994
29995Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
29996nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
29997delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
29998understands are:
29999
30000@enumerate
30001@item
30002The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
30003@samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
30004@item
30005Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
30006@item
30007Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
30008@item
30009Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
30010@item
30011Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
30012@end enumerate
30013
30014@xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
30015your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
30016on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
30017
30018If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
30019instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and includes
30020that many lines forward or backward (respectively, including the current
30021line). Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
30022
30023With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region (delimited
30024by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters. With a prefix
30025argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc uses the current line as the formula.
30026
30027@kindex C-x * w
30028@pindex calc-embedded-word
30029The @kbd{C-x * w} (@code{calc-embedded-word}) command will start Embedded
30030mode on the current ``word''; in this case Calc will scan for the first
30031non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a digit,
30032sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e}) forward and
30033backward to delimit the formula.
30034
30035When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
30036between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
30037Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
30038Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
30039can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
30040Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
30041sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
30042for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
30043in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
30044the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
30045interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
30046
30047If you press @kbd{C-x * e} or @kbd{C-x * w} to activate an embedded
30048formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
30049the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
30050an algebraic entry.
30051
30052Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
30053move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
30054Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
30055to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
30056not affected by Embedded mode.
30057
30058When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
30059the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
30060the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
30061You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{C-x * o} if you
30062find you need to see the entire stack.
30063
30064For example, typing @kbd{C-x * e} while somewhere in the formula
30065@samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
30066inequality:
30067
30068@example
30069We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
30070@end example
30071
30072@noindent
30073The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
30074the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
30075This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
30076to match Calc's usual display style:
30077
30078@example
30079We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
30080@end example
30081
30082@noindent
30083No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
30084in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
30085Embedded mode.
30086
30087Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
30088are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
30089the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
30090This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
30091move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
30092needs to be commuted.
30093
30094@example
30095We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
30096@end example
30097
30098The @kbd{C-x * o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
30099without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
30100verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
30101@kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
30102
30103@example
30104We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
30105@end example
30106
30107@noindent
30108with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
30109at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
30110@samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
30111normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
30112it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
30113RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
30114stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{C-x * o}).
30115
30116Typing @kbd{C-x * e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
30117window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
30118removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
30119Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
30120leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
30121that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
30122Embedded mode is concerned.
30123
30124If you press @kbd{C-x * e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
30125possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
30126formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
30127``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
30128press @kbd{C-x * e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
30129regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
30130the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
30131own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
30132will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
30133you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
30134
30135@node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30136@section More About Embedded Mode
30137
30138@noindent
30139When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
30140the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
30141loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
30142written. If the formula contains any La@TeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
30143it is parsed (i.e., read) in La@TeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
30144be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
30145it is parsed according to the current language mode.
30146
30147Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
30148the formula it reads in. Even though it can read a La@TeX{} formula when
30149not in La@TeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
30150whatever language mode is in effect.
30151
30152@tex
30153\bigskip
30154@end tex
30155
30156@kindex d p
30157@pindex calc-show-plain
30158Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
30159example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
30160specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
30161recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
30162command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
30163formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
30164When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
30165front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
30166version.
30167
30168Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
30169by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
30170character begins a comment in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}, so if your formula is
30171embedded in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} document its plain version will be
30172invisible in the final printed copy. Certain major modes have different
30173delimiters to ensure that the ``plain'' version will be
30174in a comment for those modes, also.
30175See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode} to see how to change the ``plain''
30176formula delimiters.
30177
30178There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
30179formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
30180read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
30181and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
30182Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
30183the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
30184these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
30185Calc will be able to read your formula later.
30186
30187Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
30188specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
30189any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
30190lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
30191mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
30192in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
30193
30194@tex
30195\bigskip
30196@end tex
30197
30198Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
30199exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
30200which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
30201type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
30202If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
30203full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
30204even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
30205formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
30206each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
30207save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
30208all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
30209``plain'' mode.
30210
30211@tex
30212\bigskip
30213@end tex
30214
30215In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
30216sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
30217work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
30218like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
30219the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
30220
30221@smallexample
30222The derivative of
30223
30224 ln(ln(x))
30225
30226is
30227
30228 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
30229
30230whose value at x = 2 is
30231
30232 @r{(the value)}
30233
30234and at x = 3 is
30235
30236 @r{(the value)}
30237@end smallexample
30238
30239@kindex C-x * d
30240@pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
30241The @kbd{C-x * d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
30242handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{C-x * d},
30243the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30244mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30245Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30246
30247For this example, you would start with just
30248
30249@smallexample
30250The derivative of
30251
30252 ln(ln(x))
30253@end smallexample
30254
30255@noindent
30256and press @kbd{C-x * d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30257is
30258
30259@smallexample
30260The derivative of
30261
30262 ln(ln(x))
30263
30264
30265 ln(ln(x))
30266@end smallexample
30267
30268@noindent
30269with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30270You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30271@kbd{C-x * d C-x * d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30272To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30273the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30274and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30275
30276Finally, you would want to press @kbd{C-x * e} to exit Embedded
30277mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30278various formulas and numbers.
30279
30280@tex
30281\bigskip
30282@end tex
30283
30284@kindex C-x * f
30285@kindex C-x * '
30286@pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30287The @kbd{C-x * f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30288creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30289some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30290and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30291then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30292typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30293the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{C-x * e}. The key sequence
30294@kbd{C-x * '} is equivalent to @kbd{C-x * f}.
30295
30296@kindex C-x * n
30297@kindex C-x * p
30298@pindex calc-embedded-next
30299@pindex calc-embedded-previous
30300The @kbd{C-x * n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{C-x * p}
30301(@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30302next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30303can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30304formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30305text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30306which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30307@kbd{C-x * n} and @kbd{C-x * p} are a useful way to tell which
30308embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30309commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30310formula, they just move the cursor.
30311
30312@kindex C-x * `
30313@pindex calc-embedded-edit
30314The @kbd{C-x * `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30315embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30316Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30317@kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30318
30319@node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30320@section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30321
30322@noindent
30323The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30324are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30325a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30326other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30327
30328An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30329
30330@example
30331foo := 5
30332@end example
30333
30334@noindent
30335records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30336purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30337does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30338of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30339formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30340
30341One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30342Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30343@kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30344@code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30345is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30346
30347@example
30348foo + 7 => 12
30349@end example
30350
30351@xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30352
30353If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30354@samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30355
30356@example
30357foo := 17
30358
30359foo + 7 => 24
30360@end example
30361
30362The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30363assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30364Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30365by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30366variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30367
30368@example
3036917
30370
30371foo + 7 => foo + 7
30372@end example
30373
30374The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30375will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30376Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30377Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30378
30379@kindex C-x * j
30380@pindex calc-embedded-select
30381The @kbd{C-x * j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30382easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{C-x * e},
30383except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30384@kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30385is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30386A formula can also be a combination of both:
30387
30388@example
30389bar := foo + 3 => 20
30390@end example
30391
30392@noindent
30393in which case @kbd{C-x * j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
30394
30395The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
30396mode.
30397
30398@kindex C-x * u
30399@pindex calc-embedded-update-formula
30400Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
30401to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
30402mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
30403the change. The @kbd{C-x * u} (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula})
30404command is a convenient way to do this.
30405
30406@example
30407foo := 6
30408
30409foo + 7 => 13
30410@end example
30411
30412Pressing @kbd{C-x * u} is much like pressing @kbd{C-x * e = C-x * e}, that
30413is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
30414cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{C-x * u} does
30415not actually use @kbd{C-x * e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
30416else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{C-x * u} and
30417that formula will not be disturbed.
30418
30419With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * u} updates all active
30420@samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
30421been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
30422@samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
30423(This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
30424
30425With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u C-x * u} updates only in the
30426region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
30427
30428@kbd{C-x * u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
30429@samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
30430file.
30431
30432@kindex C-x * a
30433@pindex calc-embedded-activate
30434The @kbd{C-x * a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
30435through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
30436that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
30437that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
30438formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
30439the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
30440changed.
30441
30442It is a good idea to type @kbd{C-x * a} right after loading a file
30443that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
30444``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
30445automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
30446a few lines that look like this:
30447
30448@example
30449--- Local Variables: ---
30450--- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
30451--- End: ---
30452@end example
30453
30454@noindent
30455where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
30456any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
30457or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
30458leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
30459C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
30460trailing strings.
30461
30462When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
30463section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
30464section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
30465@kbd{C-x * a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
30466The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
30467end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
30468page of the file if the file has any page separators.
30469@xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
30470Emacs manual}.
30471
30472Note that @kbd{C-x * a} does not update the formulas it finds.
30473To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 C-x * u} after @w{@kbd{C-x * a}}.
30474Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
30475formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
30476saved.
30477
30478Normally, @kbd{C-x * a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
30479any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
30480positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * a} first deactivates
30481all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
30482its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
30483@kbd{C-x * a} simply deactivates all formulas.
30484
30485Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
30486which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
30487It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
30488formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{C-x * a}
30489and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
30490happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
30491a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
30492due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
30493@samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
30494formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
30495a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{C-x * a}, or if you
30496used @kbd{C-x * a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
30497because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
30498in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
30499(e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- C-x * a}).
30500
30501Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
30502in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
30503nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
30504following assignment is used.
30505
30506@example
30507x => 1
30508
30509x := 1
30510
30511x => 1
30512
30513x := 2
30514
30515x => 2
30516@end example
30517
30518As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
30519expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
30520@code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
30521Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
30522but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
30523only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
30524
30525If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
30526stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
30527or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
30528Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
30529and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
30530@kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
30531@pxref{Operations on Variables}.
30532
30533The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
30534recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
30535recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{C-x * u} to update these
30536formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
30537plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
30538to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 C-x * u}
30539to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
30540controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
30541Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
30542stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
30543use @kbd{C-x * u} to update the buffer by hand.
30544
30545@node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30546@section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
30547
30548@kindex m e
30549@pindex calc-embedded-preserve-modes
30550@noindent
30551The mode settings can be changed while Calc is in embedded mode, but
30552by default they will revert to their original values when embedded mode
30553is ended. However, the modes saved when the mode-recording mode is
30554@code{Save} (see below) and the modes in effect when the @kbd{m e}
30555(@code{calc-embedded-preserve-modes}) command is given
30556will be preserved when embedded mode is ended.
30557
30558Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
30559settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
30560in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
30561file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
30562case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
30563is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
30564
30565When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
30566mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
30567a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
30568delimiter of the formula.
30569
30570@example
30571% [calc-mode: fractions: t]
30572% [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30573@end example
30574
30575When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
30576the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
30577Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
30578in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
30579the file, or up to a line of the form
30580
30581@example
30582% [calc-defaults]
30583@end example
30584
30585@noindent
30586which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
30587scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
30588``zone'' of mode settings and another.
30589
30590If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
30591closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
30592formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
30593below).
30594
30595The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
30596square brackets and the text they enclose. In fact, the leading
30597characters are different for different major modes. You can edit the
30598mode annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
30599@xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
30600that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
30601mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
30602the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
30603Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
30604
30605If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
30606a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
30607modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
30608one.
30609
30610Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
30611after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
30612of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
30613the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
30614or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
30615second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
30616sure the value is of a valid type or range; if you write an
30617annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
30618will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
30619
30620While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
30621the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
30622annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
30623formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
30624causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
30625@kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
30626
30627@code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
30628that look like this, respectively:
30629
30630@example
30631% [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30632% [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
30633@end example
30634
30635The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
30636is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
30637when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
30638is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
30639yet, is not relevant here.)
30640
30641@code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
30642of the file:
30643
30644@example
30645% [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
30646@end example
30647
30648Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
30649and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
30650mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
30651the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
30652formulas in the file.
30653
30654Enabling a formula with @kbd{C-x * e} causes a fresh scan for local
30655mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
30656above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
30657a formula with @kbd{C-x * u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
30658global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{C-x * a}.
30659
30660Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
30661mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
30662In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
30663first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
30664formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
30665rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
30666
30667@example
30668% [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
306691.23e2
30670
30671456.
30672@end example
30673
30674We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{C-x * u}
30675on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
30676
30677Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are available
30678which are also available outside of Embedded mode.
30679(@pxref{General Mode Commands}.) They are @code{Save}, in which mode
30680settings are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given
30681by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el})
30682rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
30683mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
30684the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
30685annotations at all.
30686
30687When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
30688for @code{Save} have no effect.
30689
30690@node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30691@section Customizing Embedded Mode
30692
30693@noindent
30694You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
30695variables described here. These variables are customizable
30696(@pxref{Customizing Calc}), or you can use @kbd{M-x set-variable}
30697or @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly.
30698(Another possibility would be to use a file-local variable annotation at
30699the end of the file;
30700@pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the Emacs manual}.)
30701Many of the variables given mentioned here can be set to depend on the
30702major mode of the editing buffer (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
30703
30704@vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
30705The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
30706expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
30707, Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
30708how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
30709pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
30710blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
30711@code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
30712regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
30713in detail.
30714
30715The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
30716Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
30717@code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
30718Lisp program.
30719
30720The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
30721contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
30722of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
30723string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
30724interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
30725new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
30726So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
30727@samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
30728
30729Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
30730to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
30731a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
30732expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
30733or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
30734@samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
30735
30736The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
30737``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
30738which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
30739that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
30740that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
30741one or two dollar signs.
30742
30743The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
30744like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
30745recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
30746
30747By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
30748or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
30749is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
30750newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
30751latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
30752The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
30753must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
30754
30755See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
30756But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
30757which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
30758some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
30759the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
30760must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
30761account for each of these six backslashes!)
30762
30763@vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
30764The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
30765expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
30766regular expression to match the above example would be
30767@code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
30768other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
30769@samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
30770of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
30771case).
30772
4a65fb7a
JB
30773@vindex calc-embedded-word-regexp
30774The @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} variable holds a regular expression
30775used to define an expression to look for (a ``word'') when you type
30776@kbd{C-x * w} to enable Embedded mode.
4009494e
GM
30777
30778@vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
30779The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
30780begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
30781formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
30782actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
30783to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
30784The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space), but may
30785be different for certain major modes.
30786
30787@vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
30788The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
30789ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}, but may be
30790different for different major modes. Without
30791the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
30792that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
30793
30794@vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
30795The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
30796which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
30797@kbd{C-x * f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
30798string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{C-x * f} is
30799typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip this
30800first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
30801the file.
30802
30803@vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
30804The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
30805string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
30806value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
30807@w{@kbd{C-x * f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
30808@kbd{C-x * f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
30809newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
30810
30811@vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
30812The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
30813expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
30814The @kbd{C-x * a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
30815@samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{C-x * a} will
30816not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
30817all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
30818But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
30819actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
30820The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, but may be
30821different for different major modes.
30822This pattern will check for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of
30823lines beginning with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to
30824make Calc consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the
30825formula's opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
30826
30827@vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
30828The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
30829regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
30830Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
30831annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
30832the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
30833The default is @code{"% "}, but may be different for different major
30834modes.
30835
30836@vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
30837The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
30838follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
30839is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}, but may be different for different
30840major modes. If you change this, it is a good idea still to end with a
30841newline so that mode annotations will appear on lines by themselves.
30842
30843@node Programming, Copying, Embedded Mode, Top
30844@chapter Programming
30845
30846@noindent
30847There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
30848on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
30849
30850@enumerate
30851@item
30852@dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
30853and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
30854keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
30855as loops and conditionals.
30856
30857@item
30858@dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
30859new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
30860as an interactive command.
30861
30862@item
30863@dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
30864@xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
30865@code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
30866results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
30867evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
30868
30869@item
30870@dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
30871is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
30872can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
30873can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
30874rewrite rules.
30875@end enumerate
30876
30877@kindex z
30878Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
30879prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
30880beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
30881use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
30882command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
30883The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
30884described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
30885
30886@menu
30887* Creating User Keys::
30888* Keyboard Macros::
30889* Invocation Macros::
30890* Algebraic Definitions::
30891* Lisp Definitions::
30892@end menu
30893
30894@node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
30895@section Creating User Keys
30896
30897@noindent
30898@kindex Z D
30899@pindex calc-user-define
30900Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
30901(@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
30902sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
30903
30904The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
30905press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
30906prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
30907run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
30908available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
30909@kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
30910in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
30911@kbd{z s} to be something else.
30912
30913You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
30914backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
30915
30916As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
30917all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
30918Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
30919
30920User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
30921(@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
30922function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
30923You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
30924of a letter if you wish.
30925
30926@kindex Z U
30927@pindex calc-user-undefine
30928The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
30929For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
30930key we defined above.
30931
30932@kindex Z P
30933@pindex calc-user-define-permanent
30934@cindex Storing user definitions
30935@cindex Permanent user definitions
30936@cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
30937The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
30938binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
30939sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
30940your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
30941@code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}.) For example,
30942@kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
30943you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
30944file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
30945use a different file for the Calc init file.)
30946
30947The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
30948command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
30949key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
30950which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
30951command will save all of these definitions.
30952To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
30953when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
30954without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
30955@samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
30956(If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
30957and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
30958not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
30959or key bindings associated with the function.)
30960
30961@kindex Z E
30962@pindex calc-user-define-edit
30963@cindex Editing user definitions
30964The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
30965of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
30966keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
30967following sections.
30968
30969@node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
30970@section Programming with Keyboard Macros
30971
30972@noindent
30973@kindex X
30974@cindex Programming with keyboard macros
30975@cindex Keyboard macros
30976The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
30977keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
30978this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
30979performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
30980Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
30981execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
30982@xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
30983information.
30984
30985When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
30986treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
30987display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
30988fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
30989macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
30990other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
30991command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
30992and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
30993outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
30994buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
30995must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
30996at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
30997instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
30998
30999Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
31000Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
31001macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
31002analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
31003
31004@menu
31005* Naming Keyboard Macros::
31006* Conditionals in Macros::
31007* Loops in Macros::
31008* Local Values in Macros::
31009* Queries in Macros::
31010@end menu
31011
31012@node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31013@subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
31014
31015@noindent
31016@kindex Z K
31017@pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
31018Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
31019key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
31020This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
31021example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
31022define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
31023(@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
31024@kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
31025sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
31026just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
31027@samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
31028@kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
31029descriptive command name if you wish.
31030
31031Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
31032in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
31033as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
31034give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
31035
31036Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
31037@kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
31038
31039@cindex Keyboard macros, editing
31040The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31041been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
31042edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
31043the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
31044buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
31045The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
31046@code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
31047sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
31048@code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
31049copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
31050same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
31051takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
31052we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
31053@kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
31054
31055@kindex C-x * m
31056@pindex read-kbd-macro
31057The @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
31058of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
31059It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
31060in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
31061
31062@node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31063@subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
31064
31065@noindent
31066@kindex Z [
31067@kindex Z ]
31068@pindex calc-kbd-if
31069@pindex calc-kbd-else
31070@pindex calc-kbd-else-if
31071@pindex calc-kbd-end-if
31072@cindex Conditional structures
31073The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
31074commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
31075sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
31076a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
31077zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
31078@kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
31079performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
31080
31081For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
31082function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
31083number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
31084(@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
31085executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
31086command is skipped.
31087
31088To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
31089keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
31090executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
31091re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
31092suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
31093don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
31094
31095Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
31096one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
31097
31098@kindex Z :
31099The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
31100two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
31101@var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
31102(i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
31103has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
31104@var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
31105be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
31106
31107@kindex Z |
31108The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
31109between any number of alternatives. For example,
31110@kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
31111@var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
31112otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
31113it will execute @var{part3}.
31114
31115More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
31116next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
31117actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
31118@kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
31119@kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
31120equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
31121does not.
31122
31123Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
31124keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
31125and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
31126constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
31127occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
31128uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
31129is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
31130not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
31131Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
31132
31133@kindex Z C-g
31134If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
31135macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
31136actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
31137
31138@node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31139@subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
31140
31141@noindent
31142@kindex Z <
31143@kindex Z >
31144@pindex calc-kbd-repeat
31145@pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
31146@cindex Looping structures
31147@cindex Iterative structures
31148The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
31149(@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
31150which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
31151the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
31152body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
31153computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
31154stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
31155pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
31156repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
31157
31158Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
31159In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
31160conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
31161happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
31162Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
31163then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
31164another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
31165in a buffer, then use @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
31166macro.
31167
31168@kindex Z /
31169@pindex calc-break
31170The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
31171of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
31172if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
31173innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
31174after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
31175effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
31176in the C language.
31177
31178@kindex Z (
31179@kindex Z )
31180@pindex calc-kbd-for
31181@pindex calc-kbd-end-for
31182The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
31183commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
31184value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
31185@kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
31186command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
31187a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
31188The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
31189stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
31190counter each time until the loop finishes.
31191
31192@cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
31193By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
31194less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
31195than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
31196executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
31197once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
31198squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
31199
31200If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
31201forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
31202is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
31203Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
31204argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
31205argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
31206
31207@kindex Z @{
31208@kindex Z @}
31209@pindex calc-kbd-loop
31210@pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
31211The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
31212(@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
31213@kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
31214effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
31215loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
31216doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
31217to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
31218feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
31219running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
31220this feature.)
31221
31222The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
31223keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
31224For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
31225ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
31226as easily as in a macro definition.
31227
31228@xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
31229conditional and looping commands.
31230
31231@node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31232@subsection Local Values in Macros
31233
31234@noindent
31235@cindex Local variables
31236@cindex Restoring saved modes
31237Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
31238without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
31239macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
31240precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
31241modes.
31242
31243@kindex Z `
31244@kindex Z '
31245@pindex calc-kbd-push
31246@pindex calc-kbd-pop
31247Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
31248local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
31249outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31250(@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31251
31252When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31253the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31254variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31255you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31256Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31257
31258If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31259a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31260the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31261@kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31262in exceptional conditions.
31263
31264If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31265you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31266edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31267as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31268type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31269will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31270macros were involved.
31271
31272The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31273and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31274simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31275Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31276(Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31277thereof) are also saved.
31278
31279Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31280they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31281or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31282be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31283for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31284
31285In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31286listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31287will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31288Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31289to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31290outside the construct.
31291
31292The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31293other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31294are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31295
31296@node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31297@subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31298
31299@c @noindent
31300@c @kindex Z =
31301@c @pindex calc-kbd-report
31302@c The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31303@c message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31304@c to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31305@c is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31306@c to turn such messages off.
31307
31308@noindent
31309@kindex Z #
31310@pindex calc-kbd-query
31311The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command prompts for an algebraic
31312entry which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro
31313execution. All the normal conventions of algebraic input, including the
31314use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported. The prompt message itself is
31315taken from the top of the stack, and so must be entered (as a string)
31316before the @kbd{Z #} command. (Recall, as a string it can be entered by
31317pressing the @kbd{"} key and will appear as a vector when it is put on
31318the stack. The prompt message is only put on the stack to provide a
31319prompt for the @kbd{Z #} command; it will not play any role in any
31320subsequent calculations.) This command allows your keyboard macros to
31321accept numbers or formulas as interactive input.
31322
31323As an example,
31324@kbd{2 @key{RET} "Power: " @key{RET} Z # 3 @key{RET} ^} will prompt for
31325input with ``Power: '' in the minibuffer, then return 2 to the provided
31326power. (The response to the prompt that's given, 3 in this example,
31327will not be part of the macro.)
31328
31329@xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31330@kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31331keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31332@kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31333any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31334return control to the keyboard macro.
31335
31336@node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31337@section Invocation Macros
31338
31339@kindex C-x * z
31340@kindex Z I
31341@pindex calc-user-invocation
31342@pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31343Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{C-x * z}
31344(@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31345your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31346macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31347@kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31348There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31349additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31350@kbd{C-x * z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31351
31352For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31353numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31354by typing @kbd{C-x * r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31355To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( C-x * r
31356V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31357just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{C-x * z}.
31358
31359Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31360all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31361do not apply. @kbd{C-x * z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31362uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31363macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31364
31365The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31366@kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31367@xref{General Mode Commands}.
31368
31369@node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31370@section Programming with Formulas
31371
31372@noindent
31373@kindex Z F
31374@pindex calc-user-define-formula
31375@cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31376Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31377The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31378formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31379command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31380name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31381non-numeric arguments.
31382
31383For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31384@samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31385formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31386name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31387for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31388@code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31389@kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31390
31391If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31392@key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31393@kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
31394@kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
31395
31396The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
31397use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
31398prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
31399it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
31400This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
31401new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
31402Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
31403stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
31404formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
31405
31406The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
31407associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
31408The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
31409into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
31410This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
31411two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
31412@samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
31413push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
31414would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
31415@expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
31416@samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
31417@expr{b=100} in the definition.
31418
31419You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
31420control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
31421you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
31422in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
31423for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
31424with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
31425@samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
31426
31427You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
31428formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
31429In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
31430using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
31431
31432The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
31433arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
31434executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
31435arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
31436form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
31437then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
31438arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
31439formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
31440question.
31441
31442If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
31443call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
31444Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
31445derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
31446
31447@kindex Z G
31448@pindex calc-get-user-defn
31449Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
31450with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
31451key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
31452key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
31453specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
31454an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
31455by a @kbd{Z F} command.
31456
31457The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31458been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
31459to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
31460store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
31461@kbd{C-x k} to
31462cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
31463definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
31464@kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
31465then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
31466
31467As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
31468In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
31469definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
31470
31471You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
31472@kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
31473used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
31474which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
31475``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
31476@expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
31477default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
31478in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
31479@kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
31480
31481@node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
31482@section Programming with Lisp
31483
31484@noindent
31485The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
31486do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
31487in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
31488automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
31489@code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
31490Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
31491standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
31492bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
31493will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
31494
31495Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
31496assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
31497Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
31498to program the Calculator.
31499
31500This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
31501small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
31502your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
31503Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
31504for the true Lisp enthusiast.
31505
31506@menu
31507* Defining Functions::
31508* Defining Simple Commands::
31509* Defining Stack Commands::
31510* Argument Qualifiers::
31511* Example Definitions::
31512
31513* Calling Calc from Your Programs::
31514* Internals::
31515@end menu
31516
31517@node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
31518@subsection Defining New Functions
31519
31520@noindent
31521@findex defmath
31522The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
31523except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
31524range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
31525to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
31526example,
31527
31528@example
31529(defmath myfact (n)
31530 (if (> n 0)
31531 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31532 1))
31533@end example
31534
31535@noindent
31536This actually expands to the code,
31537
31538@example
31539(defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31540 (if (math-posp n)
31541 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31542 1))
31543@end example
31544
31545@noindent
31546This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
31547
31548The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
31549expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
31550formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
31551factorial function would be written along the following lines:
31552
31553@smallexample
31554(defmath myfact (n)
31555 (if (> n 0)
31556 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31557 (if (= n 0)
31558 1
31559 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
31560@end smallexample
31561
31562If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
31563(except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
31564will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
31565time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
31566it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
31567efficiently as possible.
31568
31569The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
31570@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
31571@code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
31572@code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
31573@code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
31574@code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
31575
31576For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
31577@samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
31578name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
31579is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
31580used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
31581the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
31582always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
31583
31584Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
31585the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
31586@code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
31587or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
31588@samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
31589
31590A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
31591
31592@itemize @bullet
31593@item
31594The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
31595Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
31596element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
31597the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
31598yields one element of a Calc matrix.
31599
31600@item
31601The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
31602Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
31603a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
31604@code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
31605in which case the effect is to store into the specified
31606element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
31607into one element of a matrix.
31608
31609@item
31610A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
31611@samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
31612binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
31613form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
31614without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
31615Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
31616are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
31617@expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
31618@code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
31619that each element of the header is a list of three or four
31620things, not just two.
31621
31622@item
31623The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
31624For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
31625@code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
31626@expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
31627the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
31628
31629@item
31630The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
31631@code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
31632value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
31633loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
31634
31635@item
31636The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
31637function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
31638as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
31639inside the body of the function.
31640@end itemize
31641
31642Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
31643directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
31644reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
31645Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
31646formula can go between the quotes. For example,
31647
31648@smallexample
31649(defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
31650 (and (numberp x)
31651 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
31652@end smallexample
31653
31654expands to
31655
31656@smallexample
31657(defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
31658 (and (math-numberp x)
31659 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
31660@end smallexample
31661
31662Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
31663a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
31664could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
31665@samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
31666step of @code{myfact} could have been written
31667
31668@example
31669:"n * myfact(n-1)"
31670@end example
31671
31672A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
31673(the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
31674@file{~/.calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
31675If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
31676and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
31677seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
31678this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
31679loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
31680actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
31681commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
31682to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
31683
31684@example
31685(put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
31686 (defmath ... )
31687 (defmath ... )
31688))
31689@end example
31690
31691@noindent
31692@vindex calc-define
31693The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
31694symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
31695property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
31696its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
31697the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
31698values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
31699properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
31700(like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
31701name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
31702
31703The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
31704file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
31705that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
31706after Calc itself is loaded.
31707
31708The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
31709that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
31710@file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
31711that the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
31712
31713If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
31714you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
31715call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
31716after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
31717sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
31718new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
31719@kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
31720protect against this situation, you can put
31721
31722@example
31723(run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
31724@end example
31725
31726@findex calc-check-defines
31727@noindent
31728at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
31729looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
31730has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
31731is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
31732
31733Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
31734property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
31735the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
31736Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
31737
31738@node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
31739@subsection Defining New Simple Commands
31740
31741@noindent
31742@findex interactive
31743If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
31744a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
31745function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
31746with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
31747with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
31748the command work in the Calc environment.
31749
31750In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
31751for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
31752
31753@smallexample
31754(defmath increase-precision (delta)
31755 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
31756 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
31757 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
31758@end smallexample
31759
31760This expands to the pair of definitions,
31761
31762@smallexample
31763(defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
31764 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31765 (interactive "p")
31766 (calc-wrapper
31767 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
31768
31769(defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
31770 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31771 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
31772@end smallexample
31773
31774@noindent
31775where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
31776that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
31777the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
31778@code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
31779
31780@findex calc-wrapper
31781The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
31782the function with code that looks roughly like this:
31783
31784@smallexample
31785(let ((calc-command-flags nil))
31786 (unwind-protect
31787 (save-excursion
31788 (calc-select-buffer)
31789 @emph{body of function}
31790 @emph{renumber stack}
31791 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
31792 @emph{realign cursor and window}
31793 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
31794 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
31795@end smallexample
31796
31797@findex calc-select-buffer
31798The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @samp{*Calculator*}
31799buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
31800the @samp{*Calc Trail*} window.
31801
31802@findex calc-set-command-flag
31803You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
31804set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
31805following command flags:
31806
31807@table @code
31808@item renum-stack
31809Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
31810after this command completes. This is set by routines like
31811@code{calc-push}.
31812
31813@item clear-message
31814Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
31815(to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
31816
31817@item no-align
31818Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
31819
31820@item position-point
31821Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
31822@code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
31823this command finishes.
31824
31825@item keep-flags
31826Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
31827and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
31828
31829@item do-edit
31830Switch to buffer @samp{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
31831
31832@item hold-trail
31833Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
31834there.
31835@end table
31836
31837@kindex Y
31838@kindex Y ?
31839@vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
31840Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
31841extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
31842this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
31843from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
31844@kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
31845(initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
31846other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
31847future versions of Calc.
31848
31849If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
31850others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
31851you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
31852consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
31853stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
31854within your package.
31855
31856Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
31857that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
31858example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
31859to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
31860value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
31861if necessary without having to modify the file.
31862
31863Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
31864command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
31865decreases the precision.
31866
31867@smallexample
31868;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
31869;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
31870
31871(defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
31872 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
31873
31874(put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
31875
31876(define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
31877 'increase-precision)
31878(define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
31879 'decrease-precision)
31880
31881(setq calc-Y-help-msgs
31882 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
31883 calc-Y-help-msgs))
31884
31885(defmath increase-precision (delta)
31886 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31887 (interactive "p")
31888 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
31889
31890(defmath decrease-precision (delta)
31891 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
31892 (interactive "p")
31893 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
31894
31895)) ; end of calc-define property
31896
31897(run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
31898@end smallexample
31899
31900@node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
31901@subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
31902
31903@noindent
31904To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
31905on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
31906
31907@example
31908(interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
31909@end example
31910
31911@noindent
31912where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
31913to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
31914@code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
31915function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
31916@code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
31917parameters is valid.
31918
31919Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
31920acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
31921are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
31922recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
31923a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
31924or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
31925
31926As an example, the definition
31927
31928@smallexample
31929(defmath myfact (n)
31930 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31931 (interactive 1 "fact")
31932 (if (> n 0)
31933 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31934 (and (= n 0) 1)))
31935@end smallexample
31936
31937@noindent
31938is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
31939as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
31940
31941@smallexample
31942(defun calc-myfact ()
31943 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31944 (interactive)
31945 (calc-slow-wrapper
31946 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
31947 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
31948
31949(defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31950 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31951 (if (math-posp n)
31952 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31953 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
31954@end smallexample
31955
31956@findex calc-slow-wrapper
31957The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
31958that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
31959computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
31960with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
31961
31962@findex calc-top-list-n
31963The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
31964of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
31965calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
31966empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
31967
31968@findex calc-enter-result
31969The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
31970@var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
31971Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
31972resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
31973of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
31974being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
31975
31976Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
31977``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
31978in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
31979onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
31980containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
31981
31982The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
31983Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
31984@var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
31985
31986@example
31987(defmath foo (a b &optional c)
31988 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
31989 @var{body})
31990@end example
31991
31992In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
31993@samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
31994executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
31995
31996The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
31997code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
31998number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
31999In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
32000arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
32001
32002@node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
32003@subsection Argument Qualifiers
32004
32005@noindent
32006Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
32007an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
32008
32009@example
32010(defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
32011 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
32012 &rest @var{param})
32013 @var{body})
32014@end example
32015
32016@noindent
32017where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
32018
32019@example
32020(@var{qual} @var{param})
32021@end example
32022
32023The following qualifiers are recognized:
32024
32025@table @samp
32026@item complete
32027@findex complete
32028The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
32029(This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
32030function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
32031own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
32032
32033@item integer
32034@findex integer
32035The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
32036it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
32037formulas are rejected.
32038
32039@item natnum
32040@findex natnum
32041Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
32042
32043@item fixnum
32044@findex fixnum
32045Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
32046which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
32047argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
32048
32049@item float
32050@findex float
32051The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
32052vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
32053actually rejected by this qualifier.)
32054
32055@item @var{pred}
32056The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
32057standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
32058
32059@item not-@var{pred}
32060The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
32061@end table
32062
32063For example,
32064
32065@example
32066(defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
32067 &rest (integer d))
32068 @var{body})
32069@end example
32070
32071@noindent
32072expands to
32073
32074@example
32075(defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
32076 (and (math-matrixp b)
32077 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
32078 (or (math-constp b)
32079 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
32080 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
32081 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
32082 @var{body})
32083@end example
32084
32085@noindent
32086which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
32087body of the function.
32088
32089@node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
32090@subsection Example Definitions
32091
32092@noindent
32093This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
32094These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
32095@pxref{Internals}.
32096
32097@menu
32098* Bit Counting Example::
32099* Sine Example::
32100@end menu
32101
32102@node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
32103@subsubsection Bit-Counting
32104
32105@noindent
32106@ignore
32107@starindex
32108@end ignore
32109@tindex bcount
32110Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
32111``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
32112to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
32113that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
32114create an intermediate set.
32115
32116@smallexample
32117(defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32118 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32119 (let ((count 0))
32120 (while (> n 0)
32121 (if (oddp n)
32122 (setq count (1+ count)))
32123 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
32124 count))
32125@end smallexample
32126
32127@noindent
32128When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
32129Emacs Lisp function:
32130
32131@smallexample
32132(defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
32133 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
32134 (let ((count 0))
32135 (while (math-posp n)
32136 (if (math-oddp n)
32137 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
32138 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
32139 count))
32140@end smallexample
32141
32142If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
32143of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
32144recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
32145involve actual division.
32146
32147To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
32148@var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
32149they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
32150routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
321511000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
32152
32153@smallexample
32154(defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32155 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32156 (let ((count 0))
32157 (while (not (fixnump n))
32158 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
32159 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
32160 n (car qr))))
32161 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
32162
32163(defun bcount-fixnum (n)
32164 (let ((count 0))
32165 (while (> n 0)
32166 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
32167 n (lsh n -1)))
32168 count))
32169@end smallexample
32170
32171@noindent
32172Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
32173Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
32174it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
32175than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
32176uses.
32177
32178The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
32179the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
32180might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
32181more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
32182actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
32183a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
32184same thing with a single division by 512.
32185
32186@node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
32187@subsubsection The Sine Function
32188
32189@noindent
32190@ignore
32191@starindex
32192@end ignore
32193@tindex mysin
32194A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
32195well-known Taylor series expansion for
32196@texline @math{\sin x}:
32197@infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
32198
32199@smallexample
32200(defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
32201 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32202 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32203 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
32204 newsum
32205 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
32206 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
32207 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
32208 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
32209 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
32210 x (* x xnegsqr)
32211 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
32212 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
32213 (break)) ; then we are done.
32214 (setq sum newsum))
32215 sum))
32216@end smallexample
32217
32218The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
32219to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
32220ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
32221is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
32222round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
32223by a separate algorithm.
32224
32225@smallexample
32226(defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
32227 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32228 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32229 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
32230 (cond ((complexp x)
32231 (mysin-complex x))
32232 ((< x 0)
32233 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
32234 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
32235
32236(defmath mysin-raw (x)
32237 (cond ((>= x 7)
32238 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
32239 ((> x (pi-over-2))
32240 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
32241 ((> x (pi-over-4))
32242 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
32243 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
32244 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
32245 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
32246@end smallexample
32247
32248@noindent
32249where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
32250numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
32251series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
32252@code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
32253
32254The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
32255@code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
32256to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
32257test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
32258that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
32259we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
32260the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
32261recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32262clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32263that this rule misses.
32264
32265If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32266it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32267when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32268a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32269
32270@node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32271@subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32272
32273@noindent
32274A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32275Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32276inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32277So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32278@code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32279need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32280much simpler to use!
32281
32282It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32283options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32284
32285In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32286string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32287the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32288
32289Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32290functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32291Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32292loaded and initialized for you.
32293
32294All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32295evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32296
32297@ifinfo
32298@example
32299
32300@end example
32301@end ifinfo
32302@subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32303
32304@noindent
32305If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32306the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32307separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32308@samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32309
32310The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32311request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32312one by one below.
32313
32314You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32315@samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32316example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32317expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32318(assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32319used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32320
32321@ifinfo
32322@example
32323
32324@end example
32325@end ifinfo
32326@subsubsection Error Handling
32327
32328@noindent
32329If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32330the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32331string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32332standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32333division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32334return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32335
32336If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32337using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32338errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32339to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32340
32341If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32342are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32343ignored.
32344
32345As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32346to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32347it permanently with @code{setq}.
32348
32349@ifinfo
32350@example
32351
32352@end example
32353@end ifinfo
32354@subsubsection Numbers Only
32355
32356@noindent
32357Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32358rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32359@code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32360that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32361reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32362or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32363
32364A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32365object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32366is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32367
32368@ifinfo
32369@example
32370
32371@end example
32372@end ifinfo
32373@subsubsection Default Modes
32374
32375@noindent
32376If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32377element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32378various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32379evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32380digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32381mode is used.
32382
32383This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32384If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32385be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32386
32387If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32388variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32389settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32390@file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32391the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32392original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32393
32394For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
32395computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
32396using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
32397of the default of 12.
32398
32399It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
32400program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
32401to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
32402consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
32403when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
32404
32405As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
32406checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
32407string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
32408come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
32409conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
32410see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
32411
32412@ifinfo
32413@example
32414
32415@end example
32416@end ifinfo
32417@subsubsection Raw Numbers
32418
32419@noindent
32420Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
32421You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
32422in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
32423numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
32424from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
32425
32426If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
32427as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
32428how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
32429treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
32430structure.
32431
32432There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
32433@code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
32434an error if that object is not a constant).
32435
32436You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
32437string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
32438arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
32439addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
32440in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
32441function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
32442
32443In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
32444as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
32445integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
32446form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
32447
32448When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
32449to format it as a string.
32450
32451It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
32452values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
32453except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
32454
32455Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
32456containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
32457various kinds of error returns discussed above.
32458
32459@ifinfo
32460@example
32461
32462@end example
32463@end ifinfo
32464@subsubsection Predicates
32465
32466@noindent
32467If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
32468treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
32469@code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
32470non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
32471
32472For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
32473one value is less than another.
32474
32475As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
32476the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
32477indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
32478wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
32479@samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
32480
32481@ifinfo
32482@example
32483
32484@end example
32485@end ifinfo
32486@subsubsection Variable Values
32487
32488@noindent
32489Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
32490replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
32491@code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
32492if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
32493@code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
32494formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
32495will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
32496
32497To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
32498corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
32499@samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
32500understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
32501although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
32502to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
32503
32504@example
32505(setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
32506@end example
32507
32508@ifinfo
32509@example
32510
32511@end example
32512@end ifinfo
32513@subsubsection Stack Access
32514
32515@noindent
32516If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
32517evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
32518result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
32519(unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
32520case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
32521usual way).
32522
32523If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
32524@code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
32525many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
32526argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
32527is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
32528@samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
32529the stack.
32530
32531If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
32532@code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
32533stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
32534@samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
32535integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
32536
32537The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
32538that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
32539as a string.
32540
32541In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
32542order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
32543Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
32544second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
32545instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
32546hexadecimal instead of decimal.
32547
32548It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
32549found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
32550actually expecting it to affect the stack.
32551
32552Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @samp{*Calculator*}
32553buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
32554the stack buffer if necessary.
32555
32556@ifinfo
32557@example
32558
32559@end example
32560@end ifinfo
32561@subsubsection Keyboard Macros
32562
32563@noindent
32564If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
32565string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
32566This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
32567For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
32568vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
32569with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
32570notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
32571
32572If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
32573safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
32574installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
32575@kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
32576``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
32577
32578If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
32579of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
32580that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
32581
32582The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
32583
32584@ifinfo
32585@example
32586
32587@end example
32588@end ifinfo
32589@subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
32590
32591@noindent
32592Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
32593@code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
32594be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
32595quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
32596@code{calc-eval}.
32597
32598The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
32599switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
32600For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
32601will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
32602
32603An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
32604This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
32605by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
32606Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
32607a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
32608automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
32609also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
32610In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
32611your original buffer when it is done.
32612
32613As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
32614expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
32615
32616The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
32617returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
32618
32619@ifinfo
32620@example
32621
32622@end example
32623@end ifinfo
32624@subsubsection Example
32625
32626@noindent
32627@findex convert-temp
32628Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
32629you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
32630Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
32631references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
32632Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
32633command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
32634already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
32635
32636@example
32637(defun convert-temp ()
32638 (interactive)
32639 (save-excursion
32640 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
32641 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
32642 (bot1 (match-end 1))
32643 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
32644 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
32645 (bot2 (match-end 2))
32646 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
32647 (if (equal type "F")
32648 (setq type "C"
32649 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
32650 (setq type "F"
32651 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
32652 (goto-char top2)
32653 (delete-region top2 bot2)
32654 (insert-before-markers type)
32655 (goto-char top1)
32656 (delete-region top1 bot1)
32657 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
32658 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
32659 (insert number))))
32660@end example
32661
32662Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
32663``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
32664instead of after it.
32665
32666@node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
32667@subsection Calculator Internals
32668
32669@noindent
32670This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
32671may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
32672rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
32673conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
32674generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
32675apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
32676their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
32677prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
32678
32679The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
32680Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
32681for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
32682function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
32683autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
32684in the remaining component files.
32685
32686Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
32687generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
32688normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
32689be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
32690special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
32691from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
32692before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
32693prove this file will already be loaded.
32694
32695@menu
32696* Data Type Formats::
32697* Interactive Lisp Functions::
32698* Stack Lisp Functions::
32699* Predicates::
32700* Computational Lisp Functions::
32701* Vector Lisp Functions::
32702* Symbolic Lisp Functions::
32703* Formatting Lisp Functions::
32704* Hooks::
32705@end menu
32706
32707@node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
32708@subsubsection Data Type Formats
32709
32710@noindent
32711Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
32712Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
32713Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
32714which is not a Lisp list.
32715
32716Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
32717@var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for positive integers 1000000 or more, or
32718@samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative integers
32719@mathit{-1000000} or less. Each @var{d} is a base-1000 ``digit,'' a Lisp integer
32720from 0 to 999. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
32721@var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
32722example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} is stored as @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
32723
32724The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
32725the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
32726returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
32727integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
32728If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
32729and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
32730
32731Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
32732where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
32733integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
32734prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
32735to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
32736are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
32737
32738Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
32739@var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
32740@samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
32741precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
32742the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
32743@mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
32744are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
32745except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
32746always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
32747rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
32748
32749Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
32750@var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
32751integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
32752The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
32753components are converted to real numbers automatically.
32754
32755Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
32756@var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
32757is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
32758usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
32759or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
32760If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
32761(If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
32762negative real number.)
32763
32764Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
32765@var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
32766a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
32767float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
32768in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
32769
32770Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
32771a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
32772January 1, 1 AD. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
32773form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
32774
32775Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
32776positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
32777form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
32778
32779Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
32780is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
32781component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
32782(a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
32783converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
32784complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
32785
32786Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
32787where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
32788@var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
32789is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
32790closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
32791the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
32792@w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
32793intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
32794represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
32795is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
32796
32797Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
32798is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
32799An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
32800where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
32801Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
32802generally unused by Calc data structures.
32803
32804Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
32805@var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
32806of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
32807value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
32808special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
32809@var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
32810signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
32811@samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
32812contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
32813@code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
32814object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
32815value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
32816value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
32817@var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
32818which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
32819which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
32820only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
32821cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
32822the variable is used.
32823
32824A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
32825The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
32826and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
32827of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
32828sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
32829right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
32830of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
32831function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
32832@var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
32833The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
32834for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
32835elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
32836functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
32837that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
32838object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
32839wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
32840functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
32841about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
32842and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
32843
32844@node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
32845@subsubsection Interactive Functions
32846
32847@noindent
32848The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
32849commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
32850existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
32851you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
32852
32853@defun calc-set-command-flag flag
32854Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
32855may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
32856stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
32857there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
32858@end defun
32859
32860@defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
32861If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
32862remove it from that list.
32863@end defun
32864
32865@defun calc-record-undo rec
32866Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
32867current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
32868automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
32869you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
32870which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
32871contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
32872the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
32873contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
32874@var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
32875previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
32876which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
32877@var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
32878@samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
32879@end defun
32880
32881@defun calc-record-why msg args
32882Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
32883This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
32884if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
32885enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
32886@var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
32887@samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
32888formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
32889some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
32890(such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
32891satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
32892integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
32893automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
32894@end defun
32895
32896@defun calc-is-inverse
32897This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
32898i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
32899@end defun
32900
32901@defun calc-is-hyperbolic
32902This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
32903@end defun
32904
32905@node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
32906@subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
32907
32908@noindent
32909The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
32910stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
32911
32912@defun calc-push-list vals n
32913Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
32914@var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
32915are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
32916elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
32917end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
32918The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
32919are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
32920is an empty list, nothing happens.
32921
32922The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
32923You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
32924be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
32925must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
32926in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
32927@end defun
32928
32929@defun calc-top-list n m
32930Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
32931stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
32932taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
32933defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
32934one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
32935@var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
32936element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
32937range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
32938is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
32939evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
32940
32941If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
32942been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
32943this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
32944stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
32945which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
32946a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
32947``invalid operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
32948the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
32949If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
32950or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
32951command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
32952list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
32953formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
32954@end defun
32955
32956@defun calc-pop-stack n m
32957Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
32958and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
32959value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
32960
32961If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
32962@kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
32963error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
32964argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
32965contain selections.
32966@end defun
32967
32968@defun calc-record-list vals tag
32969This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
32970are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
32971tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
32972will be used.
32973@end defun
32974
32975@defun calc-normalize n
32976This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
32977least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
32978current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
32979selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
32980actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
32981it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
32982@end defun
32983
32984@defun calc-top-list-n n m
32985This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
32986@code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
32987are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
32988objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
32989commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
32990standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
32991are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
32992This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
32993@code{calc-top-list}.
32994@end defun
32995
32996@defun calc-top-n m
32997This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
32998a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
32999of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
33000@end defun
33001
33002@defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
33003This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
33004The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
33005of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
33006stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
33007non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
33008A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
33009
33010@smallexample
33011(calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
33012 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
33013@end smallexample
33014
33015If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
33016selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
33017this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
33018equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
33019@var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
33020happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
33021arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
33022element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
33023selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
33024@var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
33025you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
33026combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
33027are present.
33028@end defun
33029
33030@defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
33031This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
33032argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
33033argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
33034as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
33035elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
33036
33037@smallexample
33038(defun calc-zeta (arg)
33039 (interactive "P")
33040 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
33041@end smallexample
33042@end defun
33043
33044@defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
33045This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
33046@code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
33047arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
33048one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
33049is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
33050is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
33051is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
33052specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
33053the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
33054stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
33055mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
33056top element.
33057@end defun
33058
33059@defun calc-stack-size
33060Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
33061does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
33062truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
33063@end defun
33064
33065@defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
33066Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
33067will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
33068this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
33069If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
33070line number, not the stack entry itself.
33071@end defun
33072
33073@defun calc-substack-height n
33074Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
33075entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
33076will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
33077one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
33078be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
33079mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
33080entries.)
33081@end defun
33082
33083@defun calc-refresh
33084Erase the @code{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
33085This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
33086display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
33087entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
33088is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
33089rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
33090@end defun
33091
33092@node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
33093@subsubsection Predicates
33094
33095@noindent
33096The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
33097true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
33098true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
33099from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
33100to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
33101the full range of Calc data types.
33102
33103@defun zerop x
33104Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
33105types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
33106it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
33107@samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
33108and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
33109@end defun
33110
33111@defun negp x
33112Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
33113of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
33114all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
33115@samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
33116and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
33117@end defun
33118
33119@defun posp x
33120Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
33121numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
33122@end defun
33123
33124@defun looks-negp x
33125Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
33126@var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
33127such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
33128made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
33129@end defun
33130
33131@defun integerp x
33132Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
33133@end defun
33134
33135@defun fixnump x
33136Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
33137@end defun
33138
33139@defun natnump x
33140Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
33141@end defun
33142
33143@defun fixnatnump x
33144Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
33145@end defun
33146
33147@defun num-integerp x
33148Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
33149true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
33150the decimal point.
33151@end defun
33152
33153@defun messy-integerp x
33154Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
33155A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
33156@code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
33157@end defun
33158
33159@defun num-natnump x
33160Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
33161@end defun
33162
33163@defun evenp x
33164Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
33165@end defun
33166
33167@defun looks-evenp x
33168Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
33169multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
33170@end defun
33171
33172@defun oddp x
33173Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
33174@end defun
33175
33176@defun ratp x
33177Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
33178fraction.
33179@end defun
33180
33181@defun realp x
33182Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
33183or floating-point number.
33184@end defun
33185
33186@defun anglep x
33187Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
33188@end defun
33189
33190@defun floatp x
33191Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
33192interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
33193is a float.
33194@end defun
33195
33196@defun complexp x
33197Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
33198(but not a real number).
33199@end defun
33200
33201@defun rect-complexp x
33202Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
33203@end defun
33204
33205@defun polar-complexp x
33206Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
33207@end defun
33208
33209@defun numberp x
33210Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
33211@end defun
33212
33213@defun scalarp x
33214Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
33215@end defun
33216
33217@defun vectorp x
33218Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
33219is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
33220@end defun
33221
33222@defun numvecp x
33223Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
33224@end defun
33225
33226@defun matrixp x
33227Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
33228all of the same size.
33229@end defun
33230
33231@defun square-matrixp x
33232Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
33233@end defun
33234
33235@defun objectp x
33236Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
33237complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33238modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
33239as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
33240@end defun
33241
33242@defun objvecp x
33243Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
33244incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
33245mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
33246@end defun
33247
33248@defun primp x
33249Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
33250i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
33251includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
33252and intervals.
33253@end defun
33254
33255@defun constp x
33256Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
33257HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
33258components are @code{constp}.
33259@end defun
33260
33261@defun lessp x y
33262Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33263if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33264undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33265by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33266@code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33267converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33268and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33269@end defun
33270
33271@defun beforep x y
33272Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33273of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33274will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33275other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33276objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33277function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33278by @kbd{a s} to put the terms of a product into canonical order:
33279This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to @samp{2 x y}.
33280@end defun
33281
33282@defun equal x y
33283This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33284@var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33285to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
332860 and 0.0 as different.
33287@end defun
33288
33289@defun math-equal x y
33290Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33291they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33292@code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33293converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33294@end defun
33295
33296@defun equal-int x n
33297Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33298is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33299used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33300whenever possible.
33301@end defun
33302
33303@defun nearly-equal x y
33304Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33305equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33306314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33307precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33308precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33309use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33310series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33311to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33312error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33313lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33314In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33315The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33316@end defun
33317
33318@defun nearly-zerop x y
33319Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33320checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33321to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33322if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33323due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33324@var{y} must be real.
33325@end defun
33326
33327@defun is-true x
33328Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33329Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33330or a provably non-zero formula.
33331@end defun
33332
33333@defun reject-arg val pred
33334Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33335This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33336Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33337function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33338@end defun
33339
33340@defun inexact-value
33341If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33342@code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33343``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33344Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33345@code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33346function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33347@samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33348return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33349@end defun
33350
33351@defun overflow
33352This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33353@end defun
33354
33355@defun underflow
33356This signals a floating-point underflow.
33357@end defun
33358
33359@node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33360@subsubsection Computational Functions
33361
33362@noindent
33363The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33364Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33365the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33366the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33367this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33368command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33369is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33370
33371The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33372@code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33373in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33374@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33375respectively, instead.
33376
33377@defun normalize val
33378(Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33379Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33380is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33381if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33382(i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33383small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33384forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33385in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33386return 6.
33387
33388If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33389number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
33390@code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
33391the formula still in symbolic form.
33392
33393If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
33394only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
33395powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
33396not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
33397which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
33398as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
33399never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
33400on the stack.
33401@end defun
33402
33403@defun evaluate-expr expr
33404Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
33405then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
33406when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
33407@end defun
33408
33409@defmac with-extra-prec n body
33410Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
33411digits. This is a macro which expands to
33412
33413@smallexample
33414(math-normalize
33415 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
33416 @var{body}))
33417@end smallexample
33418
33419The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
33420result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
33421is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
33422mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
33423@end defmac
33424
33425@defun make-frac n d
33426Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
33427@samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
33428@end defun
33429
33430@defun make-float mant exp
33431Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
33432of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
33433properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
33434if @var{exp} is out of range.
33435@end defun
33436
33437@defun make-sdev x sigma
33438Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
33439If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
33440If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
33441If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
33442error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33443@end defun
33444
33445@defun make-intv mask lo hi
33446Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
33447integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
33448@var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
33449This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
33450@end defun
33451
33452@defun sort-intv mask lo hi
33453Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
33454@var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
33455bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
33456@end defun
33457
33458@defun make-mod n m
33459Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
33460forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
33461is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
33462is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
33463@end defun
33464
33465@defun float x
33466Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
33467converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
33468numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33469modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
33470or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33471@end defun
33472
33473@defun compare x y
33474Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
33475@samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
334760 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
33477undefined or cannot be determined.
33478@end defun
33479
33480@defun numdigs n
33481Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
33482@samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
33483considered to have zero digits.
33484@end defun
33485
33486@defun scale-int x n
33487Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
33488digits with truncation toward zero.
33489@end defun
33490
33491@defun scale-rounding x n
33492Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
33493integer rather than truncating.
33494@end defun
33495
33496@defun fixnum n
33497Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
33498If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
3349924 binary bits) the result is undefined.
33500@end defun
33501
33502@defun sqr x
33503Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
33504@end defun
33505
33506@defun quotient x y
33507Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
33508and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
33509direction of rounding is undefined.
33510@end defun
33511
33512@defun idiv x y
33513Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
33514integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
33515@samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
33516slower than for @code{quotient}.
33517@end defun
33518
33519@defun imod x y
33520Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
33521and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
33522integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
33523For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
33524@end defun
33525
33526@defun idivmod x y
33527Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
33528@code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
33529is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
33530@end defun
33531
33532@defun pow x y
33533Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
33534also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
33535@w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
33536@end defun
33537
33538@defun abs-approx x
33539Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
33540example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
33541the absolute values of the components.
33542@end defun
33543
33544@findex e
33545@findex gamma-const
33546@findex ln-2
33547@findex ln-10
33548@findex phi
33549@findex pi-over-2
33550@findex pi-over-4
33551@findex pi-over-180
33552@findex sqrt-two-pi
33553@findex sqrt-e
33554@findex two-pi
33555@defun pi
33556The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
33557Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
33558@code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
33559@code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, @code{ln-10}, @code{phi} and
33560@code{gamma-const}. Each function returns a floating-point value in the
33561current precision, and each uses caching so that all calls after the
33562first are essentially free.
33563@end defun
33564
33565@defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
33566This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
33567@code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
33568It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
33569if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
33570form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
33571is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
33572satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
33573with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
33574two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
33575calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
33576digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
33577again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
33578@end defmac
33579
33580@findex half-circle
33581@findex quarter-circle
33582@defun full-circle symb
33583If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
33584integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
33585corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
33586@samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
33587function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
33588@end defun
33589
33590@defun power-of-2 n
33591Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
33592integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
33593particular @var{n} is expensive.
33594@end defun
33595
33596@defun integer-log2 n
33597Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
33598is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
33599return @code{nil}.
33600@end defun
33601
33602@defun div-mod a b m
33603Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
33604there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
33605@end defun
33606
33607@defun pow-mod a b m
33608Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
33609@var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
33610algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
33611@end defun
33612
33613@defun isqrt n
33614Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
33615of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
33616If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
33617@end defun
33618
33619@defun to-hms a ang
33620Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
33621it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
33622or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
33623is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
33624@end defun
33625
33626@defun from-hms a ang
33627Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
33628it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
33629current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
33630is returned as-is.
33631@end defun
33632
33633@defun to-radians a
33634Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
33635angular mode.
33636@end defun
33637
33638@defun from-radians a
33639Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
33640If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
33641@end defun
33642
33643@defun to-radians-2 a
33644Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
33645radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
33646@end defun
33647
33648@defun from-radians-2 a
33649Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
33650degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
33651@end defun
33652
33653@defun random-digit
33654Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
33655@end defun
33656
33657@defun random-digits n
33658Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
33659in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
33660@end defun
33661
33662@defun random-float
33663Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
33664@end defun
33665
33666@defun prime-test n iters
33667Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
33668one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
33669because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
33670was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
33671@samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
33672are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
33673test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
33674and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
33675iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
33676@var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
33677case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
33678you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
33679@code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
33680@end defun
33681
33682@defun to-simple-fraction f
33683If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
33684as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
33685For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
33686fast.
33687@end defun
33688
33689@defun to-fraction f tol
33690Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
33691a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
33692function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
33693@end defun
33694
33695@defun quarter-integer n
33696If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
33697returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
33698@mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
33699it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
33700returns @code{nil}.
33701@end defun
33702
33703@node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
33704@subsubsection Vector Functions
33705
33706@noindent
33707The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
33708matrices.
33709
33710@defun math-concat x y
33711Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
33712in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
33713@end defun
33714
33715@defun vec-length v
33716Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
33717result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
33718rows in the matrix.
33719@end defun
33720
33721@defun mat-dimens m
33722Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
33723a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
33724but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
33725of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
33726the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
33727produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
33728@samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
33729and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
33730elements.
33731@end defun
33732
33733@defun dimension-error
33734Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
33735The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
33736form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
33737@end defun
33738
33739@defun build-vector args
33740Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
33741For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
33742@samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
33743@end defun
33744
33745@defun make-vec obj dims
33746Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
33747@var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
33748filled with 27's.
33749@end defun
33750
33751@defun row-matrix v
33752If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
33753a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
33754leave it alone.
33755@end defun
33756
33757@defun col-matrix v
33758If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
33759matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
33760already a matrix, leave it alone.
33761@end defun
33762
33763@defun map-vec f v
33764Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
33765@samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
33766of vector @var{v}.
33767@end defun
33768
33769@defun map-vec-2 f a b
33770Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
33771If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
33772vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
33773for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
33774@var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
33775For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
33776with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
33777work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
33778just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
33779@end defun
33780
33781@defun reduce-vec f v
33782Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
33783@var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
33784If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
33785@end defun
33786
33787@defun reduce-cols f m
33788Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
33789example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
33790is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
33791@end defun
33792
33793@defun mat-row m n
33794Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
33795@samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
33796(@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
33797@end defun
33798
33799@defun mat-col m n
33800Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
33801The arguments are not checked for correctness.
33802@end defun
33803
33804@defun mat-less-row m n
33805Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
33806number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
33807@end defun
33808
33809@defun mat-less-col m n
33810Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
33811@end defun
33812
33813@defun transpose m
33814Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
33815@end defun
33816
33817@defun flatten-vector v
33818Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
33819if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
33820@end defun
33821
33822@defun copy-matrix m
33823If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
33824@code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
33825element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
33826element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
33827the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
33828vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
33829@end defun
33830
33831@defun swap-rows m r1 r2
33832Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
33833other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
33834function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
33835matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
33836is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
33837@var{m}.
33838@end defun
33839
33840@node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
33841@subsubsection Symbolic Functions
33842
33843@noindent
33844The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
33845Calculator.
33846
33847@defun calc-prepare-selection num
33848Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
33849omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
33850it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
33851useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
33852variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
33853the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
33854@code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
33855list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
33856as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
33857a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
33858which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
33859their corresponding sub-formulas.
33860
33861A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
33862formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
33863@samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
33864other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
33865appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
33866@code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
33867@code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
33868replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
33869@samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
33870plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
33871user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
33872entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
33873is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
33874these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
33875@end defun
33876
33877@defun calc-encase-atoms x
33878This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
33879formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
33880described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
33881the formula in-place.
33882@end defun
33883
33884@defun calc-find-selected-part
33885Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
33886the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
33887called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
33888formula, this returns @code{nil}.
33889@end defun
33890
33891@defun calc-change-current-selection selection
33892Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
33893@var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
33894of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
33895The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
33896to reflect the new selection.
33897@end defun
33898
33899@defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
33900Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
33901by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
33902sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
33903is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
33904@var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
33905@end defun
33906
33907@defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
33908Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
33909@var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
33910is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
33911will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
33912sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
33913@var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
33914This function does not take associativity into account.
33915@end defun
33916
33917@defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
33918This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
33919(unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
33920to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
33921@samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
33922return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
33923return the whole expression.
33924@end defun
33925
33926@defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
33927This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
33928complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
33929parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
33930has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
33931@end defun
33932
33933@defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
33934This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
33935@var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
33936@samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
33937If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
33938If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
33939function does not take associativity into account.
33940@end defun
33941
33942@defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
33943This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
33944sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
33945@end defun
33946
33947@defun simplify expr
33948Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying various algebraic rules.
33949This is what the @w{@kbd{a s}} (@code{calc-simplify}) command uses. This
33950always returns a copy of the expression; the structure @var{expr} points
33951to remains unchanged in memory.
33952
33953More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
33954first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
33955@code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
33956the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
33957each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
33958further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
33959traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
33960before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
33961the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
33962until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
33963needed:@: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
33964further simplifications were possible.
33965@end defun
33966
33967@defun simplify-extended expr
33968Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
33969help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
33970circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
33971to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
33972implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
33973to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
33974Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
33975before taking any action.
33976@end defun
33977
33978@defun simplify-units expr
33979Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
33980whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
33981@code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
33982@end defun
33983
33984@defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
33985Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
33986form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
33987(like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
33988applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
33989@var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
33990functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
33991function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
33992executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
33993the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
33994if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
33995ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
33996If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
33997substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
33998
33999At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
34000original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
34001first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
34002function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
34003of the main @code{simplify} loop.
34004
34005Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
34006be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
34007provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
34008function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
34009
34010The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
34011before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
34012list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
34013allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
34014convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
34015
34016@smallexample
34017(math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
34018 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
34019 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
34020 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
34021 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
34022 (or math-living-dangerously
34023 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
34024 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
34025@end smallexample
34026
34027This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
34028for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
34029@samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
34030replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
34031@end defmac
34032
34033@defun common-constant-factor expr
34034Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
34035same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
34036For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
340373 is a common factor of all the terms.
34038@end defun
34039
34040@defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
34041Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
34042divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
34043destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
34044it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
34045allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
34046square roots:
34047
34048@smallexample
34049(math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
34050 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
34051 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
34052 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
34053 (math-normalize
34054 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
34055 (math-cancel-common-factor
34056 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
34057@end smallexample
34058@end defun
34059
34060@defun frac-gcd a b
34061Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
34062rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
34063numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
34064It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
34065@code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
34066@end defun
34067
34068@defun map-tree func expr many
34069Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
34070@var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
34071argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
34072@var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
34073@var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
34074recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
34075until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
34076is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
34077@var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
34078@var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
34079integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
34080default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
34081@end defun
34082
34083@defun compile-rewrites rules
34084Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
34085be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
34086the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
34087for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
34088with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
34089message.
34090@end defun
34091
34092@defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
34093Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
34094@var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
34095top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
34096matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
34097the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
34098it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
34099@var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
34100rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
34101@code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
34102down to just a few rules in the rule set.
34103@end defun
34104
34105@defun rewrite-heads expr
34106Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
34107@code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
34108@end defun
34109
34110@defun rewrite expr rules many
34111This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
34112specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
34113rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
34114times.
34115@end defun
34116
34117@defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
34118Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
34119pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
34120of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
34121non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
34122@end defun
34123
34124@defun deriv expr var value symb
34125Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
34126(which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
34127the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
34128derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
34129functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
34130functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
34131However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of undifferentiable
34132functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
34133@code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
34134
34135Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
34136adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
34137of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
34138function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
34139should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
34140original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
34141a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
34142is defined by
34143
34144@smallexample
34145(put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
34146 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
34147@end smallexample
34148
34149The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
34150@smallexample
34151(put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
34152 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34153(put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
34154 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34155@end smallexample
34156@end defun
34157
34158@defun tderiv expr var value symb
34159Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
34160@code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
34161assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
34162@end defun
34163
34164@defun integ expr var low high
34165Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
34166@xref{Calculus}, for further details.
34167@end defun
34168
34169@defmac math-defintegral funcs body
34170Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
34171this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
34172The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
34173with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
34174function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
34175variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
34176evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
34177should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
34178@var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
34179@code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
34180
34181@smallexample
34182(math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
34183 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
34184 (and int
34185 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
34186
34187(math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
34188 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
34189 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
34190@end smallexample
34191
34192In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
34193relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
34194cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
34195@code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
34196the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
34197result.
34198@end defmac
34199
34200@defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
34201Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
34202This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
34203is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
34204@var{v}.
34205@end defmac
34206
34207@defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
34208Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
34209the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
34210side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
34211@var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
34212the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
34213different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
34214which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
34215If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
34216and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
34217as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
34218
34219@smallexample
34220(put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
34221 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
34222@end smallexample
34223
34224This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
34225a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
34226@samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
34227variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
34228if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
34229@end defun
34230
34231@defun solve-eqn expr var full
34232This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
34233typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
34234interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
34235equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
34236@end defun
34237
34238@defun solve-system exprs vars full
34239This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
34240and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
34241@xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
34242@end defun
34243
34244@defun expr-contains expr var
34245Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
34246of @var{expr}.
34247
34248This function might seem at first to be identical to
34249@code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
34250@code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
34251@code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
34252@samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
34253@code{eq} to each other.
34254@end defun
34255
34256@defun expr-contains-count expr var
34257Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
34258of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
34259@end defun
34260
34261@defun expr-depends expr var
34262Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
34263In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
34264in common.
34265@end defun
34266
34267@defun expr-contains-vars expr
34268Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34269contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34270@end defun
34271
34272@defun expr-subst expr old new
34273Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34274by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34275to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34276@var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34277@end defun
34278
34279@defun multi-subst expr old new
34280This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34281are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34282list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34283are ignored.
34284@end defun
34285
34286@defun expr-weight expr
34287Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34288number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34289``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34290@end defun
34291
34292@defun expr-height expr
34293Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34294which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34295counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34296@end defun
34297
34298@defun polynomial-p expr var
34299Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34300@var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34301highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34302for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34303@code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34304(@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34305appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34306@var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34307a polynomial of degree 0.
34308@end defun
34309
34310@defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34311Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34312@var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34313where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34314@var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34315list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34316produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34317be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34318constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34319if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34320specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34321value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34322@samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34323@var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34324is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34325@var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34326themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34327polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34328x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34329expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34330@end defun
34331
34332@defun polynomial-base expr pred
34333Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34334if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34335this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34336be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34337and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34338the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34339The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34340you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34341have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34342is found.
34343@end defun
34344
34345@defun poly-simplify poly
34346Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34347clipping off trailing zeros.
34348@end defun
34349
34350@defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34351Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34352@code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34353@var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34354polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34355@end defun
34356
34357@defun poly-mul a b
34358Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34359result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34360@end defun
34361
34362@defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34363Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34364list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34365(@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34366expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34367to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34368@end defun
34369
34370@defun check-unit-name var
34371Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34372name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34373will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34374prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34375Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34376for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34377is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34378@end defun
34379
34380@defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34381Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34382interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34383expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34384checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34385@end defun
34386
34387@defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34388Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34389return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34390not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
34391two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
34392@end defun
34393
34394@defun to-standard-units expr which
34395Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
34396is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
34397can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
34398where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
34399is an expression to substitute for it.
34400@end defun
34401
34402@defun remove-units expr
34403Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
34404This expression is generally normalized before use.
34405@end defun
34406
34407@defun extract-units expr
34408Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
34409by ones.
34410@end defun
34411
34412@node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
34413@subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
34414
34415@noindent
34416The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
34417Calc numbers and formulas.
34418
34419@defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
34420This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
34421@xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
34422@end defun
34423
34424@defun read-number str
34425If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
34426fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
34427number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
34428@end defun
34429
34430@defun read-expr str
34431Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
34432not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
34433@samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
34434into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
34435a string describing the problem.
34436@end defun
34437
34438@defun read-exprs str
34439Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
34440Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
34441shown above is returned instead.
34442@end defun
34443
34444@defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
34445Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
34446conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
34447is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
34448entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
34449if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
34450given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
34451If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
34452is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
34453be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
34454@code{calc-normalize} first.
34455
34456To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
34457@code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
34458to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
34459@code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
34460will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
34461that actually appeared in the input.
34462@end defun
34463
34464@defun format-number a
34465Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
34466@end defun
34467
34468@defun format-flat-expr a prec
34469Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
34470in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
34471This is a simple format designed
34472mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
34473@code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
34474complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
34475result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
34476you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
34477surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
34478@end defun
34479
34480@defun format-nice-expr a width
34481This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
34482except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
34483specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
34484rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
34485command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
34486@end defun
34487
34488@defun format-value a width
34489Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
34490format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
34491not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
34492grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
34493contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
34494parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
34495the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
34496window is used.
34497@end defun
34498
34499@defun compose-expr a prec
34500Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
34501language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
34502structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
34503You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
34504a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
34505whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
34506arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
34507mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
34508@code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
34509In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
34510tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
34511or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
34512normal function-call notation for that language.
34513@end defun
34514
34515@defun composition-to-string c w
34516Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
34517a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
34518newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
34519The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
34520followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
34521@end defun
34522
34523@defun comp-width c
34524Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
34525@end defun
34526
34527@defun comp-height c
34528Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
34529@end defun
34530
34531@defun comp-ascent c
34532Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
34533above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
34534@end defun
34535
34536@defun comp-descent c
34537Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
34538the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
34539@end defun
34540
34541@defun comp-first-char c
34542If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
34543(leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
34544return @code{nil}.
34545@end defun
34546
34547@defun comp-last-char c
34548If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
34549(rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
34550@end defun
34551
34552@comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34553@comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
34554@comment
34555@comment @noindent
34556@comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
34557
34558@node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34559@subsubsection Hooks
34560
34561@noindent
34562Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
34563which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
34564that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
34565function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
34566other customization-related variables are also described here.
34567
34568@defvar calc-load-hook
34569This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
34570been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
34571@code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
34572@end defvar
34573
34574@defvar calc-ext-load-hook
34575This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
34576@end defvar
34577
34578@defvar calc-start-hook
34579This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
34580At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
34581necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
34582and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
34583@end defvar
34584
34585@defvar calc-mode-hook
34586This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
34587this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
34588after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
34589has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
34590have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
34591@code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
34592evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
34593been evaluated yet.
34594@end defvar
34595
34596@defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
34597This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
34598It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
34599Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
34600per Emacs session.
34601@end defvar
34602
34603@defvar calc-end-hook
34604This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
34605presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
34606be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
34607step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
34608@end defvar
34609
34610@defvar calc-window-hook
34611If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc window.
34612Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
34613(The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
34614hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
34615generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
34616and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
34617@end defvar
34618
34619@defvar calc-trail-window-hook
34620If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc Trail
34621window. The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
34622which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook}, this hook
34623must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
34624@end defvar
34625
34626@defvar calc-embedded-mode-hook
34627This hook is called the first time that Embedded mode is entered.
34628@end defvar
34629
34630@defvar calc-embedded-new-buffer-hook
34631This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is entered in a
34632new buffer.
34633@end defvar
34634
34635@defvar calc-embedded-new-formula-hook
34636This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is enabled for a
34637new formula.
34638@end defvar
34639
34640@defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
34641This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
34642commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
34643The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
34644@code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
34645text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
34646@code{calc-edit} command.)
34647@end defvar
34648
34649@defvar calc-mode-save-hook
34650This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
34651after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
34652Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
34653message is inserted.
34654@end defvar
34655
34656@defvar calc-reset-hook
34657This hook is called after @kbd{C-x * 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
34658reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
34659@end defvar
34660
34661@defvar calc-other-modes
34662This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
34663concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
34664mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
34665``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
34666by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
34667@end defvar
34668
34669@defvar calc-mode-map
34670This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
34671to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
34672Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
34673loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
34674which is a command that loads the extensions package and
34675``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
34676one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
34677extensions are loaded.
34678@end defvar
34679
34680@defvar calc-digit-map
34681This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
34682entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
34683key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
34684@code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
34685@end defvar
34686
34687@defvar calc-alg-ent-map
34688This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
34689mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
34690@end defvar
34691
34692@defvar calc-store-var-map
34693This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
34694commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
34695mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
34696@end defvar
34697
34698@defvar calc-edit-mode-map
34699This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
34700temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
34701and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
34702@end defvar
34703
34704@defvar calc-mode-var-list
34705This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
34706Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
34707and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
34708is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
34709non-default variables are written out.
34710@end defvar
34711
34712@defvar calc-local-var-list
34713This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
34714Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
34715These variables also have their default values manipulated by
34716the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
34717Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
34718used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
34719list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
34720@end defvar
34721
34722@node Copying, GNU Free Documentation License, Programming, Top
34723@appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
34724@include gpl.texi
34725
34726@node GNU Free Documentation License, Customizing Calc, Copying, Top
34727@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
34728@include doclicense.texi
34729
34730@node Customizing Calc, Reporting Bugs, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
34731@appendix Customizing Calc
34732
34733The usual prefix for Calc is the key sequence @kbd{C-x *}. If you wish
34734to use a different prefix, you can put
34735
34736@example
34737(global-set-key "NEWPREFIX" 'calc-dispatch)
34738@end example
34739
34740@noindent
34741in your .emacs file.
34742(@xref{Key Bindings,,Customizing Key Bindings,emacs,
34743The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information on binding keys.)
34744A convenient way to start Calc is with @kbd{C-x * *}; to make it equally
34745convenient for users who use a different prefix, the prefix can be
34746followed by @kbd{=}, @kbd{&}, @kbd{#}, @kbd{\}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{+} or
34747@kbd{-} as well as @kbd{*} to start Calc, and so in many cases the last
34748character of the prefix can simply be typed twice.
34749
34750Calc is controlled by many variables, most of which can be reset
34751from within Calc. Some variables are less involved with actual
34752calculation, and can be set outside of Calc using Emacs's
34753customization facilities. These variables are listed below.
34754Typing @kbd{M-x customize-variable RET @var{variable-name} RET}
34755will bring up a buffer in which the variable's value can be redefined.
34756Typing @kbd{M-x customize-group RET calc RET} will bring up a buffer which
34757contains all of Calc's customizable variables. (These variables can
34758also be reset by putting the appropriate lines in your .emacs file;
34759@xref{Init File, ,Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)
34760
34761Some of the customizable variables are regular expressions. A regular
34762expression is basically a pattern that Calc can search for.
34763See @ref{Regexp Search,, Regular Expression Search, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}
34764to see how regular expressions work.
34765
34766@defvar calc-settings-file
34767The variable @code{calc-settings-file} holds the file name in
34768which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P} store ``permanent''
34769definitions.
34770If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user init file (typically
34771@file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is
34772@code{nil}, then Calc will automatically load your settings file (if it
34773exists) the first time Calc is invoked.
34774
34775The default value for this variable is @code{"~/.calc.el"}.
34776@end defvar
34777
34778@defvar calc-gnuplot-name
34779See @ref{Graphics}.@*
34780The variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name} should be the name of the
34781GNUPLOT program (a string). If you have GNUPLOT installed on your
34782system but Calc is unable to find it, you may need to set this
34783variable. You may also need to set some Lisp variables to show Calc how
34784to run GNUPLOT on your system, see @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices} .
34785The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-name} is @code{"gnuplot"}.
34786@end defvar
34787
34788@defvar calc-gnuplot-plot-command
34789@defvarx calc-gnuplot-print-command
34790See @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices}.@*
34791The variables @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
34792@code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} represent system commands to
34793display and print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
34794@code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
34795@samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
34796Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
34797to display or print the output.
34798
34799The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} is @code{nil},
34800and the default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} is
34801@code{"lp %s"}.
34802@end defvar
34803
34804@defvar calc-language-alist
34805See @ref{Basic Embedded Mode}.@*
34806The variable @code{calc-language-alist} controls the languages that
34807Calc will associate with major modes. When Calc embedded mode is
34808enabled, it will try to use the current major mode to
34809determine what language should be used. (This can be overridden using
34810Calc's mode changing commands, @xref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
34811The variable @code{calc-language-alist} consists of a list of pairs of
34812the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} . @var{LANGUAGE})}; for example,
34813@code{(latex-mode . latex)} is one such pair. If Calc embedded is
34814activated in a buffer whose major mode is @var{MAJOR-MODE}, it will set itself
34815to use the language @var{LANGUAGE}.
34816
34817The default value of @code{calc-language-alist} is
34818@example
34819 ((latex-mode . latex)
34820 (tex-mode . tex)
34821 (plain-tex-mode . tex)
34822 (context-mode . tex)
34823 (nroff-mode . eqn)
34824 (pascal-mode . pascal)
34825 (c-mode . c)
34826 (c++-mode . c)
34827 (fortran-mode . fortran)
34828 (f90-mode . fortran))
34829@end example
34830@end defvar
34831
34832@defvar calc-embedded-announce-formula
34833@defvarx calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist
34834See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34835The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} helps determine
34836what formulas @kbd{C-x * a} will activate in a buffer. It is a
34837regular expression, and when activating embedded formulas with
34838@kbd{C-x * a}, it will tell Calc that what follows is a formula to be
34839activated. (Calc also uses other patterns to find formulas, such as
34840@samp{=>} and @samp{:=}.)
34841
34842The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which checks
34843for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning with
34844@samp{%} and a space.
34845
34846The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist} is used to
34847set @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} to different regular
34848expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34849It consists of a list of pairs of the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} .
34850@var{REGEXP})}, and its default value is
34851@example
34852 ((c++-mode . "//Embed\n\\(// .*\n\\)*")
34853 (c-mode . "/\\*Embed\\*/\n\\(/\\* .*\\*/\n\\)*")
34854 (f90-mode . "!Embed\n\\(! .*\n\\)*")
34855 (fortran-mode . "C Embed\n\\(C .*\n\\)*")
34856 (html-helper-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34857 (html-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34858 (nroff-mode . "\\\\\"Embed\n\\(\\\\\" .*\n\\)*")
34859 (pascal-mode . "@{Embed@}\n\\(@{.*@}\n\\)*")
34860 (sgml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34861 (xml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34862 (texinfo-mode . "@@c Embed\n\\(@@c .*\n\\)*"))
34863@end example
34864Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
34865should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
34866and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
34867@end defvar
34868
34869@defvar calc-embedded-open-formula
34870@defvarx calc-embedded-close-formula
34871@defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist
34872See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34873The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
8dc6104d 34874@code{calc-embedded-close-formula} control the region that Calc will
4009494e
GM
34875activate as a formula when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x * e}.
34876They are regular expressions;
34877Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
34878nearest text matching these regular expressions to be the ``formula
34879delimiters''.
34880
34881The simplest delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that
34882Embedded mode understands by default are:
34883@enumerate
34884@item
34885The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
34886@samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
34887@item
34888Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
34889@item
34890Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
34891@item
34892Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
34893@item
34894Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
34895@end enumerate
34896
34897The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist} is used to
34898set @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
34899@code{calc-embedded-close-formula} to different regular
34900expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34901It consists of a list of lists of the form
34902@code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-FORMULA-REGEXP}
34903@var{CLOSE-FORMULA-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
34904@code{nil}.
34905@end defvar
34906
4a65fb7a
JB
34907@defvar calc-embedded-word-regexp
34908@defvarx calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist
4009494e 34909See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
4a65fb7a
JB
34910The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} determines the expression
34911that Calc will activate when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x *
34912w}. It is a regular expressions.
34913
34914The default value of @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} is
34915@code{"[-+]?[0-9]+\\(\\.[0-9]+\\)?\\([eE][-+]?[0-9]+\\)?"}.
34916
34917The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist} is used to
34918set @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} to a different regular
34919expression depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
4009494e 34920It consists of a list of lists of the form
4a65fb7a 34921@code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{WORD-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
4009494e
GM
34922@code{nil}.
34923@end defvar
34924
34925@defvar calc-embedded-open-plain
34926@defvarx calc-embedded-close-plain
34927@defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist
34928See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34929The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
34930@code{calc-embedded-open-plain} are used to delimit ``plain''
34931formulas. Note that these are actual strings, not regular
34932expressions, because Calc must be able to write these string into a
34933buffer as well as to recognize them.
34934
34935The default string for @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} is
34936@code{"%%% "}, note the trailing space. The default string for
34937@code{calc-embedded-close-plain} is @code{" %%%\n"}, without
34938the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
34939that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
34940
34941The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist} is used to
34942set @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
34943@code{calc-embedded-close-plain} to different strings
34944depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34945It consists of a list of lists of the form
34946@code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-PLAIN-STRING}
34947@var{CLOSE-PLAIN-STRING})}, and its default value is
34948@example
34949 ((c++-mode "// %% " " %%\n")
34950 (c-mode "/* %% " " %% */\n")
34951 (f90-mode "! %% " " %%\n")
34952 (fortran-mode "C %% " " %%\n")
34953 (html-helper-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34954 (html-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34955 (nroff-mode "\\\" %% " " %%\n")
34956 (pascal-mode "@{%% " " %%@}\n")
34957 (sgml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34958 (xml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34959 (texinfo-mode "@@c %% " " %%\n"))
34960@end example
34961Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
34962should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
34963and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
34964@end defvar
34965
34966@defvar calc-embedded-open-new-formula
34967@defvarx calc-embedded-close-new-formula
34968@defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist
34969See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34970The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
34971@code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} are strings which are
34972inserted before and after a new formula when you type @kbd{C-x * f}.
34973
34974The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} is
34975@code{"\n\n"}. If this string begins with a newline character and the
34976@kbd{C-x * f} is typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip
34977this first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in the
34978file. The default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} is
34979also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by @w{@kbd{C-x * f}}
34980if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if @kbd{C-x * f} is
34981typed on a blank line, both a leading opening newline and a trailing
34982closing newline are omitted.)
34983
34984The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist} is used to
34985set @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
34986@code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} to different strings
34987depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34988It consists of a list of lists of the form
34989@code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-NEW-FORMULA-STRING}
34990@var{CLOSE-NEW-FORMULA-STRING})}, and its default value is
34991@code{nil}.
34992@end defvar
34993
34994@defvar calc-embedded-open-mode
34995@defvarx calc-embedded-close-mode
34996@defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist
34997See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34998The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
34999@code{calc-embedded-close-mode} are strings which Calc will place before
35000and after any mode annotations that it inserts. Calc never scans for
35001these strings; Calc always looks for the annotation itself, so it is not
35002necessary to add them to user-written annotations.
35003
35004The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} is @code{"% "}
35005and the default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} is
35006@code{"\n"}.
35007If you change the value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode}, it is a good
35008idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations will appear on
35009lines by themselves.
35010
35011The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist} is used to
35012set @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35013@code{calc-embedded-close-mode} to different strings
35014expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35015It consists of a list of lists of the form
35016@code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-MODE-STRING}
35017@var{CLOSE-MODE-STRING})}, and its default value is
35018@example
35019 ((c++-mode "// " "\n")
35020 (c-mode "/* " " */\n")
35021 (f90-mode "! " "\n")
35022 (fortran-mode "C " "\n")
35023 (html-helper-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35024 (html-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35025 (nroff-mode "\\\" " "\n")
35026 (pascal-mode "@{ " " @}\n")
35027 (sgml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35028 (xml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35029 (texinfo-mode "@@c " "\n"))
35030@end example
35031Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}
35032should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35033and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}.
35034@end defvar
35035
35036@defvar calc-multiplication-has-precedence
35037The variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} determines
45b778a6
JB
35038whether multiplication has precedence over division in algebraic
35039formulas in normal language modes. If
35040@code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is non-@code{nil}, then
35041multiplication has precedence (and, for certain obscure reasons, is
35042right associative), and so for example @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted
35043as @samp{a/(b*c)}. If @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is
35044@code{nil}, then multiplication has the same precedence as division
35045(and, like division, is left associative), and so for example
4009494e
GM
35046@samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted as @samp{(a/b)*c}. The default value
35047of @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is @code{t}.
35048@end defvar
35049
35050@node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Customizing Calc, Top
35051@appendix Reporting Bugs
35052
35053@noindent
35054If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
35055
35056@example
35057jay.p.belanger@@gmail.com
35058@end example
35059
35060@noindent
35061There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
35062you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
35063line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
35064send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
35065reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
35066regular mailbox.
35067
35068If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, please send
35069them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already top-heavy with
35070features; this obviously cannot be the case, so if you have ideas, send
35071them right in.
35072
35073At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
35074future work. If any enthusiastic souls wish to take it upon themselves
35075to work on these, please send a message (using @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug})
35076so any efforts can be coordinated.
35077
35078The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
35079CVS tree. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
35080
35081@c [summary]
35082@node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
35083@appendix Calc Summary
35084
35085@noindent
5a83c46e 35086This section includes a complete list of Calc keystroke commands.
4009494e
GM
35087Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
35088last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
35089and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
35090The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
35091Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
35092command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
35093command name refer to notes at the end.
35094
35095Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
35096keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
35097@xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
35098
35099@iftex
35100@begingroup
35101@tex
35102\vskip-2\baselineskip \null
35103\gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
35104\gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
35105\leavevmode%
35106{\smallfonts
35107\hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
35108\hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
35109\hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
35110\hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
35111\thinspace%
35112{\tt#5}%
35113{\sl#6}%
35114}}%
35115\gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
35116\gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
35117\gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
35118\gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
35119\gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
35120\gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
35121@end tex
35122@let@:=@sumsep
35123@let@r=@sumrow
35124@catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
35125@catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
35126@catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
35127@catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
35128@end iftex
35129@format
35130@iftex
35131@advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
35132@let@c@sumbreak
35133@end iftex
35134@r{ @: C-x * a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
35135@r{ @: C-x * b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
35136@r{ @: C-x * c @: @: @:calc@:}
35137@r{ @: C-x * d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
35138@r{ @: C-x * e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
35139@r{ @: C-x * f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
35140@r{ @: C-x * g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
35141@r{ @: C-x * i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35142@r{ @: C-x * j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
35143@r{ @: C-x * k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
35144@r{ @: C-x * l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
35145@r{ @: C-x * m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
35146@r{ @: C-x * n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
35147@r{ @: C-x * o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
35148@r{ @: C-x * p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
35149@r{ @: C-x * q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
35150@r{ @: C-x * r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
35151@r{ @: C-x * s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35152@r{ @: C-x * t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35153@r{ @: C-x * u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update-formula@:}
35154@r{ @: C-x * w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
35155@r{ @: C-x * x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35156@r{ @: C-x * y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35157@r{ @: C-x * z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
35158@r{ @: C-x * : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
35159@r{ @: C-x * _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
35160@r{ @: C-x * ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
35161@r{ @: C-x * 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
35162
35163@c
35164@r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
35165@r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
35166@r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
35167@r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
35168@r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@tfn{#}number}
35169@r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
35170@r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
35171@r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35172@r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35173
35174@c
35175@r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
35176@r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
35177@r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
35178
35179@c
35180@r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
35181@r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
35182@r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
35183@r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
35184@r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
35185@r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
35186@r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
35187@r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
35188@r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
35189@r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
35190@r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
35191@r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
35192@r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
35193@r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
35194@r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
35195@r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
35196@r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
35197
35198@c
8dc6104d
JB
35199@r{ ... a@: @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35200@r{ ... a@: @summarykey{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35201@r{... a b@: @summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
35202@r{. a b c@: M-@summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
35203@r{... a b@: @summarykey{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
35204@r{ ... a@: @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35205@r{... a b@: M-@summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
35206@r{ @: M-@summarykey{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
4009494e
GM
35207@r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
35208
35209@c
35210@r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35211@r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
35212@r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
35213@r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
35214@r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35215@r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
35216@r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
35217
35218@c
35219@r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
35220@r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
35221@r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
35222@r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
35223@r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
35224@r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
35225@r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
35226
35227@c
35228@r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
35229@r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
35230@r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
35231@r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
35232@r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
35233@r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
35234
35235@c
35236@r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
35237@r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
35238@r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
35239@r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35240@r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
35241@r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
35242@r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35243
35244@c
35245@r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
35246@r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
35247@r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35248@r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
35249@r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
35250@r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
35251@r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
35252@r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
35253@r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
35254@r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
35255@r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
35256@r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
35257@r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
35258@r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
35259@r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
35260@r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
35261@r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
35262@r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
35263@r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
35264@r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
35265@r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
35266@r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
35267@r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
35268@r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
35269@r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
35270@r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
35271@r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
35272@r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
35273@r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
35274@r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35275@r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
35276@r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
35277@r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
35278@r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
35279@r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
35280@r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
35281@r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
35282@r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
35283@r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
35284@r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
35285@r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
35286@r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
35287@r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35288@r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
35289
35290@c
35291@r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
35292@r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
35293@r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
35294@r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
35295@r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
35296@r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
35297@r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
35298@r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
35299@r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
35300@r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
35301@r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
35302@r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
35303@r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
35304
35305@c
35306@r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35307@r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35308@r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
35309@r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
35310
35311@c
35312@r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
35313@r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
35314@r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
35315@r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
35316
35317@c
35318@r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
35319@r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
35320@r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
35321@r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
35322@r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
35323@r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
35324@r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
35325@r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
35326@r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
35327@r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
35328@r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
35329@r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
35330@r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
35331@r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
35332@r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
35333@r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
35334@r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
35335@r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
35336@r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
35337@r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
35338
35339@c
35340@r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35341@r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35342@r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35343@r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
35344@r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
35345@r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
35346@r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
35347@r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
35348@r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
35349@r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
35350@r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
35351@r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
35352@r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
35353@r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
35354@r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
35355@r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
35356@r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
35357@r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
35358@r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
35359
35360@c
35361@r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
35362@r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
35363@r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
35364@r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35365@r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35366@r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
35367@r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
35368@r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
35369@r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35370@r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35371@r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35372@r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35373@r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
35374@r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
35375@r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
35376
35377@c
35378@r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
35379@r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
35380@r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
35381@r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
35382@r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
35383@r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
35384@r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35385@r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35386@r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
35387@r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
35388@r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
35389@r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
35390@r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
35391@r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
35392@r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
35393@r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
35394@r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35395@r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35396@r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
35397@r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
35398@r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
35399@r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
35400@r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
35401
35402@r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
35403@r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
35404@r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
35405@r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
35406
35407@c
35408@r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35409@r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35410@r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
35411@r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
35412@r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
35413@r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
35414@r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
35415@r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
35416@r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
35417@r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
35418@r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
35419
35420@c
35421@r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
35422@r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
35423
35424@c
35425@r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
35426
35427@c
35428@r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
35429@r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
35430@r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
35431@r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
35432@r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
35433@r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
35434@r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
35435@r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
35436@r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
35437@r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
8dc6104d
JB
35438@r{ @: d @summarykey{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
35439@r{ @: d @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
4009494e
GM
35440
35441@c
35442@r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
35443@r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
35444@r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
35445@r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
35446
35447@c
35448@r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
35449@r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
35450@r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
35451@r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
35452@r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
35453@r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
35454@r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
35455@r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
35456@r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
35457@r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
35458@r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
35459@r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
35460@r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
35461@r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
35462@r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
35463@r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
35464@r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
35465@r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
35466
35467@c
35468@r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
35469@r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
35470@r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
35471@r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
35472@r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
35473@r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
35474@r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
35475@r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
35476@r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
35477@r{ @: d L @: @: 50 @:calc-latex-language@:}
35478@r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
35479@r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
35480
35481@c
35482@r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
35483@r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
35484
35485@c
35486@r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
35487@r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
35488@r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
35489@r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
35490@r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
35491@r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
35492@r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
35493@r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
35494@r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
35495@r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
35496@r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
35497@r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
35498
35499@c
35500@r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
35501@r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
35502@r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
35503@r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
35504@r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
35505@r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
35506@r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
35507@r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
35508@r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
35509@r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35510@r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
35511@r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
35512@r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
35513@r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35514@r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
35515@r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
35516@r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
35517
35518@c
35519@r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
35520@r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
35521@r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
35522@r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
35523@r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
35524@r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
35525@r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
35526@r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
35527@r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
35528@r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
35529@r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
35530@r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
35531@r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
35532@r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
35533@r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
35534@r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
35535@r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
35536@r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
35537@r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
35538
35539@c
35540@r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
35541@r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
35542@r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
35543@r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
35544@r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
35545@r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
35546@r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
35547@r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
35548@r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
35549@r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
35550@r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
35551@r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
35552@r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
35553@r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
35554@r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
35555@r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
35556
35557@c
35558@r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
35559@r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
35560@r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
35561
35562@c
35563@r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
35564@r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
35565@r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
35566@r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
35567@r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35568@r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
35569@r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
35570@r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35571@r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35572@r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
35573
35574@c
35575@r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
8dc6104d
JB
35576@r{ @: j @summarykey{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
35577@r{ @: j @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
4009494e
GM
35578@r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
35579@r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
35580@r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
35581
35582@c
35583@r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
35584@r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
35585@r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
35586@r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
35587@r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
35588
35589@c
35590@r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
35591@r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
35592@r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
35593@r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
35594@r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
35595@r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
35596@r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
35597@r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
35598@r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
35599@r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
35600@r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
35601@r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
35602@r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
35603@r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
35604
35605@c
35606@r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
35607@r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
35608@r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
35609@r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
35610@r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
35611@r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
35612@r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
35613@r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
35614@r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
35615@r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
35616@r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
35617@r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
35618
35619@c
35620@r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
35621@r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
35622@r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
35623@r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
35624@r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
35625@r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
35626@r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
35627@r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
35628@r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
35629@r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
35630@r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
35631@r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
35632@r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
35633@r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
35634@r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
35635@r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
35636@r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
35637@r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
35638@r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
35639@r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
35640
35641@c
35642@r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
35643@r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
35644@r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
35645@r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
35646@r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
35647@r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35648@r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35649@r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
35650@r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
35651@r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
35652@r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
35653@r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
35654@r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
35655
35656@c
35657@r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
35658@r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
35659@r{ @: m e @: @: @:calc-embedded-preserve-modes@:}
35660@r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
35661@r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
35662@r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
35663@r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
35664@r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
35665@r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
35666@r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
35667@r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
35668@r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
35669@r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
35670@r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
35671@r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
35672
35673@c
35674@r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
35675@r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
35676@r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
35677@r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
35678@r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
35679@r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
35680@r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
35681@r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
35682@r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
35683@r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
35684@r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
35685
538c2573
JB
35686@c
35687@r{ @: r s @:register @: 27 @:calc-copy-to-register@:}
35688@r{ @: r i @:register @: @:calc-insert-register@:}
35689
4009494e
GM
35690@c
35691@r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
35692@r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
35693@r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
35694@r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
35695@r{ @: s k @:const, var @: 29 @:calc-copy-special-constant@:}
35696@r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
35697@r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
35698@r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
35699@r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
35700@r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
35701@r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
35702@r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
35703@r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
35704@r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
35705@r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
35706@r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
35707@r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
35708
35709@c
35710@r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
35711@r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
35712@r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
35713@r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
35714@r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
35715@r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
35716@r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
35717@r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
35718@r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
35719@r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
35720@r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
35721@r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
35722@r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
35723
35724@c
35725@r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
35726@r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
35727@r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
35728@r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
35729@r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
35730@r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
35731@r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
35732@r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
35733@r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
35734@r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @tfn{:=} b}
35735@r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @tfn{=>}}
35736
35737@c
35738@r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
35739@r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
35740@r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
35741@r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
35742@r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
35743
35744@c
35745@r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
35746@r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
35747@r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
35748@r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
35749@r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
35750@r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
35751@r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
35752@r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
35753@r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
35754@r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
35755@r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
35756@r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
35757@r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
35758
35759@c
35760@r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35761@r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35762@r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
35763@r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
35764@r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
35765@r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
35766@r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
35767@r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
35768@r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
35769@r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
35770@r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
35771@r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
35772@r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
35773@r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
35774@r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
35775@r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
35776@r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
35777@r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
35778@r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
35779
35780@c
35781@r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
35782@r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
35783
35784@c
35785@r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
35786@r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
35787@r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
35788@r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
35789@r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
35790@r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
35791@r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
35792@r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
35793@r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
35794@r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
35795@r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
35796@r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
35797@r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
35798@r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
35799
35800@c
35801@r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
35802@r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
35803@r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
35804@r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
35805@r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
35806@r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
35807@r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
35808@r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
35809@r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
35810@r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
35811@r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
35812@r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
35813@r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
35814@r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
35815@r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
35816@r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
35817
35818@c
35819@r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
35820@r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
35821@r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
35822
35823@c
35824@r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
35825@r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
35826@r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
35827@r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
35828@r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
35829@r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
35830@r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
35831@r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
35832@r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
35833@r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
35834
35835@c
35836@r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
35837@r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
35838@r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
35839@r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
35840@r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
35841@r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
35842
35843@c
35844@r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
35845
35846@c
35847@r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
35848@r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
35849@r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
35850@r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
35851@r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
35852@r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
35853@r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
35854@r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
35855@r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
35856@r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
35857@r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
35858@r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
35859@r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
35860@r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
35861@r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
35862@r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
35863@r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
35864@r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
35865@r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
35866@r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
35867@r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
35868@r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
35869@r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
35870@r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
35871@r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
35872@r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
35873@r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
35874@r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
35875@r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
35876@r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
35877@r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
35878@r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
35879
35880@c
35881@r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
35882@r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
35883@r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
35884@r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
35885@r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
35886@r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
35887@r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
35888@r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
35889@r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
35890@r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
35891@r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
5a83c46e 35892@r{ m1 m2@: V K @: @: @:kron@:(m1,m2)}
4009494e
GM
35893@r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
35894@r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
35895@r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
35896@r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
35897@r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
35898@r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
35899@r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
35900@r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
35901@r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
35902@r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
35903@r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
35904@r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
35905@r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
35906@r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
35907@r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
35908@r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
35909@r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
35910
35911@c
35912@r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
35913
35914@c
35915@r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
35916
35917@c
35918@r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
35919@r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
35920@r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
35921@r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
35922
35923@c
35924@r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
35925@r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
35926@r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
35927@r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
35928@r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
35929@r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
35930@r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
35931
35932@c
35933@r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
35934
35935@c
35936@r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
35937@r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
35938@r{ @: Z # @: @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
35939
35940@c
35941@r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
35942@r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
35943@r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
35944@r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
35945@r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
35946@r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
35947@r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
35948@r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
35949@r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
35950@r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
35951@r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
35952
35953@end format
35954
35955@noindent
35956NOTES
35957
35958@enumerate
35959@c 1
35960@item
35961Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
35962Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
35963A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
35964@kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
35965
35966@c 2
35967@item
35968Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
35969Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
35970and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
35971
35972@c 3
35973@item
35974Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
35975Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
35976A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
35977
35978@c 4
35979@item
35980Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
35981
35982@c 5
35983@item
35984Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
35985Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
35986
35987@c 6
35988@item
35989A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
35990A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
35991
35992@c 7
35993@item
35994A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
359951=Default, 2=like @kbd{a s}, 3=like @kbd{a e}.
35996
35997@c 8
35998@item
35999A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
36000
36001@c 9
36002@item
36003Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
36004Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
36005
36006@c 10
36007@item
36008Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
36009cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
36010
36011@c 11
36012@item
36013From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
36014
36015@c 12
36016@item
36017Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
36018prefix always clears the mode.
36019
36020@c 13
36021@item
36022Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
36023
36024@c 14
36025@item
36026A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
36027@expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
36028@iftex
36029{@advance@tableindent10pt
36030@end iftex
36031@table @asis
36032@item Integer
36033Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36034@item Float
36035Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36036@item 0.0
36037Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
36038@item Error form
36039Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
36040@item Interval
36041Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
36042@item Vector
36043Random element from the vector.
36044@end table
36045@iftex
36046}
36047@end iftex
36048
36049@c 15
36050@item
36051A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
36052to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
36053
36054@c 16
36055@item
36056A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
36057time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
36058
36059@c 17
36060@item
36061A prefix argument specifies a day number (0-6, 0-31, or 0-366).
36062
36063@c 18
36064@item
36065If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
36066the new units.
36067
36068@c 19
36069@item
36070With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
36071input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
36072
36073@c 20
36074@item
36075With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
36076@texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
36077@infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
36078matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
36079
36080@c 21
36081@item
36082The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
36083argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
36084from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
36085a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
36086
36087@c 22
36088@item
36089The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
36090desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
36091or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
36092@kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
36093be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
36094may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
36095last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
36096prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
36097stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
36098
36099@c 23
36100@item
36101One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
36102by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
36103reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
36104entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
36105@code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
36106or @code{d} for ``down.''
36107
36108@c 24
36109@item
36110The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
36111is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
36112(for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
36113prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
36114may be an integer or a vector of integers.
36115@iftex
36116{@advance@tableindent-20pt
36117@end iftex
36118@table @cite
36119@item -1
36120(@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
36121@item -2
36122(@var{2}) Polar complex number.
36123@item -3
36124(@var{3}) HMS form.
36125@item -4
36126(@var{2}) Error form.
36127@item -5
36128(@var{2}) Modulo form.
36129@item -6
36130(@var{2}) Closed interval.
36131@item -7
36132(@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
36133@item -8
36134(@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
36135@item -9
36136(@var{2}) Open interval.
36137@item -10
36138(@var{2}) Fraction.
36139@item -11
36140(@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
36141@item -12
36142(@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
36143@item -13
36144(@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
36145@item -14
36146(@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
36147@item -15
36148(@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
36149@end table
36150@iftex
36151}
36152@end iftex
36153
36154@c 25
36155@item
36156A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
36157prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
36158the input vector.
36159
36160@c 26
36161@item
36162The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
36163
36164@c 27
36165@item
36166Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
36167
36168@c 28
36169@item
36170Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
36171
36172@c 29
36173@item
36174Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
36175
36176@c 30
36177@item
36178Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
36179@key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
36180buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
36181of the result of the edit.
36182
36183@c 31
36184@item
36185The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
36186
36187@c 32
36188@item
36189Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
36190
36191@c 33
36192@item
36193With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
36194prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
36195
36196@c 34
36197@item
36198Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
36199prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
36200non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
36201backward by that many lines.
36202
36203@c 35
36204@item
36205Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
36206parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
36207parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
36208region between point and mark as a single formula.
36209
36210@c 36
36211@item
36212Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
36213prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
36214A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
36215prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
36216
36217@c 37
36218@item
36219A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
36220
36221@c 38
36222@item
36223Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
36224later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
36225
36226@c 39
36227@item
36228Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
36229@expr{v - v_0}.
36230
36231@c 40
36232@item
36233With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
36234common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
36235@expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
36236contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
36237@expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
36238
36239@c 41
36240@item
36241With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
36242
36243@c 42
36244@item
36245With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
36246With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
36247
36248@c 43
36249@item
36250With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
36251value for this graph.
36252
36253@c 44
36254@item
36255With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
36256
36257@c 45
36258@item
36259Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
36260number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
36261otherwise.
36262
36263@c 46
36264@item
36265Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
36266entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
36267delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
36268in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
36269stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
36270causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
36271of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
36272to evaluate variables.
36273
36274@c 47
36275@item
36276The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
36277Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
36278assigns
36279@texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
36280@infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
36281
36282@c 48
36283@item
36284Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
36285variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
36286independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
36287takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
36288and a vector from the stack.
36289
36290@c 49
36291@item
36292With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
36293destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
36294
36295@c 50
36296@item
36297All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
36298The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
36299entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
36300
36301@c 51
36302@item
36303A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
36304default 2D resolution.
36305
36306@c 52
36307@item
36308This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
36309@var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
36310@var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
36311grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
36312@end enumerate
36313
36314@iftex
36315(Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
36316@page
36317@endgroup
36318@end iftex
36319
36320
36321@c [end-summary]
36322
36323@node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
36324@unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
36325
36326@printindex ky
36327
36328@node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
36329@unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
36330
36331Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
36332@kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
36333types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
36334@kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
36335
36336@printindex pg
36337
36338@node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
36339@unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
36340
36341This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
36342expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
36343@samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
36344@iftex
36345All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
36346Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
36347@end iftex
36348
36349@printindex tp
36350
36351@node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
36352@unnumbered Concept Index
36353
36354@printindex cp
36355
36356@node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
36357@unnumbered Index of Variables
36358
36359The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
36360as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
36361corresponding Lisp variable.
36362
36363The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
36364in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
36365
36366@printindex vr
36367
36368@node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
36369@unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
36370
36371The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
36372@code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
36373the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
36374@samp{math-}.
36375
36376@printindex fn
36377
36378@bye
36379
36380
36381@ignore
36382 arch-tag: 77a71809-fa4d-40be-b2cc-da3e8fb137c0
36383@end ignore